Combined - Out Icai MCQ
Combined - Out Icai MCQ
Combined - Out Icai MCQ
4 Embracing IT will enable Auditors provide Consulting and Assurance services to an enterprise in the areas of
A. IT Risk Management
B. IT Strategic Planning
C. IT Security Management
D. All of the above.
5 An IS Auditor auditing the on-line transaction processing system of an organization outsourced to a third party
will be most concerned that
A. Transactions are authorized by the outsourced agency.
B. Transaction log is not printed on daily basis.
C. Organization does not have adequate trained IT personnel.
D. The third party is providing outsourced services to other clients also.
ANSWERS
1 C
2 C
3 B
4 D
5 A
Module: 1, Primer on Information Technology – Facilitated e-Learning
3 Which of the following is a tool that helps in predicting future trends & behaviors, allowing business managers
to make proactive, knowledge driven decisions
A. Data warehouse
B. Data mining
C. Data marts
D. Data Dictionary
6 E-commerce is:
A. Any electronic communication between a Company and its shareholders
B. Organization using electronic media to link to its employees
C. Conduct of business activities over computer networks electronically.
D. The use of electronic communications for all business processes.
ANSWERS
1 D
2 C
3 B
4 B
5 D
6 C
Module: 1, Primer on Information Technology – Facilitated e-Learning
1 C
2 D
3 D
4 B
5 D
Module: 1, Primer on Information Technology – Facilitated e-Learning
2 Which of the following refers to a normal operational activity for conduct of business?
A. DSS
B. Expert Systems
C. Artificial Intelligence
D. Transaction Processing Systems
5 Which of the following systems is used to present high-level overview of information as well as the ability to
drill down to details for senior managers?
A. Decision support system
B. Executive support system
C. Expert support system
D. Transaction-processing system
ANSWERS
1 B
2 D
3 A
4 C
5 B
Module: 1, Primer on Information Technology – Facilitated e-Learning
Questions
1. Initial adoption of Business Model adopted by an organisation is dependent upon:
A. Business Applications
B. Business Objective
C. Controls in business applications
D. Business Laws
A. Business Application
B. Business Controls
C. Business Model
D. Business Laws
A. A, B, C, D
B. D, A, B, C
C. D, C, B, A
D. B, C, D, A
4. ISACA ITAF 1202, states IS auditor needs the following for an enterprise:
A. Inherent Risk and Audit Risk.
B. Detection Risk and Control Risk.
C. Subject matter risk and Audit risk.
D. None of above
Module 6
2. C. Business Model, needs to be assessed first by IS Auditor. The, b and d, are assessment to be
made later on. As an IS Auditor it becomes important to understand the business model adopted by
an organisation for a better understanding of risk associated with business model adopted by an
organisation.
4. B ISACA ITAF 1202, states IS auditor needs to consider subject matter risk and audit risk. Subject
matter risk, relates to business risk, country risk, contract risks. Audit risk, is define as auditor reaching
incorrect conclusion after an audit. The components of audit risk being control risk, inherent risk and
detection risk.
5. A. COBIT 5 can be best described as “Business framework for the governance and management
of enterprise IT by ‘a’. Other answers are part of COBIT framework but not full Framework.
Chapter 2, Part 3: Cases of Application Controls
Questions
1. Application controls shall include all except
2. As per Income Tax Act, 1961 and banking norms, all fixed deposit holders of bank need to submit
their PAN or form 60/61(a form as per Income Tax Act/Rules). Bank in its account opening form, has
not updated the need for form 60/61 in case PAN is not there. This defines which control lapse as per
COBIT.
3. In a public sector bank while updating master data for advances given, the bank employee does
not update “INSURANCE DATA”. This includes details of Insurance Policy, Amount Insured, Expiry
Date of Insurance and other related information. This defines which control lapse as per COBIT.
4. Emailed purchase order for 500 units was received as 5000 units.
5. An IS Auditor, processes a dummy transaction to check whether the system is allowing cash
payments in excess of Rs.20,000/-. This check by auditor represents which of the following evidence
collection technique?
6. While auditing e-commerce transactions, auditor’s key concern includes all except:
A. Authorisation
B. Authentication
C. Author
D. Confirmation
7. RBI instructed banks to stop cash retraction in all ATMs across India from April 1, 013. This was
result of few ATM frauds detected. This action by RBI can be best classified as:
A. Creation
B. Rectification
C. Repair
D. None of above
9. Company’s billing system does not allow billing to those dealers who have not paid advance amount
against proforma invoice. This check is best called as:
A. Limit Check
B. Dependency Check
C. Range Check
D. Duplicate Check
Chapter 2, Part 3: Cases of Application Controls
10. While posting message on FACEBOOK, if user posts the same message again, FACEBOOK
gives a warning. The warning indicates which control.
A. Limit Check
B. Dependency Check
C. Range Check
D. Duplicate Check
Module 6
2. A. is the correct answer as the source data capture is not proper. Ensure that source documents
are prepared by authorised and qualified personnel following established procedures, taking into
account adequate segregation of duties regarding the origination and approval of these documents.
Errors and omissions can be minimised through good input form design.
3. C. This ensures that transactions are accurate, complete and valid. Validate data that were input,
and edit or send back for correction as close to the point of origination as possible.
4. D. is the correct answer. As per COBIT, where transactions are exchanged electronically,
establish an agreed-upon standard of communication and mechanisms necessary for mutual
authentication, including how transactions will be represented, the responsibilities of both parties
and how exception conditions will be handled.
5. D. IS Auditor may process test data on application controls to see how it responds.
6. C. Is correct. Others are key concerns of an IS auditor while auditing e-commerce transactions.
7. B. is the right answer. A, is not an answer as action by RBI is based on fraud detection. Repair is
done to rectify an error which has occurred in a working system.
8. D. is the correct answer. The other options are related to non-repudiation. A, is definition of word.
B, digital signatures create non-repudiation. E-commerce transactions need it (non-repudiation) for
execution of contract.
9. B. Dependency check is one where value of one field is related to that of another.
Questions
1. The best way to define the purpose for an IS Audit in one word:
A. Assurance
B. Activity
C. Review
D. Performance
2. What is the primary basis of audit strategy? It should be based on:
A. knowledge.
B. life-cycle.
C. user-request
D. risk assessment.
3. Which of the following audit tools is MOST useful to an IS auditor when an audit trail is required?
A. User Controls
B. Application Control
C. Input Control
D. Output Control
6. An employees has left the company. The first thing to do is to:
8. Common features in ISACA ITAF 401, SA 700 and NFRA (National Financial Reporting Authority)
is.
A. Reporting
B. Auditing
C. Accounting
D. Standard
2. D. Audit Strategy is based on risk assessment done by the auditor. Other answers do not represent
basis for deciding audit strategy.
3. D. Snapshots is the right answer as in this technique IS auditor can create evidence through IMAGE
capturing? A snapshot tool is most useful when an audit trail is required. ITF can be used to
incorporate test transactions into a normal production run of a system. CIS is useful when transactions
meeting certain criteria need to be examined. Audit hooks are useful when only select transactions or
processes need to be examined.
4. A. is the first step towards compliance test. Other steps are more part of application system
transaction audit.
5. A. user controls are not properly defined. User controls need to be defined based on NEED TO DO
and NEED TO DO basis. The above is reflection of a greater problem of improper assessment user
profiles created in the system.
6. B. the first thing to do as soon as an employee leaves the company is to disable his/her access
rights in system. This needs to be done to prevent frauds being committed. Other answers may be
valid but are not the first thing to do.
C is the correct answer other options are components of SQL.
7. D. ISACA ITAF is a reporting standard by ISACA. SA 700 is a reporting standard by ICAI. NFRA is
an authority created in the new Companies act, to prescribe standard for accounting and auditing.
Chapter 1 Concepts of Governance and Management of Information Systems
Questions
1. Who is responsible for establishing right structure of decision-making accountabilities?
A. Senior management
B. Operational management
C. Chief information officer
D. IT steering committee
8. The effectiveness of the IT governance structure and processes are directly dependent
upon level of involvement of
A. Heads of Business units
B. Internal auditor department
C. Technology management
D. Board/senior management
10. Which of the following is the primary objective for implementing ERM?
A. Implement right level of controls.
B. Better availability of information.
C. Tighter security at lower cost.
D. Implement IT best practices.
Chapter 1 Concepts of Governance and Management of Information Systems
Questions
1. The most important requirement for IT governance function to be effective is:
A. Monitoring
B. Evaluation
C. Directing
D. Managing
6. Designing and implementing a control to reduce the likelihood and/or impact of risk
materializing is a:
A. Risk acceptance
B. Risk transfer
C. Risk treatment
D. Risk transfer
Module 3
8. Which of the following is primary reason for periodic review of risk? The changes in:
A. risk factors
B. risk appetite
C. budget
D. risk strategy
10. Which of the following is the most essential action after evaluation of inherent risks?
A. Evaluate implemented controls.
B. Update risk register.
C. Prepare heat map.
D. Prioritized evaluated risk.
Chapter 2: GRC Frameworks and Risk Management Practices
Questions
1. Which of the following scenarios has the highest impact?
A. Absence of business continuity plan.
B. Absence of Security operations center.
C. Absence of monitoring of SLA.
D. Absence of risk management process.
2. Which of the following is the best strategy to address the risk of non-compliance?
A. Maintain inventory compliance requirements.
B. Embedding risk of non-compliance in operations.
C. Appointing chief compliance officer.
D. Implement IT governance framework.
5. Which of the following is main benefit of implementing GRC framework with organization?
A. Reduction in compliance expenditure
B. Assurance on compliance and controls
C. Reduction in internal audit cycles over year
D. Availability of compliance status dashboard
Module 3
8. Which of the following is first step in implementing GRC framework with organization?
A. Perform IT risk assessment
B. Identify internal policy requirements
C. Determining critical success factors
D. Perform control gap analysis
9. Primary objective of implementing legal and regulatory requirement framework like SOX or
clause 49 is to:
A. Make management accountable
B. Protect stakeholder’s interest
C. Get assurance on internal controls
D. Facilitate trading on stock exchanges
Questions
1. Which of the following is most important resource of the organization?
A. Policies and procedures
B. IT infrastructure and applications
C. Information and data
D. Culture, ethics and behaviour
10. Which of the following is best control for building requisite skills and competencies within
organization?
A. Hiring only highly qualified people
B. Outsourcing the critical operations
C. Conducting skill enhancement training
D. Defining skill requirements in job description
Chapter 4: Key Enablers of GEIT
Questions
1. Which of the following is best approach for monitoring the performance of IT resources?
A. Compare lag indicators against expected thresholds
B. Monitor lead indicators with industry best practices
C. Define thresholds for lag indicators based on long term plan
D. Lead indicators have corresponding lag indicator.
2. Performance monitoring using balance score card is most useful since it primarily focuses
on:
A. Management perspective
B. Product and services
C. Customer perspectives
D. Service delivery processes
4. The PRIMARY objective of base lining IT resource performance with business process
owners is to:
A. define and implement lead and lag indicators.
B. ensure resource planning is aligned with industry.
C. assess cost effectiveness of outsourcing contracts.
D. benchmark expected performance measurement.
B. Ensuring availability
C. Conducting training programs
D. Information security issues
8. Which of the following is the PRIMARY purpose of optimizing the use of IT resources within
an enterprise?
A. To increase likelihood of benefit realization.
B. To ensure readiness for future change.
C. To reduce cost of IT investments.
D. To address dependency on IT capabilities.
10. Organization considering deploying application using cloud computing services provided by
third party service provider. The MAIN advantage of this arrangement is that it will:
A. minimize risks associated with IT
B. help in optimizing resource utilization.
C. ensure availability of skilled resources.
D. reduce investment in IT infrastructure.
Chapter 5: Performance Management Systems
reduce investment in IT, i.e. it may reduce need for acquisition of IT infrastructure, but there
is cost associated with outsourcing and there is additional cost for SLA monitoring.
Chapter 6: Implementing Governance and Management Practices
Questions
1. Which of the following is MOST critical for implementing GEIT?
A. Obtaining financial budget for IT
B. Building business case for implementation.
C. Creating the right environment.
D. Documenting the enterprise architecture
2. Which of the following principles are MOST relevant for Governance domain?
A. Plan, Do, Check and Act
B. Evaluate, Direct and Monitor
C. Plan, Build, Run and Monitor
D. Four dimensions of Balanced Scorecard
4. Which of the following is MOST critical for ensuring sustained alignment of IT strategic
plans? The IT strategic plans provide:
A. direction to IT department on deployment of information systems
B. key functionaries are involved in development and implementation.
C. IT long and short-range plans are communicated to stakeholders.
D. feedback is captured, reported and evaluated for inclusion in future IT planning.
7. In order to ensure that IT strategic plan is successful, the organization first ensure that the
plan:
A. focuses on optimization of cost.
B. is aligned with business strategy
C. provides direction for IT deployment
D. consists of long and short term goals
9. Which of the following is most important to be included in SLA, while considering the
outsourcing of IT operation to cloud service provider?
A. Ownership of information
B. Periodic audit reports
C. Logical access controls
D. Reduction in operational costs
10. Which of the following is primary input for IT resource capacity management planning?
A. Annual financial budget for IT
B. IT resource acquisition plan
C. Number of databases in use
D. Expected growth of business
Chapter 6: Implementing Governance and Management Practices
2. B. Governance domain is built on the three principles of Evaluate, Direct and Monitor. PDCA is
pertaining to continuous improvement initiatives. PBRM is pertaining to management domain. The
four dimensions of Balanced Scorecard are useful in translating strategy into action. They are useful
aid in implementing Governance as measure of performance management but they are not principles
of Governance.
4. D. Capturing, reporting and evaluating feedback for inclusion in future IT planning is MOST critical
for ensuring sustained alignment of IT strategic plans as this provides metrics for monitoring and also
ensuring that the performance is maintained not only for the current but also for the future. Top
management shares the enterprise strategy based on which IT strategy is prepared by the IT
department. There is no direction to IT department on deployment of information systems provided
as part of IT strategic planning. The involvement of key functionaries in development and
implementation is critical to ensure success but it is required in the initial stages. However, this does
not guarantee the sustainability of the initiative. The communication of IT long and short-range plans
is important to get buy-in and to keep all stakeholders informed but this is only a reporting process.
6. B. The key benefit of capacity management is to ensure that not just the current but the future
business requirements are met in a cost-effective manner. Capacity management looks at both long-
term as well as short-term business goals in a cost effective and timely manner. Defining, describing
Module 3
and maintaining relationships between key resources and capabilities is a primary requirement of
capacity management and not a benefit. Assessing the impact of changes and deal with service
incidents is one of the benefits of capacity management but compared to option A, this is not a key
benefit.
7. B. IT strategic plan must be aligned with business strategic plan in order to maximize benefit
realization, optimize cost, provide direction to management and consist of long term and short term
goals.
8. C. Most IT initiatives are approved based on cost and benefits indicates that the IT strategy is
focused on benefit realization. B Indicated focus in on cost reduction. A indicates that IT initiatives
does not achieve expected benefits and D indicates that IT services are just enough.
10. D. Expected growth of business is primary input for capacity planning of IT resources. IT resources
must fulfil the business requirements. Other options depends on expected business growth.
Module 2
Questions
1. Who among the following is responsible for establishing IS Audit function in the organisation?
A. Audit Charter
B. Audit Governance
C. Audit Objectives
D. Audit Project Plan
2. Which of the following control classifications identify the cause of a problem and minimize the impact of
threat?
A. Administrative Controls
B. Detective Controls
C. Preventive Controls
D. Corrective Controls
4. Which of the following are most commonly used to mitigate risks discovered by organizations?
A. Controls
B. Personnel
C. Resources
D. Threats
6. What means the rate at which opinion of the IS Auditor would change if he selects a larger sample size?
A. Audit Risk
B. Materiality
C. Risk Based Audit
D. Controls
8. After you enter a purchase order in an on-line system, you get the message, “The request could not be
processed due to lack of funds in your budget”. This is an example of error?
A. Detection
B. Correction
1
Chapter 1: Concepts of IS Audit
C. Prevention
D. Recovery
9. When developing a risk-based audit strategy, an IS auditor should conduct a risk assessment to ensure
that:
A. controls needed to mitigate risks are in place.
B. vulnerabilities and threats are identified.
C. audit risks are considered.
D. a gap analysis is appropriate
10. Reviewing management's long-term strategic plans helps the IS auditor:
2. Corrective Controls classifications identify the cause of a problem and minimize the impact of threat. The
Goal of these controls is to identify the root cause of an issue whenever possible and eliminate the
potential for that occurring again. The other controls are useful but perform other functions instead.
3. Scoping risk is not generally considered as category of audit risk. The other risk categories are also
possible types of risk; however they are not the one that question demand.
4. Controls are most commonly used to mitigate risks discovered by organizations. This is what
organizations implement as a result of the risks an organization discovers. Resources and personnel are
often expended to implement controls.
5. Administrative is not a type of internal controls. Detective is designed to detect errors or irregularities that
may have occurred. Corrective is designed to correct errors or irregularities that have been detected.
Preventive is designed to keep errors or irregularities from occurring.
6. Audit risk means the rate at which opinion of the IS Auditor would change if he selects a larger sample
size. Audit risk can be high, moderate or low depending on the sample size selected by the IS Auditor. A
risk based audit approach is usually adapted to develop and improve the continuous audit process.
Materiality means importance of information to the users. It is totally the matter of the professional
judgment of the IS Auditor to decide whether the information is material or immaterial.
7. Inherent risk means overall risk of management which is on account of entity’s business operations as a
whole. Controllable risk is the risk present in the internal control system and the enterprise can control
this risk completely and eliminate it form the system. Detection risk is the risk of the IS Auditor when he
is not able to detect the inherent risk or the controllable risk.
8. To stop or prevent a wrong entry is a function of error prevention. All other options work after an error.
Prevention works before an occurring of error.
9. In developing a risk-based audit strategy, it is critical that the risks and vulnerabilities are understood.
This will determine the areas to be audited and the extent of coverage. Understanding whether
2
Module 2
appropriate controls required to mitigate risks are in place is a resultant effect of an audit. Audit risks are
inherent aspects of auditing, are directly related to the audit process and are not relevant to the risk
analysis of the environment to be audited. Gap analysis would normally be done to compare the actual
state to an expected or desirable state.
10. Strategic planning sets corporate or departmental objectives into motion. Strategic planning is time and
project-oriented, but must also address and help determine priorities to meet business needs. Reviewing
long-term strategic plans would not achieve the objectives expressed by the other choices.
3
Module 2
Questions
1. The IS Auditor should use which of the following when developing the overall IS Audit Plan and
determining priorities for the effective allocation of IS Audit Resources?
A. Audit Materiality
B. The work of outside experts
C. Risk Assessment
D. IT Governance
2. Which of the following sampling types is used to estimate the rate of occurrence of a specific quality in
population?
A. Discovery Sampling
B. Statistical Sampling
C. Attribute Sampling
D. Stop-or-go Sampling
3. Which of the following criteria for selecting the applications to be audited is LEAST likely to be used?
A. Materiality of audit risk
B. Sensitivity of transactions
C. Technological complexity
D. Regulatory agency involvement
4. The first step the IS Audit Manager should take when preparing the annual IS audit plan is to:
A. Meet with the audit committee members to discuss the IS audit plan for the upcoming
year.
B. Ensure that the IS audit staff is competent in areas that are likely to appear on the plan
and provide training as necessary.
C. Perform a risk ranking of the current and proposed application systems to prioritize the IS
audits to be conducted.
D. Begin with the prior year's IS audit plan and carry over any IS audits that had not been
accomplished.
6. While reviewing internal controls in a microcomputer environment, an IS auditor recommends that duties
should be regularly rotated. The effect of implementing this recommendation would ensure which of the
following controls?
A. Detective
B. Compensating
C. Corrective
D. Preventive
1
Chapter 2: IS Audit in phases
7. Which of the following is the least important factor in determining the need for an IS Auditor to be involved
in a new system development project?
A. The cost of the system
B. The value of the system to the organization.
C. The potential benefits of the system.
D. The number of lines of code to be written.
9. Which of the following types of audits requires the highest degree of data processing expertise?
A. Systems software audits
B. General controls reviews
C. Microcomputer application audits
D. Mainframe application audits
1. C. The IS Auditor should use Risk Assessment while developing an overall IS Audit Plan. The other
examples are examples of audit standards.
2. C. Attribute sampling is used to estimate the rate of occurrence of a specific quality in population.
The other sampling methods described are legitimate sampling methods often employed by auditors
during audit.
3. C. Because technical complexity of an application is not as important as the materiality of the audit
risk associated with an application or sensitivity of the transactions. Regulatory agency requirements
also play an important role in determining what to audit. Answer "b" is NOT the best choice because
sensitivity of transactions would be an exposure to a company and should be considered in
determining which applications should be audited. Answer "a" is NOT the best choice because the
measurement of audit risk is an important component when determining the scope of an audit
plan. The materiality of the audit risk associated with specific application would have an impact on
whether the application is included in the audit scope. Answer "d" is NOT the best choice because
applications may relate to operational areas of the Company where regulatory agencies have
required audits.
4. C Because IS audit services should be expended only if the risk warrants it. Answers a, b, and d
occur after c has been completed. Answer "b" is NOT correct because the IS Audit Manager does
not know what areas are to appear on the IS audit plan until a risk analysis is completed and
discussions are held with the audit committee members. Answer "a" is NOT correct because the IS
Audit Manager would not meet with the audit committee until a risk analysis of areas of exposure has
been completed. Answer "d" is NOT correct because a risk analysis would be the first step before
any IS audit services are expended.
2
Module 2
5. A. The compliance tests determine whether prescribed controls are working. Answer "b" is NOT the
best choice. Current and accurate documentation may be a good procedure but it is only one type
of control procedure, therefore, answer 'A' is a better choice as more control procedures are
evaluated. Answer "c" is NOT the best choice because segregation of duties is only one type of
control procedure; therefore, answer 'A' is a better choice as more control procedures are
evaluated. Answer "d" is NOT the correct choice. Exposures are defined and quantified to determine
audit scope. Compliance tests provide reasonable assurance that controls are working as
prescribed.
6. B. A small institution may find that separation of duties (which is a preventative control) may not be
practical since there are too few employees. In such a circumstance, it may be possible to establish
an acceptable control environment by instituting compensating measures such as rotation of job
duties.
7. D. The size of the system is the least important of the factors listed. All other factors have specific
financial implications and an IS Auditor can be used to help mitigate the risk to the corporation with
the development of a new system.
8. C. Balancing of daily control totals relates to specific applications and is not considered an
overall general control concern. Answer "b" is NOT the best answer since documentation
procedures within the IS Department is an important general control concern. Answer "a" is NOT
the best answer since organization of the IS Department is an important general control concern.
Answer "d" is NOT the best answer since physical access controls and security measures are
important general control concerns.
3
Module 2
Questions
1. Which of the following factors should not be considered in establishing the priority of audits included in
an annual audit plan?
A. Prior audit findings
B. The time period since the last audit
C. Auditee procedural changes
D. Use of audit software
2. Which of the following is LEAST likely to be included in a review to assess the risk of fraud in application
systems?
A. Volume of transactions
B. Likelihood of error
C. Value of transactions
D. Extent of existing controls
3. An IS auditor discovers evidence of fraud perpetrated with a manager's user id. The manager had written
the password, inside his/her desk drawer. The IS auditor should conclude that the:
1
Chapter 3: IT enabled services
C. Analyze
D. Present
9. What is also performed to assess the overall objectives within an organization, related to financial
information and assets’ safeguarding, efficiency and compliance?
A. Operational Audit
B. Financial Audit
C. Integrated Audit
D. IS Audits
2. What is designed to evaluate the internal control structure in a given process or area?
A. Operational Audit
B. Financial Audit
C. Integrated Audit
D. IS Audits
3. After initial investigation, IS auditor has reasons to believe that there is possibility of fraud, the IS auditor
has to:
A. Expand activities to determine whether an investigation is warranted.
B. Report the matter to the audit committee.
C. Report the possibility of fraud to top management and ask how they would like to proceed.
D. Consult with external legal counsel to determine the course of action to be taken.
2. B. An error is the least likely element to contribute to the potential for fraud. Answer A and C are
incorrect since volume times value of transactions gives an indication of the maximum potential loss
through fraud. Answer D is incorrect since gross risk less existing control gives net risk.
3. B. The password control weaknesses means that any of the other three options could be true. Password
security would normally identify the perpetrator. In this case, it does not establish guilt beyond doubt.
4. A. Production programs are used for processing an enterprise's data. It is imperative that controls on
changes to production programs are stringent. Lack of control in this area could result in application
programs being modified to manipulate the data. Application programmers are required to implement
changes to test programs. These are used only in development and do not directly impact the live
processing of data. The implementation of changes to batch schedules by operations support staff will
affect the scheduling of the batches only; it does not impact the live data. Database administrators are
required to implement changes to data structures. This is required for reorganization of the database to
allow for additions, modifications or deletions of fields or tables in the database.
5. C. Neural networks can be used to attack problems that require consideration of numerous input
variables. They are capable of capturing relationships and patterns often missed by other statistical
methods, and they will not discover new trends. Neural networks are inherently nonlinear and make no
2
Module 2
assumption about the shape of any curve relating variables to the output. Neural networks will not work
well at solving problems for which sufficiently large and general sets of training data are not obtainable.
6. C. The first step in managing risk is the identification and classification of critical information resources
(assets). Once the assets have been identified, the process moves onto the identification of threats,
vulnerabilities and calculation of potential damages.
7. B. Preserve refers to practice of retrieving identified information and preserving it as evidence. The
practice generally includes the imaging of original media in presence of an independent third party.
8. C. Analyse involves extracting, processing and interpreting the evidence. Extracted data could be
unintelligible binary data after it has been processed and converted into human readable format. The
analysis should be performed using an image of media and not the original.
9. C. An integrated audit combines financial and operational audit steps. An integrated audit is also
performed to assess the overall objectives within an organization, related to financial information and
assets’ safeguarding, efficiency and compliance.
10. A. An operational audit is designed to evaluate the internal control structure in a given process or area.
Audits of application controls or logical security systems are some examples of operational audits.
11. A. An IS auditor's responsibilities for detecting fraud include evaluating fraud indicators and deciding
whether any additional action is necessary or whether an investigation should be recommended. The IS
auditor should notify the appropriate authorities within the organization only if it has determined that the
indicators of fraud are sufficient to recommend an investigation. Normally, the IS auditor does not have
authority to consult with external legal counsel.
3
Module 4
Questions
1: Which of the following shall BEST help in deciding upon the protection level for information asset?
A. Location of asset.
B. Impact of risk.
C. Vulnerabilities in asset.
D. Inventory of threats
3: After a Tsunami, a business decides to shift the location of data centre from coastal area to mid land? Which
type of risk response option it has exercised?
A. Accept
B. Avoid
C. Mitigate
D. Transfer
4: Organizations capacity to sustain loss due to uncertainty and expressed in monetary terms is best known as:
A. Risk appetite
B. Risk tolerance
C. Risk acceptance
D. Risk mitigation
6: Of the following who is accountable for deciding and implementing controls based on risk mitigation plan?
A. Chief risk officer
B. Risk owner
C. IT operations manager
D. Board of directors
7: Which of the following is a risk factor that may have impact on organization?
A. Management decides to acquire new application software.
B. A new application required by organization is released.
C. Vendor decides to stop supporting existing application.
D. Organization retires old application that is not in use.
1
Chapter 1: Information Risk Management and Controls
8: While auditing risk monitoring process which of the following IS auditor should review FIRST?
A. Risk assessment process
B. Risk management framework
C. Alignment with business risks
D. Annual review of risk register
9: The quantum of risk after organization has implemented controls based on risk mitigation plan is:
A. Accepted risk
B. Residual risk
C. Inherent risk
D. Current risk
10: Which of the following shall best help in aligning IT risk with enterprise risk?
A. Presenting IT risk results in business terms.
B. Conducting business impact analysis.
C. Making Chief risk officer accountable.
D. Align IT strategy with business strategy.
2. C: Of the four main risk response options accept, avoid, mitigate and transfer, Insurance cover is a risk
response option of risk transfer
3. B. BY shifting location the business has avoided the risk associated with Tsunami.
4. A. It is the definition of risk appetite. Risk tolerance is capacity to tolerate down time due to risk
materialization. Risk acceptance and risk mitigation are risk response decision based on risk appetite.
5. C. Main use of risk register is to develop risk profile of the organization for management’s review and
enable risk informed decisions.
6. B: Risk owner is primarily accountable for deciding and implementing on nature of controls. Generally
risk owner is process owner. Chief risk office guides risk owner, IT head is responsible for responding to
risk owned by IT head. Although board of directors is ultimately accountable, for specific risk, risk
owners are responsible.
7. C. Vendor decides to stop supporting existing software changes the market situation that will affect
organization, since it has to take decision on replacing application. Release of new application though
changes market, it may not affect the organization immediately as the organization may not need to
take action. A and D are internal decisions and will be based after risk assessment hence are not risk
factors.
8. D. Risk monitoring refers to review of identified and assed risks based on changes, incidents, and
periodically. Other options are part of risk management framework.
2
Module 4
9. B. Accepted risk is where controls are not implemented is part of residual risk, Inherent risk is total risk
before implementing controls. Current risk is residual risk at a point in time during control
implementation.
10. A. Expressing IT risk in business terms i.e. as impact on business will help business in understating
relevance of IT risks. Business impact analysis may be useful however it may or may not help
depending upon scope of project. Making chief risk officer accountable may help but best is A. Aligning
IT strategy with business strategy shall help in defining better IT plan, but it is at higher level.
3
Module 4
Questions
1: The Primary objective of implementing Information security management is to:
A. Ensure reasonable security practices.
B. Comply with internal audit requirements.
C. Adopt globally recognized standards.
D. Protect information assets.
3: IT security policies are set of various policies addressing different IT areas based on the IT infrastructure of
organization. Which of the following policy is most common in all organizations?
A. Acceptable use policy
B. BYOD policy
C. Data encryption policy
D. Biometric security policy
7. Which of the following is primary reason for periodic review of security policy?
A. Compliance requirements.
B. Changes on board of directors
C. Changes in environment
D. Joining of new employees.
1
Chapter 2: Information Security Management
9. Which of the following is best evidence indicting support and commitment of senior management for information
security initiatives?
A. Directive for adopting global security standard.
B. Higher percentage of budget for security projects.
C. Assigning responsibilities for security to IT head.
D. Information security is on monthly meeting agenda.
10. Which of the following is a concern for compliance with information security policy?
A. Decrease in low risk findings in audit report
B. High number of approved and open policy exceptions
C. Security policy is reviewed once in two years
D. Security policy is signed by chief information officer
2. B. Policies are vehicle to communicate management’s intent to all stakeholders. Information security
practices are aligned with business objectives and not the strategy. Security policies are defined as outcome
of risk assessment. Compliance with standard is not primary function of policies.
3. C. Acceptable use policy that address the use of IT assets by users is most common in all organizations that
depends upon IT. Policies in other option depend upon organization’s use of BYOD or Encryption or
Biometric.
4. A. Data Diddling is the changing of data before or during entry into the computer system with malicious intent.
5. C. Integrity primarily refers to reliability that is achieved by implementing controls to ensure accuracy and
completeness of data.
6. D. Primary function of IT security steering committee is to direct and guide IT security within organization.
Other functions can be delegated.
7. C. Changes in environment introduce new risks. In order to address them it is necessary to review the security
policy based on assessment of new risks. Other options are secondary reasons
8. D. Main benefit of control self-assessment is process owners are aware of risks and threats impacting desired
outcome of process since they are asked to select and evaluate the controls.
2
Module 4
9. D. Without senior management’s support security cannot be a success. There are many activities senior
management is involved in effective security initiative. Reviewing progress of security in monthly meeting is
one of them. Other options may or may not indicate unless there is more evidence to conclude.
10. B. Policy exceptions are temporary and must be reviewed and closed as per plan. Increasing number of
exceptions indicates that the policy provisions may not be appropriate and hence need to be reviewed. Others
are not concerns.
3
Module 4
Questions
1: Which of the following is Primary purpose of Information classification?
A. Comply with regulatory requirement
B. Assign owner to information asset
C. Provide appropriate level of protection
D. Reduce costs of data protection
5. Which of the following best helps in classifying the information within organizations?
A. using minimum classes in classification schema.
B. Conducting training on classification schema.
C. Labelling all information based on classification schema.
D. Determining storage based on classification schema.
6. A business application is hosted on a server. Being a small application the database required the application is
also on the same server. Which of the following is best way to determine the class of the server?
A. All servers are critical assets for organization
B. Based on classification of application hosted
C. Same as class of database decided by business
D. As decided by data base administrator(DBA)
7. Which of the following is a major threat related to private data of customers collect by the organization?
A. Loss of data
B. Integrity of data
C. Data diddling
D. Identify theft
1
Chapter 3: Information Assets and their Protection
8. Which of the following controls can be implemented effectively due to classification of data?
A. Input validation
B. Access controls
C. Scanning for viruses
D. Internal audit
9. While determining appropriate level of protection to information asset, IS auditor should PRMARILY
focus on which of the following evidence?
A. Results of risk assessment
B. Relative value to business
C. List of users having access
D. Classification of asset
10. Which of the following is PRIMARY consideration for classifying information assets? Assets to be
classified based on:
A. level of protection provided.
B. inputs by data owner.
C. result of risk analysis.
D. requirements of security policy.
2. A. DBA is an Information custodian as DBA is responsible for maintaining database but do not have right to
modify the data.
3 A. Security awareness program helps users and employees to understand reason for security and help in
implementing it effectively. Options B, C and D do not provide information on improvement aspect.
4. C. It helps in assessing the risks associated and determine the protection level i.e. class of information. A, B and
C are determined based on classification.
5. B. Training users on how to classify information as per definition provided in classification schema shall best
help users in classifying the information. A. Number of classes shall depend upon organization’s objectives. C and
D are performed after classification of information.
6. C. The primary asset in this case is data that is being stored and process by the application. The server supports
the data and hence must be classified as per the classification of database owned by business function.
7 D. Misuse of customer’s private data can result in identity theft resulting in making organization liable for losses
and might affect reputation adversely. A, B and C are threats can be managed by internal controls.
8 B. Information classifications help management in implementing better access controls for sensitive information.
Other controls are not related to data classification.
2
Module 4
9 A. Appropriate level of protection to asset is determined based on risk associated with asset based on
vulnerabilities. Results of risk assessment, therefore is primary information IS auditor should review.
Relative value of asset to business is considered while assessing impact of risk associated. Access to
asset is determined based on classification of asset and need to do basis which is determined based on
risk associated. Assets are classified based on result of risk assessment.
10 C. Assets must be primarily classified based on risk associated. Level of protection is to be decided
based on result of risk analysis and not the other way round. Inputs from the owner are useful in assessing
risk for the organization. Security policy provides intent of management however the policies are based
on result of risk analysis.
3
Module 4
Questions
1. Which of the following is first action when a fire detection system raises the alarm?
A. Turn off the air conditioning.
B. Determine type of fire.
C. Evacuate the facility.
D. Turn off power supply
2. Which of the following is most important controls for unmanned data center?
A. Access control for entry and exit for all doors.
B. The humidity levels need not be maintained.
C. The temperature must be at sub-zero level.
D. Halon gas based fire suppression system.
4. Which of the following is main reason for appointing human guards at main entrance of facilities?
A. Address visitors’ requirements to visit.
B. Issue the access cards to visitors.
C. Cost of automation exceeds security budget.
D. Deter the unauthorized persons.
5. Which of the following is major concern associated with biometric physical access control?
A. High acceptability.
B. High false positives.
C. High false negatives.
D. High cost.
6. Which of the following evidence is best to provide assurance on automated environmental controls?
A. Annual maintenance contract with vendor.
B. Simulation testing of devices during audit.
C. Device implementation report by vendor
D. Documented results of periodic testing.
7. What are the problems that may be caused by humidity in an area with electrical devices?
A. High humidity causes excess electricity, and low humidity causes corrosion.
B. High humidity causes power fluctuations, and low humidity causes static electricity.
C. High humidity causes corrosion, and low humidity causes static electricity.
D. High humidity causes corrosion, and low humidity causes power fluctuations.
1
Chapter 4: Physical and Environmental Controls
8. Automated access controls opens doors based on access cards, pins, and/or biometric devices and are
powered by electricity. Which of the following best policy in case of power failure?
A. Keep the door in locked state
B. Open door and appoint guard
C. Find root cause of power failure
D. Arrange for battery backup
9. While selecting site for a data center which of the site is best to be selected?
A. On topmost floor to delay the unauthorised visitor to reach.
B. In the basement not easily accessible to perpetrator.
C. On ground floor do that users can access is easily.
D. On middle floor to strike the balance for above concerns.
10. Which of the following is main reason for not allowing mobile devices into data center?
A. Unauthorized changes and access in configuration.
B. Prevent photography of data center layout.
C. User can provide information to attacker on phone.
D. Mobile devices generate wireless communication.
2. B. Unmanned data center requires strong physical access controls and environmental access controls
too. However most essential are strong access controls. B, C and D are inappropriate controls. Halon is
environmentally hazardous gas.
3. A. Primary purpose of all types of physical access control is to prevent unauthorized entry. Other
objectives are secondary.
4. A. Human guard make decisions and can address visitor’s requirement and direct them appropriately.
Others are supplementary functions.
5. B. False positive is a concern in biometric access security as it results in unauthorized access. Other
option does not result in unauthorized access.
6. D. Automated environmental controls must be tested periodically by expert and provide report on
effective performance of equipment. Simulated tests may not be possible for all controls. AMC is a
contract, periodic testing is performance of contract.
7. C. High humidity can cause corrosion, and low humidity can cause excessive static electricity. Static
electricity can short out devices or cause loss of information.
8. B. Best policy is to keep door open and appoint guard temporarily for monitoring accesses. Keeping
doors locked shall be a problem in evacuation in case of emergency. Finding root cause can be done
independently. Arranging Battery backup after power failure is not right policy.
2
Module 4
9. D. Top floor and basement has risk of seepage and flooding. Ground floor has risk of easy attack.
10. A. Mobile devices can be connected to servers and resulting in unauthorized changes. Other concerns
are secondary.
3
Module 4
Questions
1: Which of the following pair of authentication can be considered as two factor?
A. Password and passphrase
B. Passphrase and PIN
C. Token and access card
D. Access card and PIN
2: Which of the following is primary requirement of granting user access to information asset?
A. Identification
B. Authorization
C. Authentication
D. Need to know
.
3. Mandatory access controls are those controls that are:
A. Based on global standards
B. Defined by security policy
C. Part of compliance requirements
D. Granted by asset owner
5. Which of the following non-compliance with security policy is most difficult to detect or get evidence for?
A. Use of removable media
B. Password sharing by user
C. Access to banned web sites
D. Passing information over phone
6. Which of following processes in user access management is most essential to detect errors and omissions
resulting in unauthorised or excess accesses to users?
A. Identification
B. Authentication
C. Authorization
D. Review
7. While auditing compliance with password policy, IS auditor observed that configuration of password parameters
in system is as per policy. Which of the following the auditor should verify?
A. Review enforcement for sample users.
B. Verify all assets have same configuration.
C. Review log for password configuration.
D. Interview users on policy enforcement.
1
Chapter 5: Logical Access controls
9. Which of the following has been attack to break the user password is difficult to control?
A. Brute Force
B. Dictionary attack
C. Spoofing
D. Social engineering
10. Which of the following is a primary objective of implementing logical access controls?
A. Identify users on the system
B. Fixing accountability of actions
C. Authorize users based on role
D. Compliance with policy
2. A. Identification of user is first and primary requirement of granting access. Next will be authentication method
to be established and finally finding authorization levels based on role that also addresses need to know.
3. B. Mandatory accesses are those controls that are to be applied uniformly across organization and are defined
by security policy. D is discretionary access controls. B and C generally do not specify such requirements.
4. C. Single point of failure is a major concern. One password if compromised, all accesses for that user are
available to perpetrator.
5. B. Password sharing by user is most difficult to get evidence for or detect. Others can be monitored or enforced
using technology.
6. D. Periodic user access review helps in ensuring that all users have appropriate level of accesses. This happens
due to changes in internal environment like role changes, emergency situation, resignation and retiring of
employees. In such situations sometimes revocation of accesses is missed out, and can be corrected during
review.
7. C. Generally automated configuration need not be reviewed for samples except for sample assets. However it
most important to review the password configuration changes for ongoing enforcement of policy.
8. A. Strength of one-time password is that they are active for short time, if user does not login during that time the
password expires. Password is unique for each session and user, however it is not a strength. It can be
communicated by suitable means.
2
Module 4
9. D. Social engineering attacks weakest link that is human. Attacker uses techniques to compel users to reveal
passwords and other confidential information. For example Phishing. Other options are technology based attacks
and can be detected or controlled.
10. B. Primary objective of implementing access controls is to fix accountability on user for their actions. Others
are means to implement access controls not objectives.
3
Module 4
Questions
3. While auditing organization’s network which of the following control IS auditor must verify first?
A. Encrypted communication.
B. Network zoning.
C. Firewall configuration.
D. Penetration test report.
6. The intrusion detection monitoring on a host for data integrity attack by malicious software is a:
A. Technical control
B. Corrective control
C. Detective Control
D. Preventive Control
1
Chapter 6: Network Security Controls
1. A. Other methods are active attacks on network after getting information about networks.
2. C. Message digest is a hash function that helps in confirming integrity of data communicated over network.
3. B. Network segmentation or zoning is first control to implement network security. Other controls depends upon
segmentation.
4. B. Checksum is a type of hash that is used to check integrity of data after communication. It is different that
parity bit that adds an extra bit for each byte and word.
5. C. Primary function of SOC is to collect and monitor logs based on identified rules. It also defines correlation
between various logs and identifies possible incidents which are communicated to respective asset owners. A is
role of security manager, B and D are role of network team.
6. C. Intrusion detection detects the possible intrusion attempt. It does not prevent or corrects it. It is a control
implemented using technology.
7. B. It is most essential to get consent from affected asset owners for before performing test, so that they can
ensure that operations are not affected. Maintaining secrecy shall depend upon type of test. Report must be kept
confidential and accessed only by select few. Test generally is performed when it will have least impact, but is not
most important.
8. A. Most web application attacks like SQL injection can be prevented by validating input which can reject the
attackers input that can exploit vulnerability. Encryption may or may not prevent an attack. Penetration test shall
provide input on vulnerability that must be closed. Access controls may prevent some attacks.
2
Module 4
9. D. Social engineering attack is attack on human and hence no technology can prevent it. It is best prevented by
awareness training.
10. B. Logic bomb can be unintentional due to mistakes of developers going unnoticed.
3
Chapter 1: System Development Life Cycle (SDLC) introduction and Concepts
Questions
1. System development life cycle (SDLC) primarily refers to the process of:
A. Developing IT based solution to improve business service delivery.
B. Acquiring upgraded version of hardware for existing applications.
C. Redesigning network infrastructure as per service provider’s needs.
D. Understanding expectations of business managers from technology.
3. Which of the following is main reason to perform User acceptance testing (UAT)?
A. To train and educate users on features of new solution.
B. To confirm form users that solution meets requirements.
C. To complete formality of sign-off to mark end of project.
D. To finalize the implementation plan for new IT solution.
5. In which of the following phases of SDLC, controls for security must be considered FIRST?
A. Requirement definition
B. Feasibility study
C. System design
D. Implementation
6. IS auditor has been part of SDLC project team. Which of the following situation does not
prevent IS auditor from performing post implementation review? The IS Auditor has:
A. designed the security controls.
B. implemented security controls.
C. selected security controls.
D. developed integrated test facility.
Module 5
3. B. UAT is mainly conducted to confirm from the users and application owners that application
meets their requirements. Sign-off is a formality to be completed only if requirements are met.
Training and implementation planning are different activities which are not dependent on UAT.
4. B. Make or buy decision is the outcome of feasibility study where technical, economical and
social feasibilities are considered.
6. D. Active role of IS auditor in design and development of controls affects the independence.
Hence, IS auditor cannot perform review or audit of the application system. However, developing
integrated test facility within application is not a control, but a facility to be used by auditors in
future. Hence, this does not impact independence of IS auditor.
Chapter 2: Initiating SDLC
Questions
1. An organization has implemented an IT based solutions to support business function. Which
of the following situation shall indicate the need to initiate SDLC project?
A. Vendor has launched a new hardware which is faster.
B. Organizations has unused surplus budget for IT.
C. Regulators have requested additional reports from business.
D. Competitor has launched an efficient IT based service.
3. Which of the following is the primary reason for organization to outsource the SDLC project?
Non-availability of:
A. Skilled resources
B. Budgetary approvals
C. Security processes
D. Infrastructure
4. Which of the following is an example of addressing social feasibility issue in SDLC project?
A. Organization decides to use existing infrastructure.
B. Beta version of application is made available to users.
C. Configuration of purchased software requires more cost.
D. Allowing employees to access social media sites.
5. Which if the following is not an indicator to assess benefit realization for internal application
software developed in-house?
A. Increase in number of customers because of new application.
B. Decrease in audit findings related to regulatory non-compliance.
C. Reduced number of virus attacks after implementing new software.
D. Increase in productivity of employees after implementation.
6. Which of the following requirements for an application to be developed for use by human
resource department are non-functional requirements? The application should:
A. Capture the employee data at the time of hiring.
B. Provide option to all only to edit own information.
C. Capture performance details required for appraisals.
D. Use relational database as backend to store data.
Module 5
2. C. Business case is a document that narrates all aspect including benefit realization, cost and
effort estimates, outcome of feasibility study, available budget. That helps management in
decision on the need of the SDLC project.
3. A. Non availability of skilled resources required for application development is primary reason
for outsourcing the SDLC project. Other reasons can be addressed. i.e. (B) budget can be made
available, (C) security processes can be established. (D) Infrastructure can be acquired,
depending upon design of new application and hence it is not a reason.
4. B. In order to ensure the acceptability by users, beta version of solution is made available to
users. Based on feedback changes are made so that the solution can be socialized. Option A
addresses technical feasibility, Option C addresses economic feasibility. Option D addresses IT
policy that has nothing to do with SDLC.
5. C. Since the application is for internal use and developed in house it has nothing to do with
reduction in virus attacks. This can be benefit realization for anti-virus solution.
Questions
1. Who among the following is responsible for ongoing facilitation of a SDLC project?
A. Project sponsor
B. Project manager
C. Steering committee
D. Board of directors
3. Which of the following primarily helps project manager in mitigating the risk associated with
change in scope of software development project?
A. Change management process
B. Use of prototyping
C. Revising effort estimates
D. Baselining requirements
4. Monitoring which of the following aspect of SDLC project shall help organization in benefit
realization over sustained period of time? The project adhering to:
A. Quality
B. Budget
C. Schedule
D. Methodology
5. Which of the following tools and techniques primarily help in improving productivity of SDLC
project team members?
A. Use of standard methodology
B. Software sizing using FPA
C. Developers’ workbench
D. Appropriate HR policies
6. While performing mid-term review of SDLC project, the IS auditor primarily focuses on:
A. Project risk management process
B. Adherence to the schedule
C. Reviewing minutes of steering committee meeting
D. Cost management is as per budget
Module 5
2. B. Considering the spread of organization the organization shall initiate a program for
implementing ERP, consisting of different project for each location. The program shall be part
of IT program portfolio of organization. Since the decision has been made, feasibility study either
has been completed or shall be initiated as part of program.
3. D. Scope creep of continued changes in requirements during SDLC project is most common
risk. If not properly handled the project may be delayed and benefit realization from the project
shall be affected. The project manager therefore, must freeze the scope by base-lining
requirements. Any change after base-lining shall follow change management process. Change
management process without base-lining may not help. Project manager may or may not use
prototyping for freezing the requirements. Revised effort estimate are applicable after change is
approved.
4. A. Quality is most important aspect for SDLC project, since it minimizes errors that can impact
operations.
5. C. Automated tools help team in improving productivity as these tools help in managing
mundane and structure activities and developers can focus on core activities. Developers’
workbench provides various functions that help in improving productivity. Use of standards help
in following uniform methods and reducing rework. Software sizing is useful in monitoring
productivity. HR policies may help in motivating team but it is secondary.
6. A. Auditor should primarily focus on risk management that will provide inputs on events that
has impact on all aspects of project. Option B, C and D help in confirming the findings from
review of risk management process.
Chapter 4: Different Models and Methods for SDLC
Questions
1. A SDLC project for updating existing application has been initiated, however project
manager has realized that the documentation has not been updated and source code is not
available. Which of the following method shall help the project manager?
A. Business process reengineering
B. Reverse engineering
C. Component based development
D. Agile development method
5. Which of the following model addresses the weakness of waterfall model related to
accommodating changes during development stage?
A. Spiral model
B. Incremental model
C. Validation and verification
D. Web development method
Module 5
6. Which of the following activity is most important for IS auditor conducting mid-term review of
SDLC?
A. Ensure risks associated with development method are controlled.
B. Review appropriateness of development method.
C. Extrapolate the completion time based on current state.
D. Perform code review of programs developed so far.
Chapter 4: Different Models and Methods for SDLC
3. B. The major challenge faced by Agile development is weak documentation of design and
related record. Since it heavily depends upon working in interaction with users, where small
team of experts captures requirements and develops functional code that can be deployed.
4. D. Prototyping helps in finalizing user requirements where users can review the prototype
and confirm if it meets the requirements. This method is used in various models like rapid
application development, agile development, spiral model etc.
5. C. Waterfall model requires finalization of earlier phase before beginning next phase. This
makes it difficult to accommodate subsequent changes. Validation and verification method helps
in overcoming this weakness by introducing iteration during each phase.
6. A. IS auditor should ensure that objectives of organization in initiating SDLC project are met
by confirming that the risks associated with development are controlled.
Chapter 5: System Acquisition Framework
Questions
1. While auditing the software acquisition process the IS auditor PRIMARILY review which of
the following to understand the benefits to the business?
A. System requirement specifications
B. Cost comparison of different products
C. Alignment of IT strategy with business
D. Vendor with lowest cost has been selected
2. While auditing outsourced software development the IS auditor primarily ensure that:
A. vendor selected has experience in similar engagements
B. organization has followed established procurement process
C. outcome of feasibility study has indicated for outsourcing
D. ownership of design and source code has been established
3. Which of the following is primary objective of monitoring activities of vendor hired for
software development?
A. Invoke the penalty clause in contract.
B. Mitigate risk associated with performance.
C. Ensure senior management satisfaction.
D. Monitor third-party resource performance.
4. While acquiring application software the organization has finalized products as follows:
Product Functional requirements coverage User acceptability
A 96% 50%
B 88% 75%
C 80% 95%
D 69% 80%
6. Compliance with terms of license for software purchased is primarily which type of
compliance?
A. Legal
B. Contractual
C. Regulatory
D. Standard
Chapter 5: System Acquisition Framework
2. D. While outsourcing the software development the IS auditor must ensure that the ownership
of developed software is within the organization. In absence of this provision organization may
lose the IPR. Other things are secondary.
3. B. The primary objective of monitoring vendor activities is that the non-performance by vendor
should not impact the organization’s benefit realization plan.
4. C. The effective requirements meeting for each product is A = 48% (96*.50), B = 66%
(88*.75), C = 76 % (80*.95), D = 55% (69*.80)
6. B. Terms of software license are governed by the contract between software vendor and
purchaser. Hence, it is a contractual compliance.
Chapter 6: Implementation and Maintenance
Questions
1. Which of the following process during implementation of banking software is most critical to
minimize the risk associated with frauds?
A. Training and awareness
B. Data conversion
C. Hardware configuration
D. Procedure conversion
2. Which of the following is a major concern for IS auditor while auditing implementation phase
of SDLC project?
A. Requirement of resilient infrastructure are captured during implementation
B. Hardware acquisition has been delayed due delay in procurement process
C. Organization has contracted multiple network service providers for connectivity
D. Organization has decided to use existing site for implementing new solution
3. Who among the following should be primarily responsible for approving changes to
application system?
A. Head of IT department
B. Business process users
C. Application administrator
D. Affected business stakeholders
4. Which of the following method is most useful in implementing an ERP application at multiple
locations of same organization?
A. Parallel
B. Pilot
C. Phased
D. Cut off
5. An organization has developed a web based application for the use of internal users to be
hosted on intranet. Before finalizing and making it live it was decided to make it available to
users for providing feedback. This is an example of:
A. Internal audit
B. Alfa testing
C. Beta testing
D. User training
Module 5
6. A major concern associated with using sanitized old production data for testing new
application is that:
A. User may not provide sign off.
B. Production data may be leaked.
C. Integration testing cannot be performed.
D. All conditions cannot be tested.
Chapter 6: Implementation and Maintenance
4. B. Pilot is method is most useful, as organization can implement application at one location
and run for few days. This will help in finalizing the basic configuration and also learn from post
implementation issues. Once successful the same can be replicated at other locations.
5. C. Beta testing is making product available for user for feedback before launching.
6. D. Production data generally may not cover all paths the data can take and hence system
cannot be tested for all possible cases. Data leakage is not a major concern since data is
sanitized. Options A and C are not concerns.
Questions
1. Organizations consider virtualization primarily to:
A. Optimize resource utilization
B. Eliminate hardware cost
C. Implement cloud application
D. Reduce license requirements
5. Which of the following the organization should consider first while allowing users to access
organization’s data from their own device?
A. Formulating a policy for use of personal devices
B. Selection of encryption appropriate for all devices
C. Savings in cost required for acquiring devices
D. Define uniform configuration for personal device
6. Which of the following controls are most important for big data application?
A. Data encryption
B. Data classification
C. Data access
D. Data analysis
Module 5
3. B. Business case is the first document IS auditor should review to understand the reasons
behind the decision. Business case generally covers feasibility study and requirement analysis.
SLA and vendor selection can be reviewed later.
4. D. Using mobile application helps organization to add service delivery channel that enables
customers to get information anywhere. It may not enhance security, usage of technology may
not be concern for organization and although it may help in match the competition it may not
help in leading in market.
5. A. Organizations considering BYOD, must first formulate policy for usage of such devices so
as to protect the information of organization. Other aspects may be considered based on policy.
6. B. Although most important control for big data application are access controls since data is
stored in denormalized form, access controls need to be implement at data element level. This
can be achieved by data classification. Also encryption controls can be considered for most
sensitive data based on classification so that data analysis controls can be implemented
effectively.
Chapter 8: SDLC Reviews and Audit
Questions
1. The primary reason why post implementation review is not performed immediately after
implementation is to ensure that auditor can review:
A. Change management process based on incidents
B. Measure changes customer satisfaction levels
C. Compare benefits realized with business case
D. Comment of conformance of implementation process
3. While reviewing the prioritization and coordination of SDLC projects and program
management, IS auditor shall FIRST ensure that:
A. Project selection framework is aligned with IT strategy.
B. Risks are identified, monitored and mitigated in time.
C. Projects are completed within stipulated time and budget.
D. Project and program related documentation is available.
5. Which of the following pair of activities IS auditor cannot perform as team member for software
development project?
A. Conduct the midterm review and recommend controls
B. Implement controls and develop integrated test facility
C. Develop a control module and perform unit testing
D. Implement controls and perform post implementation review
6. Which of the following SDLC project related document shall best provide input on design of
controls in application being developed?
A. Project business case and feasibility study
B. PERT, CPM diagrams and Gantt Charts
Module 5
2. B. Increasing number of errors affecting service delivery after implementing new application
indicates that the application contains bugs that are affecting service delivery and is a major
concern. Other options are normal processes and may or may not affect the service delivery.
5. D. Auditor cannot audit a project where auditor has been actively involved in implementation.
6. C. Detail design document shall best provide information on controls that are being embedded
in application being developed. Requirements shall also provide information. However, design shall
ensure that requirements are captured in design.
Chapter 1: BCM, BCP and DRP
Questions
1. An organisation's disaster recovery plan should address early recovery of:
3. Which of the following BEST describes difference between a DRP and a BCP? The DRP:
A. works for natural disasters whereas BCP works for unplanned operating incidents such
as technical failures.
B. works for business process recovery and information systems whereas BCP works
only for information systems.
C. defines all needed actions to restore to normal operation after an un-planned incident
whereas BCP only deals with critical operations needed to continue working after an
un-planned incident.
D. is the awareness process for employees whereas BCP contains procedures to recover
the operation.
4. The MOST significant level of BCP program development effort is generally required during
the:
5. Disaster recovery planning for a company's computer system usually focuses on:
A. Risk
B. Vulnerability
C. Disaster
D. Resilience
7. Which of the following strategy does not encompass disaster recovery plan?
A. Preventive
B. Detective
C. Corrective
D. Administrative
A. Crisis Phase
B. Emergency Response Phase
C. Recovery Phase
D. Restoration Phase
A. Loss of Productivity
B. Loss of Revenue
C. Loss of Human Life
D. Loss of Goodwill & Market Share
Chapter 1: BCM, BCP and DRP
3. C. The difference pertains to the scope of each plan. A disaster recovery plan recovers all
operations, whereas a business continuity plan retrieves business continuity (minimum
requirements to provide services to the customers or clients). Choices A, B and D are
incorrect because the type of plan (recovery or continuity) is independent from the sort of
disaster or process and it includes both awareness campaigns and procedures.
4. A. A company in the early stages of business continuity planning (BCP) will incur the most
significant level of program development effort, which will level out as the BCP program
moves into maintenance, testing and evaluation stages. It is during the planning stage that
an IS Auditor will play an important role in obtaining senior management's commitment to
resources and assignment of BCP responsibilities.
5. D. It is important that disaster recovery identify alternative processes that can be put in place
while the system is not available.
6. C. Disaster is event which interrupts business processes sufficiently to threaten the viability
of the organisation. Risk is a combination of the probability of an event and its consequence.
Vulnerability is the degree to which a person, asset, process, information, infrastructure or
other resources are exposed to the actions or effects of a risk, event or other occurrence.
Resilience is the ability of an organisation to resist being affected by the incident.
7. D. There are three basic strategies that encompass a disaster recovery plan: preventive
measures, detective measures, and corrective measures. Preventive measures will try to
prevent a disaster from occurring. These measures seek to identify and reduce risks.
Detective measures are taken to discover the presence of any unwanted events within the
IT infrastructure. Their aim is to uncover new potential threats. Corrective measures are
aimed to restore a system after a disaster or otherwise unwanted event takes place.
Module 7
9. D. Restoration phase will start with a damage assessment, usually within a day or so of the
disaster, when the cause for evacuation or stopping of operations has ended, normal working
will be restarted. During the Restoration Phase, any damage to the premises and facilities
will be repaired.
C. Protection of human life is of utmost importance and, the overriding principle behind continuity
plans. Rest all are to be considered later.
Chapter 2: Strategies for development of BCP
Questions
1. Which of the following control concepts should be included in a complete test of disaster
recovery procedures?
3. All of the following are security and control concerns associated with disaster recovery
procedures EXCEPT:
4. Which of the following business recovery strategies would require the least expenditure of
funds?
A. Warm site
B. Empty shell
C. Hot site
D. Reciprocal agreement
6. Which of the following would warranty a quick continuity of operations when the recovery
time window is short?
7. For which of the following applications would rapid recovery be MOST crucial?
A. Point-of-sale
B. Corporate planning
C. Regulatory reporting
D. Departmental chargeback
8. Which of the following principles must exist to ensure the viability of a duplicate information
processing facility?
A. The site is near the primary site to ensure quick and efficient recovery is achieved.
B. The workload of the primary site is monitored to ensure adequate backup is complete.
C. The site contains the most advanced hardware available from the chosen vendor.
D. The hardware is tested when it is established to ensure it is working properly.
9. While reviewing the business continuity plan of an organisation, the IS auditor observed that
the organisation's data and software files are backed up on a periodic basis. Which
characteristic of an effective plan does this demonstrate?
A. Deterrence
B. Mitigation
C. Recovery
D. Response
10. As updates to an online order entry system are processed, the updates are recorded on a
transaction tape and a hard copy transaction log. At the end of the day, the order entry files
are backed up onto tape. During the backup procedure, the disk drive malfunctions and the
order entry files are lost. Which of the following are necessary to restore these files?
A. The previous day's backup file and the current transaction tape
B. The previous day's transaction file and the current transaction tape
C. The current transaction tape and the current hardcopy transaction log
D. The current hardcopy transaction log and the previous day's transaction file
Chapter 2: Strategies for development of BCP
2. D. Hot sites can be made ready for operation normally within hours. However, the use of
hot sites is expensive, should not be considered as a long-term solution and does require
that equipment and systems software be compatible with the primary installation being
backed up.
3. D. The inability to resolve system deadlock is a control concern in the design of database
management systems, not disaster recovery procedures. All of the other choices are control
concerns associated with disaster recovery procedures.
4. D. Reciprocal agreements are the least expensive because they usually rely on a
gentlemen's agreement between two firms.
5. D. A UPS typically cleanses the power to ensure wattage into the computer remains
consistent and does not damage the computer. All other answers are features of a UPS.
7. A. A point-of-sale system is a critical online system that when inoperable will jeopardize
the ability of a company to generate revenue and properly track inventory.
8. B. Resource availability must be assured. The workload of the site must be monitored
to ensure that availability for emergency backup use is not impaired. The site chosen
should not be subject to the same natural disaster as the primary site. In addition, a
reasonable compatibility of hardware/software must exist to serve as a basis for backup.
The latest or newest hardware may not adequately serve this need. Testing the site
when established is essential, but regular testing of the actual backup data is necessary
to ensure the operation will continue to perform as planned.
9. B. An effective business continuity plan includes steps to mitigate the effects of a disaster.
To have an appropriate backup plan, an organisation should have a process capability
established to restore data and files on a timely basis, mitigating the consequence of a
disaster. An example of deterrence is when a plan includes installation of firewalls for
information systems. An example of recovery is when a plan includes an organisation's hot
site to restore normal business operations.
Module 7
A. The previous day's backup will be the most current historical backup of activity in the system. The
current day's transaction file will contain all of the day's activity. Therefore, the combination of these
two files will enable full recovery up to the point of interruption.
Chapter 3: Audit of BCP
Questions
1. An IS auditor reviewing an organisation's information systems disaster recovery plan should
verify that it is:
2. Which of the following would an IS auditor consider to be the MOST important to review
when conducting a business continuity audit?
3. Which of the following findings would an IS auditor be MOST concerned about when
performing an audit of backup and recovery and the offsite storage vault?
4. A company performs full back-up of data and programs on a regular basis. The primary
purpose of this practice is to:
5. Which of the following procedures would an IS auditor perform to BEST determine whether
adequate recovery/restart procedures exist?
7. Which of the following offsite information processing facility conditions would cause an IS
auditor the GREATEST concern?
8. Which of the following methods of results analysis, during the testing of the business
continuity plan (BCP), provides the BEST assurance that the plan is workable?
A. Quantitatively measuring the results of the test
B. Measurement of accuracy
C. Elapsed time for completion of prescribed tasks
D. Evaluation of the observed test results
10. Which of the following would be of MOST concern for an IS auditor reviewing back-up
facilities?
2. D. Without data to process, all other components of the recovery effort are in vain. Even in
the absence of a plan, recovery efforts of any type would not be practical without data to
process.
3. C. More than one person would need to have a key to the vault and location of the vault is
important, but not as important as the files being synchronized. Choice A is incorrect
because more than one person would typically need to have a key to the vault to ensure that
individuals responsible for the offsite vault can take vacations and rotate duties. Choice B is
not correct because the IS auditor would not be concerned whether paper documents are
stored in the offsite vault. In fact, paper documents such as procedural documents and a
copy of the contingency plan would most likely be stored in the offsite vault.
4. B. Back-up procedures are designed to restore programs and data to a previous state prior
to computer or system disruption. These backup procedures merely copy data and do not
test or validate integrity. Back-up procedures will also not prevent changes to program and
data. On the contrary, changes will simply be copied. Although backup procedures can ease
the recovery process following a disaster, they are not sufficient in themselves.
6. C. Adequate fire insurance and fully tested backup processing facilities are important
elements for recovery, but without the offsite storage of transaction and master files, it
is generally impossible to recover. Regular hardware maintenance does not relate to
recovery.
7. A. The offsite facility should not be easily identified from the outside. Signs identifying
the company and the contents of the facility should not be present. This is to prevent
intentional sabotage of the offsite facility should the destruction of the originating site be
from malicious attack. The offsite facility should not be subject to the same natural
disaster that affected the originating site. The offsite facility must also be secured and
controlled just as the originating site. This includes adequate physical access controls
such as locked doors, no windows and human surveillance.
9. D. The primary concern is to establish a workable disaster recovery plan which reflects
current processing volumes to protect the organisation from any disruptive incident.
Censuring the deputy CEO will not achieve this, and is generally not within the scope of
an IS Auditor to recommend anyway. Setting up a board to review the plan, which is two
years out of date, may achieve an updated plan, but is not likely to be a speedy operation
and issuing the existing plan would be folly without first ensuring that it is workable. The
best way to achieve a disaster recovery plan in a short timescale is to make an
experienced manager responsible for coordinating the knowledge of other managers,
as established by the audit interviews, into a single, formal document within a defined
time limit.
10. C Adequate fire insurance and fully tested backup processing facilities are important
elements for recovery, but without the offsite storage of transaction and master files, it is
generally impossible to recover. Regular hardware maintenance does not relate to recovery.
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system,
or transmitted, in any form, or by any means, electronic mechanical, photocopying, recording,
or otherwise, without prior permission, in writing, from the publisher.
DISCLAIMER
The views expressed in this material are those of author(s). The Institute of Chartered
Accountants of India (ICAI) may not necessarily subscribe to the views expressed by the
author(s).
The information in this material has been contributed by various authors based on their
expertise and research. While every effort has been made to keep the information cited in this
material error free, the Institute or its officers do not take the responsibility for any
typographical or clerical error which may have crept in while compiling the information
provided in this material. There are no warranties/claims for ready use of this material as this
material is for educational purpose. The information provided in this material are subject to
changes in technology, business and regulatory environment. Hence, members are advised to
apply this using professional judgement. Please visit CIT portal for the latest updates. All
copyrights are acknowledged. Use of specific hardware/software in the material is not an
endorsement by ICAI.
Price : `
ISBN No : 978-81-8441-810-1
2
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. All connecting tubes, hoses, joints, cables and pipelines carrying IT cables
D. All parts of the computer which are complex and hard to understand
KEY B
Justification
A. A, C & D are clearly wrong answers which have no relation to the definition in
paragraph 1.2.6
B. As defined clearly in paragraph 1.2.6
6. The basic sequential steps of the machine cycle performed by the CPU are
_____________
A. Fetch, Decode, Execute and Store
B. Decode, Execute, Store and Fetch
C. Store, Fetch, Decode and Execute
D. Execute, Fetch, Decode and Store
KEY A
Justification
As defined clearly in paragraph 1.3.2
B,C & D are clearly wrong answers which contain the wrong sequence
7. Cache memory ________________
A. Is a large, slow memory which is no longer used in computers
B. Helps bridge speed difference between Registers and Primary Memory
C. Is a virtual memory which is an image of another memory
D. Is a memory where only valuable, secret information is stored
KEY B
Justification
Cache memory is a small & fast memory very much in use even today.
As brought out in paragraph 1.3.3
It is not a virtual memory
It maintains copies of most frequently used data from main memories and not only for
secret information
8. Secondary Memory _______________
3
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
4
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
5
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
6
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
7
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
8
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
9
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
It is access control software which is vested with the responsibility for assigning
ownership of all data for purposes of accountability (para 2.3.2). Data Communications
software generally assists the OS for local and remote terminal access (option B). Utility
programs and defragmenters basically help improve computer efficiency and
performance and have nothing to do with ownership assignment of all data.
26. Access control lists in the OS manage OS Controls. The lowest level of control
that can be exercised is, generally, up to :
A. The level of an individual directory
B. The level of a particular page in a file
C. The level of individual words in a file
D. The level of individual files
KEY D
Justification
Most systems are designed to exercise access control only up to the level of a file and
not below. Hence the choice of D as the right option above and the rejection of the
other options
27. State Yes or No
In a newly formed organization, the System Administrator is faced with requests for
access to particular files from multiple users. On closer scrutiny, he finds that though
the users are different, he is able to detect a pattern whereby individuals handling
particular functions all seek access to the same files. The System Administrator is
aware that, while the individuals handling these functions may change, the actual
functions, by and large, are permanent. He feels that it would be simpler to provide
access control for files to particular functions and would like to know the feasibility of
doing so in the Operating system. What is your view ? Is it possible to provide access to
‘Roles’ which could comprise multiple users, instead of creating individual access
controls for each of the users ? :
A. Yes, it would be possible
B. No, it would not be possible
10
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
Access control lists are widely used with Roles comprising multiple users. The individual
users can keep changing depending upon the roles they take up. Hence, Option A
above is correct.
28. What is the first step in Software acquisition ?
A. Establish criteria for selecting and rejecting alternatives
B. Carry out Cost/Benefit analysis, including make or buy decision
C. Establish scope, objectives background & project charter
D. Determine supplier’s technical capabilities & support services
KEY C
Justification
Without first establishing the scope and objectives, software acquisition may end up
failing on fundamental aspects of meeting end user needs. This would be the starting
point, therefore, for any acquisition exercise. The other options get ruled out by default.
29. What is an Endpoint device ?
A. A device used as a pointer during Power point presentations
B. The key-board or a mouse on a computer
C. A device which identifies the end of each software program
D. An internet-capable computer hardware device on a TCP/IP network
KEY D
Justification
Endpoint devices can be computers, smart phones, thin clients, etc. which have
connectivity to the internet as brought out in option D. The very fact that they have this
connectivity raises concerns of security with respect to possible leakage of information
to the outside world or vulnerability to virus or other malicious software which may
attempt to enter the system from the internet.
30. What is Digital Rights Management ?
A. Management of binary digit codes in the system software
B. Technology used for preventing users from using the content in any manner other
than that permitted by the content provider
C. Conversion of analog records to digital mode
D. Optimization of binary digit codes in application software
11
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
Justification
Digital Rights Management refers to the control on use of copyrighted / IPR material
and, hence, option B is correct. The other options are wrong.
31. Does the Operating system need auditing ?
A. Yes; there is risk of the OS being compromised
B. No; the application software prevents direct access to the OS
C. No; the OS is a robust system which cannot be tampered with
D. No, it is adequate if the application software are audited
KEY A
Justification
Though, in the normal course, end-users to do not have direct access to the OS, they
could find ways of by-passing the application software and reaching out to the OS.
Unlike the application software which has high security features to prevent end users
tampering with data which is not open to them, the OS is relatively more vulnerable
since it sees all data as simple bits/bytes & cannot even distinguish between different
types of data of different criticality
32. Which of the following is the correct sequence of data hierarchy?
A. File, Database, Record, Field, Characters
B. Database, Record, File, Field, Characters
C. Database, File, Record, Field, Characters
D. Database, File, Field, Character, Records
KEY C
Justification
The sequence of hierarchy from higher to lower levels is clearly as per Option C and the
sequence of hierarchy for the other options are, therefore, wrong.
33. What are Characters ?
A. Characters are a group of bytes
B. Characters are a collection of bits
C. Characters are a group of 8 records
D. Characters are a group of 16 records
12
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY B
Justification
Characters are at the lowest in the Data hierarchy and comprise a collection of bits
(Option B). The other options are wrong.
34. What are some of the major outcomes of the non-existence of an efficient
database ?
A. High redundancy and low data integrity
B. Improved data sharing
C. Reduced dependence between data and application software
D. Better linkages between data originating from different sources
KEY A
Justification
An efficient data base can reduce redundancy and improve data integrity (option A).
The absence of a database will hinder data sharing & increase dependence between
data and application software. An efficiently configured database will provide excellent
networking of data from different sources.
35. What is a Database Management System?
A. A set of pre-loaded data relating to specific industries
B. Customer profile data used for managing an organization
C. Software for creation, control & manipulation of a database
D. Hardware specifically designed to handle databases
KEY C
Justification
A database management system is a software which assists in the process of managing
a database as brought out in option C. It is not just a set of data or hardware as
indicated in the other options.
36. What are the major risks of having a Database management system ?
A. Reduced speed of access to records
B. High redundancy & duplication
C. Reduced data integrity
D. Cost and data security threats
13
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
The major risks involved are the cost (including time for implementation of a new
system) and increased vulnerability owing to centralisation of information as indicated in
Option D. Contrary to what is stated in the other options, a database management
system improves speed of access to records, reduces redundancy and improves data
integrity.
37. Which of the following is the logic typical of a Relational Database Management
System ?
A. Records have a one to many relationship in parent/child format
B. Collection of one or more relations in two dimensional table form
C. Records have many-to-many relationship in network form
D. Data is organized in a tree structure, in hierarchical format
KEY B
Justification
The logic behind RDBMS is in table form with domain & entity constraints which ensure
robustness of the system (Option B). The other options relate to the hierarchical and
network types of database and are, hence, wrong..
38. Use of integrity constraints and normalisation is strongly typical of which type of
software?
A. Relational Database Management System
B. Network Database Management System
C. Hierarchical Database Management System
D. Foxpro, Excel systems of spreadsheet
KEY A
Justification:
The use of integrity constraints and normalization is typical of RDBMS and not of the
other three options.
39. Which of the following defines the logical structure of the database, its relations
& constraints ?
A. Internal Schema
B. External Schema
14
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. Conceptual Schema
D. Logic unit in CPU
KEY C
Justification:
It is the Conceptual Schema which defines the logical structure of the database
including its relations and constraints and not the other options indicated.
40. Which of the following is a database language used to define & describe data &
relationships ?
A. Data Manipulation Language or DML
B. Data Control Language or DCL
C. Data Definition Language or DDL
D. Excel and Lotus 123
KEY C
Justification:
DDL is a collection of instructions and commands used to define and describe data and
relationships (Option C). DML, DCL & the spread sheet softwares are not the
appropriate answer.
41. Which of the following are typical features of Data Definition Language?
A. Not used by Database administrators or designers
B. SQL commands dealing with data
C. Generally used by a common user
D. Used to define both conceptual & internal schemas
KEY D
Justification:
DDL is a database language used by administrators and designers to define both
conceptual & internal schemas. It does not deal with data but only with the structure. It
is generally not used by the common user. Hence, only Option D is correct.
42. Which of the following are typical of Data Manipulation Language ?
A. Cannot be used for querying the database
B. Used to retrieve, insert, delete or modify data
C. SQL commands which do not allow changing of data
15
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
16
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Centralized deployment strategy uses a central database with all user communication
being directed to it. Decision making, too, therefore, gets centralized as a consequence
(Option C). Such a strategy use of a single hardware/software platform & a single
server; hence, the other options are not correct.
46. An important drawback of Centralised Deployment Strategy is _________________
A. Vulnerability to single point of failure
B. Resource sharing of reduced order
C. Poorer economies of scale
D. Reduced security
KEY A
Justification
Centralized deployment strategy concentrates all its resources at one central point
making it vulnerable to total system failure in the event of this central point being
compromised in any manner (Option A). Resource sharing, in fact, is a strong plus point
for centralised deployment. Similarly, this system has better economies of scale owing
to use of large size hardware & larger number of software licences. Since everything is
centralized, possibilities of leakages are reduced since the number of exposed points
are lesser. Hence, the other options are not correct.
47. An important feature of Decentralized deployment strategy would be
_____________
A. Information systems would be more compatible
B. Reduced duplication of records, processes
C. Business strategy based localisation of database possible
D. Adequate centralised control through security implementation
KEY C
Justification
The single major advantage of decentralized deployment strategy is its potential for
tweaking the database to suit local requirements (Option C). However, compatibility of
information systems may take a hit since multiple versions could be involved depending
upon the geographic or business segment-wise spread of the organization. Risk of
duplication of records is higher since multiple versions at different locations may be
involved. Centralized control and security management would also be to a reduced
extent. Hence, the other options are not correct.
17
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
18
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
A near-site facility is normally used as a data replication facility only (Option A). It would
not be a prudent choice for a disaster recovery facility since, as a proximate location,
the probability of its getting exposed to the same geographical risks is very high. In the
usual course, no separate facility is created for secondary data or for employee data
alone. Hence, the other options are not correct.
51. Configuration Identification involves ________________
A. Identification of all Information Systems components without reference to version
B. Identification of software components of Information Systems alone
C. Identification of all Information Systems components in a system
D. Identification of hardware components of Information Systems alone
KEY C
Justification
Configuration identification involves identification of all versions & updates of both
software and hardware. This facilitates continuous monitoring during the life cycle of the
product & becomes useful at the time of any proposed changes in the components
(Option C). Option A is wrong since it ignores the version, which is vital. B and D are
incorrect since they are addressing either the software or hardware alone.
52. Hardening of Systems is _____________
A.Use of robust hardware to strengthen the system
B.Securely configuring systems to minimize security risks
C. Optimising configuration of hardware systems alone
D. Auditing configuration of software systems
KEY B
Justification
Hardening of systems is the process of securely configuring computer systems to
eliminate as many security risks as possible (Option B). It does not refer to use of
robust hardware (Option A); nor does it limit itself to hardware alone (Option C) or
software alone (Option D).
53. In IT, a network refers to ________________
A.Two or more devices which are able to exchange data between each other
19
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Two or more computers which are able to exchange data between each other
C. Minimum of 8 computers which are able to exchange data between each other
D. Several computers separated over a minimum distance of 100 metres from each
other
KEY A
Justification
In IT, a network refers to two or more of any devices which are able to exchange data
between each other; it includes devices like printers, computer terminals & other
devices of communication (Option A). It is not limited to computers alone (Option B). A
network could operate even out of the same building & there is no minimum stipulated
distance between the devices (Options C & D)
54. In IT, a node refers to ______________
A. Every junction of cables in a computer network
B. Every computer in a computer network
C. Each component in a computer network
D. Every internet device in a computer network
KEY C
Justification
In IT, a node refers to each component in a computer network (Option C). It does not
refer to cable junctions (Option A). It is not restricted to computers alone but covers
every type of device in the network (Option B). It is not restricted to internet devices in a
network (Options D).
55. The main reason for networking computers is _______________
A. Reduce hardware cost
B. Reduce software cost
C. Resource sharing and communication
D. Essentially, to increase speed of computing
20
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
The main benefit of networking computers is sharing of resources and facilitating
communications (Option C). Networking does not have the objective of reducing either
hardware or software costs; nor does it have the advantage of improving speed of
computing (Options A, B, & D).
56. One major benefit of networking computers is ________________
A. Facilitating user communication
B. Compartmentalisation of data
C. Reduced computing power
D. Reduced software costs
KEY A
Justification
A. Facilitation of user communication is a major advantage of computer networking
(Option A). Networking helps sharing of data and increases availability of
computing power. It may not necessarily reduce software costs; in fact, they may
increase on account of multiple licences being required for several terminals.
Hence, the other options are not correct.
57. Protocol, in IT, is __________________
A. The basis for allotment of new computers
B. Arrangement of employee directories
C. A set of rules for Communication between systems
D. Proper behaviour while using computers
KEY C
Justification
Protocol is a set of rules that makes communication possible (Option C). It does not
refer to the basis for allotment of new computers, the arrangement of employee
directories or behaviour while using computers (Options A,B, & D).
58. Data transmission _____________
A. Can be only through a voltage signal & not through radio or microwave
B. Is always digital in nature; one cannot transfer data in analog form
C. Ìs the physical transfer of data over a communication channel
D. Can happen only through a copper wire or optical fibre
21
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Data transmission is the physical transfer of data. It can be through electrical, radio,
microwave or infrared signals. It can be over copper wires, optical fibres, wireless
channels or through a storage medium. It can be either digital or analog. Hence, only
Option C is correct and the other options are wrong.
59. Simplex communication _________________
A. Always involves uni-directional transmission of data
B. Can involve uni-directional or multi-dimensional data transmission
C. Can handle two-way communication
D. facilitates return of error or control signals to the transmitter
KEY A
Justification
A. In simplex communication data always flows from one node to another it is
always uni-directional. It does not involve multi-dimensional transmission of data.
It also cannot handle two-way communication or allow sending back of error or
control signals to the transmitter. Hence, only Option A is correct & the other
options are wrong.
60. Half Duplex communication ________________
A. has capability to send and receive simultaneously
B. is cheaper than the Simplex system
C. is costlier than the full Duplex system
D. has facilities to send and receive but only one operation can be performed at a
time
KEY D
Justification
Half Duplex communication has the capability to both send and receive but with the
restriction that only one activity can be done at a time. It is more expensive than the
Simplex system but cheaper than the full Duplex system. Hence, only Option D is
correct.
61. Full Duplex communication __________________
A. Cannot handle two way communication
22
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
23
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
24
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
25
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
Middleware are programs which help clients communicate with server applications.
They control communication, authentication as well as delivery. They manage
transporting, queuing as well as scheduling. They have the capability to work with
diverse platforms. Hence, only Option D is correct.
70. What are the features of a co-axial cable?
A. The axes of the two conductors in the co-axial cable are different
B. It comprises a core conductor enclosed by a plastic cladding, a wire mesh &
plastic cladding
C. It is easy to install but has high attenuation loss
D. It is cheaper than twister pair cables but more expensive than optical fibre cable
KEY B
Justification
Co-axial cables consist of a central core conductor surrounded by a plastic cladding, an
outer wire mesh and a protective outer plastic cladding. The axis of both the conductors
is the same & hence the name co-axial. It is easy to install and has low attenuation loss.
It is moderately expensive but cheaper than optical fibre cable. Hence, only Option B is
correct.
71. What are the characteristics of a Twisted pair cable ?
A. Comprises 2 separate insulated wires in a twisted pattern that run parallel to
each other
B. Comprises 4 separate insulated wires in a twisted pattern run parallel to each
other
C. Comprises 2 separate insulated wires in a twisted but non parallel pattern
D. It is a form of unguided transmission media
KEY A
Justification
Twisted pair cables consist of 2 separate insulated wires in a twisted pattern run parallel
to each other. It is a form of guided transmission media with reduced electro magnetic
interference. Option A is the only correct option.
26
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
27
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
28
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
bridge is used to extend or segment networks. It sits between two physical segments &
manages the flow of data. It can choose to either block or forward the data. The correct
answer, hence, is in Option A.
78. What is a typical feature of a Router ?
A. It is a networking device used to forward data packets along networks
B. It is always a dedicated hardware device & cannot be a computer
C. It copies the packets to all connected destinations without discrimination
D. It does not contain any database of network addresses or pathways
KEY A
Justification
A router is a dedicated networking device or computer system with more than one
network interface. It is used to forward data packets along networks utilising its
database of network addresses and alternate pathways. It selectively forwards data
packets to the next hope in the route to the destination. The correct answer, hence, is in
Option A.
79. What is a typical feature of a Gateway ?
A. It is necessary for connecting networks with identical protocols
B. It is a device that translates one data format to another
C. It translates both the data format as well as the data itself
D. It is used to forward data packets along networks
KEY B
Justification
A gateway is a device that translates one data format to another, eg Email gateways. It
is useful in connecting networks with different protocols. It does not tinker with the
actual data & only translates the data format.. The correct answer is Option B
80. What is typical of Bus topology ?
A. Bus topology contains a single hub connecting all nodes
B. Connects computers on a single circle of cable
C. Computers are connected on a single backbone cable
D. In this system, every node is connected to every other node
29
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
In Bus topology, all the computers in the network are connected on a single backbone
cable. All the computers in the network receive incoming messages from any other
computer; however, only the intended recipient accepts and processes the message. It
is not on a single hub or circle of cable and each of the nodes are not connected to
each other. The correct answer is Option C.
81. What is typical of Star topology ?
A. Contains a central hub or switch to which each node is connected
B. All the computers are connected to a single backbone hub
C. Connects computers on a single circle of cable
D. In this system, every node is directly connected to every other node
KEY A
Justification
Star topology comprises a system of a central hub or switch to which each node is
connected. Separate cables are drawn from each and every node to the central hub. It
does not involve a single backbone hub or a single circle of cable. Every node is
connected to the central hub or switch and not to each other. The correct answer,
therefore, is Option A.
82. What are the features of Ring topology ?
A. All the computers are connected to a single backbone hub
B. Connects computers to a central hub or switch
C. In this system, every node is directly connected to every other node
D. It connects computers on a single ring of cable
KEY D
Justification
D. In star topology, every computer is connected to two other neighbours for
communication. Messages travel uni-directionally, either clockwise or anti-
clockwise. It does not involve use of a single backbone hub or a central
hub/switch. The correct answer, therefore, is Option D.
30
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
31
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
Justification
Packet switching involves the breaking up of a message into smaller packets for
transmission session. Since each packet has the destination address, packets need not
travel in the same path or sequence; the destination device reassembles them into
proper sequence. The correct answer, therefore, is Option B.
86. What are the features of Message switching ?
A. Data is stored at switching point & sent forward whenever pathway is available
B. Data is not stored at switching points & transmitted continuously
C. Data is transmitted in packets transmitted in the same path & sequence
D. Physical path establishment is a pre-requisite to transmission
KEY A
Justification
Message switching or store-and-forward switching involves accumulation of data at
switching points and onward transmission as and when pathway is available. No
physical path is established in advance between the sender and the receiver. Data is
not transmitted in packets. The correct answer, therefore, is Option A.
87. What is multiplexing ?
A. Permits sequential transmission of multiple signals on a single carrier
B. Facilitates transmission of signals in sequence, one at a time
C. It is the simultaneous transmission of multiple signals on a single carrier
D. Refers to simultaneous transmission of multiple signals on multiple carriers
KEY C
Justification
Multiplexing refers to simultaneous transmission of multiple signals on a single carrier
(Option C). The other options are factually incorrect.
88. Frequency division multiplexing involves _________
A. Assigning non-overlapping frequency ranges to different signals/users
B. Assigning overlapping frequency ranges to different signals/users
C. Assigning non-overlapping frequency ranges to a single signal/user
D. Use of digital technology when the link bandwidth is greater than sum of signal
bandwidths
32
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
FDM assigns non-overlapping frequency ranges to different signals/users. It is an
analog technique that can be applied when the bandwidth of the link is greater than the
combined bandwidth of the signals to be transmitted. Hence, only Option A is correct .
89. Time Division Multiplexing involves ________________
A. Primarily analog technology in which several signals/bitstreams are transferred
apparently simultaneously
B. Combination of analog & digital technology in which several signal/ bitstreams
are transferred simultaneously
C. Solely analog technology in which several signals/bitstreams are transferred
simultaneously
D. Division of time domain into several concurrent time slots of fixed length, one for
each sub-channel
KEY D
Justification
TDM involves a type of digital technology (rarely analog) in which several signals/bit
streams are transferred apparently simultaneously. In actual practice, however, it uses
sub channels & each signal takes turns on the channel . Hence, only Option D is correct
90. Wavelength Division Multiplexing is _____________
A. Conceptually similar to Time Division Multiplexing but using various wavelengths
of light
B. Conceptually similar to Frequency Division Multiplexing but uses a single
wavelength of light
C. Conceptually similar to Frequency Division Multiplexing but using various
wavelengths of light
D. Conceptually similar to Time Division Multiplexing and uses a single wavelength
of light
KEY C
Justification
C. WDM is conceptually like FDM and which multiplexes multiple optical carrier
signals on a single optical fibre by using different wavelengths of laser light.
Hence, only Option C is correct
33
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
34
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
35
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
does not control flow of data and instructions. Hence, A,C & D are clearly wrong
answers.
97. Storage Registers _____________
A. Can store memory addresses that tell the CPU where in memory an instruction is
located
B. Can keep running totals of arithmetic values
C. Can temporarily store data coming from or being sent to system memory
D. Can help move data from one location in the computer to another
KEY C
Justification
As defined clearly in paragraph 1.3.2, Storage Registers can temporarily store data
coming from or being sent to system memory.
Storage Registers do not store memory addresses; this function is carried out by
address registers. Arithmetic and logical operations are handled by the Arithmetic &
Logical unit of the computer and not the storage register. Lastly, only buses move data
from one location of the computer to another. Hence, A, B, & D are clearly wrong
answers.
98. Open Systems Interconnection (OSI)_______________
A. Deals with interconnection of Open systems software
B. Is effective in dealing with Open-source software
C. Deals with communication process without truncation in managing internetwork
D. Splits communication process to small portions in managing internetwork
KEY D
Justification
Open Systems Interconnection of OSI is a model which enables integration of various
technologies & provides solutions for managing the internetwork environment. It does
this by splitting communication processes into small portions. It has nothing to do with
Open systems or Open-source software.
Hence, only Option D is correct.
99. What is ARPANET ?
A. Network of computers in Arabia & Pakistan
B. New cloud computing network being set up by the U.S.
36
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
37
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
102. Which international body handles governance of generic Top Level Domain
(gTLD) & other related responsibilities ?
A. The Internet Corporation for Assigned Names and Numbers (ICANN)
B. World Wide Web Consortium (W3C)
C. The Internet Society (ISOC)
D. The Internet Architecture Board (IAB)
KEY A
Justification
It is the ICANN which handles the role indicated in the question above. The
organizations mentioned in the other options handle other responsibilities connected to
the internet.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
103. Which international body bears the responsibility for technical activities of the
Internet, including writing specifications & protocols ?
A. World Wide Web Consortium (W3C)
B. The Internet Society (ISOC)
C. The Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF)
D. The Internet Architecture Board (IAB)
KEY C
Justification
It is the IETF which handles the role indicated in the question above. The organizations
mentioned in the other options handle other responsibilities connected to the internet.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
104. Networking Protocol ______________
A. Is a set of rules that governs what, how and when data is communicated over a
network
B. Is the set of international norms laid down for country priority in communication
over a network
C. Is the set of international norms laid down for voice data communication alone
D. Is the set of international norms laid down for use of hardware in a network
38
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
Networking protocol is the set of rules that governs what, how and when data is
communicated over a network. The protocol does not prescribe any country priority for
network communication. Its coverage is not exclusive to voice data alone. It does not
apply to usage of hardware in a network.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
105. Syntax in Protocol represents __________
A. How data is communicated
B. When data is communicated
C. What is communicated
D. What, When & How data is communicated
KEY C
Justification
Syntax represents only What is communicated. There are other terms which represent
the How and the When of data communication.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
106. Semantics in Protocol represents ________________
A. What is communicated
B. When data is communicated
C. What, When & How data is communicated
D. How data is communicated
KEY D
Justification
Semantics represents only How data is communicated. There are other terms which
represent the What and the When of data communication.
Hence, only Option D is correct.
107. Timing in Protocol represents _______________
A. When data is transmitted but not how fast
B. The global time zones when data can be transmitted
C. When data is communicated & how fast
D. What, When & How data is communicated
39
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Timing in Protocol represents How data is communicated & how fast. There are other
terms which represent the What and the When of data communication. Hence, only
Option C is correct.
108. The Open System Interaction (OSI) reference model ________________
A. Makes inter-operability across heterogeneous technology environments possible
B. Is a 5 layered model, each specifying particular network functions
C. Is a 9 layered model, each specifying particular network functions
D. Has layers which are not self-contained & hence, dependent upon other layers
KEY A
Justification
The OSI model describes how information from a software application in one computer
moves through a network medium to a software application in another computer. When
messages are sent across heterogeneous networks with a large variety of hardware
technologies, networking devices and protocols, etc, OSI makes inter-operability across
these differing environments possible. It is a 7 layered model which are quite
independent and self-contained.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
109. In an OSI model, interfaces _______________
A. Describe (horizontal) communication between adjacent layers
B. Describe (vertical) communication between any two layers
C. Describe (horizontal) communication between any two layers
D. Describe (vertical) communication between adjacent layers
KEY D
Justification
In an OSI model, interfaces describe (vertical) communication between adjacent layers.
The answers falling in options A to C are factually incorrect.
Hence, only Option D is correct.
110. In an OSI model, protocols _____________
A. Describe (vertical) communication between adjacent layers
40
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
41
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
42
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
43
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
44
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
45
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
to send notification of datagram problems back to sender. Nor can it help create new IP
addresses.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
125. What is Reverse Address Resolution Protocol (RARP) ?
A. A mechanism to ascertain the physical address (MAC), given an IP address
B. A mechanism to send notification of datagram problems back to sender
C. A method of ascertaining the IP address, given the physical address (MAC)
D. A system by which new internet IP addresses can be created
KEY C
Justification
RARP is a method of ascertaining the IP address, given the physical address (MAC). It
cannot help locate the physical address given an IP address. It is also not a mechanism
to send notification of datagram problems back to sender. Nor can it help create new IP
addresses.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
126. The protocol data unit for Transport layer of TCP/IP is called __________
A. A Segment
B. A Packet
C. A Frame
D. A Bit
KEY A
Justification
The protocol data unit for Transport Layer of TCP/IP is called a Segment; the others
refer to names used for other layers. Hence, only Option A is correct.
127. The protocol data unit for Network Layer of TCP/IP is called ___________
A. A Segment
B. A Bit
C. A Packet
D. A Frame
46
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
The protocol data unit for Network Layer of TCP/IP is called a Packet; the others refer
to names used for other layers.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
128. The protocol data unit for Data Link Layer of TCP/IP is called _____________
A. A Segment
B. A Frame
C. A Packet
D. A Bit
KEY B
Justification
The protocol data unit for Data Link Layer of TCP/IP is called a Frame; the others refer
to names used for other layers.
Hence, only Option B is correct.
129. The protocol data unit for Physical Layer of TCP/IP is called ?
A. A Packet
B. A Frame
C. A Bit
D. A Segment
KEY C
Justification
The protocol data unit for Physical Layer of TCP/IP is called a Bit; the others refer to
names used for other layers.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
130. The Data Link Layer ____________
A. Performs the task of delivery over local networks and error detection
B. Enables us to find the best way from origin to destination
C. Runs application to access other layers’ services & defines protocols
D. Provides the path through which data moves among network devices
47
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
The Data Link Layer performs the task of delivery over local networks and error
detection. The other options refer to functions of other layers of TCP/IP protocol.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
131. The Application Layer __________
A. Performs the task of delivery over local networks and error detection
B. Provides the path through which data moves among network devices
C. Runs application to access other layers’ services & defines protocols
D. Enables us to find the best way from origin to destination
KEY C
Justification
The Application Layer runs various applications which provide them the ability to access
the services of the other layers and define the protocols that applications use to
exchange data. The other options refer to functions of other layers of TCP/IP protocol.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
132. The Cyclic Redundancy Check ________________
A. Is a check conducted by Application Layer
B. Is a check carried out by the Physical Layer on each stream of bits
C. Is a calculated value of the Data Link Layer for error detection
D. Is a check carried out by the Network Layer to identify the shortest route
KEY C
Justification
The Cyclic Redundancy Check is a calculated value that is place in the Data Link trailer
that is added to the message frame. It helps detect errors. The information given in the
other options A B and D are incorrect.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
133. One characteristic of the Physical Layer of TCP/IP is ___________
A. The sender and receiver need not be synchronized at the bit level
B. It deals in zeroes and ones and voltages
48
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. The bits need not be encoded into electrical/optical signals for purposes of
transmission
D. Its data unit is called a segment
KEY B
Justification
The Physical Layer deals in zeroes and ones and voltages. The sender and receiver
need to be synchronized at the bit level. The bits themselves need to be encoded as
electrical or optical signals before transmission. Its data unit is called a bit.
Hence, only Option B is correct.
134. Wi-Fi ____________
A. Is a wireless networking technology that uses radio waves
B. Has typical access range of about 130 metres
C. Can handle internet connectivity but not to other networks
D. Is a networking technology that requires physical cable connections
KEY A
Justification
Wi-Fi is a wireless networking technology using radio waves that can handle both
internet and other network connections. The typical range of Wi-Fi is about 32 metres.
Being a wireless facility, it does not require any physical cabling for access.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
135. Bluetooth Technology ______________
A. Has typical access range of about 200 metres
B. Can handle data but not voice transmission
C. Aims at unifying different platforms & devices
D. Has a major drawback, that of data security
KEY C
Justification
Bluetooth technology, a wireless technology for exchange of data over short distances,
aims at unifying different platforms and devices. It has a typical range of about 50
metres. Both data as well as voice can be transmitted through it. Data security is fairly
good.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
49
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
50
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY B
Justification
IP Version 4 addresses are invariably of 32-bit length; the choices given in Options A C
& D are incorrect.
Hence, only Option B is correct.
139. IP Version 4 is written in the form of ______________
A. 32 bytes separated by dots
B. 16 bytes separated by dots
C. 4 Octets or bytes separated by dots
D. 4 bits separated by dots
KEY C
Justification
IP Version 4 is written in the form of 4 Octets or bytes separated by dots. The choices in
options A B and D are erroneous.
Hence, only Option C is correct.
140. An IP Version 4 address can have a value from _____________
A. to 11111111.11111111.11111111.11111111
B. to 99999999.99999999.99999999.99999999
C. to 88888888.88888888.88888888.88888888
D. to 32000000.32000000.32000000.32000000
KEY A
Justification
An IP Version 4 can have a value from 00000000.00000000.00000000.00000000 to
11111111.11111111.11111111.11111111 since each bit is binary and can take either a
0 or 1 value. All the other choices from B to D above are incorrect. Only option A is
correct.
141. Each Octet in an IP Version 4 address ____________
A. Could have as many as 32 values
B. Could have as many as 1 billion values
C. Could have only two values 0 or 1
D. Could have as many as 256 values
51
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
Each Octet in an IP Version 4 address could have a value ranging from 0000 to 1111 or
0 to 255 in binary language. Thus 256 values in total are possible.
Hence, only Option D is correct.
142. A Network IP has ______________
A. All zeros in the host bit
B. All ones in the network bit
C. All zeros in the network bit
D. All ones in the host bit
KEY A
Justification
A Network IP has all zeros in the host bit whereas a Broadcast IP has all ones in the
host bit.
Hence, only Option A is correct.
143. A Broadcast IP has ___________
A. All zeros in the network bit
B. All ones in the host bit
C. All ones in the network bit
D. All zeros in the host bit
KEY B
Justification
A Broadcast IP has all ones in the host bit whereas a Network IP has all zeros in the
host bit.
Hence, only Option B is correct.
144. The objective of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is _____________
A. To Designate separate classes based upon software used
B. Designate separate classes based upon geographical location
C. Designate separate classes based upon year of allocation
D. improve efficiency in address allocation
52
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY D
Justification
The purpose of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is to improve efficiency in address
allocation. It has nothing to do with discrimination based upon software, geographical
location or timing of allocation.
Hence, only Option D is correct.
145. The Octet decimal range of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
_____________
A. 1 to 126
B. 0 to 126
C. 155 to 201
D. 224 to 239
KEY A
Justification
The Octet decimal range of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 1 to 126
as indicated in Option A.
The other options are neither of Class A nor of the other major classes of the
addressing scheme and are, hence, wrong.
146. The Octet decimal range of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
______________
A. 138 to 191
B. 201 to 239
C. 128 to 191
D. 205 to 255
KEY C
Justification
The Octet decimal range of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 128 to 191
as indicated in Option C.
The other options are neither of Class B nor of the other major classes of the
addressing scheme and are, hence, wrong.
147. The Octet decimal range of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
_______
53
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. 201 to 223
B. 1 to 126
C. 205 to 255
D. 192 to 223
KEY D
Justification
The Octet decimal range of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 192 to 223
as indicated in Option D.
The other options are neither of Class C nor of the other major classes of the
addressing scheme and are, hence, wrong.
148. The Octet decimal range of Class D of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
____________
A. 224 to 239
B. 201 to 239
C. 1 to 126
D. 205 to 255
KEY A
Justification
The Octet decimal range of Class D of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 224 to 239
as indicated in Option A.
The other options are neither of Class D nor of the other major classes of the
addressing scheme and are, hence, wrong.
149. The Octet decimal range of Class E of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
____________
A. 240 to 256
B. 240 to 254
C. 1 to 126
D. 205 to 255
KEY B
Justification
The Octet decimal range of Class E of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 240 to 254
as indicated in Option B.
54
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
The other options are neither of Class E nor of the other major classes of the
addressing scheme and are, hence, wrong.
150. The Higher Order bit in the first Octet of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing
Scheme is _______________
A. 0000
B. 1
C. 1111
D. 0
KEY D
Justification
The higher order bit in the first Octet of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme
is 0 as shown in Option D.
The other options are not true.
151. The Higher Order bit in the first Octet of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing
Scheme is ______________
A. 110
B. 11
C. 10
D. 1111
KEY C
Justification
The higher order bit in the first Octet of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme
is 10 as shown in Option C.
The other options are not true.
152. The Higher Order bit in the first Octet of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing
Scheme is _____________________
A. 110
B. 30
C. 111
D. 1111
55
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
The higher order bit in the first Octet of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme
is 110 as shown in Option A. The other options are not true.
153. The Higher Order bit in the first Octet of Class D of the IP Classful Addressing
Scheme is ___________________
A. 9999
B. 111
C. 1110
D. 1111
KEY C
Justification
The higher order bit in the first Octet of Class D of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme
is 1110 as shown in Option C.
The other options are not true.
154. The Higher Order bit in the first Octet of Class E of the IP Classful Addressing
Scheme is ___________________
A. 9999
B. 1111
C. 1110
D. 1010
KEY B
Justification
The higher order bit in the first Octet of Class E of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme
is 1111 as shown in Option B.
The other options are not true.
155. The Network (N)/Host (H) id of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
__________________
A. N.H.H.H
B. H.N.N.N
C. N.N.H.H.
D. H.H.N.N
56
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
The Network (N)/Host (H) id of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
N.H.H.H as indicated in Option A.
The other options are not true.
156. The Network (N)/Host (H) id of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
_________________
A. H.N.N.N
B. N.H.H.H.
C. H.H.N.N
D. N.N.H.H
KEY D
Justification
The Network (N)/Host (H) id of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
N.N.H.H as indicated in Option D.
The other options are not true.
157. The Network (N)/Host (H) id of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
_________________
A. H.H.H.N
B. N.N.N.H
C. N.H.H.H.
D. H.H.N.N
KEY B
Justification
The Network (N)/Host (H) id of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
N.N.N.H as indicated in Option B.
The other options are not true.
158. The default sub-net mask of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
_________________
A. H.H.H.N
B. N.H.H.H.
57
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. 255.255.0.0
D. 255.0.0.0
KEY D
Justification:
The default sub-net mask of Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 255.0.0.0
as indicated in Option D. The other options are not true.
159. The default sub-net mask of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme
is __________________
A. 255.255.0.0
B. H.H.H.N
C. N.H.H.H.
D. 255.255.255.0
KEY A
Justification
The default sub-net mask of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
255.255.0.0 as indicated in Option A.
The other options are not true.
160. The default sub-net mask of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
_____________
A. 255.255.0.0
B. N.H.H.H.
C. 255.255.255.0
D. 256.256.256.0
KEY C
Justification
The default sub-net mask of Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
255.255.255.0 as indicated in Option C
The other options are not true.
161. The number of networks that can be accommodated in Class A of the IP Classful
Addressing Scheme is __________________
A. 255
58
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
B. 1 million
C. 365
D. 126
KEY D
Justification
The number of networks that can be accommodated in Class A of the IP Classful
Addressing Scheme is 126 as indicated in Option D. The figures given in the other
options are not true.
162. The number of networks that can be accommodated in Class B of the IP Classful
Addressing Scheme is ____________
A. 16,382
B. 126
C. 1 million
D. 255
KEY A
Justification
The number of networks that can be accommodated in Class B of the IP Classful
Addressing Scheme is 16,382 as indicated in Option A. The figures given in the other
options are not true.
163. The number of networks that can be accommodated in Class C of the IP Classful
Addressing Scheme is _____________
A. 16382
B. 1 million
C. 20,97,150
D. 255
KEY C
Justification
The number of networks that can be accommodated in Class C of the IP Classful
Addressing Scheme is 20,97,150 as indicated in Option C. The figures given in the
other options are not true.
59
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
164. The number of hosts per network (usable addresses) that can be accommodated
in Class A of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is ______________
A. (224 -2) or 1,67,77,214
B. (210-2) or 1022
C. 126
D. 255
KEY A
Justification
The number of hosts per network that can be accommodated in Class A of the IP
Classful Addressing Scheme is (224-2) or 1,67,77,214 as indicated in Option A. The
figures given in the other options are not true.
165. The number of hosts per network (usable addresses) that can be accommodated
in Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is _____________
A. 126
B. 256
C. (224 -2) or 1,67,77,214
D. (216-2) or 65,534
KEY D
Justification
The number of hosts per network that can be accommodated in Class B of the IP
Classful Addressing Scheme is (216-2) or 65,534 as indicated in Option D. The figures
given in the other options are not true.
166. The number of hosts per network (usable addresses) that can be accommodated
in Class C of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is _______________
A. 126
B. (216-2) or 65,534
C. (28-2) or 254
D. (224 -2) or 1,67,77,214
KEY C
Justification
The number of hosts per network that can be accommodated in Class C of the IP
Classful Addressing Scheme is (28-2) or 254 as indicated in Option C. The figures given
in the other options are not true.
60
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
61
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
170. In IP Addressing scheme, which of the following class / classes are defined for
universal Unicast Addressing ?
A. Classes C alone
B. Class D
C. Classes A, B & C
D. Class E
KEY C
Justification
Classes A, B and C are defined for Universal Unicast addressing as indicated in Option
C. The information in the other options are not correct.
171. In IP Addressing scheme, which of the following class / classes are reserved for
Multicasting ?
A. Class D
B. Classes A & B alone
C. Class C
D. Class E
KEY A
Justification
Class D alone is reserved for Multicast addressing as indicated in Option A. The
information in the other options are not correct.
172. In IP Addressing scheme, which of the following class / classes are reserved for
Experimental purposes ?
A. Classes D
B. Class A
C. Class E
D. Classes B & C
KEY C
Justification
Class E alone is reserved for Experimental & research purposes as indicated in Option
C. The information in the other options are not correct.
62
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
173. Which class/classes of networks are reserved for government agencies & huge
companies ?
A. Classes D
B. Class E
C. Classes D & E
D. Class A
KEY D
Justification
Class A alone is reserved for Government agencies and huge companies as indicated
in Option D. The information in the other options are not correct.
174. A characteristic of a private address in an IP Network is ?
A. Hosts within the same local network can use the same private address
B. Its IP address will be unique in the internet network as a whole
C. A user in Company A cannot have the same address as a user in Company B
D. Its IP address should not be from the three blocks created by IANA
KEY A
Justification
Multiple hosts within a specified network can use the same private address out of the
three blocks spelt out by IANA. Their individual addresses need not be unique in the
internet network as a whole; a user in one company can have the same IP address as
another user in another company. Hence, Option A alone is correct. The information in
the other options are not correct.
175. A characteristic of a public address in an IP Network is ?
A. Hosts within the same local network cannot use the same public address
B. A user in Company A can have the same public address as a user in Company B
C. Its IP address will be unique in the internet network as a whole
D. Its IP address should be from the three blocks created by IANA
KEY C
Justification
A public address is exposed to the internet network & is unique. Multiple hosts within a
specified network cannot use the same public address. The public address should be
one which is not out of the three blocks spelt out by IANA for use as private addresses.
Hence, Option C alone is correct. The information in the other options are not correct.
63
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
176. The start address for private networks with Class A addressing is ?
A. 10.0.0.0
B. 192.168.0.0
C. 100.100.100.0
D. 172.16.0.0
KEY A
Justification
The start address for private networks with Class A addressing is 10.0.0.0 as indicated
in Option A. The other options are not correct.
177. The start address for private networks with Class B addressing is ?
A. 192.168.0.0
B. 100.100.100.0
C. 172.16.0.0
D. 10.10.0.0
KEY C
Justification
The start address for private networks with Class B addressing is 172.16.0.0 as
indicated in Option C. The other options are not correct.
178. The start address for private networks with Class C addressing is ?
A. 192.168.0.0
B. 100.100.100.0
C. 172.16.0.0
D. 10.10.0.0
KEY A
Justification
The start address for private networks with Class C addressing is 192.168.0.0 as
indicated in Option A. The other options are not correct.
179. The finish address for private networks with Class A addressing is ?
A. 999.999.999.000
B. 10.255.255.255
64
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. 172.31.255.255
D. 000.000.000.000
KEY B
Justification
The finish address for private networks with Class A addressing is 10.255.255.255 as
indicated in Option B. The other options are not correct.
180. The finish address for private networks with Class B addressing is ?
A. 10.255.255.255
B. 000.000.000.000
C. 999.999.999.000
D. 172.31.255.255
KEY D
Justification
The finish address for private networks with Class B addressing is 172.31.255.255 as
indicated in Option D. The other options are not correct.
181. The finish address for private networks with Class C addressing is ?
A. 192.168.255.255
B. 172.31.255.255
C. 101.255.255.255
D. 999.999.999.000
KEY A
Justification
The finish address for private networks with Class C addressing is 192.168.255.255 as
indicated in Option A. The other options are not correct.
182. Private IP addresses ___________
A. are translated into public IP addresses through IANA process
B. cannot be translated into public IP addresses using NAT process
C. are translated into public IP addresses through NAT process
D. are translated into public IP addresses through SMTP
65
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Private IP addresses are translated into public IP addresses through Network Address
Translation or NAT. Thus, multiple hosts with a private IP addresses are enabled to
access using one or two public IP addresses as indicated by Option C above. The other
options are not correct.
183. Dynamic Host Control Protocol is a software _____________
A. That can de-link particular hosts from a network during congestion
B. That allows definition of a range of dynamic IP addresses
C. That allows definition of a range of static IP addresses
D. That regulates host access to a network depending upon priority
KEY B
Justification
Dynamic Host Control Protocol is a software that allows definition of a range of dynamic
IP addresses for a specified period of time. Hence, Option B above is correct and the
other options are incorrect.
184. What is the IP network address of a default gateway ?
A. 1.1.1.1
B. 255.255.255.255
C. 0.0.0.0
D. 255.255.255.000
KEY C
Justification
As indicated in Option C above, the IP network address for a default gateway is 0.0.0.0.
The other options are incorrect.
185. Which IP address is called a Loopback address ?
A. 100.001.100.001
B. 121.0.0.121
C. 127.0.0.127
D. 127.0.0.1
66
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY D
Justification
The Loopback address is 127.0.0.1 as indicated in Option D above. It is used to simplify
programme testing and troubleshooting. The other options are incorrect.
186. A Loopback address ______________
A. Is used to simplify programme testing and troubleshooting
B. Helps communicate with local host using local address
C. Facilitates getting acknowledgement for delivery of messages
D. Helps catalogue errors in communication for future use
KEY A
Justification
The Loopback address is used to simplify programme testing and troubleshooting. The
other options are incorrect. Hence, Option A above alone is correct.
187. Which one of the following is a non-reserved address in IP networks ?
A. Broadcast address
B. Default gateway address
C. Loopback address
D. Dynamic IP addresses
KEY D
Justification
The Broadcast, Default gateway and Loopback addresses are all reserved addresses.
The Dynamic IP address is not a reserved address and allows hosts to be allotted
different IP addresses within a specified range. Hence, Option D above is alone correct.
188. A Subnet Mask is ?
A. Comprises 32 bits divided into 2 octets
B. Comprises 8 bits which are not divided further
C. Used for deriving network & host portions from an IP address
D. Comprises 16 bits which are divided into 2 octets
KEY C
67
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
Justification
A subnet mask comprises 32 bits divided into 4 octets. It is used for deriving network
and host portions from an IP address and helps minimize waste of IP addresses. The
information in Options A B and D is erroneous. Hence, Option C above alone is correct.
189. IP version 6 ___________
A. Is a 64 bit addressing scheme
B. Is a 96 bit addressing scheme
C. Is a160 bit addressing scheme
D. Is a 128 bit addressing scheme
KEY D
Justification
IP version 6 is a128 bit version as against the 32 bit of the IP 4 version. The information
in Options A to C is erroneous. Hence, Option D above alone is correct.
190. IP version 6 _____________
A. Can accommodate as many as 2128 addresses
B. Can handle as many as 264 addresses
C. Can handle as many as 232 addresses
D. Can handle only 216 addresses
KEY A
Justification
As against IP version 4,IP version 6 is a128 bit version which can thus accommodate as
many as 2128 addresses. The information in Options B to D is erroneous. Hence, Option
A above alone is correct.
191. Migration from IP version 4 to IP version 6 ____________
A. Has not commenced in India yet; they are unwilling to do so
B. Is not possible until all devices are migrated globally
C. Has commenced in India under NASSCOM leadership
D. Is underway but many devices continue to be under version 4
KEY D
68
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
Justification
Migration from version 4 to version 6 is underway & India is one of the countries
undergoing the transition. The process is anchored by the Telecom Regulatory Authority
of India. Till complete migration takes place, it is possible to have both systems in
operation with appropriate mechanisms in place. Hence, Option D above alone is
correct.
192. IP version 6 is in the form of _____________
A. Heptadecimals
B. Decimals
C. Hexadecimals
D. Octodecimals
KEY C
Justification
As against IP version 4, IP version 6 is in Hexadecimal form. The information in Options
A, B and D are erroneous. Option C above alone is correct.
193. IP version 6 addresses are separated by _________________
A. Single Colons
B. Double Colons
C. Single Periods
D. Semi Colons
KEY A
Justification
As against IP version 4 which uses periods for separation, IP version 6 uses single
colons. The information in Options B to D is not correct. Option A above alone is
correct.
194. A Port forms a socket along with an IP address. It is composed of ___________
A. 8 bits
B. 32 bits
C. 16 bits
D. 64 bits
KEY C
69
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
Justification
A port comprises 16 bits. The information in Options A, B and D is not correct. Option C
above alone is correct.
195. The maximum number of ports possible per IP network address is
_______________
A. 216
B. 232
C. 264
D. 28
KEY A
Justification
A port comprises 16 bits & hence the maximum number of ports possible is 216. The
information in Options B to D is not correct. Option A above alone is correct.
196. Destination ports ______________
A. Are used to route packets from source to a destination host computer
B. Are used to route packets on a server to the appropriate network application
C. Are used only for HTTP traffic which are processed by a web server
D. Of numbers 0 to 1023 are used by vendors for proprietary applications
KEY B
Justification
Destination ports are used to route packets on a server to the appropriate network
application, as indicated in Option B. It is used for various purposes like HTTP, FTP &
SMTP traffic. The numbers used by vendors of proprietary applications are from 1024 to
49151. Hence, Option B above alone is correct.
197. Source ports ______________
A. Are assigned to clients & used for tracking user sessions
B. Are the ports through which data packets originate from the source
C. Are allocated numbers ranging from 49,152 to 68,568
D. Are allocated numbers ranging from 0 to 49,152
KEY A
70
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
Justification
Source ports are assigned to clients and used for tracking user sessions as indicated in
Option A. These can be any random number and no specific range is defined. Hence,
Option A above alone is correct.
198. Domain Name System ________________
A. Has the host name in binary & heptadecimal form
B. When it is in non-generic category, can be used by any person/organization
C. Envisages that both the host name & IP address are a must for communication
D. Is a distributed database with host name & IP address for all domains
KEY D
Justification
The Domain Name system is a distributed database with host name & IP address for all
domains, as indicated in Option D. It has the host name in normal English and the IP
address as per decimal format (IP Version 4) of hexadecimal format (IP Version 6).
Only the generic category of domain names are available for use by any organization of
person for any use. It is possible for us, through the Domain Name system, to identify
the IP address, given the host name and vice versa. Hence, Option D above alone is
correct.
199. On Demand Computing _______________
A. Is less economical for users with volatility in quality/volume of computing needs
B. Is not an issue in terms of privacy or security
C. Envisages provision of computing resources on as-needed/when-needed basis
D. Is ideally suited for users who have consistent quality & volume of computing
needs
KEY C
Justification
On Demand Computing envisages provision of computing resources on as-
needed/when-needed basis & is best suited to users who have uncertain volume of
demand for computing services. It helps them minimise capital expenditure & hire
computing resources on need basis. The concept’s biggest concern is privacy and
security of data. Hence, Option C alone is correct.
71
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
72
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
73
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
74
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
75
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
A Host based firewall, as stated in Option D above, is a device deployed on a single
host within a network, thus restricting incoming/outgoing traffic for that host alone. It is
not deployed between networks or within an entire network for restricting movement of
selected traffic types. Hence, only Option D above is correct.
211. A Personal Firewall _____________
A. Controls traffic between a personal computer/workstation and the
Internet/enterprise network
B. Can be used only on home computers but not in the corporate environment
C. Is typically a piece of hardware installed on a personal computer at home
D. Assumes that inbound traffic can be permitted and outbound traffic has to be
inspected
KEY A
Justification
A Personal Firewall controls traffic between a personal computer or workstation on the
one side and the Internet / enterprise network on the other. It is normally a piece of
software and can be installed on a personal computer at home or even in a corporate
environment. It assumes that outbound traffic can be freely permitted and inbound
traffic has to be inspected & controlled. Hence, only Option A above is correct.
212. A Personal Firewall Appliance _______________
A. Envisages protection to a single computer through a hardware device installed on
it
B. Envisages protection to multiple computers & is housed on a router connected to
them
C. Is typically a hardware installed on a router which provides protection to a single
SOHO computer
D. Is typically built into the operating system of individual computers
KEY B
Justification
A Personal Firewall Appliance refers to housing of firewall functionality on the router
connected to multiple computers, generally in a SOHO environment. This is unlike the
normal personal firewall which tends to be installed in the computer’s operating system.
Hence, only Option B above is correct.
76
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
77
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
Bastion Hosts are computer systems that have Hardened systems because they are
vulnerable to attack & are exposed to the internet and are also a main point of contact
for internal network users. They have essential services installed on them & restrict
access to specific hosts alone. Hence, answer in Option A is correct. The answers in
the other options are incorrect.
216. Bastion Hosts ______________
A. Cannot maintain detailed logs of all traffic
B. Are Hardened systems having non-essential services installed on them
C. Have each proxy independent of other proxies loaded on them
D. Allow free access to all hosts since they have Hardened systems anyway
KEY C
Justification
Bastion Hosts are computer systems that have Hardened systems because they are
vulnerable to attack & are exposed to the internet and are also a main point of contact
for internal network users. A Bastion Host has each proxy independent of other proxies
loaded on it. It has essential services installed on it & restricts access to specific hosts
alone. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are
incorrect.
217. Packet Filtering Router Firewall ______________
A. Has no default parameter and drops any traffic whose header does not match
firewall rules
B. Is deployed on a router within a private network
C. Matches the header content with the firewall rules to allow or block traffic
D. Is deployed on a router within a public network
KEY C
Justification
Packet Filtering Router Firewall is deployed on a screening router between a private
and a public network. It operates by matching the header content of each packet with
the firewall rules. If the content matches the firewall rule & it permits, it allows it. In case
the rule matches but does not permit, it blocks the traffic. If no match is found, the
router goes by the default parameter. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The
answers in the other options are incorrect.
78
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
79
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
80
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Packet Filtering Router Firewall works at the Internet layer of the TCP/IP model or at
Network layer of the OSI model. It is a very simple and relatively inexpensive firewall
model. It is vulnerable to attacks like the IP Address spoofing attack as also Source
Routing Attack. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
223. What are Stateful Inspection Packet Filtering Firewall ______________
A. They ignore current connection while allowing traffic to pass through
B. They are packet filters that incorporate added awareness of OSI model data
C. They possess packet characteristics but ignore session status
D. They are less secure than Packet Filtering Router Firewall
KEY B
Justification
Stateful Inspection Packet Filtering Firewall are packet filters (like Packet Filtering
Firewalls) but incorporate added awareness of OSI model data. They keep track of
current connection to ensure that only permitted traffic is allowed to pass. They keep
track of both packet characteristics as well as session checks to make sure that a
specific session is allowed. They are more secure because they track client ports
individually rather than opening all ‘high numbered ports’ for external access. Hence,
answer in Option B is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
224. Stateful Inspection Packet Filtering Firewall ____________
A. They possess packet characteristics but ignore session status
B. They are less secure than Packet Filtering Router Firewall
C. Uses a ‘State Table’ to validate inbound traffic
D. They ignore current connection while allowing traffic to pass through
KEY C
Justification
Stateful Inspection Packet Filtering Firewall are packet filters (like Packet Filtering
Firewalls) but incorporate added awareness of OSI model data. They keep track of
current connection to ensure that only permitted traffic is allowed to pass. They keep
track of both packet characteristics as well as session checks to make sure that a
specific session is allowed. They use a State Table to validate inbound traffic. They are
more secure because they track client ports individually rather than opening all ‘high
numbered ports’ for external access. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The
answers in the other options are incorrect.
81
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
82
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Application Level Gateways operate at the Applications layer of the OSI. They are
similar to Circuit gateways with the exception that they are application specific &
monitor content of the application. They have the advantage of authenticating
individuals rather than devices. They are operated on hardened operating systems.
Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
228. Application Level Gateway Firewalls ______________
A. It is not operated on hardened operating systems
B. Are implemented on hardened operating systems
C. Cannot control access based upon content or source address
D. Will result in compromising the entire network in the event of a break-in
KEY B
Justification
Application Level Gateways operate at the Applications layer of the OSI. They are
similar to Circuit gateways with the exception that they are application specific &
monitor content of the application. Among other things, they can control access based
upon content as also source address. They have the advantage of authenticating
individuals rather than devices. They are operated on hardened operating systems. Any
break-in will only compromise the firewall and not the entire network. Hence, answer in
Option B is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
229. Application Level Gateway Firewalls ____________
A. Are process intensive & can cause performance issues
B. Are not vulnerable to bugs in the running application / operating system
C. Cannot provide auditing & logging functions for future review
D. Will result in compromising the entire network in the event of a break-in
KEY A
Justification
Application Level Gateways operate at the Applications layer of the OSI. They are
similar to Circuit gateways with the exception that they are application specific &
monitor content of the application. Among other things, they can control access based
upon content as also source address. They have the advantage of authenticating
individuals rather than devices. They are operated on hardened operating systems. Any
83
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
break-in will only compromise the firewall and not the entire network. Their drawbacks
include vulnerability to bugs in the running application / operating system as also
performance issues arising out of process intensive nature. Hence, answer in Option A
is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
230. Application Level Gateway Firewalls ______________
A. Are not vulnerable to bugs in the running application / operating system
B. Cannot provide auditing & logging functions for future review
C. Will not result in compromising the entire network in the event of a break-in
D. Are less secure than Packet Filters and Stateful Inspection Firewalls
KEY C
Justification
Any break-in will only compromise the firewall and not the entire network in the case of
Application Level Gateway firewalls. They can provide auditing and logging functions.
They are more secure than Packet Filters and Stateful Inspection Firewalls. Their
drawbacks include vulnerability to bugs in the running application / operating system as
also performance issues arising out of process intensive nature. Hence, answer in
Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
231. One of the major drawbacks of Application Level Gateway Firewalls is
_____________
A. Compromise the entire network in the event of a break-in
B. Cannot provide auditing & logging functions for future review
C. Are less secure than Packet Filters and Stateful Inspection Firewalls
D. They are process intensive & cause performance issues
KEY D
Justification
Application level gateway firewalls are process intensive and cause performance
issues. However, any break-in will only compromise the firewall and not the entire
network in the case of Application Level Gateway firewalls. They can provide auditing
and logging functions. They are more secure than Packet Filters and Stateful Inspection
Firewalls. Hence, answer in Option D is correct. The answers in the other options are
incorrect.
84
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
85
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
86
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Single Homed Firewalls combine the Packet Filtering router with a separate dedicated
firewall called a Bastion proxy server. The system envisages traffic passing through the
Packet Filtering router first before crossing the proxy server. This reduces the traffic
and the load on the proxy server. Also, an intruder has to penetrate two systems before
security of internal network is compromised. They screen both for applications as well
as content. They are considered to be more secure than a packet filtering router or
application level gateway firewall alone. A disadvantage is that traffic can flow directly
between the internet and other hosts on the network if the packet filtering firewall is
compromised. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
237. A Dual Homed Host Firewall is different from Single Homed Firewall in that
____________
A. It has two NICs one connected to the external & the other connected to the
internal network
B. It screens only for applications and not content
C. It does not allow traffic to flow directly between the internet and other hosts on
the private network if the packet filtering router is compromised
D. It has increased traffic and load on the proxy server despite the Packet Filtering
router
KEY A
Justification
Single Homed Firewalls combine the Packet Filtering router with a separate dedicated
firewall called a Bastion proxy server. The system envisages traffic passing through the
Packet Filtering router first before crossing the proxy server. This reduces the traffic
and the load on the proxy server. It has two NICs; one connected to the external and
the other connected to the internal network. Also, an intruder has to penetrate two
systems before security of internal network is compromised. They screen both for
applications as well as content. They are considered to be more secure than a packet
filtering router or application level gateway firewall alone. A disadvantage is that traffic
can flow directly between the internet and other hosts on the network if the packet
filtering firewall is compromised. Hence, answer in Option A is correct. The answers in
the other options are incorrect.
238. Screened Subnet Firewalls with DMZ ___________
A. Has four packet filtering routers, two each between bastion host/internet &
bastion host/internal network
87
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Screens only the applications but not the content, making their networks more
vulnerable to attack
C. Are the best configuration for most secure environment
D. The private network is not invisible to the internet / unsecured network
KEY C
Justification
Screened Subnet firewalls are the best configuration for most secure environment. They
have two packet filtering routers, one each between the bastion host & internet and
between bastion host & internal network. They screen both for application as well as
content. Since the outside router advertises the DMZ to the external network or Internet,
the internal private network becomes invisible to it. Hence, answer in Option C is
correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
239. Screened Subnet Firewalls with DMZ ______________
A. Have two packet filtering routers, one each between bastion host/internet &
bastion host/internal network
B. Are vulnerable in that Internet systems can see through the DMZ into the internal
private network & initiate attacks
C. Permit internal users’ risky behaviour of bypassing the proxy server on the
bastion system to access the Internet directly
D. Are the least robust of firewall systems, providing limited security to internal
network systems
KEY A
Justification
Screened Subnet firewalls are the best configuration for most secure environment. They
have two packet filtering routers, one each between the bastion host & internet and
between bastion host & internal network. They screen both for application as well as
content. Since the outside router advertises the DMZ to the external network or Internet,
the internal private network becomes invisible to it. Similarly, the internal user is forced
to go through the proxy server on the bastion system to access the Internet, minimizing
risky behaviour. Hence, answer in Option A is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
240. Screened Subnet Firewalls with DMZ ______________
A. Have four packet filtering routers, two each between bastion host/internet &
bastion host/internal network
B. Are robust in that Internet systems cannot see through the DMZ into the internal
private network & initiate attacks
88
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. Are the least robust of firewall systems, providing limited security to internal
network systems
D. Permit internal users’ risky behaviour of bypassing the proxy server on the
bastion system to access the Internet directly
KEY B
Justification
Screened Subnet firewalls are the best configuration for most secure environment. They
have two packet filtering routers, one each between the bastion host & internet and
between bastion host & internal network. They screen both for application as well as
content. Since the outside router advertises the DMZ to the external network or Internet,
the internal private network becomes invisible to it. Similarly, the internal user is forced
to go through the proxy server on the bastion system to access the Internet, minimizing
risky behaviour. Hence, answer in Option B is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
241. Screened Subnet Firewalls with DMZ _______________
A. Are vulnerable in that Internet systems can see through the DMZ into the internal
private network & initiate attacks
B. Ensure that internal users access the Internet via the proxy services residing on
the bastion host
C. Have four packet filtering routers, two each between bastion host/internet &
bastion host/internal network
D. Are the least robust of firewall systems, providing limited security to internal
network systems
KEY B
Justification
Screened Subnet firewalls are the best configuration for most secure environment. They
have two packet filtering routers, one each between the bastion host & internet and
between bastion host & internal network. They screen both for application as well as
content. Since the outside router advertises the DMZ to the external network or Internet,
the internal private network becomes invisible to it. Similarly, the internal user is forced
to go through the proxy server on the bastion system to access the Internet, minimizing
risky behaviour. Hence, answer in Option B is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
242. Screened Subnet Firewalls with DMZ ___________
A. Are the least robust of firewall systems, providing limited security to internal
network systems
89
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Have four packet filtering routers, two each between bastion host/internet &
bastion host/internal network
C. Will need a Network Address Translator (NAT) to be installed on the bastion host
to eliminate the need to re-number or re-subnet the private network
D. Are vulnerable in that Internet systems can see through the DMZ into the internal
private network & initiate attacks
KEY C
Justification
Screened Subnet firewalls are the best configuration for most secure environment. They
have two packet filtering routers, one each between the bastion host & internet and
between bastion host & internal network. They screen both for application as well as
content. Since the outside router advertises the DMZ to the external network or Internet,
the internal private network becomes invisible to it. Similarly, the internal user is forced
to go through the proxy server on the bastion system to access the Internet, minimizing
risky behaviour. Since the DMZ network is different from the private network, a NAT can
be installed on the bastion host to eliminate the need to re-number or re-subnet the
private network. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
243. In general, Firewalls ____________
A. Can enforce password policy and prevent misuse of passwords
B. Are very effective against non-technical security risks such as social engineering
C. Can block internal users from accessing websites with malicious codes
D. Cannot prevent users or attackers with modems from dialling into or out of the
internal network, bypassing the firewall
KEY D
Justification
Firewalls have quite a few limitations. They cannot prevent users or attackers with
modems from dialling into or out of the internal network. They cannot enforce password
policy or prevent misuse of passwords. They are not very effective against non-
technical security risks like social engineering. They cannot, also, block internal users
from accessing websites with malicious codes. Hence, answer in Option D is correct.
The answers in the other options are incorrect.
244. In general, Firewalls _________
A. Cannot enforce password policy and prevent misuse of passwords
90
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
B. Can prevent users or attackers with modems from dialling into or out of the
internal network, bypassing the firewall
C. Can provide complete protection against viruses
D. Can block internal users from accessing websites with malicious codes
KEY A
Justification
Firewalls have quite a few limitations. They cannot enforce password policy and prevent
misuse of passwords. They cannot prevent users or attackers with modems from
dialling into or out of the internal network. They cannot enforce password policy or
prevent misuse of passwords. They are not very effective against non-technical security
risks like social engineering. They cannot provide complete protection against viruses.
They cannot, also, block internal users from accessing websites with malicious codes.
Hence, answer in Option A is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
245. In general, Firewalls __________
A. Can enforce password policy and prevent misuse of passwords
B. Can prevent users or attackers with modems from dialling into or out of the
internal network, bypassing the firewall
C. Cannot provide complete protection against viruses
D. Can block internal users from accessing websites with malicious codes
KEY C
Justification
Firewalls have quite a few limitations. They cannot provide complete protection against
viruses. They cannot enforce password policy and prevent misuse of passwords. They
cannot prevent users or attackers with modems from dialling into or out of the internal
network. They cannot enforce password policy or prevent misuse of passwords. They
cannot, also, block internal users from accessing websites with malicious codes. Hence,
answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
246. Appliance based firewall ___________
A. Is a firewall software installed on top of commercial operating systems
B. Is less secure than those deployed on top of commercial operating systems
C. Is scalable depending upon changing requirements of business
D. Refers to appliances with firewall software embedded as firmware
KEY D
91
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
Justification
Appliance based Firewalls refer to appliances with firewall software embedded as
firmware. They are more secure than those deployed on top of commercial operating
systems since the latter are more vulnerable. Their major drawback is the limitation on
scalability. Hence, answer in Option D is correct. The answers in the other options are
incorrect.
247. Appliance based firewall ______________
A. Does not include appliances with firewall software embedded as firmware
B. Is more secure than those deployed on top of commercial operating systems
C. Is a firewall software installed on top of commercial operating systems
D. Are scalable depending upon changing requirements of business
KEY B
Justification
Appliance based Firewalls refer to appliances with firewall software embedded as
firmware. They are more secure than those deployed on top of commercial operating
systems since the latter are more vulnerable. Their major drawback is the limitation on
scalability. Hence, answer in Option B is correct. The answers in the other options are
incorrect.
248. Appliance based firewall __________
A. Is less secure than those deployed on top of commercial operating systems
B. Does not include appliances with firewall software embedded as firmware
C. Suffers from scalability issues & inability to meet changed environmental needs
D. Is a firewall software installed on top of commercial operating systems
KEY C
Justification
Appliance based Firewalls refer to appliances with firewall software embedded as
firmware. They are more secure than those deployed on top of commercial operating
systems since the latter are more vulnerable. Their major drawback is the limitation on
scalability. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are
incorrect.
92
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
93
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Unified Threat Management is the evolution of the traditional firewall into an all-
inclusive security product able to perform multiple security functions within one single
appliance. It can operate on a simple plug and play architecture. It has reduced
technical training requirements since only one product has to be learnt and understood.
Installation of security products is also easier and maintenance/vendor issues become
simpler. Answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
252. Unified Threat Management ____________
A. Is the Evolution of the traditional firewall into a compound security system with
multiple products
B. Has increased technical training requirements owing to its complexity
C. Complicates installation of security products
D. Can support various functionalities like VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam, etc.
apart from firewall
KEY D
Justification
Unified Threat Management is the evolution of the traditional firewall into an all-
inclusive security product able to perform multiple security functions within one single
appliance. Apart from the firewall, it can support VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam,
intrusion prevention, content filtering, bandwidth management, etc. It can operate on
simple plug and play architecture. It has reduced technical training requirements since
only one product has to be learnt and understood. Installation of security products is
also easier and maintenance/vendor issues become simpler. Answer in Option D is
correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
253. Unified Threat Management _____________
A. Can support firewall but not various functionalities like VPN, gate-way anti-
virus/anti-spam, etc.
B. Can provide centralized support with complete control for globalized operations
C. Is the Evolution of the traditional firewall into a compound security system with
multiple products
D. Has increased technical training requirements owing to its complexity
94
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY B
Justification
Unified Threat Management is the evolution of the traditional firewall into an all-
inclusive security product able to perform multiple security functions within one single
appliance. Apart from the firewall, it can support VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam,
intrusion prevention, content filtering, bandwidth management, etc. It has reduced
technical training requirements since only one product has to be learnt and understood.
Installation of security products is also easier and maintenance/vendor issues become
simpler. Overall, it is very well suited to an organization with global operations wherein
it can provide centralized support with complete control. Answer in Option B is correct.
The answers in the other options are incorrect.
254. Unified Threat Management ______________
A. Can support firewall but not various functionalities like VPN, gate-way anti-
virus/anti-spam, etc.
B. Is the Evolution of the traditional firewall into a compound security system with
multiple products
C. Can also support data-loss prevention by blocking accidental or incidental loss of
KEY data
D. Has increased technical training requirements owing to its complexity
KEY C
Justification
Apart from the firewall, Unified Threat Management can support VPN, gate-way anti-
virus/anti-spam, intrusion prevention, content filtering, bandwidth management, etc. It
can also support data-loss prevention by blocking accidental or incidental loss of
confidential, proprietary or regulated data. It has reduced technical training
requirements since only one product has to be learnt and understood. Installation of
security products is also easier and maintenance/vendor issues become simpler.
Overall, it is very well suited to an organization with global operations wherein it can
provide centralized support with complete control. Answer in Option C is correct. The
answers in the other options are incorrect.
255. A disadvantage of Unified Threat Management is ____________
A. That it becomes a Single Point of Failure (SPOF) for network traffic
B. It cannot support various functionalities like VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam,
etc.
C. Has increased technical training requirements owing to its complexity
D. It cannot support GUI interface for manageability
95
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
The single biggest disadvantage of Unified Threat Management (UTM) is the obvious
risks of centralization it becomes a Single Point of Failure (SPOF). The other major
drawback is that its deployment may have an impact on latency and band width when
the UTM cannot keep up with the traffic. Apart from the firewall, it can, indeed, support
VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam, intrusion prevention, content filtering, bandwidth
management, etc. It has reduced technical training requirements since only one product
has to be learnt and understood. It can comfortably support GUI interface for
manageability. Hence, answer in Option A is correct. The answers in the other options
are incorrect.
256. A disadvantage of Unified Threat Management is ____________
A. It cannot support GUI interface for manageability
B. Has increased technical training requirements owing to its complexity
C. That it can have impact on latency and bandwidth when it cannot cope with the
traffic
D. It cannot support various functionalities like VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam,
etc.
KEY C
Justification
A major drawback of UTM is that its deployment may have an impact on latency and
band width when the UTM cannot keep up with the traffic. Apart from the firewall, it can,
indeed, support VPN, gate-way anti-virus/anti-spam, intrusion prevention, content
filtering, bandwidth management, etc. It has reduced technical training requirements
since only one product has to be learnt and understood. It can comfortably support GUI
interface for manageability. Hence, answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the
other options are incorrect.
257. Baseline Configuration of Firewall __________
A. Should have a default policy of allowing all traffic/connections unless not
specifically permitted
B. Should not allow remote users access through VPN
C. Should be preceded by a general risk assessment & cost-benefit analysis
D. Should not allow deployment of Web & other publicly accessible servers on a
DMZ in respect of multi-location organizations
96
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Baseline configuration of a firewall should be preceded by a general risk assessment &
cost-benefit analysis. It should have a default policy of not allowing any
traffic/connections unless specifically permitted. It should permit remote users access
through VPN. In respect of large multi-location organizations, it should ideally have the
Web & other publicly accessible servers place on a DMZ for best security. Hence,
answer in Option C is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
258. Baseline Configuration of Firewall _________________
A. Should have a default policy of not allowing any traffic/connections unless
specifically permitted
B. Need not have an additional firewall for internal users since the main firewall
would be adequate
C. Should not allow deployment of Web & other publicly accessible servers on a
DMZ in respect of multi-location organizations
D. Should not allow remote users access through VPN
KEY A
Justification
Baseline configuration should have a default policy of not allowing any
traffic/connections unless specifically permitted. It should permit remote users access
through VPN. In respect of large multi-location organizations, it should ideally have the
Web & other publicly accessible servers place on a DMZ for best security. It should also
ensure that internal users should be protected with an additional firewall. Hence,
answer in Option A is correct. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
259. Personal Firewalls
A. Are based upon different methods & techniques as compared to an enterprise
firewall
B. Are more complicated compared to an enterprise firewall & require technical
expertise to operate
C. Are software installed on a user’s computer protecting against unwanted intrusion
& attacks from the Internet
D. Control incoming traffic from the Internet alone, based upon defined security
policy
97
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Personal Firewalls are software installed on a user’s computer for protection against
unwanted intrusion and attacks from the Internet. They are based upon the same
methods and techniques as firewalls for enterprises. They are simpler and can be
handled by less technically savvy persons too. Like the firewalls for enterprises, they,
too, control and monitor both incoming as well as outgoing traffic based upon a defined
security policy. Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are
obviously wrong.
260. Personal firewalls ________________
A. Are hardware devices installed on a user’s computer protecting against unwanted
intrusion & attacks from the Internet
B. Need not be monitored as constantly as firewalls for enterprises
C. Control incoming traffic from the Internet alone, based upon defined security
policy
D. Are based upon different methods & techniques as compared to an enterprise
firewall
KEY B
Justification
Personal Firewalls are software installed on a user’s computer for protection against
unwanted intrusion and attacks from the Internet. They are based upon the same
methods and techniques as firewalls for enterprises. They are simpler and can be
handled by less technically savvy persons too. Like the firewalls for enterprises, they,
too, control and monitor both incoming as well as outgoing traffic based upon a defined
security policy. They need not be monitored as constantly as enterprise firewalls.
Answer in Option B above is correct whereas the other answers are obviously wrong.
261. Personal Firewall __________________
A. Cannot block or alert the user about outgoing connection attempts
B. Cannot provide information about destination server with which an application is
trying to communicate
C. Is based upon security policy of the computer whereas enterprise firewall is
based on enterprise security policy
D. Are hardware devices installed on a user’s computer protecting against unwanted
intrusion & attacks from the Internet
98
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
A Personal Firewall is based upon the security policy of the individual computer
whereas enterprise firewall is based on enterprise security policy. It is a software
installed on a user’s computer for protection against unwanted intrusion and attacks
from the Internet. Like the firewalls for enterprises, it controls and monitors both
incoming as well as outgoing traffic based upon a defined security policy. It can block
and alert the user about outgoing connection attempts too. It can go to the extent of
providing information about a destination server with which an application is trying to
communicate.
Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are obviously wrong.
262. Personal Firewall ________________
A. Can protect a computer from unwanted incoming connection attempts
B. Are hardware devices installed on a user’s computer protecting against unwanted
intrusion & attacks from the Internet
C. Cannot provide information about destination server with which an application is
trying to communicate
D. Cannot block or alert the user about outgoing connection attempts
KEY A
Justification
A Personal Firewall is based upon the security policy of the individual computer
whereas enterprise firewall is based on enterprise security policy. It is a software
installed on a user’s computer for protection against unwanted intrusion and attacks
from the Internet. Like the firewalls for enterprises, it controls and monitors both
incoming as well as outgoing traffic based upon a defined security policy. It can protect
a computer from unwanted incoming connection attempts. It can block and alert the
user about outgoing connection attempts too. It can go to the extent of providing
information about a destination server with which an application is trying to
communicate. Answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers are
obviously wrong.
263. State True or False One of the limitations of Personal Firewall is that many
malwares can compromise the system, manipulate the firewall & even shut it
down.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
99
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
It is true that some malwares exist which can penetrate & compromise the firewall
system , disarming it in the process, leaving the internal network exposed to security
risks. Hence, answer in Option A above is correct.
264. State True or False Personal Firewalls could be impacted by vulnerabilities in the
Operating System.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
It is true that vulnerabilities in the Operating system itself could impinge on the security
of the firewall system. Hence, answer in Option A above is correct.
265. State True or False These personal firewalls could sometimes generate false
alerts which could irritate non tech-savvy users.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
It is true that some could sometimes generate false alerts which could irritate non tech-
savvy users. Hence, answer in Option A above is correct.
266. Windows 7 software _______________
A. Has no inbuilt firewall system; we would need to go in for a third party product for
security
B. Has a network-based firewall system, not host-based system
C. Has an inbuilt stateful, host-based firewall that filters incoming and outgoing
connections
D. Has a Firewall that cannot block or alert the user about outgoing connection
attempts
100
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Windows 7 software has an inbuilt, stateful, host-based Firewall system that can filter
both incoming as well as outgoing connections. It can block or alert the user against
outgoing connection attempts too. Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the
other answers are obviously wrong.
267. Windows 7 software ______________
A. Has two network location types with advanced security
B. Has a network-based firewall system, not host-based system
C. Is a network location-aware host firewall
D. Has a Firewall that cannot block or alert the user about outgoing connection
attempts
KEY C
Justification
Windows 7 software is a network location-aware host firewall. It has three network
location types with advanced security Domain, public & private. It has a Firewall system
that can filter both incoming as well as outgoing connections. It can block or alert the
user against outgoing connection attempts too. Answer in Option C above is correct
whereas the other answers are obviously wrong.
268. Windows 7 software ______________
A. Has a Firewall that cannot block or alert the user about outgoing connection
attempts
B. Stores firewall properties based on location types or profiles
C. Has a network-based firewall system, not host-based system
D. Has two network location types with advanced security
KEY B
Justification
Windows 7 software is a network location-aware host firewall. It stores firewall
properties based on location types called profiles. It has three network location types
with advanced security Domain, public & private. It has a Firewall system that can filter
both incoming as well as outgoing connections. It can block or alert the user against
outgoing connection attempts too. Answer in Option B above is correct whereas the
other answers are obviously wrong.
101
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
102
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
HIDS are implemented on individual hosts or devices on the network and they monitor
all packets to and from the hosts only. They alert the administrator when suspicious
activity is detected. Since they are deployed on each computer, they involved higher
deployment and proportionately higher maintenance cost. Answer in Option C above is
correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
272. Signature based IDS _____________________
A. Monitors packets on network but does not validate them since they do not have a
database for comparison
B. Will be able to detect attacks pre-emptively, even before the event
C. Can successfully handle even new attacks
D. Monitors packets on network and compares them against large databases of
attack signatures
KEY D
Justification
SIDS are signature based IDS that monitor packets on networks and compare them
against large databases of attack signatures. They cannot, however, detect attacks pre-
emptively and cannot handle new attacks since a comparable signature would not be
available with them. Answer in Option D above is correct whereas the other answers
are wrong.
273. Statistical Anomaly / Behaviour based IDS ________________
A. Monitors packets on network and validates them by comparing the signature in
the database
B. Assume that an intrusion can be detected by observing a normal behaviour of the
system/users
C. Will not be able to detect attacks pre-emptively, before the event
D. Cannot handle effectively new attacks
KEY B
Justification
SAB IDS monitor packet traffic on networks and compare them against an established
baseline of behaviour. They can detect attempts to exploit new and unforeseen
vulnerabilities. Their downside is that they generate a large number of false positives.
Answer in Option B above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
103
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
104
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
Cryptography is the practice and study of hiding information with the objective of secure
communication. It involves the use of encryption for transforming data into unintelligible
form. The unintelligible form can be converted back into understandable information
with the help of some additional information like a code or a key. It does provide
mechanisms for authenticating users on a network. It also enables prevention of users
from repudiating ownership of their messages. Answer in Option A above is correct
whereas the other answers are wrong.
277. Cryptography _________________
A. Helps assure the receiver about the integrity of the message
B. Does not help in preventing users from repudiating ownership of messages
C. Cannot provide mechanisms for authenticating users on a network
D. Is the process of transforming data into something that cannot be understood
even with some additional information
E. Involves use of encryption for transforming data into something that is intelligible
KEY A
Justification
Cryptography is the practice and study of hiding information with the objective of secure
communication. It involves the use of encryption for transforming data into unintelligible
form. The unintelligible form can be converted back into understandable information
with the help of some additional information like a code or a key. It does provide
mechanisms for authenticating users on a network. It also enables prevention of users
from repudiating ownership of their messages. It helps the receiver in ensuring that the
message received by him has not been altered in any fashion; ie, protect the integrity of
the message. Answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers are
wrong.
278. Cryptography ________________
A. Does not help in preventing users from repudiating ownership of messages
B. Cannot provide mechanisms for authenticating users on a network
C. Ensures the privacy or confidentiality of the contents of the message
D. Involves use of encryption for transforming data into something that is intelligible
105
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Cryptography ensures the privacy or confidentiality of a message i.e. it ensures that no
one except the intended receiver of the message can read the message. Cryptography
is the practice and study of hiding information with the objective of secure
communication. It involves the use of encryption for transforming data into unintelligible
form. The unintelligible form can be converted back into understandable information
with the help of some additional information like a code or a key. It does provide
mechanisms for authenticating users on a network. It also enables prevention of users
from repudiating ownership of their messages. It helps the receiver in ensuring that the
message received by him has not been altered in any fashion; ie, protect the integrity of
the message. Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are
wrong.
279. Cryptography ______________
A. Involves use of encryption for transforming data into something that is intelligible
B. Authenticates & convinces the receiver that the message has actually come from
the sender
C. Does not help in preventing users from repudiating ownership of messages
D. Cannot provide mechanisms for authenticating users on a network
KEY B
Justification
Cryptography authenticates & convinces the recipient that the message has actually
come from the sender. It involves the use of encryption for transforming data into
unintelligible form. The unintelligible form can be converted back into understandable
information with the help of some additional information like a code or a key. It does
provide mechanisms for authenticating users on a network. It also enables prevention of
users from repudiating ownership of their messages. Answer in Option B above is
correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
280. Any message that is intelligible is considered to be in _________________
A. Encrypted form
B. Coded form
C. Plaintext form
D. Ciphertext form
106
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Any message that is intelligible is considered to be in plaintext form. An encrypted form
will not be intelligible without the use of additional information. A ciphertext form would
be in unintelligible form till it is decrypted into plaintext form. Hence, answer in Option C
above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
281. Any message that is converted into un-intelligible form is considered to be in
_________
A. Ciphertext form
B. Plaintext form
C. Understandable form
D. Coded form
KEY A
Justification
A ciphertext form arises post encryption & would be in unintelligible form till it is
decrypted into plaintext form. Any message that is intelligible is considered to be in
plaintext form. An encrypted form will not be intelligible without the use of additional
information. Hence, answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers
are wrong.
282. The process of converting a given plaintext into ciphertext form is called
____________
A. Decryption
B. Translation
C. Transcription
D. Encryption
KEY D
Justification
The conversion of a given plaintext into ciphertext form is called encryption. This form
would be in unintelligible form till it is decrypted into plaintext form through decryption.
Any message that is intelligible is considered to be in plaintext form. An encrypted form
will not be intelligible without the use of additional information. Hence, answer in Option
D above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
107
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
283. The process of converting ciphertext back into plaintext form is called
_____________
A. Transcription
B. Encryption
C. Decryption
D. Translation
KEY C
Justification
The conversion of a given plaintext into ciphertext form is called encryption. This form
would be in unintelligible form till it is decrypted into plaintext form through decryption.
Any message that is intelligible is considered to be in plaintext form. An encrypted form
will not be intelligible without the use of additional information. Hence, answer in Option
C above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
284. The mathematical function used for encryption & decryption is ______________.
A. Binomial analysis
B. Cryptographic Algorithm
C. Transcription Algorithm
D. Exponential function
KEY B
Justification
The mathematical function used for encryption & decryption is called the cryptographic
algorithm or Cipher. Answer in Option B above is correct whereas the other answers are
wrong.
285. The mathematical function used for encryption & decryption is _______________.
A. Transcription Algorithm
B. Binomial analysis
C. Cipher
D. Exponential function
108
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
The mathematical function used for encryption & decryption is called the cryptographic
algorithm or Cipher. Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers
are wrong.
286. A Cipher is also called _______________
A. A Cryptographic Algorithm
B. Transcription Algorithm
C. Binomial analysis
D. Exponential function
KEY A
Justification
The mathematical function used for encryption & decryption is called the cryptographic
algorithm or Cipher. Answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers are
wrong.
287. A Cryptographic algorithm _______________
A. Must be difficult to use but easy to crack
B. Must be easy both to use and crack
C. Must be easy to use but difficult to crack
D. Must be difficult to use as well as to crack
KEY C
Justification
An effective cryptographic algorithm must be easy to use but difficult to crack.
Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
288. A Cryptographic algorithm ____________
A. Can be used for one function encryption alone
B. Can be used for one function decryption alone
C. Can be used for one function creation of a key
D. Can be used for two functions encryption as well as decryption
109
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
A cryptographic algorithm can be used for encryption as well as decryption.
Answer in Option D above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
289. KEYs ______________
A. Are not required in the encryption or decryption process
B. Should be difficult to use but easy to break
C. Are additional secret data in the cryptographic process
D. Should be easy to use as well as to break
KEY C
Justification
KEYs are additional secret data which are used in the encryption or decryption process
of cryptography. They need to be long enough to make breaking difficult but short
enough to use and transmit. Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other
answers are wrong.
290. KEYs ______________
A. Should be difficult to use but easy to break
B. Should be easy to use as well as to break
C. Are not required in the encryption or decryption process
D. Prevent the message from being decoded even if the algorithm is known
KEY D
Justification
KEYs are additional secret data which are used in the encryption or decryption process
of cryptography. They need to be long enough to make breaking difficult but short
enough to use and transmit. Without the keys, even if the mathematical algorithm of
encryption were known, decryption into plaintext is not possible.
Answer in Option D above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
291. The Caesar cipher was used to transmit messages during Roman wars. It was
actually a ‘shift by 3’ rule wherein alphabet A is replaced by the third alphabet D,
B by E and so on. In this case, the KEY is ___________
A. 3
B. Alphabet A
110
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. Alphabet D
D. Alphabet B
KEY A
Justification
KEYs are additional secret data which are used in the encryption or decryption process
of cryptography. In this case, the recipient of the message needs to know the algorithm
of shifting the alphabet by a few positions. However, in this specific instance, the
shifting of the alphabet is by three positions. Hence, the KEY is 3. In another situation,
the KEY can be changed to 5 or any other number depending upon security
requirements without changing the basic algorithm.
Answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
292. Symmetric KEY Cryptography _____________
A. Envisages the use of different keys for encryption and decryption
B. Envisages the use of a single KEY both for encryption as well as decryption
C. Suffers from no difficulty in terms of distribution of the key
D. Envisages the use of one KEY by the sender & another by the receiver
KEY B
Justification
Symmetric KEY cryptography envisages the use of a single KEY both for encryption as
well as decryption. Thus, the receiver uses the same KEY for decryption as was used
by the sender for encryption. The difficulty lies in distribution of the key.
Answer in Option B above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
293. The Digital Encryption Standard __________________
A. Is a NIST standard using 256 keys
B. Continues to be used by NIST even today
C. Is a NIST standard using 228 keys
D. Is not a Symmetric Encryption Standard
KEY A
Justification
DES is a National Institute for Standards and Technology Symmetric Encryption
Standard using 256 keys. It has been replaced by the Advanced Encryption standard
which deploys 128, 192 and 256 bits and proportionately more keys for better security.
Answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
111
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
112
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Asymmetric or Public KEY cryptography involves the use of a pair of keys, one for
encryption and the other for decryption. The public KEY of the individual would be in the
public domain whereas the private KEY would remain secret and not revealed. It
overcomes the difficulty of KEY distribution faced in the case of symmetric KEY
cryptography. This process, however, is thousands of times slower than the symmetric
KEY cryptography process.
Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
297. Asymmetric or Public KEY Cryptography _______________
A. Can be initiated by using either of the two keys first
B. Is not used for exchange of symmetric keys
C. Is not used for exchange of Digital signatures
D. Involves the use of two pairs of keys, one each for encryption and decryption
KEY A
Justification
Asymmetric or Public KEY cryptography involves the use of a pair of keys, one for
encryption and the other for decryption. Either of the two keys can be used, without any
particular sequence. The public KEY of the individual would be in the public domain
whereas the private KEY would remain secret and not revealed. It overcomes the
difficulty of KEY distribution faced in the case of symmetric KEY cryptography. This
process, however, is thousands of times slower than the symmetric KEY cryptography
process. Its use, therefore, is mainly in exchange of symmetric keys and digital
signatures.
Answer in Option A above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
298. Asymmetric or Public KEY Cryptography ___________________
A. Is not used for exchange of symmetric keys
B. Is not used for exchange of Digital signatures
C. Uses more computer resources compared to Symmetric KEY cryptography
D. Provides lesser security as compared to Symmetric KEY cryptography
113
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Asymmetric or Public KEY cryptography involves the use of a pair of keys, one for
encryption and the other for decryption. Either of the two keys can be used, without any
particular sequence. The public KEY of the individual would be in the public domain
whereas the private KEY would remain secret and not revealed. It overcomes the
difficulty of KEY distribution faced in the case of symmetric KEY cryptography. This
process, however, is thousands of times slower than the symmetric KEY cryptography
process and uses up more computer resources too. Its use, therefore, is mainly in
exchange of symmetric keys and digital signatures.
Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
299. Asymmetric or Public KEY Cryptography ___________
A. Uses less computer resources compared to Symmetric KEY cryptography
B. Generally has larger KEY size as compared to Symmetric KEY cryptography
C. Provides lesser security as compared to Symmetric KEY cryptography
D. Is not used for exchange of symmetric keys
KEY B
Justification
Asymmetric or Public KEY cryptography involves the use of a pair of keys, one for
encryption and the other for decryption. Either of the two keys can be used, without any
particular sequence. The public KEY of the individual would be in the public domain
whereas the private KEY would remain secret and not revealed. It overcomes the
difficulty of KEY distribution faced in the case of symmetric KEY cryptography. This
process, however, involves larger KEY sizes, is thousands of times slower than the
symmetric KEY cryptography process and uses up more computer resources too. Its
use, therefore, is mainly in exchange of symmetric keys and digital signatures. .Answer
in Option B above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
300. RSA is _________________
A. A form of cryptography which uses 24096 keys
B. Not used in common software products
C. The most common form of Asymmetric KEY Cryptography in use
D. An acronym for its developers Robin Sharma, Sundararaman and Anjaneyulu
114
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
RSA was developed by Ronald Rivest, Adi Shamir and Leonard Adleman & hence its
name. It is the most common form of Asymmetric KEY Cryptography in use. It currently
uses 22048 keys for high security. It is used extensively in common software products for
KEY exchange, digital signatures or encryption for small blocks of data.
Answer in Option C above is correct whereas the other answers are wrong.
301. What are Message Hash Functions ?
A. They are algorithms involved in computing a fixed length hash value
B. They are algorithms from which the contents & length of the plaintext can be
recovered
C. They are algorithms whose limitation is that they cannot guarantee message
integrity
They are algorithms involved in computing a variable length hash value
KEY A
Justification
Message Hash Functions are algorithms involved in computing a fixed length hash
value. In lieu of a key, a fixed length hash value is computed based upon the plaintext
that makes it impossible to recover the contents or length of the plaintext. The hash
value is recalculated at the receiver’s end and matched with that generated by the
sender. If they match, the message has not been altered during transmission.
Hence, Option A alone is correct.
302. Message Hash Functions __________
A. Are algorithms involved in computing a fixed length hash value
B. Are algorithms from which the contents & length of the plaintext can be recovered
C. Are algorithms whose limitation is that they cannot guarantee message integrity
D. Are also called Message Digests and One-way hash functions
KEY D
Justification
Message Hash Functions are algorithms involved in computing a fixed length hash
value. They are also called Message Digests and One-way hash functions. In lieu of a
key, a fixed length hash value is computed based upon the plaintext that makes it
impossible to recover the contents or length of the plaintext. The hash value is
115
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
recalculated at the receiver’s end and matched with that generated by the sender. If
they match, the message has not been altered during transmission.
Hence, Option D alone is correct.
303. What are Digital Signatures ?
A. Are data strings dependent only on a secret known only to the sender
B. Are data strings dependent on a secret known only to the sender & the message
content
C. Are cryptography tools which depend upon use of Symmetric KEYs
D. They are algorithms whose limitation is that they cannot guarantee message
integrity
KEY B
Justification
Digital signatures are data strings dependent on a secret known only to the sender and,
additionally, on the content of the message. They use Asymmetric KEYs and Hash.
They meet the communication objectives of authentication, integrity and
repudiation. .Option B alone is correct.
304. What are Digital Signatures ?
A. They are algorithms whose limitation is that they cannot guarantee message
integrity
B. Are data strings dependent on a secret built into the message content alone
C. Are cryptography tools which depend upon use of Asymmetric KEYs & Message
Hash content
D. Are data strings dependent only on a secret known only to the sender
KEY C
Justification
Digital signatures are data strings dependent on a secret known only to the sender and,
additionally, on the content of the message. They use Asymmetric KEYs and Hash.
They meet the communication objectives of authentication, integrity and repudiation.
Option C alone is correct.
305. What are the characteristics of Digital Signatures ?
A. They achieve the communication objectives of confidentiality, authentication &
integrity
B. They comply with the goals of authentication, access control and non-repudiation
116
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. They are algorithms whose limitation is that they cannot guarantee message
integrity
D. They achieve the communication objectives of authentication, integrity & non-
repudiation
KEY D
Justification
Digital signatures are data strings dependent on a secret known only to the sender and,
additionally, on the content of the message. They use Asymmetric KEYs and Hash &
involve the use of private and public keys. They meet the communication objectives of
authentication, integrity and repudiation.
Option D alone is correct.
306. What are the characteristics of Public KEY Infrastructure (PKI) ?
A. They achieve the communication objectives of confidentiality & authentication
alone
B. They achieve all the five basic communication objectives
C. They provide the infrastructure for generation, storage and security of public keys
D. They are algorithms which are not as effective as Digital signatures
KEY B
Justification
PKI are advanced cryptographic tools which help achieve all the five basic
communication objectives of confidentiality, authentication, integrity, non-repudiation
and access control. It involves the use of a digital envelope, which, in turn, deploys both
secret KEY and public KEY cryptography methods to send the secret KEY to the
recipient. It thus combines public-KEY encryption and digital signature services to
create a comprehensive system.
Hence, Option B alone is correct.
307. What are characteristic of Public KEY Infrastructure (PKI) ?
A. Digital certificates are used with support from Certificate authority & LDAP
directory
B. They provide the infrastructure for generation, storage and security of public keys
C. They achieve the communication objectives of confidentiality & authentication
alone
D. They are algorithms which are not as effective as Digital signatures
117
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
PKI are advanced cryptographic tools which help achieve all the five basic
communication objectives of confidentiality, authentication, integrity, non-repudiation
and access control. It involves the use of a digital envelope, which, in turn, deploys both
secret KEY and public KEY cryptography methods to send the secret KEY to the
recipient. It thus combines public-KEY encryption and digital signature services to
create a comprehensive system. The system leans heavily on a robust Certification
authority and Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) directory. Hence, Option A
alone is correct.
308. What are the typical characteristics of a Digital Certificate ?
A. It is a digitally signed document used to verify that a private KEY belongs to an
individual
B. It is a digitally signed document used to verify that a public KEY belongs to an
individual
C. It is a digitally signed document which is permanent, without any validity/expiry
date
D. It is a digitally signed document used to verify both public & private keys of an
individual
KEY B
Justification A Digital certificate is a digitally signed document that associates a public
KEY with a user. It will be signed by a Certification Authority. Its contents would include
serial number, subject, signature, issuer, validity dates(valid from, expiry date), public
key, thumbprint algorithm and thumbprint. Hence, Option B alone is correct.
309. Who are Certifying Authorities ?
A. In India, Certifying authorities are not regulated/ licensed & hence, certificates
have no legal validity
B. They are not responsible for verification of registration, suspension and
revocation requests
C. They are Trusted Third Parties to verify and vouch for the identities of entities in
an electronic environment
D. In India, Certifying authorities are regulated/licensed by NASSCOM
118
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Certifying Authorities (CAs) are Trusted Third Parties to verify and vouch for the
identities of entities in an electronic environment. In India, the IT Act provides for the
Controller of Certifying Authorities, a body under the Ministry of Communications &
Information Technology, is responsible for the licensing and regulation of Certifying
Authorities & to ensure that the IT Act provisions are complied with. The main role of a
CA is to digitally sign and publish the public KEY bound to a given user. One of the
major roles & responsibilities is verification of registration, suspension and revocation
requests.
Hence, answer in Option C is correct.
310. Who are Registering Authorities ?
A. They authenticate the identity of a person before the CA releases the digital
certificate
B. They are independent of the CA and are responsible to NASSCOM
C. They are not responsible for verification of identity but only for formal registration
D. They are a Government department who register the Certifying Authority
KEY A
Justification
Registering Authorities are work under the control of Certifying authorities (CAs) and
are responsible for authenticating the identity of a person prior to issue of a digital
certificate by the CA. They are also the body who interact with subscribers for providing
CA services. The CAs themselves, who are independent entities, are licensed and
regulated by the Controller of Certifying Authorities, a government body under the
Ministry of Communications and Information Technology.
Hence, only the answer in Option A is correct.
311. Certification Revocation Lists (CRLs) ______________
A. Are lists of Certifying Authorities who have been de-licensed by the CCA
B. Are issued by a Certifying Authority different from one that issued the original
certificate
C. Are lists of serial numbers of certificates which have been revoked
D. Are issued by Registering Authorities and not signed by the Certifying Authority
119
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Certificate Revocations Lists (CRLs) are lists of serial numbers of digital certificates
which have been revoked along with reasons for revocation. These certificates are
themselves signed by the Certifying Authority (CA) themselves. The CRL is always
issued by the CA who issued the corresponding certificate. Entities presenting those
certificates can no longer be trusted.
Hence, only the answer in Option C is correct.
312. Certification Practice Statement is a statement of the practices which a
Certification Authority employs in issuing and managing certificates.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
Certification Practice Statement is a statement of the practices which a Certification
Authority employs in issuing and managing certificates. It carries various types of
information like policies, procedures & processes involved in certificate issue, policies
for revocation, policies for renewal, certificate lifetime, etc.
The answer in Option A is correct.
313. Which of the following is true off Cryptanalysis ?
A. Analysis of data for encryption using Symmetric key
B. Analysis of encryption/decryption records for audit purposes
C. Refers to methods of recovering plaintext from ciphertext without using the key
D. It is used to study strengths of a cryptosystem
KEY C
Justification
Cryptanalysis refers to methods of recovering plaintext from ciphertext without using the
key. In other words, it is the study of methods for obtaining the meaning of encrypted
information, without access to the secret information which is normally required to do
so. It also deals with identifying weaknesses in the cryptosystem. The term
cryptanalysis is also used to refer to attempts to break the security of other types of
cryptographic algorithms and protocols, apart from encryption.
The answer in Option C only is correct.
120
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
314. How does a Cryptanalyst manage to identify the KEY for launching a Known
plaintext attack ?
A. He ascertains the KEY by compromising the Certifying Authority’s servers
B. He programs his computer to continuously check random keys till he finds the
right one
C. He breaks into the sender’s system and identifies the private KEY for the
transmission
D. He deduces the KEY by accessing both ciphertext as well as plaintext of several
messages
KEY D
Justification
The Cryptanalyst can deduce the KEY by accessing & comparing both the ciphertext as
well as the plaintext of several messages. He can then launch a Known plaintext attack.
The answer in Option D only is correct.
315. Secure Socket Layer (SSL) _____________
A. Cannot work with any program using TCP, even with modifications
B. Is a protocol that provides a secure communication channel between two
machines
C. Has limited flexibility in choice of encryption used
D. Does not have built-in data compression capability
KEY B
Justification
SSL is a protocol that provides a secure communication channel between two machines
operating on the Internet or an internal network. Any program using TCP can be
modified to use SSL connection. SSL is also flexible in choice of symmetric encryption,
authentication and message digest that can be used. It does have in-built data
compression capability.
Hence, the answer in Option B only is correct.
316. Secure Socket Layer (SSL) __________
A. Subsequently became an internet standard known as Transport Layer Security
B. Does not have built-in data compression capability
C. Has limited flexibility in choice of encryption used
121
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
122
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
Justification
SSL was originally developed by Netscape and subsequently became the Internet
standard known as Transport Layer Security (TLS). It is a protocol that provides a
secure communication channel between two machines operating on the Internet or an
internal network. SSL is also flexible in choice of symmetric encryption, authentication
and message digest that can be used. Any program using TCP can be modified to use
SSL connection. It does have in-built data compression capability. It is the most widely
used system in the world currently. In particular, it is capable of handling sensitive
information like credit card numbers, social security numbers and login credentials to be
transmitted securely.
Hence, the answer in Option D only is correct.
319. Secure Socket Layer (SSL) ______________
A. Is a transparent protocol requiring little user interaction for establishing a secure
session
B. Cannot secure cloud-based computing platforms
C. Has limited flexibility in choice of encryption used
D. Cannot secure connection between E-mail Client and E-mail Server
KEY A
Justification
SSL was originally developed by Netscape and subsequently became the Internet
standard known as Transport Layer Security (TLS). It is a protocol that provides a
secure communication channel between two machines operating on the Internet or an
internal network. SSL is also flexible in choice of symmetric encryption, authentication
and message digest that can be used. It is a transparent protocol requiring little end
user interaction for establishing a secure session.
Hence, the answer in Option A only is correct.
320. Secure Socket Layer (SSL) ______________
A. Alerts users to its presence by displaying an eagle’s head in the browser
B. Alerts users to its presence by displaying a padlock in the browser
C. Cannot secure system logins and any sensitive information exchanged online
D. Cannot secure connection between E-mail Client and E-mail Server
123
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
Justification
SSL is a protocol that provides a secure communication channel between two machines
operating on the Internet or an internal network. It is a transparent protocol requiring
little end user interaction for establishing a secure session. It alerts users to its
presence by displaying a padlock in the browser. Among other things, it can secure
system logins and other sensitive information normally exchanged online. It can also
secure connection between E-mail Client and E-mail Server.
Hence, the answer in Option B only is correct.
321. HTTP Secure _______________
A. Is used widely except for payment transactions & other sensitive transactions
B. Is an advanced version of HTTP which is superior to SSL/TLS protocol
C. Is basically layering of HTTP protocol over the SSL/TLS protocol
D. Requires both the client as well as the remote server to be authenticated
compulsorily
KEY C
Justification
HTTP Secure is basically layering of HTTP protocol over the proven Secure Sockets
Layer (SSL) protocol. It is used widely, especially for payment transactions, emails, etc.
While the SSL portion can comfortably authenticate both ends of a session, in the
normal course only the server end is authenticated by the client.
Hence, the answer in Option C only is correct.
322. HTTP Secure _____________
A. Is an advanced version of HTTP which is superior to SSL/TLS protocol
B. Requires both the client as well as the remote server to be authenticated
compulsorily
C. Has a basic limitation of slowing down the web service
D. Is used widely except for payment transactions & other sensitive transactions
124
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
HTTP Secure is basically layering of HTTP protocol over the proven Secure Sockets
Layer (SSL) protocol. It is used widely, especially for payment transactions, emails, etc.
While the SSL portion can comfortably authenticate both ends of a session, in the
normal course only the server end is authenticated by the client. Its one limitation is that
it slows down the web service.
Hence, the answer in Option C only is correct.
323. Virtual Private Network (VPN) _______________
A. Can operate between two private networks but not the Internet
B. Does not provide confidentiality & integrity over un-trusted intermediate networks
C. Not compatible for operations with IPSec
D. Can link two networks or individual systems providing privacy & strong
authentication
KEY D
Justification
VPNs can link two individual systems or networks providing privacy and strong
authentication. The networks can be private networks or the Internet. They provide
confidentiality & integrity over un-trusted intermediate networks. IPSec enables VPN
and creates a virtual tunnel with encryption to ensure secure communication.
Hence, the answer in Option D only is correct.
324. IPSec ___________
A. Protects application data across IP Networks
B. Requires applications to be specifically designed to work with it
C. Cannot be of help for implementation of VPN
D. Cannot be of help for remote user access through dial-up connection
KEY A
Justification
IPSec protects application data across IP Networks. It is encrypted at network layer of
IP. Hence, it does not require applications to be specifically designed for use with it. It is
useful for implementation of VPN as also for remote user access through dial-up
connection. Hence, the answer in Option A only is correct.
125
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
126
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY D
Justification
IPSec protects application data across IP Networks. It is encrypted at network layer of
IP. Hence, it does not require applications to be specifically designed for use with it. It is
useful for implementation of VPN as also for remote user access through dial-up
connection. It has as its basic goals authenticity and data integrity. It can operate in two
modes transport & tunnel. In transport mode, it provides secure connection between two
end points. In this mode, the data is encrypted and the packet header is not encrypted.
In tunnel mode, used for VPN, the entire IP packet is encrypted and a new header
added to the packet for transmission.
Hence, the answer in Option D only is correct.
328. Tunnel Mode of IPSec _____________
A. Is used to create Virtual Private Networks
B. Involves encryption of data but not of the packet header
C. Involves encryption of the entire packet, for use in non-VPN functions
D. Can operate with entire IP packet encrypted & old header added
KEY A
Justification
IPSec protects application data across IP Networks. It is encrypted at network layer of
IP. Hence, it does not require applications to be specifically designed for use with it. It is
useful for implementation of VPN as also for remote user access through dial-up
connection. It has as its basic goals authenticity and data integrity. It can operate in two
modes transport & tunnel. In tunnel mode, used for VPN, the entire IP packet is
encrypted and a new header added to the packet for transmission.
Hence, the answer in Option A only is correct.
329. Secure Shell (SSH) is a protocol ____________
A. Which is basically VPN layered on SSL protocol
B. Which cannot operation in conjunction with Telnet
C. Used for secure remote login & for command execution over an insecure network
D. Works only for peer-to-peer mode
127
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
SSH is a protocol used for remote login and for executing commands over an insecure
network. It is basically Telnet +SSL+ some other features. It works well for client-server
mode, with both ends authenticated using certificates. It is usually used on UNIX
systems.
The correct answer is as in Option C
330. Secure Shell (SSH) is a protocol ____________
A. That cannot be used for remote login or command execution
B. Comprising Telnet+SSL+other features
C. Which is basically VPN layered on SSL protocol
D. Which cannot operation in conjunction with Telnet
KEY B
Justification
SSH is a protocol used for remote login and for executing commands over an insecure
network. It is basically Telnet +SSL+ some other features. It works well for client-server
mode, with both ends authenticated using certificates. It is usually used on UNIX
systems.
The correct answer is as in Option B.
331. Secure Shell (SSH) is a protocol ____________
A. Which cannot operation in conjunction with Telnet
B. Which is basically VPN layered on SSL protocol
C. That cannot be used for remote login or command execution
D. That is usually used on UNIX systems
KEY D
Justification
SSH is a protocol used for remote login and for executing commands over an insecure
network. It is basically Telnet +SSL+ some other features. It works well for client-server
mode, with both ends authenticated using certificates. It is usually used on UNIX
systems.
The correct answer is as in Option D.
128
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
129
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
130
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
131
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
132
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY B
Justification
The backbone in a typical WAN Network Topology is usually of optical fibre with
redundant routes. The last mile connects the branch / small office to the POP of the
service provider. The last mile links, in most cases, are leased lines backed up by a
secondary link ISDN, WiFi or satellite link. The Data Centre and the Disaster Recovery
Centre are invariably located in different seismic zones to prevent the possibility of both
being impacted simultaneously.
The correct answer is, thus, as in Option B
342. One feature of WAN Network Topology is ____________
A. The Near-site DC is normally located in a different room/floor within the same
complex as the DC
B. The DC, Near-site DC and DRC are not connected, to prevent spread of
malicious viruses, etc.
C. Banks maintain a Near-site Data Centre (Near DC) in addition to the Data centre
(DC) & Disaster Recovery Centre (DRC)
D. The DC and the DRC are invariably located in the same seismically safe area
KEY C
Justification
The Data Centre and the Disaster Recovery Centre are invariably located in different
seismic zones to prevent the possibility of both being impacted simultaneously. The
Near-site Data Centre is maintained in addition to the DRC within a radius of about 20-
30 kms of the DC. The Near DC is connected both to the DC as well as the DRC
through redundant links and would serve as the back-up for operational data in case of
failure of the DC.
The correct answer is, thus, as in Option C
343. One feature of WAN Network Topology is ____________________
A. Data to & from the WAN to branches, DC, Near DC & DRC is in plaintext & not
encrypted
B. The DC, Near-site DC and DRC are not connected, to prevent spread of
malicious viruses, etc.
C. The DC and the DRC are invariably located in the same seismically safe area
D. Domain services are hosted in the Data centre (DC), Near-site Data Centre (Near
DC) & Disaster Recovery Centre (DRC) in different De-Militarized Zones (DMZs)
133
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
Domain services are hosted in the DC, Near DC & DRC in different DMZs. The Data
Centre and the Disaster Recovery Centre are invariably located in different seismic
zones to prevent the possibility of both being impacted simultaneously. The Near-site
Data Centre is maintained in addition to the DRC within a radius of about 20-30 kms of
the DC. The Near DC is connected both to the DC as well as the DRC through
redundant links and would serve as the back-up for operational data in case of failure of
the DC. Data to and from the WAN to branches, DC, Near DC & DRC is all encrypted.
The correct answer is, thus, as in Option D
344. This is a feature of WAN Network Topology.
A. Redundancy is built in at DC, with links from minimum of two ISPs
B. The DC and the DRC are invariably located in the same seismically safe area
C. Data to & from the WAN to branches, DC, Near DC & DRC is in plaintext & not
encrypted
D. The DC, Near-site DC and DRC are not connected, to prevent spread of
malicious viruses, etc.
KEY A
Justification
To pre-empt the risk of failure of ISP (Internet Service Provider) link, redundancy is built
in at the DC with links from a minimum of two ISPs. The Data Centre and the Disaster
Recovery Centre are invariably located in different seismic zones to prevent the
possibility of both being impacted simultaneously. The Near-site Data Centre is
maintained in addition to the DRC within a radius of about 20-30 kms of the DC. The
Near DC is connected both to the DC as well as the DRC through redundant links and
would serve as the back-up for operational data in case of failure of the DC. Data to and
from the WAN to branches, DC, Near DC & DRC is all encrypted.
The correct answer is, thus, as in Option A.
345. Chartered Accountants are impacted by IT mainly in the following way
_______________
A. The IT industry is becoming global
B. The IT industry is being dominated by India
C. Automation of their clients’ operations & their data going digital
D. The Institute of Chartered Accountants is going digital
134
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
CAs are impacted by IT primarily by the automation of their client’s operations & their
data going digital. Also, CA firms themselves have to use IT in their own offices to
provide services.
The correct answer is, thus, as in Option C.
346. Chartered Accountants are impacted by IT mainly in the following way _________
A. The Institute of Chartered Accountants is going digital
B. The IT industry is being dominated by India
C. CA firms themselves will need to use IT for servicing their customers
D. The IT industry is becoming global
KEY C
Justification
CAs are impacted by IT primarily by the automation of their client’s operations & their
data going digital. Also, CA firms themselves have to use IT in their own offices to
provide services.
The correct answer is, thus, as in Option C
347. A Data Warehouse is a collection of decision-support data that is
_________________
A. Volatile & updated on a daily basis
B. Exclusively relating to sales & marketing
C. Historical, supporting analysis & reporting functions
D. De-centralized with warehouses distributed over the country
KEY C
Justification
A data warehouse is a centralized analytically oriented, integrated, time-oriented & non-
volatile collection of data. It relates to all areas of operations which have relevance to
business goals. Hence, only Option C is correct.
348. A Data Mart ___________
A. Contains detailed data relating to a single aspect of business in large companies
135
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
136
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
351. Your daughter orders five salwar-kameez sets on the Myntra website for door
delivery. She uses the Government wireless communication facility for carrying
out this task. Which model of e-commerce would this fall in ?
A. Business-to-business
B. Consumer-to-consumer
C. Business-to-Government
D. Business-to-consumer
KEY D
Justification
This would obviously be a case of a business-to-consumer model &, hence, only Option
D is correct.
352. Cloud computing refers to ___________
A. On demand, networked access to a shared pool of computing resources
B. Computing carried out using software loaded on satellites
C. Strategic planning carried out through computerised simulations
D. Computing with light & minimal software
KEY A
Justification
Cloud computing refers to on demand, networked access to a shared pool of computing
resources as indicated in Option A. It is generally offered as a utility to users, payable
on the basis of consumption. Hence Option A is correct & the other options incorrect.
353. The Front-end in Cloud computing refers to _________
A. The Client’s computer alone; the access software is available on the cloud
B. The various computers, servers & data storage systems in the cloud system
C. The software available on the cloud computing systems
D. The Client’s computer as well as the software required to access the cloud
KEY D
Justification
The Front-end in Cloud computing comprises the Client’s computer as well as the
software required to access the cloud. Hence, Option D is correct whereas the other
options are incorrect.
137
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
138
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY D
Justification
Hybrid Cloud computing provides both private & public computing services, as indicated
in Option D. Hence, the other options are incorrect.
357. A Platform as a Service (PaaS) Cloud Computing model allows clients access to
______________
A. Hardware & operating system on the cloud but not the underlying infrastructure
B. Hardware & operating system on the cloud and also the underlying infrastructure
C. A variety of software provided on the cloud
D. Infrastructure, in terms of processing, storage & other computer networks, alone
KEY A
Justification
Option A above captures the correct services offered by PaaS; the other options are
incorrect.
358. A Software as a Service (SaaS) Cloud Computing model allows clients access to
______________
A. Hardware & operating system on the cloud but not the underlying infrastructure
B. Hardware & operating system on the cloud and also the underlying infrastructure
C. Infrastructure, in terms of processing, storage & other computer networks, alone
D. A variety of software applications made available by the provider on the cloud
KEY D
Justification
Option D above captures the correct services offered by SaaS; the other options are
incorrect.
359. One of the major risks associated with Cloud computing is __________________
A. Increased cost of operations
B. Greater dependency on third parties & vulnerability to risk
C. Increase in manpower requirements
D. Loss of competitive advantage
139
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
Justification
Options at A,C & D are incorrect; cloud computing should actually help reduce costs,
improve competitive advantage & not lead to increased manpower requirements.
However, to the extent one is forced to use a third party cloud computing service, the
client’s dependency increases with consequent risk perception. Hence, Option B alone
is correct.
360. What are the major perspectives in the role of a Chartered Accountant (CA) in the
post implementation stage of Enterprise Resource Planning (ERP) software ?
A. Defining criticality of the business & applying priorities
B. Cost-benefit analysis of customization
C. Optimization & security of the software system
D. Reports required for monitoring and control
KEY C
Justification
Post implementation, the CA would have already helped map the business processes &
arrived at the best configuration of the software and its applications. His focus would,
hence, be on optimization of the system & ensure adequate security. Hence, Option C
alone is correct.
361. What are some of the major challenges of using Enterprise Resource Planning
(ERP) software ?
A. Reduced data access
B. Need for redundant legacy systems to be maintained in parallel
C. Expenses & time in implementation
D. Increased operating costs
KEY C
Justification
The large expenditure involved in purchase as also the intricacies of implementation of
this software are the major challenges which would be faced by an individual launching
ERP software. Implementation of the ERP system would actually help improve data
access, reduce operating costs & eliminate the need for legacy systems, contradicting
the answers in Options A, B and D. Hence, Option C alone is correct.
362. Your client has a diversified business with manufacturing units & offices at multi-
locations. He is now trying to streamline operations by opting for a centralized
140
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
ERP system. You have assisted him in screening potential products & arriving at
the one best suited to his needs. The next step which would be critical for
optimizing the ERP software & aligning it to the business’s needs would be
_______________
A. Understanding business processes, identifying priorities & incorporating best
practices
B. Eliminating legacy systems
C. Implementing the system immediately to save on time & reap the benefits quickly
D. Implementing the system in a part of the organization alone, to start with
KEY A
Justification
Before commencing implementation of the ERP software, it is important to get a
thorough understanding of the business processes involved & identifying priority areas
(as mentioned in Option A). Based upon this, relevant best practices & benchmark
indices can be identified & incorporated in the final model in order to extract maximum
benefit from the software. Legacy systems elimination can be undertaken only after
successful commissioning of the ERP (at least at the pilot level). While it may seem
attractive to accelerate the implementation with the objective of generating savings
earlier, it would be far better to ensure that the approved model is robust & flexible
enough to accommodate potential changes in the environment. Lastly, an ERP is ideally
implemented enterprise-wide in order to harness the power of the software.
Implementing it in part of the organization would leave it in a stunted & sub-optimal
form. Hence, Option A alone is correct.
363. Which of the following is true of a typical Enterprise Resource Planning (ERP)
system ?
A. Capable of operation only on batch processing basis; cannot be real-time based
B. At any point of time, the same data, on real-time basis, can be accessed by
people in different parts of the organization
C. Capable of generating a balance sheet and P&L statement even on a daily basis
D. Implementation of a new ERP system can be done very quickly since it is
modular
141
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
ERP systems allow all users access to real-time data. Of course, access may be limited
to individual users on a ‘need-to-know’ basis. Once configured & implemented, it should
technically be possible to generate financial statements even on a daily basis. One of
the limitations of any robust ERP system is the time taken for implementation. For best
results, the implementation process has to be rigorous & scrupulously adhered to. Short
cuts can be counter-productive. Hence, Option C alone is correct.
364. One of the major risks of Enterprise Resource Planning (ERP) systems is ?
A. Increased complexity of simply legacy processes
B. Increased manpower requirement, particularly in the accounting area
C. Risk of depending upon one ERP vendor for all the critical operations of the
organization
D. Increased operating costs
KEY C
Justification
A major risk with ERP systems is the fact that they cover the entire operations of an
organization & any default or failure on the part of the ERP system vendor can have
catastrophic consequences for operations. The situation is further compounded by the
fact that there are very few dependable ERP system vendors, leaving little choice. A
well implemented ERP would actually simplify legacy business processes. A major
positive outcome of ERP implementation is generally a reduction in manpower,
particularly in the accounting department. Costs would, obviously be lower than before.
Hence, Option C alone is correct.
365. You are a budding entrepreneur running a Small & Medium Enterprise. The SME is
on a rapid growth path & you have ambitious expansion plans. You have invested
substantial sums in creating a robust IT system for the organization keeping in
mind your future plans. You realize that the success of any system lies in checks
and balances, including a proper auditing system & decide on appointing an
auditor. The qualities you would pragmatically expect an ideal auditor to possess
for this role would be ______________
A. Expertise in all areas of IT technology
B. Thorough knowledge on the financial aspects alone
C. Adequate working knowledge of IT hardware & software
D. Expertise both in financial and IT technology aspects
142
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
C.A.s knowledge of IT technology need not and cannot be complete and total. They
only need adequate knowledge to effectively audit the IT functions of an organization
C.A.s cannot be expected to be experts in all areas of IT technology; this is not their
role
Knowledge of financial aspects alone in a technology oriented function like IT will not
facilitate effective auditing of the IT function
A C.A. cannot be expected to have thorough knowledge of both financial & IT
technology aspects
366. You are a Sales Manager in a consumer product company equipped with the
latest laptop computer. You use the laptop for analysing territory-wise sales
trends, customer preferences, etc. After a recent upgrade of software by your
company’s IT department, you observe that you are no longer able to analyze
historical sales trends. However, when you check the database in the computer,
the historical sales data is very much available. The problem you are facing is
probably due to ___________
A. A bug or inadequacy in the operating system
B. A bug or inadequacy in the application software
C. Insufficient memory space in the computer
D. Defective hardware in the laptop
KEY B
Justification
The problem has arisen after upgrade of the application software by the IT department.
The database clearly has the relevant data & it is the access to and/or manipulation of
this data which is the issue. Hence, Option B is correct. The other options are not
correct since they are not likely to create the problem encountered by the Sales
Manager.
367. Following an orientation programme on Information Technology, four members
from the group of participants are picked up and named Mr Fetch, Mr Decode, Ms
Execute and Ms Store as representative parts of the CPUs machine cycle. In
which sequence should these individuals queue up in order to accurately
demonstrate the machine cycle performed by the CPU ?
A. Mr Decode, Ms Execute, Ms Store and Mr Fetch
143
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
144
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY B
Justification
As brought out in paragraph 1.5.2., Mean Time Between Failures must be high and
Mean Time To Repair must be low.
All the other answers are, therefore, obviously wrong.
370. As a Chartered Accountant, you feel that Hardware Auditing __________
A. Is best carried out by the purchase department of the I.T. department
B. Should be restricted to the financial aspects of hardware usage
C. Primarily encompasses hardware acquisition & capacity management
D. Is not as critical as software auditing which can be a more vulnerable area
KEY C
Justification
Paragraph1.6 elaborates on the criticality of hardware acquisition & capacity
management as KEY Areas of Hardware auditing.
Hardware is a vulnerable area which needs to be closely reviewed by Audit. Hence, the
other three options are not correct
371. Your client reports to you concern about security of the data in his organization
and would like to install software which effectively manages ownership
assignment of all data for accountability. What type of software would you
recommend him to install ?
A. Data Communications Software
B. Access Control Software
C. Utility programs
D. Defragmenters
KEY B
Justification
It is access control software which is vested with the responsibility for assigning
ownership of all data for purposes of accountability (para 2.3.2). Data Communications
software generally assists the OS for local and remote terminal access (option A). Utility
programs and defragmenters basically help improve computer efficiency and
performance and have nothing to do with ownership assignment of all data.
145
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
372. You are auditing a major software purchase transaction by your client. In your
opinion, what should your client have done as a first step in acquiring the
software ?
A. Establish scope, objectives background & project charter
B. Establish criteria for selecting and rejecting alternatives
C. Carry out Cost/Benefit analysis, including make or buy decision
D. Determine supplier’s technical capabilities & support services
KEY A
Justification
Without first establishing the scope and objectives, software acquisition may end up
failing on fundamental aspects of meeting end user needs. This would be the starting
point, therefore, for any acquisition exercise. The other options get ruled out by default.
373. Your client is in the process of deploying IT in his business operations & seeks
advice about the potential drawbacks of following a Centralised Deployment
Strategy. Your answer would be that the major drawback of this strategy would be
____________
A. Resource sharing of reduced order
B. Poorer economies of scale
C. Reduced security
D. Vulnerability due to single point of failure
KEY D
Justification
Centralized deployment strategy concentrates all its resources at one central point
making it vulnerable to total system failure in the event of this central point being
compromised in any manner (Option D). Resource sharing, in fact, is a strong plus point
for centralised deployment. Similarly, this system has better economies of scale owing
to use of large size hardware & larger number of software licences. Since everything is
centralized, possibilities of leakages are reduced since the number of exposed points
are lesser. Hence, the other options are not correct.
374. Your client is in the process of deploying IT in his business operations & seeks
advice about the potential drawbacks of following a De-centralised Deployment
Strategy. Your answer would be that the major drawback of this strategy would be
_____________
A. Less flexibility to cope with internal/external changes
146
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
147
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
148
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
149
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
An Optic fibre cable consists of an inner core made of glass/plastic/polymer/acrylic
which uses light based signalling. It has high integrity as well as low attenuation over
long distances. It has higher carrying capacity & consumer lesser power since signals
do not degrade as fast as in other systems. Hence, Option A is the only correct option.
381. You have recently taken on a Travel agency as your client. You are familiarizing
yourself with the agency & its operations. You are told that they use a network of
computers which are designed as per Bus topology. You realize then that the
agency’s computer system involves ____________
A. A single hub connecting all nodes
B. Connection of its computers on a single circle of cable
C. Connection of computers on a single backbone cable
D. Connection of every node to every other node
KEY C
Justification
In Bus topology, all the computers in the network are connected on a single backbone
cable. All the computers in the network receive incoming messages from any other
computer; however, only the intended recipient accepts and processes the message. It
is not on a single hub or circle of cable and each of the nodes are not connected to
each other. The correct answer is Option C
382. You have signed on for an audit of an Internet service provider. What sort of
network topology do you expect this organization to have adopted ?
A. Ring topology, involving connection of all the computers on a single ring of cable
B. Star topology, connecting all the computers to a central hub or switch
C. Mesh topology, involving physical connection of every node with every other
node
D. Bus topology with all systems Ideally suited for systems with need for low degree
of fault tolerance
150
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
This involves physical connection of every node with every other node. It is rather
complex and requires maximum number of cables. However, it is ideally suited for large
telecommunication companies or an internet service provider who cannot afford to have
a high degree of fault tolerance. It is not connected to a single backbone or hub/switch.
The correct answer, therefore, is Option C.
383. Your client has noted that a user with a particular IP address has been trying to
access its server & wishes to identify the physical address (MAC) of the user.
Which is the protocol which would have to be used for doing this ?
A. Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP)
B. Transmission Control Protocl (TCP)
C. Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP)
D. Address Resolution Protocol or ARP
KEY D
Justification
ARP is a method of ascertaining the physical address (MAC), given the IP address. The
other protocols in Options B to C have other capabilities. Hence, only Option D is
correct.
384. You observe that the first Octet of the IP address of one of your clients is 195 in
decimal range. In which Class of the IPv4 Classful Addressing Scheme does this
fall ?
A. C
B. D
C. A
D. E
KEY A
Justification
The first Octet of Class C of the IPv4 Classful Addressing Scheme is any number
ranging between 192 and 223 & the client’s number of 195 falls within this range.
Hence, the answer in Option A is correct. The other options are incorrect.
385. Technology development by design from a strategic perspective by CA firms
could _____________
151
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
152
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY D
Justification
Class E of the IPv4 Classful Addressing scheme is reserved for research &
development / study. The first Octet would fall within a range of 240 to 254. Option D,
thus, gives the correct answer & the other options are incorrect.
388. You have just taken on as your client, a huge international organization with a
large presence on internet networks. Which of the following types of Network
(N)/Host (H) id of the IPv4 Classful Addressing Scheme would you expect the
client to have ?
A. N.H.H.H
B. H.N.N.N
C. N.N.H.H.
D. H.H.N.N
KEY A
Justification
Large organizations with extensive presence on the internet are generally included in
Class A of the IPv4 Classful Addressing scheme. The first Octet would then represent
the network id and the other Octets, the host id, as indicated in Option A. The other
options are not correct.
389. Your new client advises you that its IP address falls under Class C of the IPv4
Classful Addressing Scheme. Which of the following types of Network (N)/Host
(H) id would you expect the client to have ?
A. H.N.N.N
B. N.N.H.H.
C. N.N.N.H
D. H.H.N.N
KEY C
Justification
Large organizations with extensive presence on the internet are generally included in
Class A of the IPv4 Classful Addressing scheme. The first Octet would then represent
the network id and the other Octets, the host id, as indicated in Option C. The other
options are incorrect.
153
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
390. If your client’s IT manager advises you that his company’s default sub-net mask
under the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is 255.255.0.0, which of the following IP
classes does his company’s network belong ?
A. Class A
B. Class C
C. Class B
D. Class E
KEY C
Justification
The default sub-net mask of Class B of the IP Classful Addressing Scheme is
255.255.0.0; hence, Option C is correct. The other options are not correct.
391. You are with the IT Manager of your client, trying to understand their systems.
The IT Manager is a person who revels in creating puzzles. When you ask him
about his company’s IP address, he tells you that it belongs to an IPv4 class that
can accommodate the least number of networks but the maximum number of
hosts per network (usable addresses). To which IP class is he referring ?
A. Class A
B. Class B
C. Class C
D. Class D
KEY A
Justification
The IP class A of IPv4 can handle the least number of networks (126) and maximum
number of usable addresses (1,67,77,214). Hence, Option A is correct & the other
options are incorrect.
392. You are with the IT Manager of your client, trying to understand their systems.
The IT Manager is a person who revels in playing with puzzles. When you ask him
about his company’s IP address, he tells you that it belongs to an IPv4 class that
can accommodate nearly 21 lakh networks. He adds, however, that the flip side is
that the number of useable addresses per network would be a measly figure of
about 250. To which IP class is he referring ?
A. Class A
B. Class B
154
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
C. Class D
D. Class C
KEY D
Justification
The IP class C of IPv4 can handle as many as 20,97,150 networks but number of
usable addresses can be only 254. Hence, Option D is correct & the other options are
incorrect.
393. As an experienced Chartered Accountant, you are addressing a group of freshers
on the subject of the massive quantities of information available to any
organization. In this background, what would you stress as most critical for
successful business operations ?
A. Establishing hardware infrastructure to handle voluminous information
B. Recruiting more IT personnel to handle large volume of data
C. Building more storage space for the voluminous data
D. Capability to pick out the KEY Aspects which can help serve the customer better
KEY D
Justification
The most critical factor for business success in the current information age is the
capability to sift the grain from the chaff, pick out the exceptions & appreciate customer
preferences & nuances of demand. The other options of creating infrastructure, adding
people or storage space are, at best, short term measures for coping with dealing with
‘big data’ rather than means of identifying customer needs & satisfying them.
A retail grocery chain store analyses data of its sales over different time periods over
the day. It observes that in many of its markets, substantial sales happen throughout
the day but in certain specific markets, sales peaked late in the evening. In these
markets, frequent instances were also reported of staff having to send away customers
as late as 10 pm in the night since closing time for the store had been crossed. On
carrying out a more detailed analysis of the profile of the customers in these markets, it
discovered that these were dominated by young employees of IT & BPO companies,
many of whom worked in line with U.S. and European markets & returned home late in
the night.
394. The store then decided to experiment with extended timings, up till midnight, for
the stores in such markets & was delighted to find sales burgeoning. Which of the
following best describes this initiative ?
A. Leveraging Business Intelligence to identify latent customer needs
155
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
156
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
factors as also sales elements, etc. Such a cloud facility would be deemed to be a
______________
A. Public Cloud facility
B. Private Cloud facility
C. Community Cloud facility
D. Hybrid Cloud facility
KEY C
Justification
When several businesses share a common cloud computing resource, it is called a
community cloud facility. Hence, Option C is correct whereas the other options are
incorrect.
397. One of your client’s managers tells you that they have recently opted for some
cloud computing facilities. Being a non-IT official, he says he does not
understand what exactly is meant by the term but he has been told that they have
opted for a model of Infrastructure as a Service (IaaS). With your own background
knowledge of the subject, you explain to him that an IaaS model involves
_____________
A. Provision of processing, storage networks & other basic computing resources
B. Provision of various types of software on the cloud which can be used by any
client
C. Provision of hardware & operating system platform alone
D. Provision of manpower on remote access basis
KEY A
Justification
The Iaas model involves provision of processing, storage networks & other basic
computing resources as brought out in Option A. Hence, the other options are incorrect.
398. Your client hires the services of an e-auction platform for launching its reverse
auction for purchase of various raw materials. The client accesses the platform
through the internet. Several suppliers register themselves with the platform &
participate in the reverse auction on the planned date. Which model of e-
commerce would this fall in _____________
A. Business-to-Government
B. Business-to-consumer
C. Business-to-business
157
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
D. Consumer-to-consumer
KEY C
Justification
This would obviously be a case of a business-to-business model &, hence, only Option
C is correct.
399. The Tamil Nadu State Government has announced that payment of house taxes,
electricity bills, etc. can be made by citizens through the respective portals using
internet banking or credit / debit cards. Which model of e-commerce would this
fall in ______________
A. Business-to-business
B. Business-to-Government
C. Consumer-to-consumer
D. E-Government
KEY D
Justification
This would obviously be a case of E-Government, facilitating payment of taxes & bills
through an Internet based facility. Hence, only Option D is correct.
400. You are a Google account holder. Google informs you that they have begun to
offer cloud computing facilities to its users & that, as an existing user, you will be
allowed up to 15 GB of data storage on the cloud free of cost & thereafter, a
nominal $ 0.026 per GB per month. Delighted, you begin using the facility with
your laptop. Soon, you receive an alert on the system that you have exhausted
the 15 GB free storage space & would need to begin paying for securing more
storage space. Which of the characteristics of Cloud computing does this
demonstrate ?
A. Resource Pooling
B. Network access from any device
C. Measured services & on-demand self-service
D. Access to software & computing capabilities
158
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
In the given instance, the client is being offered measured services & on-demand self
service as brought out in Option C. The example does not throw up any specific
information about Resource pooling or facility for accessing the cloud through any
device other than the laptop being used. It does not also speak of other Cloud
computing services like access to software, etc. Hence, only Option C is correct.
401. The Bring Your Own Device (BYOD) concept _____________
A. Envisages permitting employees to use their own personal devices for official
work
B. Envisages permitting employees to do their personal work on official devices
C. Is a risk free & beneficial system for corporate
D. Envisages storage of both official & personal information on the same device
without any demarcation
KEY A
Justification
The BYOD concept envisages permitting employees to use their own personal devices
for official work. It has the advantage of saving IT infrastructure expenditure &
convenience for employees. It does not envisage usage of company properties by
employees for their personal work. While it has many advantages, it is vulnerable to
some risks. In general, when the same device is used both for personal as well as
official use, virtual demarcation is made of the information storage system & adequate
firewalls incorporated. Thus, Option A alone is correct.
402. eXtensible Markup Language or XML _______________
A. Describes how data can be presented in the form of web pages
B. Involves use of pre-determined tags
C. Is a platform-independent, standard data exchange format
D. Is less powerful than Hypertext Markup Language or HTML
KEY C
Justification
As indicated in Option A above, XML is a platform-independent, standard data
exchange format. It performs presentation, communication & storage of data. It does
not involve use of pre-determined tags; instead, users need to define their own tags.
XML is more powerful than HTML since it facilitates automatic manipulation &
interpretation of data. Thus, Option C alone is correct.
159
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
160
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
As indicated in Option A above, XBRL has the advantage of being a standard that has
been accepted and adopted the world over. The other answers in Options A B and D
are equally applicable both to XML as well as XBRL. Hence, the correct answer is only
in Option C.
406. An advantage of eXtensible Business Reporting Language or XBRL over
eXtensible Markup Language or XML is that the former _______________
A. Is much faster and allows real-time preparation of reports
B. Provides a standard format for data exchange
C. Is portable and vendor neutral
D. Can help create data that can be read by different applications
KEY A
Justification
As indicated in Option A above, XBRL has the advantage of facilitating faster and real-
time preparation of business reports. The other answers in Options B to D are equally
applicable both to XML as well as XBRL. Hence, the correct answer is only in Option A.
407. An advantage of eXtensible Business Reporting Language or XBRL over
eXtensible Markup Language or XML is that the former ______________
A. Provides a standard format for data exchange
B. Is portable and vendor neutral
C. Can express more than one relationship amongst elements
D. Can help create data that can be read by different applications
KEY C
Justification
As indicated in Option A above, XBRL has the advantage of being capable of
expressing more than one relationship amongst elements, such as multiple hierarchies.
This is because it defines relationships separately from elements, unlike XML. The
answers in Options A B and D are equally applicable both to XML as well as XBRL.
Hence, the correct answer is only in Option C.
408. A feature of eXtensible Business Reporting Language or XBRL which is not found
in eXtensible Markup Language or XML is that the former _________
161
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
162
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY A
Justification
Social media is social interaction among people in which they create, share or
exchange information & ideas in virtual communities and networks. LinkedIn as an
example of social networking is an example of social media. The other instances are
examples of magazines and newspapers which do not fall within the ambits of social
media. Hence, the correct answer is only in Option A.
411. State True or False. In Social Media, content is supplied and managed by user
himself through the use of tools and platforms supplied by social media sites.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
Social media is social interaction among people in which they create, share or
exchange information & ideas in virtual communities and networks. Social media sites
like Facebook do allow users to supply & manage content using the tools and platform
provided by the sites. Hence, the correct answer is as in Option A.
412. What is the major aspect of Social Media which is relevant to business, in general
____________
A. It helps sell more software related to tools of social media
B. It renders physical markets and direct contact with customers redundant
C. It facilitates a platform for business to interact with customers
D. It is relevant only to members of the higher income group in society
KEY C
Justification
Social media is social interaction among people in which they create, share or
exchange information & ideas in virtual communities and networks. It provides
businesses a platform to interact with customers to conduct market research, carry out
sales promotion, reward campaigns, etc. The prospect of selling relevant software is not
a generalized benefit but restricted to a narrow spectrum of business. While it does
increase the importance of presence in social media, it does not, necessarily, reduce
the importance of physical markets & direct customer contact. It is also not true to say
that social media is more relevant only to members of the higher income group in
society. Hence, the correct answer is as in Option C.
163
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
413. Breach of privacy, fear of legal action, potential for negative reputation, etc. are
potential risks for business leveraging social media. What is the other major type
of risk which a CA may have to address ______________
A. The risk of ignoring customers who are not members of the social media
B. The risk of development of new social media platforms
C. The risk of use of social media by employees on organization networks/devices
D. The risk of the collapse of all social media
KEY C
Justification
The risk of use of social media by employees on organization networks and devices is
the other major risk which CAs would have to be alert to. For, this could lead to
intentional or accidental leak of organizational data as also provide a route for hackers
to access the organization’s data base. The other risks outlined in Options A B and D
are not significant enough to cause concern. Hence, the correct answer is as in Option
C.
414. What is one of the important measures required for mitigating security concerns
in using Social Media?
A. The organization avoiding use of Social media
B. Creation of & compliance with a robust, comprehensive Social Media policy
C. Banning employees from being members of social media
D. Creating firewalls blocking out potential hackers
KEY B
Justification
The single major initiative that an organization can take is the creation of a robust &
comprehensive Social Media policy. Avoiding use of social media is a sub-optimal &
escapist solution which will not benefit the organization. Banning employees is too
tyrannical a measure to take in an era when most people, particularly, from the younger
generation, are members of some form or social media. This may actually deter
potential employees from joining the organization. The use of firewalls is required as a
matter of standard policy, whether the organization is using social media or not. Hence,
the correct answer is as in Option B.
415. How is Geolocation different from Global Positioning System (GPS) ?
A. It is not different; it is just another term for GPS
164
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
165
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
166
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
The word-processing software pops up suggested words based upon the first few words
keyed in by the user. Also, when the user keys in a new word which is not available in
its repertoire, it adds it to its collection & reflects it as an option the next time similar
letters are initiated. In effect, the software is able to observe & record patterns and
improves through ‘learning’. The other answers in Options A B and D involve the basic
computing functions of a computer which is based on a ‘go / no-go’ logic which does not
involve pattern recognition or further learning. Hence, the correct answer is only as in
Option C which displays characteristics of artificial intelligence.
421. Artificial Intelligence works with the help of two concepts; one of them is Artificial
neurons. The other is ?
A. ‘If-then’ statements and logics
B. ‘What-if’ scenarios
C. The four ‘W’s What, When, Where & Why
D. ‘How-Why’ statements
KEY A
Justification
Artificial intelligence works with the help of Artificial neurons as also ‘If-then’ statements
/logics. The answers in the other options are no correct. Hence, the correct answer is
only as in Option A.
422. Artificial Intelligence works with the help of two concepts; one of them is Artificial
neurons. The other is ?
A. ‘What-if’ scenarios
B. The four ‘W’s What, When, Where & Why
C. ‘If-then’ statements and logics
D. ‘How-Why’ statements
KEY C
Justification
Artificial intelligence works with the help of Artificial neurons as also ‘If-then’ statements
/logics. The answers in the other options are no correct. Hence, the correct answer is
only as in Option C.
423. An Expert System _____________
167
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
168
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
169
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
170
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
Justification
DSS have the capability to support both semi-structured as well as structured problems.
Their configuration is such that they can be used by managers as an aid to both
operational as well as strategic decision-making. Hence, the above statement is true
and Option A is correct.
430. A KEY differentiator for a Decision Support System over a Transaction
Processing System is _______________.
A. It can handle large amounts of data in batch as well as online mode
B. It is more interactive & model-driven, performing mathematical & qualitative
analysis
C. It has a larger database as compared to the transaction processing system
D. It can more reliably handle large volume of information relating to transactions
KEY B
Justification
Decision support systems are far more interactive and model-driven, as brought out in
Option A above. The answers in Options A,C and D are not correct and probably relate
more to Transaction processing systems. They are surely not KEY differentiators.
Hence, the correct answer is only as in Option B.
431. The type of software support system which would generally be suited for top-level
decision-making, like spinning-off a portion of the company, acquiring another
company, entering a new business, etc. is ____________
A. Decision Support System
B. Data Base Management System
C. Executive Support System
D. Delphi system
KEY C
Justification
Executive support systems are the appropriate choice for such top-level decision
making support, as brought out in Option C above. The answers in Options A, B and D
are not correct. The correct answer is only as in Option C.
171
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
172
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY C
Justification
Data collection in large quantities, per se, carries limited value. It is the careful analysis
of humongous volumes of data to elicit patterns of customer behaviour, market trends,
etc. that are the major prize won through Big Data. Such exercises help companies to
tap new markets, implicit demand, etc. and thus, be one up on the competition. Hence,
the answer in Option C above alone is correct. The answers in Options A B and D are
not correct.
435. What is the major control aspect of dealing with Big Data which a Chartered
Accountant needs to be aware of ?
A. Privacy, security & legal aspects of dealing with customer & other parties’
information
B. Providing adequate storage space for the large volumes of data
C. Instituting adequate steps for collection & collation of the data
D. Ensuring adequate storage security through redundancy
KEY A
Justification
There are potential risks involved in collecting, storing & utilising customer data. There
is a need for ensuring the entire process is carried out in a legal manner without
causing dis-comfort or loss of faith with the customer. Protecting information passed on
by a customer based upon trust, is another KEY Aspect. Thus, the answer in Option A
above is correct & the other answers are wrong.
436. Returning from school one day, your daughter cannot wait to talk about what they
taught her on that day regarding environmental degradation & global warming.
She tells you that electricity is generated by power plants to meet our energy
needs but they are, at the same time, releasing greenhouse gases like Carbon
dioxide which contribute to global warming, leading to cascading effects. An
impact of this sort, created by an organization, individual or activity is referred to
as _________
A. Carbon credits
B. Carbonification
C. Carbon footprint
D. Oxidisation
173
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
The level of green house gases generated by activities & actions of an individual or
organization is referred to as a ‘carbon footprint’. Hence, the girl’s description of her
learnings at school refer to the carbon footprint of setting up a power plant. Thus, the
answer in Option C above is correct & the other answers are wrong.
437. Apart from the conscious choices of minimising the carbon foot print &
networking hardware, Green Information Technology involves ______________
A. Use or organic products in the organization
B. Minimizing use of water in the organization
C. Avoiding air conditioning, utilising natural cooling and light
D. Minimization of computer devices’ energy consumption
KEY D
Justification
The third of the choices to be made in Green Information technology is minimization of
computer devices’ energy consumption over their life cycle, as indicated in Option D
above. The answers in the other options are not correct.
438. One of following actions could be an intrinsic part of Green Information
Technology implementation ________________
A. Moving back storage & processing capacity from the cloud
B. Replacing a single server system with multiple servers
C. Installation of automatic shutdown/power-up processes
D. Avoiding replacement of old equipment with new ones
KEY C
Justification
The answers in Options A, B and D would act, by and large, counter to the goals of
Green information technology. Moving to cloud computing helps improved utilisation of
resources; similarly, a single server system is probably more energy efficient than
multiple servers. Though it may appear worthwhile continuing to sweat old equipment,
new equipment are generally more energy efficient and can more than compensate the
benefits of retaining the old equipment. The answer in Option C, however, is relevant &
will make a meaningful contribution to the goals of Green IT. Hence, only Option C is
the correct answer.
174
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
175
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. Setting of clear goals for power reduction, decreased carbon footprint, etc.
B. Replacing a single server system with multiple servers
C. Avoiding replacement of old equipment with new ones
D. Moving back storage & processing capacity from the cloud
KEY A
Justification
The answers in Options B to D would act, by and large, counter to the goals of Green
information technology. Moving to cloud computing helps improved utilisation of
resources; similarly, a single server system is probably more energy efficient than
multiple servers. Though it may appear worthwhile continuing to sweat old equipment,
new equipment are generally more energy efficient and can more than compensate for
the benefits of retaining the old equipment. The answer in Option A, however, is
relevant & will make a meaningful contribution to the goals of Green IT. The setting of
clear goals helps direct focus to the effort. Hence, only Option A is the correct answer.
442. What is characteristic of Web 2.0 ?
A. Communication from one person/unit to many
B. HTML Web pages & email newsletters
C. Facilitates collaboration & information sharing online
D. Two-way communication not possible
KEY C
Justification
The Web 2.0 version is a two-way communication facility covering blogs, wikis and
social networking sites. It facilitates collaboration & information sharing online, as
indicated in Option C. It is not a case of communication from only one person to many.
It is also an improvement over the Web 1.0 version which comprised HTML web pages
& email newsletters. Hence, Option C is the correct answer.
443. What is a distinguishing feature of Web 3.0 ?
A. Communication from one person/unit to many
B. Facilitates convergence of mobile phones, smartphone apps, etc.
C. HTML Web pages & email newsletters
D. Two-way communication not possible
176
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
KEY B
Justification
The Web 3.0 version is an evolving system which is an improvement over Web 2.0. It
facilitates convergence of mobile phones, smart phone apps, tablets, etc. It is not a
case of communication from only one person to many. Like Web 2.9, it is also an
improvement over the Web 1.0 version which comprised HTML web pages & email
newsletters. Hence, Option B is the correct answer.
444. What is one of the controls that can be practically established for overcoming the
risks of Web 2.0 without compromising on operational efficiencies ?
A. Blocking social networking sites like Facebook
B. Restricting access to blog sites
C. Blocking access to forums
D. Using extended validation, SSL certification for websites
KEY D
Justification
Blocking out features like social networking, forums, blogs, etc. would prevent utilization
of some of the KEY features of Web 2.0 and, hence, would be a sub-optimal approach.
It would be better to build in preventive measures like website validation, as brought out
in Option D. Hence, Option D is the correct answer.
445. One practical control that can be established for overcoming the risks of Web 2.0
without compromising on operational efficiencies is ?
A. To develop & implement internal policies for safeguarding against risks
B. Restricting access to blog sites
C. Blocking access to forums
D. Blocking social networking sites like Facebook
KEY A
Justification
Blocking out features like social networking, forums, blogs, etc. would prevent utilization
of some of the KEY features of Web 2.0 and, hence, would be a sub-optimal approach.
It would be better to draw up a robust policy which addresses all the potential risks of
Web 2.0 and the preventive measures required to minimizing them. Hence, only answer
in Option A is correct.
446. What is an example of Click jacking ?
177
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
178
Primer on Information Technology, IS Infrastructure & Emerging Technologies
449. Which is one of the major areas of emerging technology wherein CAs need to play
a KEY role ?
A. Management of social media & the risks associated with it
B. Development of new software technology
C. New techniques of marketing of products
D. Developments in the field of integrated circuits
KEY A
Justification
One major area of importance to CAs in the changing global environment is that of
management of social media & the risk associated with it. For, organizations are
increasingly shifting their marketing focus from the physical to the virtual market,
exploiting the strengths of the Internet. As more and more products get linked to the
Internet, the value of social media will increase tremendously as will the risks
associated with it. Hence, Option A is the correct answer. The other answers from
Options B to D are not correct.
450. Which one of the following is a KEY Area to be focussed upon by CAs in the
current era of emerging technologies ?
A. New techniques of marketing of products
B. Developments in the field of integrated circuits
C. Security of Systems and Data
D. Development of new software technology
KEY C
Justification
Apart from social media, the other major area of importance to CAs in the changing
global environment is security of systems and data. With the explosion of the Internet &
connected devices and expanded use of the Internet, the number of interfaces between
an organization & its customers / stake holders has grown exponentially. As a
consequence, security risks have mushroomed & the CA would have to focus on this as
a KEY element driving not just the success of an organization but also in preventing
failures in the organization. Thus, the answer in Option C is the correct answer. The
other answers from Options A, B and D are not correct.
451. Information System Audit encompasses independent review & evaluation of
___________
A. Automated information systems, related manual systems & their interfaces
179
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
180
Module 2
Information Systems Assurance Services
452. In COBIT 5 enablers are factors that influence that something will work in
governance & management of enterprise IT. How many such categories of
enablers does the COBIT 5 system identify ?
A. 7 categories of enablers
B. 5 categories of enablers
C. 8 categories of enablers
D. 10 categories of enablers
KEY A
Justification
COBIT5 is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT. It helps
organizations manage risk & ensure compliance, continuity, security & privacy. One of
its 5 KEY principles is meeting stakeholders’ needs. This principle creates value by
balancing the benefits against the optimization of risk & the use of resources. The
system identifies 7 categories of enablers that facilitate governance & management of
enterprise IT. Hence, the answer in Option A is correct and the other options are wrong.
453. Guidance on evaluating and assessing the internal controls implemented in an
enterprise is available in _________________
A. MEA 02 of COBIT 5
B. ITAF 1200 series
C. IS/IEF 27001
D. ITAF 1400 series
KEY A
Justification
COBIT5 is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT. MEA 02 of
COBIT5 is a process which provides guidance on evaluating and assessing the internal
controls implemented in an enterprise. Hence, the answer in Option A is correct and the
other options are wrong.
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
454. You have been engaged as a Consultant to carry out IS Audit of a large
organization. What is the first step you would take while commencing your work ?
A. Commence auditing of the financials
B. List all the software and hardware used in the organization
C. Peruse financials for the previous three years
D. Identify all risks present in the IT environment of the organization
KEY D
Justification
The first step in audit engagement is risk assessment based upon which the auditing
programme can be developed, giving more importance to high risk areas. Thus, the
auditor needs to identify all the risks present in the IT environment of the organization.
Hence, the answer in Option D is correct and the other options are wrong.
455. What is the minimum frequency of risk assessment to be carried out as per ISACA
guidelines ?
A. Once in 6 months
B. Once in 3 years
C. Once a year
D. Once in 2 years or whenever any major change in systems takes place
KEY C
Justification
The minimum frequency of risk assessment to be carried out as per ISACA guidance is
one year. Hence, the answer in Option C is correct and the other options are wrong.
456. State TRUE or FALSE. As per ISACA guidance, the IS auditor can complete the
risk assessment process and present the final findings to the stake holders. The
auditor needs to maintain his independence and does not need to seek the
specific approval of the stake holders for the findings.
A. FALSE
B. TRUE
KEY A
Justification
As per ISACA guidance, the IS auditor needs to seek approval of the risk assessment
from the audit stake holders and other appropriate parties Hence, the statement in the
question stem is false & the answer in Option A is correct.
182
Information Systems Assurance Services
457. State True or False. Standards on Risk assessment pertaining to IS Audit are
different from those prescribed by ICAI under SA315. IS Audit follow a different
set of standards laid down by ISACA.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY B
Justification
The standards on risk assessment pertaining to IS audit as prescribed by ICAI under
SA315 are also applicable to risk assessment under IS Audit. Hence, the statement in
the question stem is false & the answer in Option B is correct.
458. For effective risk assessment, auditors should ideally supplement the regular risk
assessment procedures with _______________
A. Observation, inspection & analytical procedures
B. Interviews with client’s competitors
C. Intensive analysis of historical data
D. Interviews with client’s suppliers
KEY A
Justification
While the risk assessment procedures outlined by ISACA, ICAI, etc. provide a ready-
made template that helps ensure typically vulnerable areas to be captured, observation,
inspection & analytical procedures help zero in on risk areas which are peculiar to the
particular business or specific period of time. The approaches in the other options may
also add value but may not be as significant as that achievable through the answer at
Option A. Hence, the statement in the question stem is false & the answer in Option A is
correct.
459. The ideal risk assessment technique _____________
A. Is a computerized scoring system based upon evaluation of risk factors
B. Is judgemental, based upon the auditor’s personal assessment
C. Depends upon the complexity level & detail appropriate for the organization
D. Is a combination of computerized scoring & judgemental system
183
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
The ideal risk assessment technique depends upon the complexity level & detail
appropriate for the particular organization. It could be one or a combination of more
than one technique. Hence, the statement in the question stem is false & the answer in
Option C is correct.
460. An IS Auditor carries out a preliminary visit to his client’s site to get a feel of the
operations and identify risks, if any, missed out during his initial study of the
records of the organization. In the server room, he feels uncomfortable and
realizes that the humidity level as well as the ambient temperature are quite high.
On further probing, he discovers that the air conditioning equipment had failed &
the original supplier had ceased operations. The administration manager was
struggling to find an alternate agency to set the problem right. Also, no fall back
system was in place. The IS Auditor is wondering whether this would fall within
the purview of his IT General Controls Review. What is your view ?
A. Yes, it would fall within the purview of IT General Control Review
B. No, it would not fall within the purview of IT General Control review
KEY A
Justification
A general control review would include infrastructure and environment controls too.
Hence, the answer in Option A is correct.
461. As part of his exploratory trips to his client’s office, an IS Auditor meets up with
the Server Manager. The manager is despondent and the auditor learns it is
because of his network cable supervisor’s resignation and impending relief. The
manager is unable to find a substitute immediately and dreads the thought of
managing any network cabling issues in the interim. The auditor discusses the
matter with the manager who feels that the incumbent supervisor is virtually
indispensable and he has no subordinate who could step into his shoes.
The auditor probes further and also visits some of the locations wherein cable
inspection slots were located. He discovers that the cabling junctions had been
done in a very haphazard fashion and were not even labelled. Nor was there any
manual or chart identifying the network of cables, their junctions/ports, etc. He
realizes that the incumbent supervisor had become indispensable on account of
this disorganized cabling system as also the absence of any manual. Ideally, the
cabling should have been carried out more scientifically, there should have been
a ready-reckoner or manual showing the details of the network and a second-in-
184
Information Systems Assurance Services
line should have been in place to stand in for the supervisor in the event of his
short term absence or resignation.
Would the auditor be well within his rights to include this aspect as a lacuna in
the general controls review ?
A. No, he would not be right to include this as a lacuna in his general controls
review
B. Yes, he would be right in including this aspect as a lacuna in his general controls
review
KEY B
Justification
A general control review would include infrastructure and environment controls too.
Hence, the answer in Option B is correct.
462. Is segregation of duties useful as an Organizational control ? Why ?
A. Yes, it reduces employee cost
B. Yes, it reduces fraud risk & facilitates accuracy check of one person’s work by
another
C. No, it is not an advantage; it increases employee cost
D. No, it complicates the role of the manager who has to manage more employees
KEY B
Justification
Segregation of duties is an important control tool whereby, conflicting roles in particular,
are segregated and handled by different individuals. It reduces the risk of fraud since
one person cannot independently commit any fraud but would need to collude with the
second. Also, since the output of one individual may become the input of another, an
independent accuracy check of one person’s work by another person becomes a built-in
reality. This may increase head-count and, hence, manpower cost but, employed
judiciously, the higher manpower cost can be more than compensated by the reduced
risks to the organization. Hence, the answer in Option B is correct.
463. A newly appointed Senior executive in an organization, who happened to be a
close relative of the promoter, is miffed when the IT Manager refuses access to
him to the Server room citing policy guidelines. The executive shares with you,
the Auditor of the organization, what he perceives to be insulting behaviour by
the IT Manager. You question him about the purpose of the visit and learn that the
executive just wanted to have a tour of the facility, as part of his induction. Do
you agree or disagree with the executive ? Why ?
185
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. Yes, I would agree. As a close relative of the promoter, he would surely have the
organization’s best interests at heart.
B. No, I would not agree. As a new employee, he should not be given access to the
server room
C. Yes, I would agree. The server, in any case, would be password protected & no
harm can be done
D. No, I would not agree. Physical access control to the server is an important
control mechanism
KEY D
Justification
Physical access control to the server room is an important part of IT General controls in
any organization. The server is a sensitive equipment with certain commands & settings
being exclusive to it. Un-authorized access to it could compromise the security of the IT
system & the organization, obviously, has a clearly defined access policy which has to
be respected. Relationship to the promoter cannot be an excuse for breaking the policy;
if, indeed, he had genuine need to visit the server room, he could have got the
necessary clearances. Denial of access cannot be owing to the newness of the
employee. Lastly, any robust system operates at different levels of redundancy & the
mere existence of password protected access to the server does not prevent a second
level of defence, in the form of access control, being done away with. Hence, the
answer in Option D is correct.
464. As a measure of IT General control, an organization decides to separate those
who can input data from those that can reconcile or approve data. Is this a good
move ? Why ?
A. No, it is not a good move; the person who inputs the data is the best person to
approve the data too
B. Yes, it is a good move; it can help prevent unauthorised data entry
C. Yes, it is a good move; inputting data & reconciling data requires different skills
D. No, it is not a good move; data entry errors would be compounded
KEY B
Justification
Segregation of duties is an important control tool whereby, conflicting roles in particular,
are segregated and handled by different individuals. It reduces the risk of fraud since
one person cannot independently commit any fraud but would need to collude with the
second. Also, since the output of one individual may become the input of another, an
independent accuracy check of one person’s work by another person becomes a built-in
reality
Hence, the answer in Option B is correct.
186
Information Systems Assurance Services
187
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
independent accuracy check of one person’s work by another person becomes a built-in
reality. In this case, conflict in roles is clearly existing. Also, while the user dept. may
have the need for a change, it is up to the programmer to devise an appropriate method
of programming logic to satisfy the user’s requirement. Time savings could, perhaps, be
gained by using the same person but this would mean paying the expensive price of
potentially unauthorised & defective programs being run. Hence, the answer in Option A
is correct.
467. Thanks to its growing popularity, a family-run fast food restaurant is transforming
itself into a chain of branded restaurants & has created a formal organization
structure to manage the growing organization. Having identified young and
upcoming IT industry employees as their core base of customers, the family
decides to build a strong backbone of IT to facilitate online ordering of food,
creation of customer database, etc. Since the immediate primary purpose is to
enable online payments for the purchases by customers, the trustworthy family
retainer & Junior Accountant is given the responsibility of installing and
maintaining the IT system.
As an IS Auditor, do you think the family was right in giving the Junior
Accountant the responsibility ? Why ?
A. No. A senior management representative should take responsibility in the interest
of IT General Control
B. Yes, since the accountant is the main beneficiary of the IT system
C. No. The Senior Accountant in the chain should have been given the responsibility
D. Yes, this role requires a trustworthy person & the family retainer is the best fit
KEY A
Justification
Responsibility for IT systems should lie with the top management with appropriate
delegation to lower levels. This would not only ensure that the highly vulnerable IT
systems are properly controlled at the highest levels in the company but also ensure
that appropriate IT policies are framed, keeping in mind organizational objectives and
goals. The perspective of an accountant, whether junior or senior, would be rather
limited to his area of operations and responsibility; it may lack the breadth of vision
which would be essential at the top management level as also the interfaces between
various functions in the business. In any professional organization, no positive bias can
be allowed for the dominance of so-called ‘family retainers’ however trustworthy they
may be. The operations have to be system driven & not personality driven. Hence, the
answer in Option A is correct.
188
Information Systems Assurance Services
189
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
This is a dual control system which falls under Finance control mechanism since it
entails two people simultaneously accessing an asset. Hence, the answer in Option A is
correct.
470. What is the first step for an Auditor in an Application software review ?
A. Ascertain the creator of the application software
B. Ascertain the validity of the user licence for the software
C. Ascertain the business function or activity that the software performs
D. Identify the users who have been granted access to the software
KEY C
Justification
The first step for an Auditor is to ascertain the business function or activity that the
software performs. The auditor needs to understand the intricacies of the business and
the way in which the software facilitates the business. Hence, the answer in Option C is
correct.
471. As an IS Auditor reviewing Application software in your new client’s organization,
you have started by thoroughly understanding the nature of the business and the
manner in which the Application software meets the business requirements. What
is the next step which you would take in the process of the Application software
review ?
A. Identify the users who have been granted access to the software
B. Ascertain the creator of the application software
C. Ascertain the validity of the user licence for the software
D. Check how the software handles the risks associated with the particular area of
business dealt with by it
KEY D
Justification
The next important step for an Auditor is to identify the potential risks associated with
the business activity/function served by the software & see how the risks are handled by
the software. Hence, the answer in Option D is correct.
472. State True or False. IT Application controls are controls which are in-built in the
software application itself.
190
Information Systems Assurance Services
A. FALSE
B. TRUE
KEY B
Justification
IT application controls are, indeed, controls which are in-built in the software application
itself. Hence, the answer in Option B is correct.
473. Which of the following are one of the KEY Areas that should be covered during an
IS Audit of Application software ?
A. List of authorised users of the software
B. Adherence to business rules in the flow & processing accuracy
C. Validity of software licence
D. Cost of the software & availability of cheaper alternatives
KEY B
Justification
One of the KEY Areas to be covered is the software’s adherence to business rules in
the flow and processing accuracy. The other answers in Options A, C and D are not of
immediate relevance or urgency. The answer in Option B is correct.
474. Which of the following are one of the KEY Areas that should be covered during an
IS Audit of Application software ?
A. Cost of the software & availability of cheaper alternatives
B. List of authorised users of the software
C. Validations of various data inputs
D. Validity of software licence
KEY C
Justification
One of the KEY Areas to be covered is the validation of various data inputs. The other
answers in Options A, B and D are not of immediate relevance or urgency. The answer
in Option C is correct.
475. Which of the following are one of the KEY Areas that should be covered during an
IS Audit of Application software ?
A. Logical access control and authorization
191
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
192
Information Systems Assurance Services
193
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
CAATs are basically computer assisted audit tools which help auditors sift through large
volumes of information to identify control issues, defaults, etc. They can greatly
enhance the efficiency and effectiveness of IS auditors. The answer in Option A is the
correct one.
481. What are some of the KEY reasons for establishing controls and auditing in a
computerized environment ?
A. Computers are more prone to make errors in handling subjective big data
B. There is more scope for fraud & error in a computerized environment
C. Data may be entered into the system without supporting documents
D. There is no choice since most operations are computerized
KEY C
Justification
A KEY vulnerability of computerized systems is the fact that, at times, data may be
entered into the system without supporting documents. This is a fundamental principle
of accounting which we cannot afford to ignore. Hence, the answer in Option C is the
correct one. The others are incorrect Computer are not more prone than humans in
making errors & one cannot say that there is increased scope for fraud & error in a
computerized environment.
482. What are some of the KEY reasons for establishing controls and auditing in a
computerized environment ?
A. Transaction trail may be partly in machine language & retained only for a limited
period
B. There is more scope for fraud & error in a computerized environment
C. Computers are more prone to make errors in handling subjective big data
D. There is no choice since most operations are computerized
KEY A
Justification
A KEY vulnerability of computerized systems is the fact that, at times, data may be
entered into the system without supporting documents. This is a fundamental principle
of accounting which we cannot afford to ignore. Another aspect is the fact that
transaction trails may not be visible they may be partly in machine language & retained
194
Information Systems Assurance Services
only for a limited period. Hence, the answer in Option A is the correct one. The others
are incorrect Computer are not more prone than humans in making errors & one cannot
say that there is increased scope for fraud & error in a computerized environment.
483. What is one of the KEY tests which can be ideally carried out using Computer
Assisted Audit Tools (CAATs) ?
A. Projections on future trends for specific parameters
B. Carrying out employees’ reference checks
C. Identification of exceptional transactions based upon set criteria
D. Carry out employee appraisals
KEY C
Justification
One of the many Key tests that can be carried out by CAATs is identification of
exceptional transactions based upon set criteria. The IS auditor can set the criteria
based upon the sort of transactions which are not expected to occur basis the controls
which are to have been incorporated in the organization’s systems. CAATs are more in
the nature of audit tools & would not be ideal for the other purposes listed in Options A,
B and D above. Hence, answer at Option C alone is correct.
484. What is one of the Key tests which can be ideally carried out using
Computer Assisted Audit Tools (CAATs) ?
A. Carry out employee appraisals
B. Identify potential areas of fraud
C. Projections on future trends for specific parameters
D. Carrying out employees’ reference checks
KEY B
Justification
One of the many Key tests that can be carried out by CAATs is identification of potential
areas of fraud. The IS auditor can set the criteria based upon the sort of transactions
which are not expected to occur basis the controls which are to have been incorporated
in the organization’s systems. CAATs are more in the nature of audit tools & would not
be ideal for the other purposes listed in other options above. Hence, answer at Option B
alone is correct.
485. What is one of the Key tests which can be ideally carried out using Computer
Assisted Audit Tools (CAATs) ?
195
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
196
Information Systems Assurance Services
KEY A
Justification
One of the many KEY tests that can be carried out by CAATs is establishing whether
the set controls are working as intended. CAATs are more in the nature of audit tools &
would not be ideal for the other purposes listed in Options B to D above. Hence, answer
at Option A alone is correct.
488. What is one of the KEY tests which can be ideally carried out using Computer
Assisted Audit Tools (CAATs) ?
A. Carry out market surveys for a new product launch
B. Projections on future trends for specific parameters
C. Establishing relationship between two or more areas & identify duplicate
transactions
D. Estimation of competitor activity
KEY C
Justification
One of the many KEY tests that can be carried out by CAATs is establishing whether
the set controls are working as intended. CAATs are more in the nature of audit tools &
would not be ideal for the other purposes listed in Options A, B and D above. Hence,
answer at Option C alone is correct.
489. What is Compliance testing ?
A. Testing any activity in compliance with Government rules and regulations
B. Checking whether the organization has remitted employee provident fund into the
relevant account
C. Checking whether the office employees are checking into and leaving the office
as per approved working hours
D. Checking whether controls are operated in compliance with management
policies/procedures
KEY D
Justification
Compliance testing deals with checking the controls which have been established in the
organization rather than checking compliance of any specific activity per se. Hence,
answer at Option D alone is correct. The answers in other options deal with the actual
activity rather than the controls and, hence, are not correct.
197
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
198
Information Systems Assurance Services
199
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
200
Information Systems Assurance Services
498. Which is the ICAI standard on auditing which deals with what constitutes audit
evidence in an audit of financial statements as also with the Auditor’s
responsibility to design and perform audit procedures ?
A. SA 230
B. SA 500
C. SA 1205
D. SA 580
KEY B
Justification
SA 500 is the ICAI standard on auditing which deals with what constitutes audit
evidence in an audit of financial statements as also with the Auditor’s responsibility to
design and perform audit procedures. Hence, the answer at Option B alone is correct.
499. Which is the ICAI standard on auditing which deals with the Auditor’s
responsibility to obtain written representations from the management as also
those charged with governance ?
A. SA 580
B. SA 230
C. SA 1205
D. SA 500
KEY A
Justification
SA 580 is the ICAI standard on auditing which deals with the Auditor’s responsibility to
obtain written representations from the management as also those charged with
governance. Hence, the answer at Option A alone is correct.
500. Which is the ISACA standard on evidence which IS auditors are required to
comply with?
A. 230
B. 1206
C. 500
D. 1205
201
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
The ISACA standard on evidence which IS auditors are required to comply with is 1205.
Hence, the answer at Option D alone is correct.
501. What are Test working papers in IS Audit Documentation ?
A. Draft of the final IS audit report prepared for the Board of Directors
B. Those prepared or obtained as a result of compliance/testing procedures
C. Draft of the preliminary IS audit report submitted to senior management for
comments
D. IS audit team’s answers to test questions on the auditee’s business &
environment
KEY B
Justification
Test working papers in IS Audit documentation are those prepared or obtained as a
result of compliance/testing procedures. Hence, the answer at Option B alone is correct.
502. Which is the ISACA standard relating to use of services of external experts ?
A. 1206
B. 230
C. 1205
D. 500
KEY A
Justification
The ISACA standard relating to use of services of external experts is 1206. Hence, the
answer at Option A alone is correct.
503. Which is the tool used in IS audit for assessing the proper level of controls ?
A. ISACA method 230
B. Random sampling of transactions
C. A control matrix, comparing known types of errors with known type of controls
D. ICAI guidelines on the appropriate level of controls
202
Information Systems Assurance Services
KEY C
Justification
The tool used in IS audit for assessing the proper level of controls is the control matrix.
This basically involves comparison of known types of errors with known types of
controls. Hence, the answer at Option C alone is correct.
504. Prior to reporting a control weakness, an IS auditor ______________
A. Should carry out random sampling of transactions
B. Should check whether there are 2 or more weak controls
C. Should check for a minimum of 3 strong controls
D. Should look for compensating controls
KEY D
Justification
Prior to reporting a control weakness, an IS auditor should look for compensating
controls. . Hence, the answer at Option D alone is correct.
505. State True or False. Materiality of an IS auditor’s findings will not be different for
different levels of management. The auditor will have to report his findings
impartially & consistently whether it be to the lower echelons of management or
senior management.
A. FALSE
B. TRUE
KEY A
Justification
Materiality of an IS auditor’s findings to different levels of management would depend
upon its significance to each level. Thus, what may be material to a lower level of the
management may not be so for the higher level and vice versa. Hence, the cited
statement is false & the answer at Option A alone is correct.
506. What is Forensic Audit ?
A. Audit specializing in discovering, disclosing and following up on frauds and
crimes
B. Audit relating to the Chemical and Pesticide industry
C. Audit relating to environmental matters, including pollution
D. Audit relating to hospitals and healthcare facilities
203
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
Forensic audit specializes in discovering, disclosing and following up on frauds and
crimes. It is assuming increasing significance owing to the enhanced risks involved with
increased use of IT and globalization. Answer at Option A alone is correct.
507. What are Control Self-Assessments ?
A. These are self- assessments of the auditing process adopted by auditors
B. These are self- assessments by business process owners independent of
auditors
C. These are conducted by business process owners but facilitated by auditors
D. These are compliance audits carried out by auditors
KEY C
Justification
Control Self-Assessments are those that are conducted by business process owners on
their own but facilitated by auditors. Answer at Option C alone is correct.
508. Protective / Preventative controls and Detective controls are two of the three
fundamental types of controls. Which is the third type of control ?
A. Forensic Controls
B. Security Controls
C. Reactive / Corrective Controls
D. Legislative Controls
KEY C
Justification
The third type of Controls is Reactive/Corrective Control. Answer at Option C alone is
correct.
509. Reactive / Corrective Controls and Detective controls are two of the three
fundamental types of controls. Which is the third type of control ?
A. Protective / Preventative controls
B. Security Controls
C. Forensic Controls
D. Legislative Controls
204
Information Systems Assurance Services
KEY A
Justification
The third type of Controls is Protective / Preventative Control. Answer at Option A alone
is correct.
510. Reactive / Corrective Controls and Protective / Preventative controls are two of
the three fundamental types of controls. Which is the third type of control ?
A. Legislative Controls
B. Detective controls
C. Security Controls
D. Forensic Controls
KEY B
Justification
The third type of Controls is Detective Control. Answer at Option B alone is correct.
511. What is Cyber fraud ?
A. A fraud that involves use of computers and computer networks
B. A fraud committed exclusively through the internet
C. A fraud exceeding U.S. $ 1 million in value
D. A fraud involving software alone
KEY A
Justification
Cyber fraud is a fraud that involves use of computers and computer networks. Answer
at Option A alone is correct.
512. Which standard of auditing defines fraud & the management’s responsibility ?
A. SIA 2
B. SIA 17
C. SIA 11
D. SIA 21
KEY C
Justification
SIA 11 defines fraud & lays the responsibility on the management for prevention &
detection of frauds. Answer at Option C alone is correct.
205
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
206
Information Systems Assurance Services
207
Module 3
Governance and Management of Enterprise
Information Technology, Risk Management &
Compliance
520. Which of the following provides for compliance requirements & maintenance of
privacy of information for companies in India?
A. IT Act, amended 2008
B. Companies Act, 2013
C. Sarbanes Oxley Act, 2002
D. Shops and Establishments Act
KEY A
Justification
As indicated in Option A, the IT Act amended during 2013 provides for maintaining
privacy of information & compliance requirements on management, including penalties
for non-compliance. Hence, the answers in the other Options are not factually correct.
521. Which of the following prescribes mandatory audit covering corporate
governance as per clause 49 ?
A. IT Act, amended 2008
B. Companies Act, 2013
C. SEBI, for listed companies
D. Sarbanes Oxley Act, 2002
KEY C
Justification
As indicated in Option C, SEBI has provided for mandatory audit as per clause 49 of the
equity listing agreement. The audit primarily covers governance. Hence, the answers in
the other Options are not factually correct.
522. As per Clause 49 V (C) and (D) of the SEBI Equity listing agreement, which of the
following are held responsible for establishment and maintenance of internal
controls for financial reporting ?
A. Managing Director of listed companies
B. The Board of Directors of listed companies
C. Audit Committee of the Board of Directors of listed companies
D. CEO/CFO of listed companies
209
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
As per Clause 49 V (C) and (D) of the SEBI Equity listing agreement, the CEO/CFO are
held responsible for establishment and maintenance of internal controls for financial
reporting. Hence, the answer in Option D is correct and those in the other Options are
not factually correct.
523. Good governance alone cannot make an organization successful. Governance
should ideally be implemented with the right balance in two dimensions of
conformance and a second element. What is the second element ?
A. Risk protection
B. Internal Audit
C. Performance
D. Trust
KEY C
Justification
Good governance alone cannot make an organization successful. Governance should
ideally be implemented with the right balance in two dimensions of conformance and a
second element, performance. Hence, the answer in Option C is correct and those in
the other Options are not factually correct.
524. Which is one of the major oversight mechanisms available to the Board of
Directors to ensure that corporate governance processes are effective ?
A. Incentive schemes for Directors
B. The company’s annual report
C. Committees like audit committee comprising independent non-executive Directors
D. Quarterly Board meetings
KEY C
Justification
One of the major oversight mechanisms available to the Board of Directors to ensure
that corporate governance is effective are mandatory committees like the Audit
committee.
525. State TRUE or FALSE. ‘Unlike the conformance dimension of Corporate
Governance, which is backed by an audit committee manned by independent
directors, the performance dimension has no dedicated oversee mechanism.’
210
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
It is true that the performance dimension of Corporate governance has no dedicated
oversee mechanism, unlike the conformance dimension. Hence, answer at Option A is
correct.
526. There are oversight mechanisms for the Performance and Conformance
dimensions of business governance. One other KEY Aspect of business
conformance that is often left out is _____________
A. Profitability
B. Information Technology
C. Strategy
D. Capital investments
KEY C
Justification
The neglected aspect of oversight is generally that of strategy. Hence, answer at Option
C is correct.
527. What is the key benefit of Governance of Enterprise IT (GEIT) ?
A. It ensures the efficiency of the IT system
B. It facilitates the Balance Score card system
C. It facilitates capital investment decision making
D. It provides a consistent approach integrated & aligned with enterprise
governance
KEY D
Justification
The key benefit of GEIT is that it provides a consistent approach, integrated & aligned
with enterprise governance. Hence, answer at Option D is correct.
528. State True or False. With reference to Governance of Enterprise IT, the Reserve
Bank of India issues guidelines covering various aspects of secure technology
deployment. These guidelines are prepared based on various global practices
such as COBIT & ISO 27001.
211
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
Yes, the RBI does issue guidelines covering various aspects of secure technology
deployment which are based upon various global practices such as COBIT & ISO
27001. Hence, answer at Option A is correct.
529. Benefit realization & Risk optimization are two of the three areas of focus of
Governance of Enterprise IT as specified under COBIT 5. What is the third area of
focus ?
A. The third area of focus is Personnel Policies
B. The third area of focus is Information Technology
C. The third area of focus is Resource optimization
D. COBIT 5 specifies only two areas of focus
KEY C
Justification
The third area of focus prescribed by COBIT 5 is Resource optimization. Hence, answer
at Option C is correct.
530. Resource optimization & Risk optimization are two of the three areas of focus of
Governance of Enterprise IT as specified under COBIT 5. What is the third area of
focus ?
A. The third area of focus is Information Technology
B. The third area of focus is Personnel Policies
C. The third area of focus is Benefit realization
D. COBIT 5 specifies only two areas of focus
KEY C
Justification
The third area of focus prescribed by COBIT 5 is Benefit realization. Hence, answer at
Option C is correct.
531. Which of the following could be a recommended framework for internal controls &
risk management ?
A. COSO 2013 (Council of Sponsoring Organizations of the Tread way Commission)
212
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
B. ISO 17001
C. ITAF 1200 series
D. COBIT 5
KEY A
Justification
COSO 2013 framework would be ideal for internal controls and risk management.
Hence, answer at Option A is correct.
532. GEIT involves both Conformance as well as Performance perspectives. What
would be the KEY Areas of focus of GEIT from the Conformance perspective ?
A. Strategic decision making and value creation
B. Best practices, tools and techniques
C. Board Structure, Roles and Remuneration
D. Balanced Score Card
KEY C
Justification
The Board Structure, Roles and Remuneration would be the KEY focus areas of GEIT
from the Conformance perspective. Hence, answer at Option C is correct. The other
options are incorrect.
533. GEIT involves both Conformance as well as Performance perspectives. What
would be the KEY Areas of focus of GEIT from the Performance perspective ?
A. Board Structure, Roles and Remuneration
B. Standards and Codes
C. Strategic decision making and value creation
D. Audit Committee
KEY C
Justification
From the Business performance angle, quite obviously, strategic decision making and
value creation would be the KEY focus areas for GEIT. The other options from A,B to D
are incorrect. Hence, answer at Option C is correct.
534. Operations and reporting are two of the three categories of objectives of the
COSO 2013 framework. What is the third category of objectives ?
213
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. Information Technology
B. Security
C. Compliance
D. Risk Management
KEY C
Justification
Compliance is the third category of objectives of the COSO 2013 framework as
indicated in Option C. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
535. Reporting and Compliance are two of the three categories of objectives of the
COSO 2013 framework. What is the third category of objectives ?
A. Information Technology
B. Security
C. Operations
D. Risk Management
KEY C
Justification
Compliance is the third category of objective of the COSO 2013 framework as indicated
in Option C. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
536. Control environment, risk assessment, control activities and information &
communication are four of the five integrated components of internal control in
COSO. What is the fifth component ?
A. Risk Management
B. Information Technology
C. Security
D. Monitoring activities
KEY D
Justification
Monitoring activities is the fifth component of internal controls in COSO as indicated in
Option D. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
537. Control environment, control activities, information & communication and
monitoring activities are four of the five integrated components of internal control
in COSO. What is the fifth component ?
214
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
A. Risk Management
B. Information Technology
C. Risk assessment
D. Security
KEY C
Justification
Risk assessment is the fifth component of internal controls in COSO as indicated in
Option C. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
538. Risk assessment, control environment, control activities and monitoring activities
are four of the five integrated components of internal control in COSO. What is
the fifth component ?
A. Information & communication
B. Risk Management
C. Information Technology
D. Security
KEY A
Justification
Information and communication is the fifth component of internal controls in COSO as
indicated in Option A. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
539. State True or False. The COSO 2013 framework prescribes the controls to be
selected, developed and deployed for effective internal control. The management
is not left with any choice in the matter and has to rigorously comply with the
COSO 2013 framework.
A. FALSE
B. TRUE
KEY A
Justification
The COSO 2013 framework does not prescribe the controls to be selected, developed
and deployed. It is a function of management judgement based upon factors unique to
the entity. Hence, the statement in the stem is false and Option A is correct.
540. State True or False. What COSO 2013 is to internal controls, COBIT 5 is to
governance in Governance of Enterprise Information Technology.
215
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. FALSE
B. TRUE
KEY B
Justification
In GEIT, COBIT 5 is the business framework of governance and management of IT.
COSO 2013 is a framework for managing internal controls. Hence, the statement in the
stem above is correct and the answer is true as per Option B above.
541. COBIT 5 ______________
A. Is best suited for large corporates
B. Is best suited for small and medium enterprises
C. Is a set of globally accepted principles, practices, analytical tools and models
D. Is not ideally suited for non-profit and government enterprises
KEY C
Justification
As indicated in Option C above, COBIT 5 is a set of globally accepted principles,
practices, analytical tools and models for governance. It can be used by all types and
sizes of organizations, whether profit-oriented or otherwise. Hence, answers at Options
A,B and D are wrong.
542. Meeting stakeholder needs, Covering the enterprise end-to-end, Applying a single
integrated framework and Enabling a holistic approach are 4 of the 5 KEY
principles of COBIT 5. Which is the fifth principle ?
A. Separating Governance from Management
B. Risk management
C. Human resources management
D. Strategic and long term planning
KEY A
Justification
The fifth principle of governance of COBIT 5 is Separating Government from
Management. The answers in Options B to D are, hence, wrong and Option A is correct.
543. Covering the enterprise end-to-end, Applying a single integrated framework,
Enabling a holistic approach and Separating Governance from Management are 4
of the 5 KEY principles of COBIT 5. Which is the fifth principle ?
216
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
A. Risk management
B. Human resources management
C. Meeting Stakeholder needs
D. Strategic and long term planning
KEY C
Justification
The fifth principle of governance of COBIT 5 is Meeting Stakeholder needs. The
answers in Options A,B and D are, hence, wrong and Option C is correct.
544. Meeting Stakeholder needs, Covering the enterprise end-to-end, Applying a single
integrated framework, and Separating Governance from Management are 4 of the
5 KEY principles of COBIT 5. Which is the fifth principle ?
A. Enabling a holistic approach
B. Human resources management
C. Risk management
D. Strategic and long term planning
KEY A
Justification
The fifth principle of governance of COBIT 5 is Enabling a holistic approach. The
answers in Options B to D are, hence, wrong and Option A is correct.
545. Which is the ISO standard for corporate governance ?
A. ISO 31000
B. ISO 27001
C. ISO 20100
D. ISO 38500
KEY D
Justification
The ISO standard for corporate governance is ISO 38500. The other Options are,
hence, wrong and Option D is correct.
546. Which is the ISO standard for IT risk management ?
A. ISO 31000
B. ISO 38500
217
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. ISO 27001
D. ISO 20100
KEY A
Justification
The ISO standard for IT risk management is ISO 31000. The answers in Options B to D
are, hence, wrong and Option A is correct.
547. Which is the ISO standard for Risk management ?
A. ISO 38500
B. ISO 27001
C. ISO 31000
D. ISO 20100
KEY C
Justification
The ISO standard for IT risk management is ISO 31000. The answers in other Options
are, hence, wrong and Option C is correct.
548. A company has developed a mobile phone which is unique for its simplicity and
ease of use. During laboratory tests, it finds that the product is really robust and
rarely fails. The industry norm is that mobile phone manufacturers invariably offer
customers the comfort of prompt and efficient after sales service, including repair.
After a lot of introspection, the company decides that the probability of failure of
their product was so low and it would not be worth their while to invest in a
network of servicing facilities. They decided, instead to offer a free replacement
in the event of failure of their product. In fact, they decided to leverage this itself
as a marketing strategy for their product and it turned out to be a roaring success.
What type of risk management strategy has the company adopted in this case ?
A. Terminate/eliminate the risk
B. Transfer/share the risk
C. Tolerate/accept the risk
D. Treat/mitigate the risk
KEY C
Justification
The company has obviously chose to tolerate/accept the risk in view of the low
probability of its occurrence and likely lower cost of incurring the risk. The answers in
other Options are, hence, wrong and Option C is correct.
218
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
549. A company markets agro chemicals on a pan India basis. Farmers use agro
chemicals, typically, only when they perceive a pest attack and would like to act
immediately then to save their crop. Hence, prompt and speedy availability is the
main driver for sales of this product. The company, which had its manufacturing
facility located in South India, found that it invariably lost out in meeting the
demand from the Northern States owing to their inability to reach their product in
time to meet such unpredictable demand. Since the market size being lost out
was substantial as compared to the cost of setting up a new plant, they ultimately
decide to set up a new manufacturing facility in Punjab which could ensure
availability of product in a timely fashion. What type of risk management strategy
has the company adopted in this case ?
A. Terminate/eliminate the risk
B. Tolerate/accept the risk
C. Transfer/share the risk
D. Treat/mitigate the risk
KEY A
Justification
The company has obviously chosen to terminate/eliminate the risk after weighing the
pros and cons of loss of business/profit versus cost of setting up a new manufacturing
facility. The answers in Options B to D are, hence, wrong and Option A is correct.
550. Section 49 C of the Listing Agreement of SEBI addresses the need for
_________________
A. Minimum public shareholding percentage
B. Creation of a board sub-committee for auditing
C. Board disclosures related to risk management & states
D. Compliance with government regulations
KEY C
Justification
This section relates to need for Board disclosures related to risk management & states.
Hence, answer at Option C is correct and the other options are incorrect.
551. Section 49 V of the Listing Agreement of SEBI deals with _________
A. Board disclosures related to risk management & states
B. Minimum public shareholding percentage
219
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
220
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
554. Apart from Clause 49 of the SEBI Listing agreement, which is based upon SOX
provisions, which other mandatory provision exists on internal controls for
corporate in India ?
A. The Indian Companies Act, The Companies (Auditor’s Report) Order 2003
B. Information Technology Act 2008
C. Sarbanes Oxley Act, 2003
D. COBIT 5
KEY A
Justification
Mandatory provisions on internal controls do exist, as per CARO, as brought out in
Option A above. The IT Act has no such provision, the SOX Act applies in the USA and
COBIT 5 is not an Act but a framework. Hence, answer at Option A above is correct.
555. State True or False. Under GRC (Governance, Risk and Compliance) norms,
compliance refers exclusively to compliance with statutory Laws and
Regulations; compliances with internal policies of an organization are not a part
of it.
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY B
Justification
Compliance under GRC refers both to external compliances, in terms of statutory laws
and regulations, as also internal compliances with regard to policies of an organization.
Hence, the above statement is false and answer at Option B is correct.
556. Principles, policies & framework, (b) Processes, (c) Organization structure, (d)
Roles, responsibilities & risks of IT department, (e) Information and (f) Services,
infrastructure & applications are six of the seven enablers of COBIT 5. Which is
the 7th enabler ?
A. Planning & communication
B. Delegation of authority
C. Compliance with statutory regulations
D. Culture, ethics & behaviour
221
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
Culture, Ethics & Behaviour is the 7th enabler under COBIT 5. Hence, answer at Option
D is the correct one.
557. Principles, policies & framework, (b) Processes, (c) Organization structure, (d)
Roles, responsibilities & risks of IT department, (e) Culture, ethics & behaviour
and (f) Services, infrastructure & applications are six of the seven enablers of
COBIT 5. Which is the 7th enabler?
A. Information
B. Planning & communication
C. Delegation of authority
D. Compliance with statutory regulations
KEY A
Justification
Information is the 7th enabler under COBIT 5. Hence, answer at Option A is the correct
one.
558. What is the purpose of Principles, policies and framework in an organization ?
A. To control the employees
B. To arrive at the business strategy of the organization
C. To convey the management’s direction & instruction
D. To comply with statutory regulations
KEY C
Justification
The purpose of Principles, policies and framework in an organization is to communicate
downward the direction the management would like the organization to take and the
means through which this can be done. They reflect the culture, ethics and values of the
organization. The objective is not to control the employees; not are they in compliance
with statutory regulations. Principles, policies and framework are not drawn up for the
purpose of business strategy; however, the strategy will evolve based upon these
elements and other strategic inputs like the market, competition, etc. Hence, answer at
Option C is the correct one.
559. Apart from being effective and efficient, what other characteristic should a good
policy possess ?
222
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
223
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
224
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
225
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
The approach of using lead indicators for performance measurement is called Proactive
approach. Hence, the answer at Option C is the correct one.
568. The approach of using lag indicators for performance measurement is called ?
A. Proactive approach
B. Reactive approach
C. Retroactive approach
D. Retrospective approach
KEY B
Justification
The approach of using lag indicators for performance measurement is called Reactive
approach. Hence, the answer at Option B is the correct one.
569. Where is the Capability Maturity framework of Performance Management Systems
generally used?
A. Hardware Development Company
B. Research & Development institution
C. Software Development Company
D. Educational institutions
KEY C
Justification
The Capability Maturity framework of Performance Management Systems is generally
used in the software development companies. . Hence, the answer at Option C is the
correct one.
570. Mr Johnson has just taken charge as Head of a fledgling educational institution
which has not had a good track record. He feels that he has his task cut out for
him he needs to focus more on the lead parameters rather than lag indicators so
that he can create sustainable results. Which of the following would be an
example of lead indicators ?
A. Number of passes by students in the Matriculation examination
B. Number of all-India rank holders from the school in the Matriculation examination
C. Number of failures in the Matriculation examination
226
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
227
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
228
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
576. What is the most important aspect of the CIMA Strategic Score Card approach ?
A. Focuses exclusively on strategy matters
B. Focuses exclusively on IT governance & strategy aspects
C. Addresses conformance as well as performance, focussing on strategic issues
D. Unlike the Balanced Score card, it focuses on lead indicators alone
KEY C
Justification
The CIMA Strategic Score Card approach addresses both conformance as well as
performance, focussing on strategic issues. The answers in other options are incorrect.
577. Strategic position, Strategic options and Strategic implementation are three of the
four basic elements of the CIMA Strategic Score card. What is the fourth
element ?
A. Strategic Risks
B. Strategic Conformance
C. Strategic Performance
D. Strategic IT
KEY A
Justification
The fourth element of the CIMA Strategic Score Card approach is Strategic Risks. The
answers in Options B to D are incorrect.
578. What is fundamental to the Capability Maturity Model Integration (CMMI) ?
A. Used universally, except in the I.T. industry
B. Is superior to COBIT 5 which does not have process capability
C. It is a process improvement approach
D. Focuses on internal process alone
KEY C
Justification
The CMMI model is a process improvement approach & is a preferred model for the IT
industry. COBIT 5, too, has process capability built in. CMMI addresses all processes.
Hence, answer at Option C above alone is correct.
229
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
230
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
KEY B
Justification
The other major reasons for implementing GEIT are trigger events which create
changes in the environment. Answers in Options A and C may also be factually true but
are not necessarily major reasons for implementing GEIT. Answer in Option D is not
correct.
Hence, the answer at Option B is correct.
582. Which one of the following could be a Critical Success factor in GEIT
implementation ?
A. The project is handled exclusively & in isolation to day-to-day business
B. Execution authority & responsibility is retained at the highest levels
C. Top management provides direction and mandate
D. Trigger events like merger/acquisition, new regulations, etc.
KEY C
Justification
One of the critical success factors above is the need for top management to provide
direction and mandate for the project, as indicated in Option C. Integration of the project
with day-to-business is essential for the success of the project contrary to what is stated
in Option B. Similarly, authority & responsibility have to be cascaded down to the level
at which project implementation happens, ideally at the level of an anchor person.
Trigger events may precipitate the implementation of GEIT but cannot be critical
success factors. Hence, the answer at Option C is correct
583. Which one of the following could be a Critical Success factor in GEIT
implementation ?
A. Trigger events like merger/acquisition, new regulations, etc.
B. The project is handled exclusively & in isolation to day-to-day business
C. Focus on quick wins to demonstrate benefit & build confidence
D. Execution authority & responsibility is retained at the highest levels
KEY C
Justification
Early successes help instil confidence in the initiative & stimulate co-operation, as
indicated in Option C. Trigger events may precipitate the implementation of GEIT but
cannot be critical success factors. Integration of the project with day-to-business is
231
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
essential for the success of the project contrary to what is stated in Option A. Similarly,
authority & responsibility have to be cascaded down to the level at which project
implementation happens, ideally at the level of an anchor person.
Hence, the answer at Option C is correct.
584. What should be the first phase of GEIT implementation ?
A. Forming an implementation team
B. Communication desired vision
C. Enable operation & use
D. Establish desire to change, stressing pain points, trigger events
KEY D
Justification
The first phase of GEIT implementation is preparing the ground for the project to take
off and targeting the mind sets of the people concerned. This can be done by identifying
the pain points / trigger events as also the consequences of inaction for the
organization as well as the individual. The answers in other options can be successive
steps in the project implementation and not the initial one.
Hence, the answer at Option D is correct.
585. What should be the final phase of GEIT implementation ?
A. Establish desire to change, stressing pain points, trigger events
B. Communication desired vision
C. Sustain changes through conscious reinforcement
D. Enable operation & use
KEY C
Justification
Any initiative, however good it may be, will not yield the desired results unless
mechanisms are built in for sustaining the momentum which has been gained in the
initial launch. This can be done, as pointed out in Option C above, through conscious
reinforcement & continuous top management commitment. The answers in the other
options are intermediate phases in the GEIT implementation process and, hence, are
not correct.
586. In line with ISO/IEC 38500, Governance processes under COBIT 5 are based upon
the principles of ______________
A. Evaluate, Direct, Monitor
232
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
233
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
234
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
592. COBIT 5 has a resource governance process to ensure that resources needs of
the enterprise are met in an optimal manner. Which one of the following is KEY
governance process to be followed ?
A. Evaluate, Direct and Monitor resource management
B. Build, Acquire and Implement
C. Align, Plan & Organize
D. Monitor, Evaluate & Assess
KEY A
Justification
The KEY governance process to be followed in this case is Evaluate, Direct and Monitor
resource management as brought out in Option A. The answers in the other options B
to D are incorrect and not applicable to the instant case.
593. Which one of the following is an important tool used for managing & monitoring
service providers ?
A. Regular meetings
B. Third party inspection arrangements
C. Service Level Agreements (SLAs)
D. Cost comparison through industry benchmarking
KEY C
Justification
While all the answers in the options above may be true to some extent or the other, the
most important tool used for managing & monitoring service providers are Service Level
Agreements which play the role not only of enforceability of commitments but,
simultaneously, of capturing clearly the responsibilities of both parties as also other
aspects like delivery expectations, escalation clauses, penalties, etc. Hence, the answer
in Option C above is correct and the rest can be deemed to be wrong.
594. The success of capacity management would depend most upon which one of the
following factors ?
A. Historical trend of capacity expansions
B. Availability of precise and timely business forecasts
C. Cost comparison through industry benchmarking
D. Availability of adequate funds for procurement
235
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
Justification
Capacity Management success would depend to a great extent upon the availability of
precise and timely business forecast, as indicated in the answer in Option B. The
answers in other options are incorrect.
595. With reference to Capex & Opex, how can valuation of any business be
improved ?
A. Increasing Capex & proportionately reducing Opex
B. Reduction in Opex irrespective of impact on day-to-day operations
C. With Capex constant, reduction in Opex without hurting day-to-day operations
D. Increasing both Capex & Opex with the objective of increased profits
KEY C
Justification
In general, industry prefers to restrict Capex & also optimize Opex to get best results for
stakeholders. Capex is considered undesirable owing to restrictions on dividend cost
being allowed as a business cost for tax purposes unlike Opex. However reduction in
Opex can hurt operations too, leading to reduced profits. Hence, the ideal situation
would be, while Capex is kept constant, Opex is reduced without hurting day-to-
operations, as indicated in Option C above. The answers in other 0ptions are incorrect.
596. What is Information ?
A. It is a collection of data which need not necessarily have meaning for its user
B. It is restricted to data in the form of numbers
C. It is data which is not necessarily specific & organized
D. It is all data processed in a meaningful context
KEY D
Justification
Information is data processed in a meaningful context. It is specific & organized and has
value to the user. It includes all forms of information like numbers, text, images, sound,
codes, etc. Hence, the answer at Option D is correct & the other options incorrect.
597. State TRUE or FALSE. When the Information System Auditor delegates work to
others, he will continue to be responsible for forming and expressing his opinion
on auditee environment as per the scope and objectives of the audit.
236
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
A. TRUE
B. FALSE
KEY A
Justification
The responsibility for forming and expressing opinion on auditee environment rests with
the IS Auditor even in respect of work he delegates to others. Hence, answer at Option
A above is correct.
598. Are Audit professionals considered to be the most appropriate professionals to
audit Information Systems (rather than IT professionals) ?
A. No; since they do not have adequate expertise in Information Technology
B. Yes; since it involves the evaluation of internal controls in computerized business
processes
C. No; since Information systems have built-in safeguards and an audit would be
superfluous
D. Yes; but only to the extent of regulatory matters about which they are proficient
KEY B
Justification
Audit professionals are, indeed, considered to be the most appropriate professionals to
audit Information systems since knowledge of business processes is extremely critical
for such audit, more than that of technical knowledge of Information technology. What is
required is an audit professional who has supplemented his audit/financial/regulatory
background with knowledge of the basics of Information technology. Hence, answer at
Option B above is correct. IS can build safeguards to meet all contingencies. The other
answers are, therefore, incorrect.
599. Risk in Information Technology ____________
A. Can be depicted as hierarchically dependent upon other risk categories
B. Does not impact on long term strategy
C. Can also be defined as Threat exploiting Vulnerabilities
D. Is not considered operational in financial industry as per Basel II framework
237
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
Since Information systems impinge on each and every part of an organization’s
business today, any risks in IT would automatically extend to all aspects of the
business. It is, in fact, considered even an operational risk in the financial industry as
per Basel II framework. However, since it is relevant to different aspects of an
organization, it is not to be depicted as hierarchically dependent upon other risk
categories. Hence, answers in Options A, B and D are incorrect. However, the definition
given in Option C is correct it is, in a way, threat exploiting vulnerabilities. Hence,
answer at Option C above is correct.
600. What is the Risk Universe ?
A. Is restricted to selected components of the business
B. Is restricted to the enterprise & excludes suppliers, service providers, clients
C. It needs to be defined & frozen for a reasonable period of time of about 5 years
D. It defines the overall environment & provides a structure for managing the IT risk
KEY D
Justification
The Risk Universe extends to the overall environment, covering all stake holders
including suppliers, service providers & clients. It aims at providing a structure for
managing IT risk. It crosses functional silos and is intended to cover end-to-end
business perspective. It needs to be dynamic & updated regularly to be aligned with
changes in the environment. Hence, answer at Option D alone is correct.
601. During 2009, the Satyam Computers scandal broke out. The Company’s Chairman
admitted to falsification of accounts to the tune of U.S. $ 1.47 billion. The auditors
for this company were mainly exposed to what type of risk ?
A. Audit Risk
B. Financial Risk
C. Procedural Risk
D. IT Risk
238
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
KEY A
Justification
Audit risk refers to the risk that an auditor may issue unqualified report due to the
auditor’s failure to detect material misstatement either due to error or fraud. The cited
example clearly refers to such a situation and, hence, answer at Option A above is the
correct answer.
602. Audit risk is _______________
A. A product of control risk & detection risk
B. A product of inherent risk, control risk & detection risk
C. Sum of inherent risk, control risk & detection risk
D. A product of inherent risk and detection risk
KEY B
Justification
Audit risk refers to the risk that an auditor may issue unqualified report due to the
auditor’s failure to detect material misstatement either due to error or fraud. It is a
product of inherent risk, control risk & detection risk. Hence, answer at Option B alone
is correct.
603. In the case of IS Audit, materiality is _____________
A. Based upon value and volume of transactions
B. Based on impact of non compliance
C. Consequence of risk in terms of potential loss
D. A product of inherent risk and detection risk
KEY C
Justification
Materiality in IS Audit is a consequence of risk in terms of potential loss. Hence, answer
at Option C is correct while the other answers are incorrect.
604. In the case of Financial audit, materiality is ______________
A. Based upon value and volume of transactions
B. Based on impact of non compliance
C. Consequence of risk in terms of potential loss
D. A product of inherent risk and detection risk
239
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
Materiality in Financial Audit is based upon value and volume of transactions and the
relevant error or discrepancy or control weakness detected. Hence, answer at Option A
is correct while the other answers are incorrect.
605. In the case of Regulatory audit, materiality is _________________
A. Based upon value and volume of transactions
B. Consequence of risk in terms of potential loss
C. Based on impact of non- compliance
D. A product of inherent risk and detection risk
KEY C
Justification
Materiality in Regulatory Audit is based upon the impact of non-compliance with
regulations. Hence, answer at Option C is correct while the other answers are incorrect.
606. Internal Controls _______________
A. Are restricted to tools for prevention of risks alone
B. Focus exclusively on financial rather than non-financial risks
C. Are driven exclusively by automated computerised systems
D. Facilitate achievement of business objectives & management of risks
KEY D
Justification
Internal controls are designed to assure the management that the organization’s
business objectives will be achieved and risk events prevented or detected and
corrected. They target prevention as well as detection & correction and are aimed at
both financial as well as non-financial risks. They can be driven either by automated
computerised systems or even manual systems. Hence, answer at Option D alone is
correct.
607. Internal Controls ________________
A. Target risk management rather than achievement of business objectives
B. Comprise Preventive, Detective & Corrective controls
C. Are driven exclusively by automated computerised systems
D. Focus exclusively on financial rather than non-financial risks
240
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
KEY B
Justification
Internal controls are designed to assure the management that the organization’s
business objectives will be achieved and risk events prevented or detected and
corrected. They target prevention as well as detection & correction and are aimed at
both financial as well as non-financial risks. They can be driven either by automated
computerised systems or even manual systems. Hence, answer at Option B alone is
correct.
608. Internal Controls _______________
A. Are the sum total of IT General controls and IT Application Controls
B. Focus exclusively on prevention of errors or irregularities
C. Are driven exclusively by automated computerised systems
D. Focus exclusively on financial rather than non-financial risks
KEY A
Justification
Internal controls are designed to assure the management that the organization’s
business objectives will be achieved and risk events prevented or detected and
corrected. They target prevention as well as detection & correction and are aimed at
both financial as well as non-financial risks. They can be driven either by automated
computerised systems or even manual systems. They include General controls which
encompass all administrative areas and Application controls which are related to
specific application software. Hence, answer at Option A alone is correct.
609. The authority, scope and responsibility of the Information System Audit function
is ________________
A. Defined by the I.T. Head of the organization, as the expert in the matter
B. Defined by the various functional divisions, depending upon criticality
C. Defined by the audit charter approved by the senior management/Board
D. Generated by the Audit division of the organization
KEY C
Justification
The authority, scope and responsibility of the Information system audit is invariably
defined by the audit charter which is approved by the senior management and, most
often, by the Board of Directors. It is not left to the Audit division, the IT Head or the
functional heads to decide on this. Hence, answer at Option C alone is correct..
241
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
242
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
KEY C
Justification
A RFP is used primarily for acquiring services and, on occasion, goods. It comprises a
complete description of the buyer’s requirements of the service/product. The successful
bidder in this process need not necessarily be the lowest-priced; non-financial aspects
like credibility, technical superiority, etc. will also be taken into account to arrive at the
optimal supplier. Hence, answer at Option C alone is correct.
613. You are advising your client on the selection & appointment of an IT service
provider. You suggest that the client should go through a Request for Proposal
(RFP) process for best results. Your client is happy with your suggestion but
requests that not all aspects of the selection process be publicised up-front. For,
the client had faced situations in the past wherein, openness in such matters had
lead to issues of disputes with suppliers who were rejected in the selection
process. The client’s argument is that, in any case, the selection will be on a fair
and equitable basis & the idea is just to avoid giving too much information to the
bidders and create the potential for nuisance attacks by mischievous,
unsuccessful bidders. As a Chartered Accountant, would your suggestion be to
clearly spell out the selection criteria or leave it ambiguous ?
A. Clearly spell out the selection criteria
B. Leave the selection criteria ambiguous
KEY A
Justification
It would be best to clearly spell out all the selection criteria. For, it would give
confidence to the potential bidders about the credibility of the buyer and also avoid build
up of un-necessary cushions to take care of any unknown contingencies. Also,
ambiguities cut both ways & may provide loopholes for unscrupulous bidders to wriggle
out of commitments or raise disputes. Contractually & legally speaking, too, such a RFP
will strengthen the organization’s hands in the event of any default or failure on the part
of the chosen supplier. Hence, answer at Option A alone is correct.
614. What are the elements common to both the Audit Charter and Audit Engagement
Letter ?
A. Responsibility, Authority & Professional Fees payable
B. Responsibility, Authority & Travel expenses budget for auditors
C. Responsibility, Authority & Accountability
243
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
The elements common to both the Audit Charter & Audit Engagement Letter are
Responsibility, Authority & Accountability. Aspects like the Professional fees payable,
travel expenses budget for auditors, etc. are generally dealt with in the Engagement
Letter and not in the Charter. Hence, answer at Option C alone is correct.
615. Based upon scope, objectives, etc. drawn up in consultation with the senior
management of an organization, an experienced audit team which has sound
knowledge of I.T. has completed & filed its preliminary audit report of the I.T.
department of the organization. On receiving the draft report, the officials in the
I.T. department react negatively to the report. They argue that the bulk of the
conclusions drawn in the report, the information reported, etc. are erroneous.
They question the validity of the findings. In your view, which one of the following
could be the likely major cause for this situation ?
A. Lack of adequate technical IT knowledge of the auditing team
B. Poor quality of audit by the team
C. Malafide intentions of the auditee team
D. In-effective communication with Auditee & buy-in
KEY D
Justification
It is clear that the auditing team is a competent one with sound knowledge of I.T. It is
unlikely that the auditee team deliberately sought to scuttle the auditing team’s report.
For, given the fact that they have the top management’s approval, the I.T. department
cannot hope to gain anything by throwing mud on the auditing team. If the auditee still
questions the validity of the team’s report, the single major cause which can be inferred
from the question stem is that the communication to the auditee has not been carried
out in an effective manner & adequate steps have not been taken to secure auditee
buy-in for the process . Hence, answer at Option D appears to be more appropriate.
616. You have just taken on the Audit of a large, established multinational company
with operations spread geographically across continents. You need to draw up
detailed scope of the proposed audit of the organization in consultation with its
top management. Your approach would be to focus upon _____________
A. Areas identified to be high risk &/or high significance to the organization
B. Sample audit of each and every geographical unit of the organization
244
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
245
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
The major categories of IS Controls are Fiduciary, Quality & Security. Hence, answer at
Option A above is the correct one.
619. The basic principles of Fiduciary Controls in Information Systems are
____________
A. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
B. Reliability of information & Compliance with laws, regulations, etc.
C. Confidentiality & Integrity of information
D. Confidentiality, Integrity & Availability of information
KEY B
Justification
The basic principle of Fiduciary Controls in IS are reliability of information & compliance
with laws, regulations, etc.. Hence, the correct answer is as per Option B. The other
answers are incorrect.
620. The basic principles of Quality Controls in Information Systems are ____________
A. Reliability of information & Compliance with laws, regulations, etc.
B. Confidentiality & Integrity of information
C. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
D. Confidentiality, Integrity & Availability of information
KEY C
Justification
The basic principle of Quality Controls in IS are efficiency & effectiveness of processes,
services or activities. Hence, the correct answer is as per Option C. The other answers
are incorrect.
621. The basic principles of Security Controls in Information Systems are
____________
A. Confidentiality, Integrity & Availability of information
B. Reliability of information & Compliance with laws, regulations, etc.
C. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
D. Confidentiality & Integrity of information
246
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
KEY A
Justification
The basic principle of Security Controls in IS are Confidentiality, Integrity & Availability
of information. Hence, the correct answer is as per Option A. The other answers are
incorrect.
622. Which of the following is one of the four KEY Areas which have to be understood
by Information System Auditors prior to commencement of audit ?
A. Thorough understanding of the business of the entity
B. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
C. Sales turnover & employee strength of the entity
D. Status of entity whether government or private
KEY A
Justification
One of the KEY Areas which have to be understood by Information System Auditors is
thorough understanding of the business of the entity. Hence, the correct answer is as
per Option A. The other answers are incorrect.
623. Which of the following is one of the four KEY Areas which have to be understood
by Information System Auditors prior to commencement of audit ?
A. Status of entity whether government or private
B. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
C. Organization structure, roles, responsibilities, policy framework, etc.
D. Sales turnover & employee strength of the entity
KEY C
Justification
One of the KEY Areas which have to be understood by Information System Auditors is
the organization structure, roles, responsibilities, policy framework. Hence, the correct
answer is as per Option C The other answers are incorrect.
624. Which of the following is one of the four KEY Areas which have to be understood
by Information System Auditors prior to commencement of audit ?
A. Status of entity whether government or private
B. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
C. Sales turnover & employee strength of the entity
D. IT infrastructure including capacities, age of software/hardware, etc.
247
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
Justification
One of the KEY Areas which have to be understood by Information System Auditors is
the IT infrastructure in terms of capacities, age of software/hardware, etc. Hence, the
correct answer is as per Option D. The other answers are incorrect.
625. Which of the following is one of the four KEY Areas which have to be understood
by Information System Auditors prior to commencement of audit ?
A. Statutory regulations, standards, frameworks
B. Status of entity whether government or private
C. Efficiency & Effectiveness of process, service or activity
D. Sales turnover & employee strength of the entity
KEY A
Justification
One of the KEY Areas which have to be understood by Information System Auditors
includes statutory regulations, standards & frameworks. Hence, the correct answer is as
per Option A. The other answers are incorrect.
626. Section 7A of the Information Technology Act 2000 (as amended in 2008)
addresses which of the following issues ?
A. Damage liability to a corporate negligent handling of personal data
B. Identity theft by corporate or individual
C. Extension of audit coverage to documents, etc. in electronic form
D. Publishing or transmission of obscene material
KEY C
Justification
Section 7A relates to extension of audit coverage to documents, records or information
stored in electronic form. Hence, the correct answer is as per Option C. The other
answers are incorrect.
627. Recently, there were reports of some criminal hacking of Facebook accounts and
theft of passwords and other personal information. You, as a Facebook account
holder, apprehend personal loss/damage and would like to proceed legally
against the Facebook organization. You would like to issue a notice to them, to
start with. Which Indian Act and which section of the Indian Act would you cite in
your notice alleging violations ?
248
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
249
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
250
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
631. A small scale industry has developed an effective, organic mosquito repellent
which shows great promise. Since they had limitations in terms of resources,
capability to scale up operations & marketing, they decided to join hands with a
large marketing company. They signed off on a contract for marketing of their
product, working capital funding and long term product development in the larger
company’s R& D laboratories. They also built in protective clauses on non-
disclosure of manufacturing formula, secret ingredients, etc which were provided
to them as encrypted soft copies. After a few months, the small scale industry
learns that the larger company has begun marketing a me-too product abroad,
manufactured by another unit, utilising the knowledge obtained while
manufacturing the small scale industry’s unique product.
Under the Information Technology Act 2000, what is the potential punishment &
penalty for such intentional disclosure of information, without the consent of the
person concerned and in breach of lawful contract ?
A. Fine of Rs. 3 lacs alone, no imprisonment
B. Imprisonment up to 3 years and fine up to Rs. 5 lacs
C. Imprisonment up to 5 years and fine up to Rs. 10 lacs
D. Fine of Rs. 5 lacs alone, no imprisonment
KEY B
Justification
Under Section 72A of the Information Technology Act 2000, such intentional disclosure
of information, without the consent of the person concerned & in breach of lawful
contract is punishable with imprisonment up to 3 years and fine up to Rs. 5 lacs. Hence
answer in Option B is correct and the other options are wrong.
632. In addition to giving opinion on the fair presentation of the organization’s
accounts, an independent auditor of an organization is expected to opine on the
effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as per a particular Act.
This is mandatory as per which Act and which section of the Act ?
A. Information Technology Act 2000, Section 43A
B. Information Technology Act 2000, Section 7A
C. Sarbanes Oxley Act 2002, Section 404
D. Gramm Leach Bliley Act or the Financial Services Modernisation Act 1999,
Section 14A
251
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
This is mandatory in the U.S. as per Section 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act 2002.
Hence answer in Option C is correct and the other options are wrong.
633. What does Auditing Standard 5 of the Public Company Accounting Oversight
Board (PCAOB) relate to ?
A. Independence & performance of statutory auditors
B. Appointment, removal & terms of the Chief Internal Auditor
C. Audit of Internal control over financial reporting integrated with audit of financial
statements
D. Implementation of enterprise risk management system in the organization
KEY C
Justification
The PCAOB was set up as a non-profit body as per the provisions of the Sarbanes
Oxley Act with the objective of setting up standards of auditing. Auditing Standard 5 of
the PCAOB relates to audit of internal control over financial reporting integrated with
audit of financial statements. Hence answer in Option C is correct and the other options
are wrong.
634. Corporate governance, including internal controls, enterprise risk management,
etc. are covered under the provisions of ______________
A. Clause 49 of the Listing agreement of SEBI
B. Section 43A of the Information Technology Act 2000
C. Section 126A of the Sarbanes Oxley Act 2002
D. Section 14A of the Gramm Leach Bliley Act or the Financial Services
Modernisation Act 1999
KEY A
Justification
Corporate governance, including internal controls, enterprise risk management, etc. are
covered under the provisions of Clause 49 of the Listing agreement of SEBI. Hence
answer in Option A is correct and the other options are wrong.
635. ISO/IEC 27000 is basically a/an ______________
A. Information security standard
252
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
253
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
254
Governance and Management of Enterprise Information Technology, Risk …
KEY B
Justification
ITAF has been designed and created by ISACA. The Performance standards, falling
under the 1200 series, deal with conduct of the assignment & the exercising of
professional judgement & due care. Hence, the answer in Option B is correct and the
other options are wrong.
641. Reporting standards under Information Technology Assurance Framework (ITAF)
_______________
A. Deal with report types, communication means & communicated information
B. Deal with the minimum performance standards expected of installed software
C. Relate to the minimum level of quality of audit to be carried out by IS auditors
D. Fall under the 1200 series of ITAF
KEY A
Justification
ITAF has been designed and created by ISACA. The Reporting standards, falling under
the 1400 series, deal with report types, communication means & communicated
information. Hence, the answer in Option A is correct and the other options are wrong.
642. COBIT 5 _____________
A. Is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT, excluding risk
aspects
B. Operates through 7 principles
C. Is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT
D. Can be useful only for large organizations with ERP systems
KEY C
Justification
COBIT is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT. It helps
organizations manage risk & ensure compliance, continuity, security & privacy. It has 5
KEY principles and can be used in any type of organization, irrespective of size or
nature of business. Hence, the answer in Option C is correct and the other options are
wrong.
643. COBIT 5’s KEY principles _____________
A. Are 3 in number & focus on shareholders’ needs
255
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Are 7 in number and applies multiple frameworks to cover the whole organization
C. Are 5 in number & Include meeting stakeholders’ needs
D. Marries the management & governance, creating shared goals & objectives
KEY C
Justification
COBIT5 is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT. It helps
organizations manage risk & ensure compliance, continuity, security & privacy. It has 5
KEY principles and can be used in any type of organization, irrespective of size or
nature of business. It applies a single integrated framework to address the entire
organization. It deliberately separates governance & management. Hence, the answer
in Option C is correct and the other options are wrong.
644. COBIT 5’s KEY principle of meeting stakeholders’ needs creates value by
_____________
A. Maximizing dividend payout to shareholders
B. Balancing benefits and the optimization of risk & use of resources
C. Reducing costs to the minimum
D. Eliminating risks & avoiding wasteful expenditure
KEY B
Justification
COBIT5 is a framework for governance & management of enterprise IT. It helps
organizations manage risk & ensure compliance, continuity, security & privacy. One of
its 5 KEY principles is meeting stakeholders’ needs. This principle creates value by
balancing the benefits against the optimization of risk & the use of resources. Hence,
the answer in Option B is correct and the other options are wrong.
256
Module 4
Protection of Information Assets
645. In order to protect its critical data from virus attacks an organisation decides to
limit internet access to its employees. What type of risk response has the
organisation exercised?
A. Mitigate
B. Avoid
C. Accept
D. Transfer
KEY A
A. “Mitigate” is the correct answer. Risk Mitigation primarily focuses on designing
and implementing controls to prevent incidents due to risk materialisation.
B “Avoid” is not correct as the organisation is not avoiding the use of technology to
avoid risks
C “Accept” is not correct as the organisation has not chosen to accept the risk
D “transfer” is not correct as the organisation is not passing on the risk to another
entity
646. A production company decides to insure against production loss due to natural
calamities. What type of response is this classified as?
A. Mitigate
B. Accept
C. Transfer
D. Avoid
KEY A
C “Transfer” is correct as the organisation passes on the risk to the insurance
company.
A: “Mitigate” is not correct as the organisation is not implementing any controls
within
B: “Accept” is not correct as organisation has not accepted the risk
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
D “Avoid” is not correct as the organisation has not decided to avoid technology to
minimise risk
647. Implementation of Information system control in an organisation ensures that:
A. Risk is transferred to another entity
B. Desired Outcome from business process is not affected
C. Losses are avoided
D. Incidents due to risk materialisation are avoided
KEY B
B is correct – Information Control includes implementation of policies, procedures and
practices which ensure that the desired outcome from business is not affected
A is not correct – this is a type of risk response
C & D are not correct – They are not a direct result of implementation of controls
648. Which of the following leads to destruction of information Assets such as
hardware, software and critical data?
A. Data error during data entry
B. Non maintenance of privacy with respect to sensitive data
C. Unauthorised access to computer systems
D. Using systems that do not meet user requirements
KEY C
C is correct - Unauthorised access to computer systems, computer viruses,
unauthorised physical access to computer facilities and unauthorised copies of sensitive
data can lead to destruction of assets
A is not correct – data error causes damage to the business process only
B is not correct – non maintenance of privacy does not cause damage to Information
Assets, it infringes on the privacy of the customer
D is not correct – this is a system efficiency objective
649. Maintenance of privacy in relation to data collected by an organisation is very
important because:
A. Errors committed during entry would cause great damage
B. It has an impact on the infrastructure and business competitiveness
C. It can be easily accessed by third parties
D. It contains critical and sensitive information pertaining to a customer
258
Protection of Information Assets
KEY D
D is correct - Today data collected in a business process contains details about an
individual on medical, educational, employment, residence etc.
A B and C are incorrect as these are not related to privacy of data
650. The role of an internal auditor in Information Systems auditing includes:
A. Safeguarding data integrity
B. Attesting management objectives
C. Attesting System effectiveness and system efficiency objectives
D. Implementing control procedures
KEY C
C is correct - management objectives of the internal auditor includes not only attest
objectives but also effectiveness and efficiency objectives.
A & B are incorrect – these are the responsibilities of an external auditor
D is incorrect – this is the responsibility of the organisation
651. What does an external Information Systems auditor focus on?
A. Attesting objectives that focus on asset safeguarding and data integrity
B. Attesting system effectiveness
C. Attesting system efficiency
D. Implementing control procedures
KEY A
A is correct - Information systems auditing is the process of attesting objectives (those
of the external auditor) that focus on asset safeguarding and data integrity
B & C are incorrect – these are the responsibilities of an external auditor
D is incorrect. This is the responsibility of the organisatio006E
652. By auditing the characteristics of the system to meet substantial user
requirements, which control objective does an IS Auditor attest?
A. Data integrity objectives
B. System Effectiveness Objectives
C. Asset safeguarding objectives
D. System efficiency objectives
259
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - Effectiveness of a system is evaluated by auditing the characteristics and
objective of the system to meet substantial user requirements.
A is incorrect – the auditor checks the extent of access to information and the value of
data to business
C is incorrect – the auditor assesses the internal controls to protect software and
hardware
D is incorrect – the auditor assesses the optimal usage of system resources
653. A statement of purpose achieved by implementing control procedures in a
particular IT process is defined as:
A. IS Control framework
B. Internal Controls
C. Control Objective
D. Preventive Controls
KEY C
C is correct - Control objective is defined as “A statement of the desired result or
purpose to be achieved by implementing control procedures in a particular IT process or
activity”
B is incorrect – it is the basic outline of the policies of the organisation towards IS
control
A & D are incorrect – these are the steps taken by the organisation to protect
information and system assets
654. Which of the following is an example of technical implementation of Internal
Control?
A. Outlining policies that safeguard information assets
B. Installing a security guard in the premises to restrict entry of unauthorised
persons
C. Locking the room containing sensitive documents
D. Investing in tools and software to restrict unauthorised access to information
KEY D
D is correct - this is an example of technical implementation
B is incorrect – this is an example of administrative implementation
A & C are incorrect – these are examples of physical implications
260
Protection of Information Assets
261
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
A is correct - These controls are designed to reduce the impact or correct an error once
it has been detected.
B is incorrect – this is a characteristic of preventive control
C is incorrect – this is a characteristic of detective control
D is incorrect – this is an example of detective control
658. An organisation decides to control the access to a software application by
segregating entry level and updation level duties. What type of internal control
does this amount to?
A. Preventive Control
B. Detective Control
C. Corrective Control
D. physical implementation of a control
KEY A
A is correct - Examples of preventive controls include – employing qualified personnel,
segregation of duties, access control, documentation etc.
B and C are incorrect – detective and corrective controls are not designed to predict
potential problems
D is incorrect – physical implementation of a control includes only physical aspects like
security guards and locked rooms
659. Under which type of control mechanism does taking a back up of everyday
activity classify as?
A. Detective Control
B. Preventive control
C. Corrective control
D. Administrative Implementation of Control
KEY C
C is correct – Examples of Corrective Controls are - contingency planning, backup and
restoration procedure, rerun procedure, procedure for treating error, etc.
A & B are incorrect – Detective and Preventive controls are not designed to reduce the
impact or correct an error once it has been detected.
D is incorrect – Administrative implications of controls are items such as policies and
processes
262
Protection of Information Assets
660. As an IS auditor, how would you rate a computerised detective control which is
moderately efficient and with corresponding corrective action?
A. High
B. Low
C. Moderate
D. Blank
KEY A
A is correct - Computerised control which is most effective, generally controls that are
computerized and applied before processing can take place; moderately efficient, with
corresponding corrective action are rated as “High”
B, C and D are incorrect –
Moderate- Controls implemented over a cause of exposure/error type and is moderately
effective.
Low-Controls implemented over a cause of exposure/error type but have low
effectiveness.
Blank- Controls not implemented or does not exist to that cause or exposure or error
type.
661. As an IS auditor, how would you rate a least effective and inefficient manual
detective control without corrective action?
A. High
B. Low
C. Blank
D. Moderate
KEY C
C is correct - Manual control which is least effective, generally manual controls applied
at front-end of processing; moderately efficient are rated as “Blank”
A, B & D are incorrect –
High- Controls implemented over a cause of exposure/error type and should be highly
effective.
Moderate- Controls implemented over a cause of exposure/error type and is moderately
effective.
Low-Controls implemented over a cause of exposure/error type but have low
effectiveness.
263
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
264
Protection of Information Assets
KEY C
C is correct - To ensure that risks are reviewed and updated organizations must have a
process that will ensure the review of risks. Periodic review: the risk assessment
exercise may be conducted after predefined period say annual. Change management
processes proactively review the possible risks and ensure they are part of
organization’s risk register.
A B and D are incorrect – these are steps to be taken towards identifying, assessing
risks and implementing internal controls
665. How does an IS auditor prioritise the controls that needs to be tested?
A. By reviewing the control catalogue (which is a collective record of all controls
implemented)
B. By reviewing control procedure documents
C. By facilitating risk assessment workshops
D. Planning the audit cycle according to the risks perceived
KEY A
A is correct - The first step in control’s assessment is to review the control catalogue
(which is a collective record of all controls implemented) and ensure that associated risk
is mitigated either by reducing likelihood or reducing impact or both.
B is incorrect – This should be done after reviewing the control procedure documents
C and D are incorrect – These are the roles of an auditor with respect to Information
risk management
666. In case of control self assessment, who does the actual testing of controls?
A. The owner of the identified risk for which the control has been implemented
B. Internal auditor, during the audit cycle as planned
C. Staff whose day-to-day role is within the area of the organisation
D. External auditor, while reviewing the management of KEY risks
KEY C
C is correct - In case organization has implemented control self-assessment, the actual
testing of the controls is performed by staff whose day-to-day role is within the area of
the organisation that is being examined as they have the greatest knowledge of how the
processes operate.
A is incorrect – though he/she is the risk owner, it is appropriate that the person who is
actually involved in the activity does the self- assessment
265
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B and D are incorrect – they are external to the specified activity and are not eligible to
do the self- assessment.
667. Of the below mentioned roles, which one should an auditor refrain from
performing?
A. Giving assurance that the risks are being evaluated correctly
B. Implementing risk response on management’s behalf.
C. Evaluating the risk management process
D. Reviewing the management of KEY risks
KEY B
B is correct - This is the job of the management, an auditor only needs to review the risk
response
A, C and D are incorrect – these are the roles of an IS auditor
668. Of the below mentioned roles, which one of the following should be performed by
an IS auditor?
A. Set the risk appetite
B. Impose risk management process
C. Evaluate Risk Management process
D. Take decision on risk responses
KEY C
C is correct - Evaluating the risk management process is the KEY role of an IS auditor
A, B and D are incorrect – these are the roles of the management and the risk owner.
669. A data centre housing about 200 employees is involved in handling businesses
processes of multinational companies. For security reasons, it decides to shift its
network server and mail server to a secluded room with restricted entry. What
kind of internal control is this?
A. Manual Preventive Control
B. Manual Detective Control
C. Computerised Preventive Control
D. Computerised Corrective Control
266
Protection of Information Assets
KEY A
A is correct - This is a preventive control which is designed to protect the data and mail
server from unauthorised access. Moreover, it is a manual control as the servers are
physically moved to a secluded room.
B, C and D are incorrect – The action does not categorise under any of these
categories for the reasons mentioned above.
670. Company depends on an MIS given to it by an outsourced vendor to identify
payment defaulters and fine them. On further investigation about the correctness
of data supplied, he finds that though at the entry level, a lot of mistakes are
prone to happen, there are computerised controls at the vendors end and also the
company’s end at processing level to minimise these. As an IS auditor, how
would you rate efficiency of these controls?
A. Blank
B. Low
C. Moderate
D. High
KEY D
D is correct – Computerised corrective controls are applied before processing and
hence efficiency of controls is high
A, B and C are incorrect – The Company is not relying on unchecked information. The
information is checked not by manual corrective control but computerised corrective
control. Hence the efficiency cannot be rated as blank, low or moderate.
671. The HR department of a company pays its employees medical claims subject to a
maximum limit per employee per year. For this, it relies on data partaining to a full
year downloaded through the appropriate software. However, it does not have a
proper back up or restoration procedure in place. How will an IS auditor rate this?
A. High control
B. Low Control
C. Blank Control
D. Moderate Control
KEY B
B is correct - Here there is no corrective control in case of loss of data and there is no
way the department can ascertain how much it has paid an employee in a year.
A, C and D are incorrect – Reason is as mentioned above
267
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
672. A data centre handling outsourced operations decides to set up a parallel facility
for its critical activities at some place other than its present place of operations.
This is done with an intention to facilitate return of business to normal levels in
case of impact of natural disasters or unforeseen events. Under what security
policy is this categorised?
A. Business Continuity Management Policy
B. Acceptable use of Information Assets policy
C. Physical Access and Security Policy
D. Asset Management Policy
KEY A
A is correct - This policy defines the requirements to ensure continuity of business
critical operations. It is designed to minimize the impact of an unforeseen event (or
disaster) and to facilitate return of business to normal levels.
B is incorrect - An acceptable use policy (AUP), also known as an Acceptable Usage
policy or Fair Use policy, is a set of rules applied by the owner or manager of a network,
website or large computer system that restrict the ways in which the network, website or
system may be used.
C is incorrect - Physical security describes security measures that are designed to
restrict unauthorized access to facilities, equipment and resources, and to protect
personnel and property from damage or harm (such as espionage, theft, or terrorist
attacks).
D is incorrect – This policy defines the requirements for Information Asset’s protection.
It includes assets like servers, desktops, handhelds, software, network devices etc.
Besides, it covers all assets used by an organization- owned or leased.
673. What are the three KEY objectives of Information Security Management (CIA
Triad)?
A. Compliance, Integrity and Availability
B. Confidentiality, Information Security and Availability
C. Confidentiality, Integrity and Availability
D. Confidentiality, Integrity and Asset Management
KEY C
C is correct - Protection of information assets includes the KEY components that ensure
confidentiality, integrity and availability (CIA) of information assets. There are three KEY
objectives of Information Security Management viz.: Confidentiality, Integrity and
Availability also called CIA Triad.
268
Protection of Information Assets
A, B and D are incorrect – Though important for Information Security, these are not the
KEY components.
674. What does “Integrity” mean with respect to Information Security Management?
A. No data/information or programs shall be allowed to be modified by anyone
without proper authority.
B. No data or information is made available to any person within or outside the
organization, other than the persons who are authorized to use that data.
C. All Information Systems including hardware, communication networks, software
applications and the data they hold, is available to authorized users to carry out
business activities.
D. Executive management endorsement of intrinsic security requirements to ensure
that security expectations are met at all levels of the enterprise
KEY A
A is correct – This is the correct definition as per paragraph 2.1 of the chapter
B and C are incorrect – these are definitions of “Confidentiality” and “Availability”
D is incorrect – this clause pertains to Senior Management Commitment and support
675. What provides the basis for ensuring that information security expectations are
met at all levels of an enterprise?
A. Adopting an internationally recognized reference framework to establish an
Information Security framework
B. Successful establishment and endorsement of intrinsic security measures by the
senior management
C. Prioritising expenditures to mitigate risks and avoid spending more resources in
assessing risks
D. Ensuring that the framework followed to implement, maintain, monitor and
improve Information Security is consistent with the organisational culture.
KEY B
B is correct - Commitment and support from senior management are important for
successful establishment and continuance of an information security management
program.
A C and D are incorrect – These are some of the critical success factors to Information
Security Management.
269
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
676. How does an enterprise ensure that the information present in any of its business
processes is protected and secure?
A. By ensuring that the framework followed to implement, maintain, monitor and
improve Information Security is consistent with the organisational culture.
B. By adopting an internationally recognized reference framework to establish an
Information Security framework
C. By spending resources widely and transparently
D. By establishing and enforcing an Information Security Program
KEY D
D is correct - Information Security program focuses on protecting information present in
business processes. Establish a program to improve Information Security management
enterprise-wide and enforce it.
A B, and C are incorrect – These are other critical success factors to Information
Security Management.
677. How does an enterprise demonstrate to staff, customers and trading partners that
their data is safe?
A. By establishing and enforcing an Information Security Program
B. By ensuring that the framework followed to implement, maintain, monitor and
improve Information Security is consistent with the organisational culture.
C. Adopting an information security standard
D. By spending resources widely and transparently
KEY C
C is correct - Adopting an information security standard seems to demonstrate to staff,
customers and trading partners that their data is safe, and that there is an independent
verification of this fact.
A B and D are incorrect – These are other critical success factors to Information
Security Management.
678. The IS policy of an enterprise that talks about protecting non-public personal
information from unauthorised use, corruption, disclosure and distribution is:
A. Acceptable usage policy or Fair Use policy
B. Data classification and Privacy Policy
C. Physical Access and Security policy
D. Asset Management Policy
270
Protection of Information Assets
KEY B
B is correct - the policy of the Organization to protect against the unauthorized access,
use, corruption, disclosure, and distribution of non-public personal information in its
possession, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations regarding such
information is termed as the Data Classification and privacy policy
A is incorrect – is a set of rules applied by the owner or manager of a network, website
or large computer system
C is incorrect – Physical security describes security measures that are designed to
restrict unauthorized access to facilities, equipment and resources
D is incorrect - This policy defines the requirements for Information Asset’s protection
679. The policy which restricts the ways in which the network, website or system may
be used by a user of an enterprise is termed as:
A. Acceptable usage policy or Fair Use policy
B. Physical Access and Security policy
C. Asset Management Policy
D. Business Continuity Management Policy
KEY A
A is correct - An acceptable use policy (AUP), also known as an Acceptable Usage
policy or Fair Use policy, is a set of rules applied by the owner or manager of a network,
website or large computer system that restrict the ways in which the network, website or
system may be used.
B is incorrect – Physical security describes security measures that are designed to
restrict unauthorized access to facilities, equipment and resources
C is incorrect - This policy defines the requirements for Information Asset’s protection
D is incorrect - This policy defines the requirements to ensure continuity of business
critical operations.
680. The IS policy which talks about protecting personnel and physical property from
damage or harm is termed as:
A. Asset Management policy
B. Business Continuity Management policy
C. Physical access and security policy
D. Password policy
271
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
C is correct - Physical security describes security measures that are designed to restrict
unauthorized access to facilities, equipment and resources, and to protect personnel
and property from damage or harm (such as espionage, theft, or terrorist attacks).
A is incorrect - This policy defines the requirements for Information Asset’s protection
B is incorrect - This policy defines the requirements to ensure continuity of business
critical operations.
D is incorrect - This policy defines high-level configuration of password to be used
within organization to access the information assets.
681. What is the IS policy that defines the requirements for Information Assets
protection?
A. Business Continuity Management Policy
B. Asset Management Policy
C. Network Security Policy
D. Password policy
KEY B
B is correct - This policy defines the requirements for Information Asset’s protection. It
includes assets like servers, desktops, handhelds, software, network devices etc.
Besides, it covers all assets used by an organization- owned or leased.
A is incorrect - This policy defines the requirements to ensure continuity of business
critical operations.
C is incorrect - A network security policy defines the overall rules for organisation’s
network access
D is incorrect - This policy defines high-level configuration of password to be used
within organization to access the information assets.
682. The characteristics of a strong password that protects information assets should
be:
A. Maximum 8 characters, case specific
B. Minimum 8 characters, only alpha numeric
C. Minimum 8 characters, only alphabets and easy to remember
D. Minimum 8 characters, case specific and containing special characters
272
Protection of Information Assets
KEY D
D is correct - The password policy defines high-level configuration of password to be
used within organization to access the information assets. For example:
• Password length must be more than 8 characters
• Password must be complex containing upper case, lower case, numeric and
special characters
• Password must be changed regularly
• Password should not be used again for minimum period
• Password should not be changed in consecutive sequence
A B and C are incorrect – These are not the characteristics of a strong password
683. What should be done to ensure that security policies are in tune with the
management’s intent?
A. Change passwords regularly
B. Restrict unauthorised access to facilities
C. Review the security policies periodically
D. Hold non public personal information in strict confidence
KEY C
C is correct - Information security policies need to be maintained and updated regularly.
This might need to revisit the security requirements and hence policies. Hence, it is
necessary to review the security policies periodically to ensure that they are in line with
the management’s intent.
A, B and D are incorrect – These are the parts of an information security policy
684. Policies are generic and sometimes cannot be enforced in specific situations. Can
there be a relaxation of adherence to policy in such cases?
A. Yes. But, it is necessary to ensure that there are suitable compensating controls
B. Yes. Policies can be relaxed in case of such situations unconditionally
C. No. Under no circumstances can an Information Security policy be relaxed
D. Yes. Adherence to the policy can be relaxed for an indefinite period for the
specific activity only.
KEY A
A is correct - In such situations it is necessary to ensure there are suitable
compensating controls so that the risks mitigated by enforcement of policy are within
acceptable limits.
273
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B, C and D are incorrect – Policies can be relaxed for a specific period provided the
exceptions are appropriately approved and these exceptions must be reviewed
periodically.
685. Standards, Guidelines and Procedures are the three elements of policy
implementation. In what order should they be followed for proper
implementation?
A. Guidelines, Procedures and Standards
B. Procedures, Standards and Guidelines
C. Standards, Guidelines and Procedures
D. Guidelines, Standards and Procedures
KEY C
C is correct - The next level down from policies is three elements of policy
implementation as given here: Standards: Specify the uniform way for the use of
specific technologies in an organization. Guidelines: Guidelines are similar to
standards; they refer to the methodologies of securing systems, but they are only
recommended actions and are not compulsory. Procedures: Procedure contains the
detailed steps that are followed to perform a specific task. Procedures are the detailed
actions that must be followed.
A, B and D are incorrect – These do not specify the correct levels of implementation.
Unless Standards are set, guidelines cannot be recommended. Unless guidelines are
recommended, procedures cannot be outlined for implementing policies.
686. With respect to Information Security, what does ‘Segregation of Duties’ mean?
A. No individual, of whatever seniority in the organization, should have the ability to
carry out every step of a sensitive business transaction.
B. The responsibility of powerful and KEY access to the system should not be
carried out by one person alone.
C. No person should be kept in one particular post for too long
D. Organisations should avoid situations where an individual becomes indispensable
to the business
KEY A
A is correct - No individual, of whatever seniority in the organization, should have the
ability to carry out every step of a sensitive business transaction. Access to too many
functions enables staff to carry out a fraudulent transaction and hide their tracks.
B is incorrect – This pertains to the ‘Four Eyes’ or ‘Two Person’ principle
274
Protection of Information Assets
275
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
689. Every corporate asset, building, item of equipment, bank account and item of
information should have a clearly defined ‘owner’. What are the responsibilities of
the owner of such assets?
A. Adding and deleting user identifiers from the system
B. Defining security responsibilities for every person in the organization
C. Ensuring that the asset is well maintained, accurate and up to date
D. Establishing and Implementing an effective IS program
KEY C
C is correct - The owner should have a defined set of responsibilities.
• Ensuring that computer rooms are kept clean and tidy
• Ensuring that equipment is well maintained and kept operational
• Ensuring that an item of data used by the organization is accurate and up to date.
A,B and D are incorrect – These are steps to ensure that Information Security is
implemented in an organisation.
690. When an owner is not able to manage a particular asset on a day to day basis, the
responsibility is passed on to a custodian. Which of the following is an example
of a custodian?
A. a vendor responsible for an outsourced activity
B. data center controlling access to production data
C. a subordinate doing the function of an owner during his absence
D. an auditor auditing the effectiveness of an asset
KEY B
B is correct - The owner should clearly state the requirements, the responsibilities and
associated levels of authority of the custodian and final management responsibility will
always reside with the owner. Examples of custodian include a data center operations
function controlling access to production data, and a computer bureau running an
application for a client.
A,C and D are incorrect – these are not examples of a custodian. They pertain to roles
of other players in Information Security Management.
691. The actual security mechanism has its application in certain KEY tasks of security
systems. What are these called as?
A. Organisational control
276
Protection of Information Assets
B. Backup data
C. Control points
D. Operating System
KEY C
C is correct - In all security systems there are KEY tasks which can be called control
points. It is at these control points that the actual security mechanism has its
application.
A is incorrect – this is the control that an organisation places to secure its information
assets
B is incorrect – this is a procedure that is adopted for safeguarding critical data
D is incorrect – Operating system is a software that manages computer hardware and
software resources
692. Name the participant which ensures that all stakeholders impacted by security
considerations are involved in the Information Security Management process.
A. Steering committee
B. Information Owner
C. Information Custodian
D. System Owner
KEY A
A is correct - It serves as an effective communications channel and provides an ongoing
basis for ensuring the alignment of the security program with business objectives. It can
also be instrumental in achieving modification of behavior toward a culture more
conducive to good security.
B is incorrect - Information Owner (also called Data Owners) is responsible for a
company information asset.
C is incorrect – Information custodian is assigned the task of implementing the
prescribed protection defined by the security procedure
D is incorrect – The system owner is responsible for one or more systems, each of
which may process and store data owned by different information owners.
693. Name the participant who ensures that security controls have been implemented
in accordance with the information classification.
A. information Custodian
B. Information Owner
277
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. System Owner
D. Process Owner
KEY B
B is correct - Information Owner (also called Data Owners) is responsible for a
company information asset. The responsibilities are generally assigned to
person/position that owns business process.
A is incorrect - Information custodian is assigned the task of implementing the
prescribed protection defined by the security procedure
C is incorrect – The system owner is responsible for one or more systems, each of
which may process and store data owned by different information owners.
D is incorrect – This person is responsible for the implementation, management and
continuous improvement of a process that has been defined to meet a business
requirement.
694. Name the participant who ensures safe keeping of information on behalf of the
information owner.
A. System Owner
B. Process Owner
C. Information Custodian
D. System Administrator
KEY C
C is correct - Information custodian is assigned the task of implementing the prescribed
protection defined by the security procedure and top level/Senior management
decisions. Among other activities, information custodian also performs following
activities:
• Ensuring safe keeping of information on behalf of information owner
• Providing access to users that are approved by owners
• Running regular backups and routinely testing from backup data
• Performing data restoration activity from the backups when necessary
A is incorrect – The system owner is responsible for one or more systems, each of
which may process and store data owned by different information owners.
B is incorrect – This person is responsible for the implementation, management and
continuous improvement of a process that has been defined to meet a business
requirement.
278
Protection of Information Assets
D is incorrect - System Administrator is the one with administrative / root level privileges
of the Operating systems like Windows, Unix etc.
695. Whose responsibility is it to ensure that adequate security is built once the
applications and systems have been acquired and are ready for use in the
production department?
A. System Owner
B. Process Owner
C. System Administrator
D. User Manager
KEY A
A is correct - A system owner is responsible for:
• Integrating security considerations into application and system purchasing
process and decisions.
• Ensuring that adequate security is built or defined once the applications and
systems have been acquired and are ready for use in production environment.
• Ensuring that the systems are properly assessed for vulnerabilities and report
any to the incident response team and information owner.
B is incorrect – This person is responsible for the implementation, management and
continuous improvement of a process that has been defined to meet a business
requirement.
C is incorrect - System Administrator is the one with administrative / root level privileges
of the Operating systems like Windows, Unix etc
D is incorrect - User manager is the immediate manager or reporting manager of an
employee.
696. Who is the person responsible for creating new system user accounts and
changing permissions of existing user accounts?
A. User Manager
B. System Administrator
C. Super User
D. Security Manager
279
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - A system administrator is responsible for:
• Creating new system user accounts,
• Changing permissions of existing user accounts,
• Implementing new security software,
• Testing security patches and updates, and
• Resetting user passwords.
A is incorrect - User manager is the immediate manager or reporting manager of an
employee.
C is incorrect – Super User is the person with the highest level of authorization access,
who can make any transaction and master setup activity immediately and sets the
conditions for transaction approvals, financial daily limits of each transaction type, and
classifies and authorizes other Users.
D is incorrect - Security manager is responsible for defining security strategy and
policies for the organization.
697. Who holds the ultimate responsibility for all user id’s and information assets
owned by the company’s employees?
A. Super User
B. Security Manager
C. Steering Committee
D. User Manager
KEY D
D is correct - User manager is the immediate manager or reporting manager of an
employee. They have ultimate responsibility for all user IDs and information assets
owned by company employees.
A is incorrect – Super User is the person with the highest level of authorization access,
who can make any transaction and master setup activity immediately and sets the
conditions for transaction approvals, financial daily limits of each transaction type, and
classifies and authorizes other Users.
B is incorrect - Security manager is responsible for defining security strategy and
policies for the organization.
C is incorrect - a steering committee is comprised of senior representatives of affected
groups. This facilitates achieving consensus on priorities and trade-offs. It also serves
as an effective communications channel and provides an ongoing basis for ensuring the
alignment of the security program with business objectives.
280
Protection of Information Assets
698. Who is responsible for defining security strategy and policies for an
organisation?
A. Steering Committee
B. Information Owner
C. Security Manager
D. Information Custodian
KEY C
C is correct - Security manager is responsible for defining security strategy and policies
for the organization. The manager also ensures defining roles and responsibilities.
A is incorrect - a steering committee is comprised of senior representatives of affected
groups. This facilitates achieving consensus on priorities and trade-offs. It also serves
as an effective communications channel and provides an ongoing basis for ensuring the
alignment of the security program with business objectives.
B is incorrect - Information Owner (also called Data Owners) is responsible for a
company information asset. The responsibilities are generally assigned to
person/position that owns business process.
D is incorrect - Information custodian is assigned the task of implementing the
prescribed protection defined by the security procedure
699. What is the role of Human Resources Security when the employment of a person
is terminated?
A. Ensure that access to sensitive data is revoked immediately
B. Define appropriate access to sensitive information for another person
C. Send regular updates in an effort to safeguard the data which was in their
possession
D. Educate the terminated employee to prevent data disclosure to 3rd parties
KEY A
A is correct - To prevent unauthorized access to sensitive information, access must be
revoked immediate upon termination/separation of an employee and 3rd parties with
access to such information. This also includes the return of any assets of the
organization that was held by the employee.
B is incorrect – Before granting access to a replacement, access of the leaving
employee should be revoked
C and D are incorrect – these are wrong steps – terminated employee should not have
access to sensitive data
281
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
282
Protection of Information Assets
KEY C
C is correct - A non-disclosure agreement (NDA), also known as a confidentiality
agreement (CA), is a legal contract between at least two parties that outlines
confidential material, knowledge, or information that the parties wish to share with one
another for certain purposes, but wish to restrict access to or by third parties.
A, B and D are incorrect – these are some of the issues and challenges of IS
Management
703. What is the primary cause for lack of integration in system and security design?
A. inadequacy of checklists as a means to address security concerns
B. limitations imposed on like organizations that operate in its competitive space
C. the challenge of finding the right balance between protecting the organization’s
core assets and processes and enabling them to do their job
D. systems and security design are undertaken in parallel rather than in an
integrated manner
KEY D
D is correct - Development duality is a phenomenon where systems and security design
are undertaken in parallel rather than in an integrated manner.
A.B and C are incorrect – These are other issues and challenges of IS management
704. What is a Denial-of-Service attack?
A. An attempt to make a machine or network unavailable to its intended users.
B. Unauthorized access to an organisation’s internal network.
C. Illegal copying of software.
D. Creation of Internet Protocol (IP) packets with a forged source IP address
KEY A
A is correct - A Denial-of-Service attack (DoS) is an attempt to make a machine or
network unavailable to its intended users. This causes legitimate users to not be able to
get on the network and may even cause the network to crash.
B is incorrect - unauthorized access to an organisation’s internal network is referred to
as Network Intrusion
C is incorrect – Illegal copying of software is referred to as Software Piracy
D is incorrect – creation of Internet Protocol (IP) packets with a forged source IP
address, with the purpose of concealing the identity of the sender or impersonating
another computing system is termed as ‘spoofing IP addresses’.
283
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
284
Protection of Information Assets
707. What should be done to minimise damage from security incidents and and to
recover from them?
A. Report an incident to an appropriate authority to know what action should be
taken
B. Handle the incident independently and follow it up if required
C. Establish a formal incident response capability and centralise it with the KEY
roles and responsibilities
D. Plan and prepare a response system proactively in case of the occurrence of an
incident
KEY C
C is correct - Establishing a formal incidence response capability and coordinating it
within the organisation to include all KEY roles and responsibilities is the proper way to
minimise damage from security incidents
A and B are incorrect – These are some of the actions to be taken while addressing a
security incident
D is incorrect – This is the first phase of an incident response capability
708. Generating a higher level of compliance by creating realistic workable policies is
one way of increasing compliance to security policies. Which guideline of
implementation does this fall under?
A. Simplify enforcement
B. Increase Awareness
C. Communicate Effectively
D. Integrate Security with corporate culture
KEY A
A is correct – Simplifying enforcement means convincing employees to comply with
every policy. Generating a higher level of compliance by creating realistic, workable
policies shall help.
B, C and D are incorrect – these are other guidelines to improve employee compliance
of security policies
709. As part of auditing Information Security of a multinational bank, an auditor wants
to assess the security of information in ATM facilities. Under which privacy policy
should he look for details pertaining to security guards and CCTV surveillance of
ATM’s?
285
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
286
Protection of Information Assets
711. The customer data for the loyalty card issued by a retail store is picked from a
form filled by the customer. The data from the form is entered into software by
data entry operators who report to a manager. In order to protect customer data,
segregation of duties are built in the software in such a way that the operators
have permission only to enter data. Any editing or modification can be done only
by the manager. It so happens that the manager quits his employment and the
store elevates the position of one of the operators to that of a manager. Who do
you think is responsible for removing the permission of the exiting manager and
changing that of the new manager?
A. Information Owner
B. New Manager
C. System Administrator
D. Information Owner
KEY A
A is correct - System Administrator is the one with administrative / root level privileges
of the Operating systems like Windows, Unix etc. This means that they can add and
remove permissions and set security configurations. A system administrator is
responsible for:
• Creating new system user accounts,
• Changing permissions of existing user accounts,
• Implementing new security software,
• Testing security patches and updates, and
• Resetting user passwords.
B, C and D are incorrect – for reasons mentioned above
712. The retail store (mentioned in question 3) has branches in locations across India
and the same process for collecting customer data for loyalty programs is
followed in all the branches. This data is then consolidated into one database and
is accessible across all branches. The persons who are assigned responsibilities
with respect to this database are as follows:
• Management as Information Owners
• General Manager – Marketing: As custodian for the data
• General Manager – Operations: as owner of the process
• System Administrator
• Branch Manager
287
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
288
Protection of Information Assets
289
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
A is correct - A non-disclosure agreement (NDA), also known as a confidentiality
agreement (CA), is a legal contract between at least two parties that outlines
confidential material, knowledge, or information that the parties wish to share with one
another for certain purposes, but wish to restrict access to or by third parties. It's a
contract through which the parties agree not to disclose information covered by the
agreement. An NDA creates a confidential relationship between the parties to protect
any type of confidential and proprietary information or trade secrets. As such, an NDA
protects non-public business information.
B, C and D are incorrect – for reasons as mentioned above
716. Organisations have to identify the information that needs various levels of
protection and put them in the appropriate ‘bucket’. Why can’t the entire
information within an organisation be protected uniformly?
A. There is a great dependence on information by organizations
B. It provides a systematic approach to protecting information consistently
C. Maintaining security in a network environment is complex
D. It will be a massive task to protect all information uniformly
KEY B
B is correct - Information classification can provide organizations with a systematic
approach to protecting information consistently across all parts of organization and for
all versions of information (original, copies, discarded, outdated etc.)
A, C and D are incorrect – though these are also reasons for classification, the primary
reason is that the appropriate bucket can be protected as per the nature of information
it contains
717. How must an organisation ensure that its information is adequately protected,
i.e., neither over protected nor under protected.
A. By training its employees who are using the information
B. By ensuring that its information is not shared in any network
C. By classifying its information and placing it in the appropriate bucket
D. By not sharing information with third parties
KEY C
C is correct - Information classification can help in determining the risk associated in
case of loss and thus prevent ‘over-protecting’ and/or ‘under-protecting’, ensuring that
information is adequately protected (e.g. against unauthorized disclosure, theft and
information leakage)
290
Protection of Information Assets
A B and D are incorrect – An organization may want to: 1. Publish 2. Share with select
entities and business partners 3. Made available to internal users and stakeholders
4.Should not be known for more than select few. A uniform protection may introduce
unnecessary delay and sometimes create challenges for operations. The solution
organization adopt is known identify the information that needs various levels of
protection and put them in appropriate “bucket”. Now the bucket can be protected as
per nature of information it contains.
718. Information classification ensures that security controls are only applied to
information that requires such protection. What is the benefit of such an
exercise?
A. Reduces operational costs of protecting information
B. Helps the management access sensitive information
C. Ensures that such information is not shared with third parties
D. Ensures that such information is not accessible to employees
KEY A
A is correct - Information classification helps to ensure that security controls are only
applied to information that requires such protection. This can help reduce the demand
on resources and staff and ultimately reduce the cost of protecting information. B, C and
D are incorrect – Classification of information labels information in such a way that it is
shared only with the appropriate person
719. How does an organisation ensure that appropriate users gain access to
appropriate files?
A. By classifying users to groups
B. By classifying and labeling information
C. By not sharing information in the general network
D. By having a supervisor for groups who controls access
KEY B
B is correct - Information classification can help enforce access control policies by using
the classification label to determine if an individual can gain access to a piece of
information (e.g. information labeled as Secret can only be accessed by individuals that
have been granted a security clearance of Secret)
A, C and D are incorrect – these options cannot effectively ensure that the appropriate
information is used by the appropriate user.
291
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
720. What are the factors to be considered for determining the level of confidentiality
of information?
A. Relevancy to a business transaction
B. Meeting particular compliance requirements
C. Changes to the content and external conditions of information
D. Appropriate User groups
KEY C
C is correct - Factors that should be considered when determining the level of
confidentiality of information are:
• Changes to the content of information
• Changes to external conditions over time
• Aggregation of individual pieces of information.
A, Band D are incorrect – these are the advantages of classifying information
721. An Information classification policy determines the accountability of Information
Owners, custodians and users. Who is responsible for assigning classifications
to information assets?
A. System Owner
B. Information Owner
C. System administrator
D. Process Owner
KEY B
B is correct - Information Owner (also called Data Owners) is responsible for a
company information asset. The responsibilities are generally assigned to
person/position that owns business process. Primary responsibilities are:
• Assign appropriate information classification and periodically review the
classification to ensure it still meets the business requirements.
• Ensure security controls have been implemented in accordance with the
information classification.
• Review and ensure currency of the access rights associated with the information
assets they own.
A, C and D are incorrect – These are some of the KEY roles in Information Security
Management – system owner is responsible for the systems – which hold the
information, a system administrator can set security configurations and a process owner
for the implementation and management of a process.
292
Protection of Information Assets
722. Under what information category does widely distributed product brochures fall?
A. Sensitive Information
B. Client Confidential Information
C. Unclassified/Public Information
D. Company Confidential Information
KEY C
C is correct - Information is not confidential and can be made public without any
implications for Company.
A is incorrect –Does not require special precautions to ensure the integrity and
confidentiality of the data by protecting it from unauthorized modification or deletion. It
does not require higher than normal assurance of accuracy and completeness.
B is incorrect – Is not Information received from clients in any form for processing in
production by Company.
D is incorrect – Is not information collected and used by Company in the conduct of its
business to employ people, to log and fulfill client orders, and to manage all aspects of
corporate finance.
723. Under what category does Company developed software codes fall?
A. Sensitive Information
B. Client Confidential Information
C. Company Confidential Information
D. Unclassified/Public Information
KEY A
A is correct - It requires special precautions to ensure the integrity and confidentiality of
the data by protecting it from unauthorized modification or deletion. It also requires
higher than normal assurance of accuracy and completeness.
B is incorrect – Is not Information received from clients in any form for processing in
production by Company.
C is incorrect – Is not information collected and used by Company in the conduct of its
business to employ people, to log and fulfill client orders, and to manage all aspects of
corporate finance.
D is incorrect – Information is confidential and cannot be made public without any
implications for Company.
724. Under what category does information received from clients fall?
293
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
294
Protection of Information Assets
A. PCIDSS
B. Electronic Communications Privacy Act
C. Information Technology Acct 2000
D. Regulations mandated by Reserve Bank
KEY A
A is correct -
Pay-card industry data security standard: De-facto standard for card related
information. Must be complied by all those deals with credit or debit cards which include
banks, merchants, intermediately. Although there may not be regulatory or legal
requirements as of now for compliance with PCIDSS, it has been accepted by industry.
B is incorrect – Electronics Communications Privacy Act extends government
restrictions on wire taps to include transmissions of electronic data.
C is incorrect - Information technology Act 2000, (Amendment 2008): Provides that any
organization is collecting PII shall be liable in case absence of reasonable security of
such information results in identify theft.
D is incorrect – These regulations have mandated processes for collecting, storing,
securing data and information including PII.
727. What is the Act which mandates how financial institutions must deal with the
private information of individuals?
A. Information technology Act 2000
B. Video Privacy Protection Act
C. Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act
D. Electronic Communications Privacy Act
KEY C
C is correct - Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act: Mandates how financial institutions must deal
with the private information of individuals.
B is incorrect - Video Privacy Protection Act: Prevents wrongful disclosure of an
individual's personally identifiable information stemming from their rental or purchase of
audio-visual material.
A is incorrect - Information technology Act 2000, (Amendment 2008): Provides that any
organization is collecting PII shall be liable in case absence of reasonable security of
such information results in identify theft.
D is incorrect –Electronic Communications Privacy Act (ECPA): Extends government
restrictions on wire taps to include transmissions of electronic data.
295
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
728. Which of the following does not classify under Personally identifiable
Information?
A. Company advertisement information
B. Medical information of patients
C. Location information of clients
D. Information collected by websites
KEY A
A is correct - This is public/unclassified information which is not sensitive and does not
require any security
B, C and D are incorrect – these are PII’s
729. How is information classification applied for information contained in a critical
database?
A. at the file or data level
B. to the entire database
C. to each individual document
D. at column level at the discretion of the information owner
KEY D
D is correct - For critical databases, classification may apply to column level, at the
discretion of the information owner
A is incorrect - For server-based systems, classification will be done at the file or data
level;
B is incorrect - For information in a database, the classification will normally apply to the
entire database;
C is incorrect – For paper documents, including output from systems, classification will
apply to each individual document
730. How can critical data be protected during transmission, processing and storing?
A. By keeping the information physically secured
B. By encrypting
C. By controlling access
D. By taking a backup
296
Protection of Information Assets
KEY B
B is correct - By encrypting critical information, we ensure that such information is
accessible only to the appropriate person
A, C and D are incorrect – these do not apply to information that is being transmitted,
stored and processed.
731. What are the solutions referred to under DLP (Data Leak Prevention)?
A. Protecting data based on the rule set and classification
B. Expecting creator of data file to choose who shall access data
C. Authenticating users out of the organisation
D. Working at data base level and managing the access rights
KEY A
A is correct - The solutions generally referred under popular acronym DLP (Data leak
prevention/ Data loss prevention/ Data leak protection) provide few capabilities to be
implemented independently e.g. there are solutions that focuses on protecting data
passing through networks based on the rule-set and classification.
B and C are incorrect – solutions referred by acronym DRM (Digital rights Management)
that can be applied to data files. The solutions expects creator of data file to decide who
shall access the data and need to add in central user list. Sometimes this becomes
impractical when such files are meant for users out of organization and they need to be
authenticated by DRM server.
D is incorrect - DAM (Digital access management) that works at data base level and
manages the access rights while providing data to applications, based on rules and
classification.
732. What is the pre requisite for successful implementation of data protection tools
like DLP, DRM and DAM?
A. Identifying information resources
B. Creating an information risk profile
C. Creating appropriate rule set and classification based on impact of risks
D. Establishing a process for data classification
KEY C
C is correct - A prerequisite for successful implementation of these tools is appropriate
rule set and data classification based on impact of risks associated with data leak.
A, B and D are incorrect – These are steps that have to be followed to create
appropriate rule set and classification
297
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
298
Protection of Information Assets
KEY B
B is correct - Network devices: devices deployed for establishing communication which
includes routers, switches, firewalls, cables, wireless devices and other network
monitoring tools.
A is incorrect – Devices in which all the data in a network is placed is a server
C is incorrect – Devices installed by telecom companies to facilitate mobile
communication are towers
D is incorrect – Devices that facilitate accessing data from anywhere are portable
devices
735. In order to ensure the privacy of personal information of an individual, a company
has to:
A. Write policies and procedures
B. Define roles and responsibilities
C. Implement an effective privacy program
D. Define incident response plans
KEY C
C is correct - It is important that the organization implements an effective privacy
program in order to ensure the privacy of the personal information of an individual
A, Band D are incorrect – These are the steps to be taken to implement a successful
privacy program
736. An auditor need not involve in one of the following while evaluating an
organisation’s privacy framework. Which is it?
A. Liaise with in-house legal counsel to understand legal implications
B. Design Incident response plans
C. Liaise with information technology specialists to understand security implications
D. Understand internal policies and guidelines
KEY B
B is correct - This is done by the organisations governing body
A, C and D are incorrect – These are the roles of an internal auditor
737. An insurance company is in the process of classifying its information according
to its sensitivity. If you formed a part of the team responsible for this
299
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
300
Protection of Information Assets
301
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
302
Protection of Information Assets
744. Threats to Information Assets like computing equipment, media and people are
known as:
A. Cyber threats
B. Environmental Threats
C. Physical Threats
D. Logical Access Threats
KEY C
C is correct - Physical threats to information system assets comprises of threats to
computing equipment, facilities which house the equipment, media and people.
A is incorrect - Cyber threats are threats due to exposure of information in the world
wide web
B is incorrect – Environment threats are undesired or unintentional or intentional
alteration in the environment in which computing resources function can result in threats
to availability of information systems and integrity of information.
D is incorrect – Logical access threat arising where unauthorized persons tried to get
information useful for breaking into organization system.
745. “Preventing modification of data by unauthorised personnel” falls under which
core principle of Information Safety?
A. Integrity
B. Confidentiality
C. Availability
D. Security
KEY A
A is correct - Confidentiality, Integrity and Availability (CIA Triad) are the core principles
of information safety. Integrity: Prevent modification of data by unauthorized personnel.
B and C are incorrect – Confidentiality: Preventing disclosure of information to
unauthorized individuals or systems, Availability: Information must be available when it
is needed.
D is incorrect – This Is not a part of the CIA Triad
746. Under what category of Physical Security threat does poor handling and cabling
of electronic equipments fall?
A. Electrical
303
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Environmental
C. Maintenance
D. Hardware
KEY C
C is correct - Maintenance: These threats are due to poor handling of electronic
components, which cause ESD (electrostatic discharge), the lack of spare parts, poor
cabling, poor device labelling, etc.
A is incorrect - Electrical vulnerabilities are seen in things such as spikes in voltage to
different devices and hardware systems, or brownouts due to an insufficient voltage
supply. Electrical threats also come from the noise of unconditioned power and, in some
extreme circumstances like total power loss.
B is incorrect – interference of natural disasters such as fires, hurricanes, tornados, and
flooding, fall under the realm of environmental threat.
D is incorrect - It has the threat of physical damage to corporate hardware or its theft.
747. Which of the following is not a source of Physical Security threat?
A. Uncontrolled/Unconditioned Power, Low voltage
B. Physical Access to IS resources by unauthorised personnel
C. Discontented or disgruntled employees
D. Interested or Informed outsiders
KEY A
A is correct - This is not a source of physical security threat, it is a source of
environmental threat
B, C and D are incorrect – These are sources of physical security threats
748. In an organisation there are instances of employees using the internet for
personal purposes. Under what threat is this classified?
A. Logical access threat
B. Environment threat
C. Improper physical access threat
D. Electrical threat
KEY C
C is correct - Threats from improper physical access usually are human-induced. Some
examples are:
304
Protection of Information Assets
305
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
306
Protection of Information Assets
attempted them. The audit trails or access logs must record the following:
• The date-and time of the access attempt
• Whether the attempt was successful or not
• Where the access was granted (which door, for example)
• Who attempted the access
• Who modified the access privileges at the supervisor level
B, C and D are incorrect – These have no relevance to maintenance of audit logs
752. What is the first step once an unauthorised event is detected?
A. Process owner should investigate and take action
B. The incident should be reported to the appropriate authority
C. Security administrator should effect modifications to the security policy
D. Should be effectively handled to mitigate losses
KEY B
B is correct - Once an unauthorised incident is detected, the first step is to report the
same.
Appropriate procedures should be in place to enable reporting of such incidents
A, C and D are incorrect – These are subsequent steps
753. Which of the following is not a Human Resource Control?
A. Providing identity cards
B. Providing training in Physical Security
C. Locking system screens when not in seat
D. Monitoring behavior
KEY C
C is correct - Locking screens forms part of logical access control
A, B and D are incorrect – These are examples of human resources control
754. The most important human resource control is:
A. Providing access cards to employees
B. Assigning responsibilities to employees
C. Provide training to employees
D. Escort terminated or resigned/retired employees
307
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
A is correct - One of most important control is process of providing access cards to
employees, vendor personnel working onsite and visitors. The process should aim in
preventing generation of false cards, modifying contents of cards, accounting for lost
cards and reconciliation of cards to detect missing/lost cards. In addition a process to
grant, change and revoke access must be in place.
B, C and D are incorrect – These controls are other human resource controls
755. Which of the following is a perimeter security?
A. Screen savers
B. Passwords
C. Access cards
D. Guards
KEY D
D is correct - Guards are commonly deployed in perimeter control, depending on cost
and sensitivity of resource to be secured. While guards are capable of applying
subjective intelligence, they are also subject to the risks of social engineering. They are
useful whenever immediate, discriminating judgment is required.
A is incorrect – Screen savers are used to lock screens when not in use
B is incorrect – Passwords are used to prevent unauthorised access to sensitive data
C is incorrect – Access cards are used as a physical security measure
756. Which of the following is not a perimeter security?
A. Compound walls and Fencing
B. Lighting exteriors
C. Encrypting data in transit
D. Bolting door locks
KEY C
C is correct - Encrypting data in transit is a logical access security
A,B and D are incorrect – thee are examples of perimeter security
757. What perimeter security is used to reduce the risk of piggy backing?
A. Dead man doors
B. Bolting door locks
308
Protection of Information Assets
309
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
C is correct - While these devices are considered highly secure, they suffer from the
following disadvantages:
• Relatively high cost of acquisition, implementation and maintenance, hence they
are used mainly to secure sensitive installations.
• Time consuming process of user registration.
• Privacy issues relating to use of devices like retina and fingerprint scanners.
• High error rates compared to other devices since they may result in a false
rejection or more critically a false acceptance.
A, B and D are incorrect – Biometric locks are sophisticated and highly secure.
Duplication of biometrics is not possible.
760. A device which creates a grid of visible white light or invisible infra red light,
which when broken activates an alarm is:
A. Photo electric sensors
B. Dry contact switches
C. Video cameras
D. Identification badges
KEY A
A is correct - Photoelectric sensors receive a beam of light from a light-emitting device,
creating a grid of either visible white light, or invisible infrared light, which when broken
activates an alarm.
B is incorrect - Dry contact switches and tape are probably the most common types of
perimeter detection. This can consist of metallic foil tape on windows or metal contact
switches on doorframes to detect when a door or window has been opened.
C is incorrect – Cameras provide preventive and detective control. Closed-Circuit
Television (CCTV) cameras have to be supplemented by security monitoring and
guards for taking corrective action.
D is incorrect - Special identification badges such as employee cards, privileged access
pass, visitor passes etc. enable tracking movement of personnel. These can also be
cards with signature and/or photo identity.
761. The process requiring all visitors to sign a visitors log at the time of entry/exit is
known as
A. Electronic logging
310
Protection of Information Assets
B. Manual logging
C. Controlled visitor access
D. Controlled single point access
KEY B
B is correct - Manual Logging: All visitors to the premises are prompted to sign a
visitor’s log recording the date and time of entry/exit, name of entrant, organization,
purpose etc. The visitor may also be required to authenticate his identity by means of a
business card, photo identification card, driver’s license etc.
A is incorrect - Electronic Logging: Electronic card users may be used to record the
date and time of entry/exit of the card holder by requiring the person to swipe the card
both time of entry and exit. This is a faster and more reliable method for restricting
access to employees and pre-authorized personnel only. These devices may use
electronic/biometric security mechanisms.
C is incorrect - Controlled single point access: Physical access to the facility is
granted though a single guarded entry point. Multiple entry points may dilute
administration of effective security.
D is incorrect – Controlled Visitor access: A pre-designated responsible employee or
security staff escorts all visitors such as maintenance personnel, contract workers,
vendors, consultants for a specified time period
762. A card reader that senses the card in possession of a user in the general area and
enables faster access is:
A. Wireless proximity readers
B. Motion detectors
C. Cable locks
D. Identification Badges
KEY A
A is correct - A proximity reader does not require physical contact between the access
card and the reader. The card reader senses the card in possession of a user in the
general area (proximity) and enables faster access.
B is incorrect - Alarm Systems/Motion detectors. Alarm systems provide detective
controls and highlight security breaches to prohibited areas, access to areas beyond
restricted hours, violation of direction of movement e.g. where entry only/exit only doors
are used. Motion detectors are used to sense unusual movement within a predefined
interior security area and thus detect physical breaches of perimeter security, and may
sound an alarm.
311
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C is incorrect - A cable lock consists of a plastic-covered steel cable that chains a PC,
laptop or peripherals to the desk or other immovable objects.
D is incorrect – Special identification badges such as employee cards, privileged access
pass, visitor passes etc. enable tracking movement of personnel.
763. Lockable switches that prevent a KEY board from being used is:
A. Switch controls
B. Biometric Mouse
C. Laptop security
D. Peripheral switch controls
KEY D
D is correct - Peripheral switch controls: These types of controls are lockable
switches that prevent a keyboard from being used.
A is incorrect - A switch control is a cover for the on/off switch, which prevents a user
from switching of the file server’s power.
B is incorrect - Biometric Mouse: The input to the system uses a specially designed
mouse, which is usable only by pre-determined/pre-registered person based on the
fingerprint of the user.
C is incorrect – Cable locks, biometric mice/fingerprint/iris recognition and encryption of
the file system are some of the means available to protect laptops and their data.
764. A smart card used for access control is also called a security access card. Which
of the following is not a type of smart card?
A. Identification cards
B. Photo Image Cards
C. Digital coded cards
D. Wireless proximity readers
KEY A
A is correct - Special identification badges such as employee cards, privileged access
pass, visitor passes etc. enable tracking movement of personnel.
B is incorrect - Photo-image cards are simple identification cards with the photo of the
bearer for identification.
C is incorrect - Digitally encoded cards contain chips or magnetically encoded strips
(possibly in addition to a photo of the bearer).
312
Protection of Information Assets
D is incorrect – A proximity reader does not require the user to physically insert the
access card.
765. Which of the following is not a biometric characteristic?
A. Finger prints
B. Retina scans
C. Passport photo
D. Palm scans
KEY C
C is correct - Passport photo does not have a biometric characteristic
A, B and D are incorrect – All these are typical biometric characteristics used to
uniquely identify or authenticate an individual
766. Name the performance measure in biometrics which is the percentage of invalid
subjects that are falsely accepted.
A. False Rejection Rate (FRR)
B. False Acceptance Rate (FAR)
C. Crossover Error Rate (CER)
D. Throughput rate
KEY B
B is correct - False acceptance rate (FAR), or Type II error: The percentage of invalid
subjects that are falsely accepted. FAR is more critical than FRR.
A is incorrect - False rejection rate (FRR), or Type I error: The percentage of valid
subjects that are falsely rejected
C is incorrect - Crossover error rate (CER): The percent at which the FRR equals the
FAR. In most cases, the sensitivity of the biometric detection system can be increased
or decreased. If the system’s sensitivity is increased, such as in an airport metal
detector, the system becomes increasingly selective and has a higher FRR. Conversely,
if the sensitivity is decreased, the FAR will increase.
D is incorrect – There is no such measure as throughput rate in biometrics
767. With respect to biometrics evaluation, how is the time taken to register with a
system referred as?
A. Enrolment time
B. Throughput rate
313
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. Acceptability
D. Registration time
KEY A
A is correct - Enrolment time is the time it takes to initially register with a system by
providing samples of the biometric characteristic to be evaluated.
B is incorrect - The throughput rate is the rate at which individuals, once enrolled, can
be processed and identified or authenticated by a system.
C is incorrect - Acceptability refers to considerations of privacy, invasiveness, and
psychological and physical comfort when using the system.
D is incorrect – there is no such evaluation as registration time with respect to
biometrics
768. With respect to audit of physical access controls, what does controls assessment
mean?
A. Ensuring that the risk assessment procedure adequately covers periodic and
timely assessment of all assets
B. Evaluating whether physical access controls are in place
C. Examining relevant documentation such as the security policy and procedures,
premises plans, building plans, etc
D. Reviewing physical access controls for their effectiveness.
KEY B
B is correct - Controls Assessment: The auditor based on the risk profile evaluates
whether physical access controls are in place and adequate to protect the IS assets
against the risks.
A is incorrect – This procedure is risk assessment
C is incorrect – This procedure is review of documentation
D is incorrect – This procedure is testing of controls
769. The review of physical access controls by an auditor need not include:
A. Observing safeguards and Physical access procedures
B. Interviewing personnel to get information of procedures
C. Authorising special access
D. Touring organisational facilities
314
Protection of Information Assets
KEY C
C is correct - This is the role of the manager/management, not of an auditor
A,B and D are incorrect – These are the roles of an auditor
770. What should an auditor check for in case of employee termination?
A. The employees tenure and his conduct during the same
B. Withdrawal and deactivation of access rights
C. Whether appropriate rights have been granted to the replacement
D. Whether there is any due from the employee to the organisation
KEY B
B is correct - Employee termination procedures should provide withdrawal of rights such
as retrieval of physical devices such as smart cards, access tokens, deactivation of
access rights and its appropriate communication to relevant constituents in the
organization.
A, C and D are incorrect – these are not the concerns of an auditor
771. What is the review procedure that should be adopted by an auditor to ensure that
there is adequate security at entrance and exits?
A. Review physical layout diagrams , risk analysis, procedure for removal and return
of storage media, knowledge and awareness of emergency procedures by
employees
B. Inspect guard procedures and practices, and facility surveillance system apart
from assessing vehicle and pedestrian traffic around high risk facility
C. Review security policies and procedures at enterprise level and system level are
aligned with business stated objectives
D. Review employee and visitor entry logs, entry/exit procedures used by
management, documentation of logs
KEY D
D is correct
A is incorrect – these procedures are to review that physical safeguards are
commensurate with the risks of physical damage or access
B is incorrect – These procedures are to review the perimeter security
C is incorrect – These procedures are to review whether security control policies and
procedures are properly documented
315
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
772. From the perspective of environmental exposures and controls, how are
computer rooms, server rooms and printer rooms categorised?
A. Information System supporting infrastructure or facilities
B. Hardware and Media
C. Documentation
D. Supplies
KEY A
A is correct - Information Systems Supporting Infrastructure or Facilities: This
typically includes the following:
• Physical Premises, like Computer Rooms, Cabins, Server Rooms/Farms, Data
Centre premises, Printer Rooms, Remote facilities and Storage Areas
• Communication Closets
• Cabling ducts
• Power Source
• Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC)
B is incorrect - Hardware and Media: Includes Computing Equipment, Communication
equipment, and Storage Media
C is incorrect - Documentation: Physical and geographical documentation of
computing facilities with emergency excavation plans and incident planning procedures.
D is incorrect – Supplies: The third party maintenance procedures for say air-
conditioning, fire safety, and civil contractors whose entry and assess with respect to
their scope of work assigned are to be monitored and logged.
773. Which of the following is a natural environmental threat?
A. War action and Bomb threats
B. Air conditioning failure
C. Earthquakes
D. Undesired activities in computer facilities such as smoking
KEY C
C is correct - Earthquake is a natural environmental threat
A, B and D are incorrect – These are man made environmental threats
774. Which of the following is a man-made environmental threat?
316
Protection of Information Assets
317
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
318
Protection of Information Assets
319
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
320
Protection of Information Assets
321
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A is incorrect - Fires caused by common combustibles (like wood, cloth, paper, rubber,
most plastics) are classed as Class A and are suppressed by water or soda acid (or
sodium bicarbonate).
B is incorrect - Electrical fires are classified as Class C fires and are suppressed by
Carbon Dioxide (CO), or FM200. Fire caused by flammable chemicals and metals (such
as magnesium and sodium) are classed as Class D and are suppressed by Dry Powder
(a special smothering and coating agent).
D is incorrect – This is a classification of suppression systems
786. Which of the following is a gas based fire suppression system?
A. Wet pipe sprinklers
B. FM 200
C. Dry pipe sprinklers
D. Pre action
KEY B
B is correct - FM200 is an inert gas, does not damage equipment as water systems do
and does not leave any liquid or solid residues, however it is not safe for humans as it
reduces the levels of oxygen.
A, C & DF are incorrect – These are water based fire suppression systems
787. How does an auditor ensure that there are safeguards against the risks of
heating, ventilation and air-conditioning systems?
A. Review heating, ventilation and air-conditioning design
B. Review any shielding strategies
C. Verify critical systems and emergency power supplies
D. Interview officials and review planning documents
KEY A
A is correct - The auditor has to review a heating, ventilation and air-conditioning design
to verify proper functioning within an organization in order to ensure safeguards against
risks of heating, ventilation and air-conditioning
B is incorrect – This is done to check control of radio emissions effect on computer
systems
C is incorrect – This is done to establish adequate interior security based on risk
D is incorrect – This is done to adequately protect against emerging threats
322
Protection of Information Assets
788. How does an auditor ensure that adequate environmental controls have been
implemented?
A. Interview security personnel to ensure their awareness and responsibilities
B. Verify critical systems and emergency power supplies
C. Interview staff, determine humidity, temperature and voltage are within
acceptable levels
D. Interview officials and review planning documents and review training records
and documentation
KEY C
C is correct - To ensure adequate environmental controls have been implemented, an
auditor has to: Interview managers and scrutinize that operations staff are aware of the
locations of fire alarms, extinguishers, shut-off power switches, air -ventilation
apparatus and other emergency devices.
Determine that humidity, temperature and voltage are controlled within the accepted
levels.
Check cabling, plumbing, room ceiling smoke detectors, water detectors on the floor are
installed and in proper working order.
A is incorrect –This is done to ensure that Staff has been trained to react to
emergencies
B is incorrect – This is done to establish adequate interior security based on risk
D is incorrect – This is done to adequately protect against emerging threats
789. Which of the following is not a component in the information systems
infrastructure between the user and the Data Base?
A. Network operating systems
B. Application software
C. Physical documents
D. Data Base Management System
KEY C
C is correct - Physical documents do not form a component in the information systems
infrastructure between the user and the database
A, B and D are incorrect – These are components in the information systems
infrastructure which have to be subjected to appropriate means of security
323
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
790. What is the task of an auditor when evaluating the risks associated with hardware
components?
A. Consider vulnerabilities of different communication channels and devices like
workstations, peripherals etc.
B. Ensure that logical access to system software are controlled to detect changes in
system configuration
C. Evaluate the access security enforced by the DBMS
D. Focus on the effectiveness of boundary controls and I/O controls
KEY A
A is correct - Hardware includes computer workstations, terminal devices,
communication devices, peripherals etc., constituting the physical interface with the
users. Here the auditor should consider vulnerabilities of different communication
channels and devices specifically (e.g. modems, network interface cards) connected to
computers. Software
B, C and D are incorrect – These are the auditors tasks when auditing systems
software, Database Management System and Application software respectively.
791. What are the tasks of an auditor while evaluating the vulnerabilities of a Data
Base Management System (DBMS)?
A. Evaluate access permissions configured in software
B. Evaluating the access security enforced by the DBMS
C. Ensure that logical access to system software are controlled to detect changes in
system configuration
D. Focus on the effectiveness of boundary controls and I/O controls
KEY B
B is correct - In environments involving voluminous data handling, a Database
Management System (DBMS) manages the organisation of data in the databases. The
auditor is required to evaluate the access security enforced by the DBMS, which could
include schema definitions, access to data dictionary, directory services and scripts to
restrict access implemented by the DBMS.
A, C and D are incorrect – These are the auditors tasks when auditing application
software, systems software and access control software respectively
792. What is Masquerading?
A. Disguising or Impersonation
324
Protection of Information Assets
325
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
326
Protection of Information Assets
KEY A
A is correct - A macro virus is a computer virus that "infects" a Microsoft Word or similar
application and causes a sequence of actions to be performed automatically when the
application is started or an event trigger. If a user accesses a document containing a
viral macro and unwittingly executes this macro virus, it can then copy itself into that
application's start-up files.
B is incorrect - Polymorphic viruses are difficult to detect because they hide themselves
from antivirus software by altering their appearance after each infection. Some
polymorphic viruses can assume over two billion different identities.
C is incorrect - Stealth viruses attempt to hide their presence from both the operating
system and the antivirus software by encrypting themselves. They are similar to
polymorphic viruses and are very hard to detect.
D is incorrect – These are Adware and Spyware that often come with some commercial
software, both packaged as well as shareware software. There is often a reference to
the Adware and Spyware software in the license agreement.
796. Which of the following is not a characteristic of Logic Bombs?
A. This blows up on the occurrence of a logical event
B. These are programmed to open specific ports to allow access for exploitation
C. This checks whether a particular condition has been met to execute the logic
code
D. These are very difficult to detect as its destructive information set is known only
after it is executed
KEY B
B is correct - This is the characteristic of a Trojan Horse
A, C and D are incorrect – These are the characteristics of Logic Bombs.
797. Which of the following is not a characteristic of a Macro Virus?
A. When executed unwittingly by a user, it copies itself to the applications start up
files
B. Its infection spreads to other machines on a network
C. These are relatively harmless
D. This can assume over two billion two billion different identities
KEY D
D is correct - This is the characteristic of a polymorphic virus
A, B and D are incorrect – These are the characteristics of macro Viruses
327
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
328
Protection of Information Assets
KEY A
A is correct - Force change on first login by the user so as to prevent possible misuse
by system administrators
B and C are incorrect – These are a few of the other password management functions
D is incorrect – Taking an undertaking is not an appropriate method
801. Which of the following is not mandatory for good password management?
A. All passwords should be authenticated
B. Password expiry must be managed as per policy
C. Every user’s password should be known to the user manager
D. Users have to be educated and made responsible for their password
KEY C
C is correct - It is not necessary for the user manager to know the passwords of all the
users
A, B and D are incorrect – these are some of the functions of password management
802. How is it possible to detect excess rights due to changes in responsibilities,
emergencies etc.?
A. By assigning access privileges
B. By getting the password of the user
C. By a person who has administrative privileges
D. By Periodic review of user’s access rights
KEY D
D is correct - Periodic review of user's access rights is essential process to detect
possible excess rights due to changes in responsibilities, emergencies, and other
changes. These reviews must be conducted by information owner and administrators
facilitates by providing available accesses recorded in system.
A, B and C are incorrect – excess rights due to changes in responsibilities cannot be
detected by these methods
803. What must an IS auditor ensure while reviewing access controls related to user id
and passwords of default users with administrative privileges?
A. They can remain but it should be known to the organisation
B. These user ids should be disabled and passwords changed
329
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
330
Protection of Information Assets
805. Name the control which helps in auditing and tracking of transactions along with
date and time?
A. Segregation of Networks
B. Network connection and routing control
C. Clock synchronisation
D. Enforced path
KEY C
C is correct - Clock synchronization is useful control to ensure that event and audit logs
maintained across an enterprise are in synch and can be correlated. This helps in
auditing and tracking of transactions along with date and time that is uniform across
organization. In modern networks this function is centralized and automated.
A is incorrect – Segregation of Networks - Based on the sensitive information handling
function; say a VPN connection between a branch office and the head-office this
network is to be isolated from the internet usage service availability for employees.
B is incorrect - This is another feature of network access control – network connection
and routing control - The traffic between networks should be restricted, based on
identification of source and authentication access policies implemented across the
enterprise network facility. The techniques of authentication and authorization as per
access policy have been implemented across the organization’s network.
D is incorrect – Enforced path - Based on risk assessment, it is necessary to specify the
exact path or route connecting the networks; say for example internet access by
employees will be routed through a firewall. And to maintain a hierarchical access levels
for both internal and external user logging. An Internet connection exposes an
organization to the entire world. This brings up the issue of benefits the organization
should derive along with the precaution against harmful elements.
806. A user is allowed to access only those items he is authorised to access. How is
access to information prevented in an application?
A. By application specific menu interfaces
B. System Access is monitored
C. By Event logging
D. By monitoring system use
KEY A
A is correct - The access to information is prevented by application specific menu
interfaces, which limit access to system function. A user is allowed to access only to
those items he is authorized to access. Controls are implemented on the access rights
of users, For example, read, write, delete, and execute. And ensure that sensitive
output is sent only to authorized terminals and locations.
331
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
332
Protection of Information Assets
808. Methods like Biometric Authentication or digital certificates are employed for
which aspect of operating system control?
A. Password Management
B. Terminal log on procedures
C. User identification and authentication
D. Automated terminal identification
KEY C
C is correct - User identification and authentication: The users must be identified and
authenticated in a fool proof manner. Depending on risk assessment, more stringent
methods like Biometric Authentication or Cryptographic means like Digital Certificates
should be employed.
A is incorrect - An operating system could enforce selection of good passwords. Internal
storage of password should use one-way encryption algorithms and the password file
should not be accessible to users.
B is incorrect - Terminal log-on procedures: The log-on procedure does not provide
unnecessary help or information, which could be misused by an intruder.
D is incorrect – Automated terminal identification: This will help to ensure that a
particular session could only be initiated from a particular location or computer terminal.
809. What are ‘Audit Trails’?
A. History of transactions
B. Record of system activities enabling examination of a transaction
C. Attempts to gain unauthorised access to system
D. Unauthorised privileges granted to users
KEY B
B is correct - Logs are also called ‘audit trail’. It is a record of system activities that
enables the reconstruction and examination of the sequence of events of a transaction,
from its inception to output of final results. Violation reports present significant, security-
oriented events that may indicate either actual or attempted policy transgressions
reflected in the audit trail. Violation reports should be frequently and regularly reviewed
by information owner to identify any unauthorized change or access.
A, C and D are incorrect – An audit associated with information system security
searches for these activities that are obtained from Audit trails.
810. What is authentication with regard to Access Control Mechanism?
333
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
334
Protection of Information Assets
KEY B
B is correct - An alternative to one-time passwords is challenge response schemes.
Instead of having the device just blindly generate a password, a user identifies himself
to the server, usually by presenting his user ID. The server then responds with a
challenge, which is usually a short phrase of letters and numbers. The user types the
challenge into the device and, based on the challenge, the device responds with an
output. The user then types that output in as his password to the server. This scheme is
slightly more complicated, but it allows the password to be based on changing input
rather than just time.
A is incorrect - This is the most common authentication technique that depends on
remembered information. The user, initially, identifies him using his login-id to the
system and then provides the password information. Once the system is able to locate
the match and is successful for both fields, the system authenticates the user and
enables access to resources based on the authorization matrix. However if a match is
not successful, the system returns a message (such as “Invalid User or password”) thus
preventing access to resources.
C is incorrect - PIN is a type of password, usually a 4-digit numeric value that is used in
certain systems to gain access, and authenticate. The PIN should be such that a person
or a computer cannot guess it in sufficient time by using a guess and check method, i.e.
where it guesses the PIN, and checks for correctness by testing it on the system that
the person is attempting to gain access to and the process is repeated with a different
guess till access is obtained. PINs are commonly used for gaining access to Automatic
Teller Machines (ATMs).
D is incorrect – One-time passwords solve the problems of user-derived passwords.
With one-time passwords, each time the user tries to log on he is given a new
password. Even if an attacker intercepts the password, he will not be able to use it to
gain access because it is good for only one session and predetermined limited time
period. For example one time password for online card transaction is provided by bank
to user on registered mobile is valid for 10 minutes only. One-time passwords typically
use a small hardware device or software that generates a new password every time.
The server also has the same software running, so when a user types in his password,
the server can confirm whether it is the correct password. Each time the user logs on he
has a new password, so it is much more secure.
813. What is the attacking technique in which the attacker uses a malicious software to
steal passwords and other information?
A. Trojan attack
B. Brute force
335
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. Dictionary attack
D. Spoofing attack
KEY A
A is correct - Trojan: A malicious software, which the attacker can use to steal access
control lists, passwords or other information.
B is incorrect - In this crude form of attack, the attacker tries out every possible
combination to hit on the successful match. The attacker may also use various
password cracking software that assist in this effort.
C is incorrect - Dictionary attack: On the similar lines as brute force, this type of attack
is based on the assumption that users tend to use common words as passwords, which
can be found in a dictionary, hence the name. The “dictionary” simply consists of a list
of words, including proper names (Raju, Ramesh, Ibrahim, etc.) and also that of
mythological or religious names (Krishna, Jesus, Osiris, Buddha, etc.).
D is incorrect – Spoofing attacks: In this technique, the attacker plants a Trojan
program, which masquerades as the system’s logon screen, gets the logon and
password information and returns control to the genuine access control mechanism.
Once the information is obtained, the attacker uses the information to gain access to
the system resources.
814. Automatic log out after a predetermined period of inactivity is a technique used
against which type of attack?
A. Spoofing attacks
B. Dictionary attacks
C. Piggy backing
D. Trojan attack
KEY C
C is correct - Piggybacking: As stated earlier, an unauthorized user may wait for an
authorised user to log in and leave a terminal unattended. The logical techniques that
are used to secure against this attack are to automatically log out the session after a
pre-determined period of inactivity or by using password-protected screen savers.
A Band D are incorrect – For these attacks other techniques are used
815. Which of the following is the feature of a Smart token only?
A. Contains information such as name, identification no, photograph etc
B. Contains a magnetic strip which stores information
336
Protection of Information Assets
337
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - An overall metric used is the Crossover Error Rate (CER) which is the
point at which FRR equals FAR.
A, C and D are incorrect – False Rejection Rate (FRR) which is wrongfully rejecting a
rightful user and False Acceptance Rate (FAR) which involves an unauthorized user
being wrongfully authenticated as a right user. Ideally a system should have a low false
rejection and low false acceptance rate. Most biometric systems have sensitivity levels
which can be tuned. The more sensitive a system becomes, FAR drops while FRR
increases. Thus, FRR and FAR tends to inversely related.
818. Which of the following is not a function of the operating system?
A. Provides independent user and access privilege management mechanism
B. Supports execution of applications and enforces and security constraints defined
at that level
C. Isolates processes from each other and protects permanent data stored in its
files
D. Provides controlled access to shared resources
KEY A
A is correct - This is not the function of an operating system, this is the function of an
application
B, C and D are incorrect – These are the functions of an operating system
819. The flexibility of a Pluggable authentication module allows to:
A. Execute applications and support any security constraints
B. Use multiple authentications for a given service
C. Provide controlled access to shared resources
D. Use physiological and behavioral characteristics to identify user
KEY B
B is correct - Applications enabled to make use of PAM can be plugged-in to new
technologies without modifying the existing applications. This flexibility allows
administrators to do the following:
Select any authentication service on the system for an application
• Use multiple authentication mechanisms for a given service
• Add new authentication service modules without modifying existing applications
338
Protection of Information Assets
339
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
340
Protection of Information Assets
C. Special users
D. Maintenance users
KEY A
A is correct - Privileged user is a user who has been allocated powers within the
computer system, which are significantly greater than those available to the majority of
users. Such persons will include, for example, the system administrator(s) and Network
administrator(s) who are responsible for keeping the system available and may need
powers to create new user profiles as well as add to or amend the powers and access
rights of existing users.
B, C and D are incorrect – There are no such user categories
826. A privileged user can use the user account that has privileged access for only:
A. Normal business use
B. Non privileged activities
C. Privileged activities
D. Logging in to a system
KEY C
C is correct - Privileged Users should be required to create strong passwords
comprising of letters, numbers, and special characters. The user account that has
privileged access should have a unique password that is different from all other
accounts accessed by the User.
A, B and D are incorrect – All Users that have access to privileged accounts should be
assigned their own user ID for normal business use. Privileged Users must use their
personal user IDs for conducting non-privileged activities. Wherever possible the User
must login to a system using their personal user ID prior to invoking a privileged
account.
827. What is a ‘back door’ or ‘trap door’?
A. Flaw that allows data to circumvent the encryption process
B. Bypass which is a means of access for authorised access
C. Flaw that allows an attacker to circumvent security mechanisms
D. Mechanism put in place by an attacker
KEY B
B is correct - A bypass that is purposefully put in place as a means of access for
authorized users is called a back door or a trap door.
341
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A is incorrect - A flaw that allows data to circumvent the encryption process and escape,
unencrypted, as plaintext isa crypto by pass
C and D are incorrect – These are definitions for bypass
828. What are the rows of an access control matrix called?
A. Access Control lists
B. Subjects
C. Objects
D. Capability lists
KEY D
D is correct - the rows are called capability lists.
A, B and C are incorrect – A subject is an active entity that is seeking rights to a
resource or object. A subject can be a person, a program, or a process. An object is a
passive entity, such as a file or a storage resource. The columns of the access matrix
are called Access Control Lists (ACLs)
829. What is the major concern of using group/generic ids?
A. Fixing accountability of actions to individual
B. It needs special approval
C. It is not allowed in ERP packages
D. It is not wise to share user id with others
KEY A
A is correct - The main concern in using group id is the fixing accountability of actions to
individual.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are all the conditions that have to be met in case
group/generic ids are used
830. What is the specialty of a Single Sign On session?
A. User ids and passwords are shared among select users
B. A single user id and password to log on to all required applications
C. Verifies that the users are whoever they claim to be
D. Verifies that the network components used by the users are within their
permission profile
342
Protection of Information Assets
KEY B
B is correct - In SSO, a user provides one ID and password per work session and is
automatically logged on to all the required applications.
A is incorrect - users Ids are created and password is shared among select users when
generic/group id’s are used
C and D are incorrect – These are the features of Kerberos
831. What is the function of Active Directory (AD) domain controller?
A. Accesses and maintains distributed directory information services over an
Internet Protocol network
B. Plays an important role in developing intranet and internet applications by
allowing the sharing of information by users
C. Authenticates and authorises all users and computers in a Windows domain type
network
D. Verifies that users are who they claim to be and the network components they
use are within their profile
KEY C
C is correct - AD is a directory service implemented by Microsoft for Windows domain
networks. It is included in most Windows Server operating systems. An AD domain
controller authenticates and authorizes all users and computers in a Windows domain
type network—assigning and enforcing security policies for all computers and installing
or updating software.
A and B are incorrect - The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is an open,
vendor-neutral, industry standard application protocol for accessing and maintaining
distributed directory information services over an Internet Protocol (IP) network.[1]
Directory services play an important role in developing intranet and Internet applications
by allowing the sharing of information about users, systems, networks, services, and
applications throughout the network.
D is incorrect – This is the primary use of Kerberos - to verify that users are who they
claim to be and the network components they use are contained within their permission
profile.
832. Which authentication mechanism issues ‘tickets’ which have a limited life span
and are stored in the users credential cache?
A. AD
B. LDAP
343
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. Kerberos
D. DNS
KEY C
C is correct - The primary use of Kerberos is to verify that users are who they claim to
be and the network components they use are contained within their permission profile.
To accomplish this, a trusted Kerberos server issues “tickets” to users. These tickets
have a limited life span and are stored in the user’s credential cache.
A, B and D are incorrect – when a user logs into a computer that is part of a Windows
domain, Active Directory checks the submitted password and determines whether the
user is a system administrator or normal user. Active Directory makes use of
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) versions 2 and 3, Microsoft's version of
Kerberos, and DNS.
833. Which of following is an advantage of Single Sign On?
A. Easier administration of changing or deleting passwords
B. It can avoid a potential single point of failure issue
C. Maintaining SSO is easy as it is not prone to human errors
D. It protects network traffic
KEY A
A is correct - The advantages of SSO include having the ability to use stronger
passwords, easier administration of changing or deleting the passwords, and requiring
less time to access resources.
B is incorrect – This is the advantage of Kerberos
C and D are incorrect – These are not advantages of SSO. Maintaining SSO is atedious
process and it is prone to human errors. It does not protect network traffic.
834. In a SSO system, once a user’s identity and authentication is established, on what
basis are access criteria determined?
A. All identified users are granted access
B. Based on Roles, groups or network location
C. All authenticated users are granted access
D. It is not necessary to establish identity or authenticity
KEY B
B is correct - Once a user’s identity and authentication are established, authorization
levels determine the extent of system rights that a user can hold.
344
Protection of Information Assets
345
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
D is correct - The access control mechanism should ensure that subjects gain access to
objects only if they are authorized to.
A B and C are incorrect – Subject of operating systems are (active) entities that
communicate with the system and use its resources. The best example for a subject is
the user or a process. Objects on the other hand are entities of the operating system
that are accessed (requested) by the subject. The access control mechanism should
ensure that subjects gain access to objects only if they are authorized to.
837. This is a multi- level secure access control which defines a hierarchy of levels of
security.
A. Discretionary Access Control
B. Mandatory Access Control
C. Role Based Access Control
D. Database Access Control
KEY B
B is correct - Mandatory Access Control- It is a multi-level secure access control
mechanism. It defines a hierarchy of levels of security. A security policy defines rules by
which the access is controlled.
A is incorrect - In this type of access control, every object has an owner. The owner
(subject) grants access to his resources (objects) for other users and/or groups.
C is incorrect - In role based systems, users get assigned roles based on their functions
in that system.
D is incorrect – This is not a type of access control mechanism
838. Which of the following is a feature of Role Based Access Control?
A. Multilevel secure access control mechanism
B. The Matrix defines the whole state of the system
C. Systems are centrally administered and are nondiscretionary
D. Access control lists are used to store the rights with object
KEY C
C is correct - Role Based Access Control- In some environments, it is problematical to
determine who the owner of resources is. In role based systems, users get assigned
roles based on their functions in that system. These systems are centrally administered,
they are nondiscretionary. An example is a hospital.
346
Protection of Information Assets
347
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
348
Protection of Information Assets
KEY A
A is correct - Automated terminal identification: This will help to ensure that a
particular session could only be initiated from a particular location or computer terminal.
B is incorrect – Terminal log-on procedures: The log-on procedure does not provide
unnecessary help or information, which could be misused by an intruder.
C is incorrect – Password management system: An operating system could enforce
selection of good passwords. Internal storage of password should use one-way
encryption algorithms and the password file should not be accessible to users.
D is incorrect – User identification and authentication: The users must be identified
and authenticated in a fool proof manner. Depending on risk assessment, more
stringent methods like Biometric Authentication or Cryptographic means like Digital
Certificates should be employed.
844. Which of the following is a process by which a user provides a claimed identity to
access a system?
A. User Authorisation
B. User Registration
C. User Identification
D. User logging
KEY C
C is correct - Identification: Identification is a process by which a user provides a
claimed identity to the system such as an account number.
A is incorrect – Authorization: The authenticated user is allowed to perform a pre-
determined set of actions on eligible resources.
B and D are incorrect -These are not par the three step process of Access Control
Mechanism
845. What are the three steps in the process of access control mechanism?
A. Authorisation, information and identification
B. Synchronisation, verification and authentication
C. Identification, authentication and authorisation
D. Synchronisation, identification and authentication
349
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
C is correct - Access control mechanism is actually a three step process – identification,
authentication and authorisation
A, B and D are incorrect – these are not the steps involved in access control
mechanism
846. In _________ authentication techniques, the system authenticates the user and
enables access to resources based on the authorisation matrix.
A. Token or smart card
B. Password
C. Biometric comparison
D. Personal Identification Number (PIN)
KEY B
B is correct – In password authentication technique, once the system is able to locate
the match and is successful for both fields, the system authenticates the user and
enables access to resources based on the authorization matrix
A, C and D are incorrect – These are other types of authentication techniques
847. Which of the following is the weakness of the password logon mechanism?
A. Periodic changing of password
B. Encrypted password
C. Repeated use of the same password
D. One user one password
KEY C
C is correct - Repeated use of the same password makes it vulnerable to attacks
A B and D are incorrect – these are techniques to protect passwords
848. _________________ is defined as automated mechanism, which uses
physiological and behavioral characteristics to determine or verify identities.
A. Biometrics
B. Plastic cards
C. Logon/password systems
D. Smart Cards
350
Protection of Information Assets
KEY A
A is correct - Biometrics as the name suggests is based on certain physical
characteristics or behavioral patterns identified with the individual, which are
measurable. The International Biometric Group defines biometrics as automated
mechanism which uses physiological and behavioral characteristics to determine or
verify identity and further explains that the physiological biometrics are based on
measurements and data derived from direct measurement of a part of the human body.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are other types of authentication techniques
849. What is/are the error(s) caused by biometrics due to the complexity of data?
A. False Rejection Rate (FRR)
B. False Acceptance Rate (FAR)
C. Crossover Error Rate (CER)
D. FRR and FAR
KEY D
D is correct - However due to the complexity of data, biometrics suffer from two types of
error viz. False Rejection Rate (FRR) which is wrongfully rejecting a rightful user and
False Acceptance Rate (FAR) which involves an unauthorized user being wrongfully
authenticated as a right user.
A and B incorrect – False Rejection Rate (FRR) which is wrongfully rejecting a rightful
user and False Acceptance Rate (FAR) which involves an unauthorized user being
wrongfully authenticated as a right user.
C is incorrect - An overall metric used is the Crossover Error Rate (CER) which is the
point at which FRR equals FAR.
850. Facial scan, iris and retina scanning are used in _______________.
A. Biometric security
B. Smart tokens
C. Bio direct security
D. Backup security
KEY A
A is correct - Some of the biometric characteristics which are used are:
• Fingerprint
• Facial Scan
351
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
• Hand Geometry
• Signature
• Voice
• Keystroke Dynamics
• Iris Scanners
• Retina Scanners
B, C and D are incorrect – these are not security measures
851. Which of the following provides system administrators the ability to incorporate
multiple authentication mechanisms into an existing system using pluggable
modules?
A. Personal Authentication Module
B. Password Processing Module
C. Pluggable Authentication Module
D. Login identification Module
KEY C
C is correct - The pluggable authentication module (PAM) framework provides system
administrators with the ability to incorporate multiple authentication mechanisms into an
existing system through the use of pluggable modules. Applications enabled to make
use of PAM can be plugged-in to new technologies without modifying the existing
applications.
A, B and D are incorrect – Thee are not authentication modules
852. Access privileges of a user for two entities, A and B for read and write are
maintained in the _____________ within an application.
A. Actual access control list
B. Access control list
C. Acquired control entry
D. Secret policy entry
KEY B
B is correct - ACL has one or more access control entries (ACEs), each consisting of
the name of a user or a group of users. The user can also be a role name, such as
programmer or tester. For each of these users, groups, or roles, the access privileges
are stated in a string of bits called an access mask.
A, C and D are incorrect
352
Protection of Information Assets
853. The characteristic of network that improves reliability and performance due to
dynamic routings between two end points is better known as:
A. Anonymity
B. Automation
C. Routing diversity
D. Opaqueness
KEY C
C is correct - Routing diversity: To maintain or improve reliability and performance,
routings between two endpoints are usually dynamic. That is, the same interaction may
follow one path through the network the first time and a very different path the second
time. In fact, a query may take a different path from the response that follows a few
seconds later.
A is incorrect - Anonymity: A network removes personal interaction i.e. most of the
clues, such as appearance, voice, or context, by which we recognize acquaintances.
B is incorrect – Automation: In some networks, one or both endpoints, as well as all
intermediate points, involved in a given communication may be machines with only
minimal human supervision.
D is incorrect - Opaqueness: Because the dimension of distance is hidden, users
cannot tell whether a remote host is in the room next door or in a different country. In
the same way, users cannot distinguish whether they are connected to a node in an
office, school, home, or warehouse, or whether the node’s computing system is large or
small, modest or powerful. In fact, users cannot tell if the current communication
involves the same machine with which they communicated the last time.
854. Network establishes communication among disperse users/machines. Which of
the following is a disadvantage of this characteristic of networks?
A. Risks like impersonation, intrusion, tapping
B. Very fast communication speed
C. Physically far end points
D. Humans cannot tell the location of the remote site
KEY A
A is correct - Though networks makes it easier to establish communication among
geographically dispersed users/machines, it also introduces risks like impersonation,
intrusion, tapping.
353
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B, C and D are incorrect – Many networks connect endpoints that are physically far
apart. Although not all network connections involve distance, the speed of
communication is fast enough that humans usually cannot tell whether a remote site is
near or far. These are not disadvantages but advantages of a network
855. What is the program that an attacker uses which reports to him which ports
responds to messages and the vulnerabilities present in each port?
A. Social Engineering
B. Dumpster diving
C. Port Scan
D. Malware
KEY C
C is correct - Port Scan: An easy way to gather network information is to use a port
scanner, a program that, for a particular IP address, reports which ports respond to
messages and which of several known vulnerabilities seem to be present.
A, B and D are incorrect – These are other methods used by an attacker
856. What does Social Engineering involve?
A. Gathering bits of on formation from various sources
B. Using social skills to persuade a victim
C. Looking through items that have been discarded
D. Eavesdropping
KEY B
B is correct - Social engineering involves using social skills and personal interaction to
get someone to reveal security-relevant information and perhaps even to do something
that permits an attack.
A, C and D are incorrect – These methods of gathering information are classified under
Reconnaissance
857. ‘Dumpster Diving’ is a commonly used ________________ technique.
A. Reconnaissance
B. Social Engineering
C. Documentation
D. Application fingerprint
354
Protection of Information Assets
KEY A
A is correct - One commonly used reconnaissance technique is “dumpster diving.” It
involves looking through items that have been discarded in garbage bins or waste paper
baskets.
B, C and D are incorrect – Dumpster diving does not fall under any of these attacking
techniques
858. The process by which an attacker comes to know about the commercial server on
which an application is running, the version and operating system for the same is
known as:
A. Biometrics
B. Protocol flaws
C. Wiretapping
D. OS and Application Fingerprinting
KEY D
D is correct - Operating System and Application Fingerprinting: Here the attacker
wants to know which commercial server application is running, what version, and what
the underlying operating system and version are.
A is incorrect – This is a method of identification of system user
B is incorrect – There are flaws in many of the commonly used protocols called protocol
flaws. These flaws can be exploited by an attacker.
C is incorrect – Wiretapping is the technique intercepting communications through some
effort.
859. How does an attacker use Malware to gather information?
A. Investigate a product that can be the target of an attack
B. Search for additional information on systems, applications or sites
C. Scavenge the system and receive information over network
D. Post latest exploits and techniques
KEY C
C is correct - Malware: Attacker may use malware like virus or worms to scavenge the
system and keep sending information to attacker over network without the knowledge of
system user.
A is incorrect – Resource kits distributed by application vendors to other developers can
also give attackers tools to use in investigating a product that can subsequently be the
355
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
target of an attack. Here, the vendors themselves distribute information that is useful to
an attacker.
B and D are incorrect – Bulletin Boards and Chats: Underground bulletin boards and
chat rooms support exchange of information among the hackers. Attackers can post
their latest exploits and techniques, read what others have done, and search for
additional information on systems, applications, or sites.
860. The process by which an attacker picks off the content of a communication
passing in an unencrypted form is known as:
A. Eavesdropping
B. Wiretapping
C. Microwave signal tapping
D. Satellite signal interception
KEY A
A is correct - An attacker can pick off the content of a communication passing in
unencrypted form. The term eavesdrop implies overhearing without expending any extra
effort. For example, an attacker (or a system administrator) is eavesdropping by
monitoring all traffic passing through a node.
B is incorrect – wiretapping means intercepting communications through some effort.
C is incorrect – Microwave signal tapping is a process by which an attacker can
intercept a microwave transmission by interfering with the line of sight between sender
and receiver.
D is incorrect – The process of intercepting satellite communication
861. What is active wiretapping?
A. Listening to communications intentionally
B. Overhearing without extra effort
C. Injecting something into the communication stream
D. Placing an illegitimate antenna to intercept communication
KEY C
C is correct - Active wiretapping means injecting something into the communication
stream.
A and B are incorrect – These methods are classified under passive wiretapping or
eavesdropping
D is incorrect – This method is microwave signal tapping
356
Protection of Information Assets
862. The costs of intercepting satellite communications are very high because:
A. All traffics passing through a node have to be monitored
B. Neither the sender nor receiver should know that contents have been intercepted
C. Satellite communications are heavily multiplexed
D. Cost of placing an illegitimate antenna is more
KEY C
C is correct - In satellite communication, the potential for interception is even greater
than with microwave signals. However, because satellite communications are heavily
multiplexed, the cost of extracting a single communication is rather high.
A B and D are incorrect – These are not reasons for the high cost of satellite
communication interception
863. A wireless signal can be picked up easily within 60 meters. Why?
A. The signal is strong up to 60 meters
B. The signal is weak up to 60 meters
C. There is no signal up to 60 meters
D. The signal is strong after 60 meters
KEY A
A is correct - A wireless signal is strong for approximately 30 to 60 meters. A strong
signal can be picked up easily.
B, C and D are incorrect – for the same reason as mentioned above
864. It is not possible to tap an optical system without detection. Why?
A. Optical fiber carries electricity but does not emanate a magnetic field
B. Optical fiber carries light energy which does not emanate a magnetic field
C. An optical signal is not very strong and hence cannot be picked up
D. An antenna needs to be placed to intercept which is detectible
KEY B
B is correct - It is not possible to tap an optical system without detection. Further optical
fiber carries light energy, not electricity, which does not emanate a magnetic field as
electricity docs.
A ,C and D are incorrect – for the same reasons as mentioned above.
357
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
865. A term used for a virtual network of zombies used to launch attack on a system
is:
A. BOTnets
B. Spam
C. Malware
D. Spoofing
KEY A
A is correct - BOTnets is a term (robotic network) used for virtual network of zombies.
BOTnet operator launches malware/virus on system that once activated remains on
system and can be activated remotely. This malware helps the BOTnet operator use the
compromised system (Zombie) remotely with to launch attack or collect information. For
example Zombies have been used extensively to send e-mail spam. This allows
spammers to avoid detection and presumably reduces their bandwidth costs, since the
owners of zombies pay for their own bandwidth.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are other methods of attack
866. An employee who is on leave reveals his authentication details to another in order
to allow access to carry out urgent activities in his absence. It so happens that
these details are passed on without encryption. How is the employee making his
authentication information vulnerable to an impersonator?
A. The impersonator can guess the identity by using common passwords
B. The impersonator can exploit flaws and weaknesses of the operating system
C. The attacker can circumvent or disable the authentication mechanism
D. These details can be rescued by an impersonator by eavesdropping or
wiretapping
KEY D
D is correct - Authentication foiled by eavesdropping or wiretapping: When the
account and authentication details are passed on the network without encryption, they
are exposed to anyone observing the communication on the network. These
authentication details can be reused by an impersonator until they are changed.
A is incorrect - Authentication foiled by guessing: Guess the identity and
authentication details of the target, by using common passwords, the words in a
dictionary, variations of the user name, default passwords, etc.
B is incorrect - Authentication Foiled by Avoidance: A flawed operating system may
be such that the buffer for typed characters in a password is of fixed size, counting all
characters typed, including backspaces for correction. If a user types more characters
than the buffer would hold, the overflow causes the operating system to by-pass
358
Protection of Information Assets
password comparison and act as if a correct authentication has been supplied. Such
flaws or weaknesses can be exploited by anyone seeking unauthorized access.
C is incorrect – Non-existent Authentication: Here the attacker circumvents or
disables the authentication mechanism at the target computer. If two computers trusts
each other’s authentication an attacker may obtain access to one system through an
authentication weakness (such as a guest password) and then transfer to another
system that accepts the authenticity of a user who comes from a system on its trusted
list. The attacker may also use a system that has some identities requiring no
authentication. For example, some systems have “guest” or “anonymous” accounts to
allow outsiders to access things the systems want to release to the public. These
accounts allow access to unauthenticated users.
867. An organisation purchases 10 new systems which are installed by the seller using
a test account without any password. However, authentications are put in place
and users access information after proper authentication. But the test account
has not been deleted. How can an impersonator foil authentication in this case?
A. Information can be accessed through session hijacking
B. Information can be hijacked by intruding between two authenticated users
C. Information becomes vulnerable through well- known test password
D. Information can be accessed through spoofing or masquerading
KEY C
C is correct - Well-Known Authentication: Most vendors often sell computers with one
system administration account installed, having a default password. Or the systems
come with a demonstration or test account, with no required password. Some
administrators fail to change the passwords or delete these accounts, creating
vulnerability.
A is incorrect - Session Hijacking: Session hijacking is intercepting and carrying on a
session begun by another entity. In this case the attacker intercepts the session of one
of the two entities that have entered into a session and carry it over in the name of that
entity. For example, in an e-commerce transaction, just before a user places his order
and gives his address, credit number etc. the session could be hijacked by an attacker.
B is incorrect – Man-in-the-Middle Attack: A man-in-the-middle attack is a similar to
session hijacking, in which one entity intrudes between two others. The difference
between man-in-the-middle and hijacking is that a man-in-the-middle usually
participates from the start of the session, whereas a session hijacking occurs after a
session has been established. The difference is largely semantic and not particularly
significant.
D is incorrect - Spoofing attacks: In this technique, the attacker plants a Trojan
program, which masquerades as the system’s logon screen, gets the logon and
359
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
password information and returns control to the genuine access control mechanism.
Once the information is obtained, the attacker uses the information to gain access to
the system resources.
868. Not only is the message itself sensitive but the fact that a message exists is also
sensitive. How can an attacker infer that sensitive messages exist between two
confidential parties?
A. Traffic flow analysis
B. Using exposures as part of attack
C. By modifying a destination address
D. Taking advantage of mis-delivery due to congestion at network elements
KEY A
A is correct - Traffic Analysis (or Traffic Flow Analysis): Sometimes not only is the
message itself sensitive but the fact that a message exists is also sensitive. For
example, if a wartime enemy sees a large amount of network traffic between
headquarters and a particular unit, the enemy may be able to infer that significant action
is being planned involving that unit. In a commercial setting, messages sent from the
president of one company to the president of a competitor could lead to speculation
about a takeover or conspiracy to fix prices.
B is incorrect - Exposure: The content of a message may be exposed in temporary
buffers, at switches, routers, gateways, and intermediate hosts throughout the network;
and in the workspaces of processes that build, format, and present the message. A
malicious attacker can use any of these exposures as part of a general or focused
attack on message confidentiality.
C and D are incorrect – Mis-delivery: Message mis-delivery happens mainly due to
congestion at network elements which causes buffers to overflow and packets dropped.
Sometimes messages are mis-delivered because of some flaw in the network hardware
or software. Most frequently, messages are lost entirely, which is an integrity or
availability issue. Occasionally, however, a destination address will be modified or some
router or protocol will malfunction, causing a message to be delivered to someone other
than the intended recipient. All of these “random” events are quite uncommon. More
frequent than network flaws are human errors, caused by mistyping an address.
869. Which of the following amounts to compromising the integrity of messages?
A. Mistyping an address so that it reaches the wrong recipient
B. Mis-delivery of messages due to some flaw in the network hardware or software
360
Protection of Information Assets
361
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - Ping of death: It is possible to crash, reboot or otherwise kill a large
number of systems by sending a ping of a certain size from a remote machine. This is a
serious problem, mainly because this can be reproduced very easily, and from a remote
machine. Ping is an ICMP protocol which requests a destination to return a reply,
intended to show that the destination system is reachable and functioning. Since ping
requires the recipient to respond to the ping request, all the attacker needs to do is
send a flood of pings to the intended victim.
A is incorrect – Connection Flooding: This is the oldest type of attack where an
attacker sends more data than what a communication system can handle, thereby
preventing the system from receiving any other legitimate data. Even if an occasional
legitimate packet reaches the system, communication will be seriously degraded.
C is incorrect - Traffic Redirection: A router is a device that forwards traffic on its way
through intermediate networks between a source host’s network and a destination’s. So
if an attacker can corrupt the routing, traffic can disappear.
D is incorrect - DNS Attacks: DNS attacks are actually a class of attacks based on the
concept of domain name server. A domain name server (DNS) is a table that converts
domain names like www.icai.org into network addresses like 202.54.74.130, a process
called resolving the domain name or name resolution. By corrupting a name server or
causing it to cache spurious entries, an attacker can redirect the routing of any traffic, or
ensure that packets intended for a particular host never reach their destination.
872. What are the multiple machines that are used by an attacker for DdS attacks
called?
A. Cookies
B. Routers
C. Zombies
D. FTP
KEY C
C is correct - In distributed denial of service (DDoS) attack more than one machine are
used by the attacker to attack the target. These multiple machines are called zombies
that act on the direction of the attacker and they don’t belong to the attacker.
A is incorrect - Cookies are data files created by the server that can be stored on the
client machine and fetched by a remote server usually containing information about the
user on the client machine. Anyone intercepting or retrieving a cookie can impersonate
the cookie’s legitimate owner.
362
Protection of Information Assets
363
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
A is incorrect - Master Boot Record (MBR) Viruses: Affects the boot sector of storage
device and further infects when the storage is accessed.
B is incorrect – Stealth viruses hide themselves by tampering the operating system to
fool antivirus software into thinking that everything is functioning normally.
C is correct - Polymorphic Viruses: Polymorphic viruses are difficult to detect because
they can modify themselves and change their identity thus able to hide themselves from
antivirus software
D is incorrect – Macro Viruses: Macro viruses are the most prevalent computer viruses
and can easily infect many types of applications, such as Microsoft Excel and Word.
875. What is a Trojan Horse?
A. Virus that affects the boot sector of storage device
B. Virus that affects applications like Microsoft Word and Excel
C. Stand- alone viruses that are transmitted independently
D. Malicious codes hidden under a legitimate program
KEY D
A is incorrect - MBR virus
B is incorrect – Macro viruses
C is incorrect – Worms
D is correct.
876. Malicious codes added to an existing application to be executed at a later date is
known as:
A. Logic bomb
B. Trojan Horse
C. Polymorphic virus
D. Stealth virus
KEY A
A is correct - Logic bombs are malicious code added to an existing application to be
executed at a later date. These can be intentional or unintentional. For example
Year2000 problem was an unintentional logic bomb. Every time the infected application
is run, the logic bomb checks the date to see whether it is time to run the bomb. If not,
control is passed back to the main application and the logic bomb waits. If the date
364
Protection of Information Assets
condition is correct, the rest of the logic bomb’s code is executed and the result can be
anything from a harmless message to a system crash.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are different types of viruses.
877. What is the method used by most of the antivirus software to identify virus
infections in a system?
A. Monitoring traffic
B. Signature detection
C. Repair or quarantine
D. Scan processes
KEY B
A, C and D are incorrect - these are the types of controls of antivirus tools
B is correct - Most of the antivirus software utilizes a method known as signature
detection to identify potential virus infections on a system. Essentially, they maintain an
extremely large database that contains the known characteristics (signatures) of all
viruses. Depending upon the antivirus package and configuration settings, it can scan
storage media periodically, check for any files that contain data matching those criteria.
878. When do injection flaws occur?
A. When untrusted data is sent to an interpreter as part of a command or query
B. When application functions related to authentication and session management
are not implemented correctly
C. When an application takes untrusted data and sends it to a web browser without
proper validation
D. When a developer exposes a reference to an internal implementation object
KEY A
A is correct - Injection (SQL Injection): Injection flaws, such as SQL, OS, and LDAP
injection occur when untrusted data is sent to an interpreter as part of a command or
query. The attacker’s hostile data can trick the interpreter into executing unintended
commands or accessing data without proper authorization.
B is incorrect - Broken Authentication and Session Management: Application
functions related to authentication and session management are often not implemented
correctly, allowing attackers to compromise passwords, keys, or session tokens, or to
exploit other implementation flaws to assume other users’ identities.
365
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
366
Protection of Information Assets
880. In case of advanced persistent threat why is an antivirus unable to detect the
malware?
A. The attack is on an identified subject
B. Social engineering methods are used
C. Malware is specifically written for this purpose
D. The attack continues for a longer duration
KEY C
C is correct - In case of Advanced Persistent threat, since the malware is specifically
written for this purpose, it cannot be detected by an antivirus
A, B and D are incorrect – These are the other characteristics of advanced persistent
threat
881. In order to limit the amount of damage a single vulnerability can allow, it is
important to:
A. All servers reside on a single segment
B. There should be different segments for different servers
C. Having a single web server
D. Eliminating single points of failure
KEY B
B is correct - Segmentation / Zoning: Segmentation / Zoning can limit the potential for
harm in a network in two important ways. Segmentation reduces the number of threats,
and it limits the amount of damage a single vulnerability can allow. A web server,
authentication server, applications and database are residing on a single server or
segment for facilitating electronic commerce transactions are a very insecure
configuration. A more secure design will use multiple segments. Since the web server
has to be exposed to the public, that server should not have other more sensitive,
functions on it or residing on the same segment such as user authentication or access
to the database. Separate segments and servers reduce the potential harm should any
subsystem be compromised.
A is incorrect – for the same reason as mentioned above
C is incorrect – This is a redundancy vulnerability
D is incorrect – This does not relate to segmentation
882. Where does encryption occur when data is encrypted in link encryption?
A. Data link layer of the receiving host
367
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Network layer
C. Data link layer in the OSI model
D. In transit between two computers
KEY C
C is correct - In link encryption, data are encrypted just before the system places them
on the physical communications link, that is, encryption occurs at the Data Link layer in
the OSI model.
A, B and D are incorrect – decryption occurs at the Data Link layer of the receiving host.
Link encryption protects the message in transit between two computers, but the
message is in plaintext inside the hosts (above the data link layer). Headers added by
the network layer (which includes addresses, routing information and protocol) and
above are encrypted, along with the message/data. The message is, however, exposed
at the Network layer and thus all intermediate nodes through which the message
passes can read the message. This is because all routing and addressing is done at the
Network layer. Link encryption is invisible to user and appropriate when the
transmission line is the point of greatest vulnerability. Link encryption provides
protection against traffic analysis.
368
Module 5
Systems Development-Acquisition,
Maintenance and Implementation
370
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
• Verify that system can identify erroneous data correctly and can handle invalid
transactions.
• Review conceptual design to ensure the existence of appropriate controls.
• Review quality assurance and quality control results of programs are developed.
• Verify the design for its completeness and correctness and it meets the defined
requirements.
• Verify that functional data created during requirement phase is complete and test
plans are developed.
A is incorrect – This is the role of an IS Auditor in the feasibility phase
C and D are incorrect – These are the roles of an IS Auditor in the development phase
886. What are the characteristics of a very well coded application program?
A. Good coding standards, Accuracy and Speed
B. Reliability, Robustness, Accuracy, Efficiency, Usability, Readability
C. Flexibility, Speed, Coding Standards
D. Reliability, Flexibility and Speed
KEY B
B is correct - A very well coded application program should have the following
characteristics:
• Reliability: It refers to the consistency with which a program operates over a
period of time. However, poor setting of parameters and hard coding of some
data subsequently could result in the failure of a program after some time.
• Robustness: It refers to the applications’ strength to perform operations in
adverse situations by taking into account all possible inputs and outputs of a
program considering even the least likely situations.
• Accuracy: It refers not only to ‘what program is supposed to do’, but also the
ability to take care of ‘what it should not do’. The second part is of great interest
for quality control personnel and auditors.
• Efficiency: It refers to the performance per unit cost with respect to relevant
parameters and it should not be unduly affected with the increase in input values.
• Usability: It refers to a user-friendly interface and easy-to-understand
internal/external documentation.
• Readability: It refers to the ease of maintenance of program even in the absence
of the program developer.
371
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A, C and D are incorrect – These are not the major characteristics of a well coded
application program
887. What is the role of an IS Auditor in the testing phase of SDLC?
A. Review the test plan for completeness and correctness
B. Ensure test plans, test data nd test results are maintained for reference
C. Verify that the system has been installed according to the organisation’s change
control procedures.
D. Review programmed procedure used for scheduling and running the system
along with the system parameters are used in executing the production schedule.
KEY A
A is correct - Role of IS Auditor in testing phase:
• Review the test plan for completeness and correctness.
• Review whether relevant users have participated during testing phase.
• Review error reports for their precision in recognizing erroneous data and for
resolution of errors.
• Verify cyclical processes for correctness( example: year-end process, quarter-
end process)
• Interview end-users of the system for their understanding of new methods,
procedures and operating instructions.
• Review the system and end-user documentation to determine its completeness
and correctness.
• Review whether reconciliation of control totals and converted data has been
performed to verify the integrity of the data after conversion.
• Review all parallel testing results.
• Test the system randomly for correctness.
• Review unit test plans and system test plans to determine that tests for internal
control are addressed.
• Verify that the system security is functioning as designed by developing and
executing access tests.
• Ensure test plans and rest results are maintained for reference and audit
B, C and D are incorrect – These are the roles of an IS Auditor in the UAT or final
testing phase
372
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
888. What are the security steps involved in the development phase of SDLC?
A. To identify possible attacks and design controls
B. To train developers on security coding practices.
C. To ensure security requirements are tested during testing.
D. To perform security scan of application after implementation.
KEY B
B is correct - Security steps involved during the development phase are:
To develop and implement security coding practices such as input data validation and
avoiding complex coding.
To train developers on security coding practices.
A, C and D are incorrect – These are security steps involved during the design, testing
and implementation phases.
889. Which of the following is a mitigation plan for risk associated with compromising
on quality and testing?
A. Understand organisation baseline for infrastructure and incorporate in design.
B. Ensure standard coding practices are adopted.
C. Ensure completion of documentation along with design and development.
D. Ensure documentation experts and technical writers are part of team.
KEY B
B is correct - The following are the mitigation plans for risk associated with
compromising on quality and testing:
Ensure standard coding practices are adopted.
Provide enough time for building test cases to cover all function, performance and
security requirements.
Build test cases along with design.
A is incorrect – This is a mitigation plan associated with the risk of inappropriate
selection of platform
C and D are incorrect – These are mitigation plans for risk associated with missing or
inadequate documentation
890. What is the mitigation plan for risk associated with absence of skilled resources?
A. Consider outsourcing or hiring skilled resources on contract.
373
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
374
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
KEY B
B is correct - Programmers convert design into programs by coding using programming
language. They are also referred to as coders or developers
A is incorrect - This is the role of a steering committee
C is incorrect – this is the role of the quality assurance team
D are incorrect – This is the role of testers
893. The technical feasibility study for automating a business process using
information technology includes which of the following?
A. Is the cost of hardware and software for the class of applications being
considered.
B. Are the benefits derived from new application such as improved efficiency,
reduced costs, business growth, and customer and user satisfaction.
C. Is the cost of conducting a full systems development/acquisition, implementation
and operation.
D. Is system scalable and can it handle the expected business and data growth?
KEY D
D is correct - The technical feasibility includes evaluation of the following factors:
• Can the solution work on existing infrastructure or does organisation need to
acquire new hardware or software? If currently the organisation is not using an
automated solution, they may have to invest in acquiring technology and solution.
• Will the proposed system provide adequate responses to inquiries, regardless of
the number or location of users? Currently there are many organisations that
have deployed such solutions and hence we can conclude that the technical
solutions can be made available to meet the response requirements.
• Is system scalable and can it handle the expected business and data growth?
There are multiple training courses and those can be deployed using scalable
infrastructure.
• Does the technology offer adequate security? Those requirements need to be
considered while developing or acquiring solution. However since many
organisations have already implemented similar solution, the required security
can be embedded.
A, B, C are incorrect – These factors are evaluated by the study of economic feasibility.
375
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
894. The business case is a KEY element of the decision making process throughout
the life cycle of project. What information does a business case provide to an
organisation?
A. decide whether the SDLC project should be undertaken
B. Explore solutions and make a recommendation
C. Develop a new application system
D. Outline and calculate of benefits
KEY A
A is correct - A business case is normally derived from the benefit realization plan and
feasibility study. A business case provides the information required for an organisation
to decide whether the SDLC project should be undertaken and if approved, becomes
the basis for a project execution and assessment.
B is incorrect – this is the objective of a feasibility study
C and D are incorrect – these are also the objectives of a feasibility study
895. What does study of history, structure and culture of information involve?
A. Identifying stakeholder expectations
B. Types of useful systems, issues that have not been addressed and require
attention
C. Identifying how the system needs to interact with its environment
D. Study of business processes, underlying activities, and actors that perform these
activities
KEY B
B is correct - The study of the history of systems in an organisation gives an idea about
the types of systems that have been extremely useful, issues that have not been
addressed over a period and new issues that require attention. It is essential to
understand organisational structure and culture as the solutions that are not consistent
with the culture often fail.
A and C are incorrect – These are the activities that come under understanding
requirements
D is incorrect – These is an activity associated with the study of information flows
896. t is important to record requirements after they have been analysed. Under which
phase of requirement Engineering does this fall?
A. Elicitation
376
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
377
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
D is correct - Project closing has processes for handing over deliverables or
terminating project.
A is incorrect – Project planning consists of processes related to developing project
execution plan, finalizing requirements, defining work breakdown structure and modules
to be developed, estimating efforts and cost, resource planning, risk management,
procurement planning and plan for communications with stakeholders.
B is incorrect - Project execution consists of processes related to direct project teams,
ensuring quality assurance and testing, managing requirements and changes in
requirements, ensuring timely procurements and manage resources.
C is incorrect - Project controlling and monitoring consists of processes related to
monitoring risks, scope creeps, quality of deliverables, costs and budgets, performance
reporting.
898. What does Work Breakdown Structure (WBS) represent?
A. The project in terms of manageable and controllable units of work
B. Detailed specifications with objectives
C. Assigned responsibilities and deadlines
D. Work documents containing the start and finish dates
KEY A
A is correct - A commonly accepted approach to define project objectives is to start with
a work breakdown structure (WBS) with each work module having its own objectives
derived from main objectives. The WBS represents the project in terms of manageable
and controllable units of work and forms the baseline for cost and resource planning.
B, C and D are incorrect – Detailed specifications regarding the WBS can be used to
develop work packages (WP). Each WP must have a distinct owner and a list of main
objectives, and may have a list of additional objectives. The WP specifications should
include dependencies on other WPs and a definition of how to evaluate performance
and goal achievement. A task list is a list of actions to be carried to complete each work
package and includes assigned responsibilities and deadlines. The task list aids the
individual project team members in operational planning and scheduling, that when
merged together forms a project schedule. Project schedules are work documents
containing the start and finish dates, percentage completed, task dependencies, and
resource names of individuals planned to work on tasks.
378
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
899. Half way through a project development, on which phase should an IS auditor
focus in order to ensure that there is no deviation from the primary objectives of
the projects?
A. Project Planning
B. Project Controlling
C. Resource Management
D. Risk Management
KEY B
B is correct - During mid-term project review IS auditor should focus on project planning
and controlling activities to ensure that these are not deviating from primary objectives
of the project.
A is incorrect –
A and C are incorrect – These phases do not require much review during this stage.
D is incorrect – Focus on risk management process provides detailed insight on the
effectiveness of the project management
900. What is the tool used to verify that deployed resources are capable of finishing a
task within the set time limit and with the expected quality level?
A. Earned value analysis
B. Work Breakdown structure
C. Work Package
D. Qualitative Analysis of Risks
KEY A
A is correct - Earned Value Analysis consists of comparing expected budget till date,
actual cost, estimated completion date and actual completion at regular intervals during
the project.
B and C are incorrect – A commonly accepted approach to define project objectives is
to start with a work breakdown structure (WBS) with each work module having its own
objectives derived from main objectives. The WBS represents the project in terms of
manageable and controllable units of work and forms the baseline for cost and resource
planning. Detailed specifications regarding the WBS can be used to develop work
packages (WP). Each WP must have a distinct owner and a list of main objectives, and
may have a list of additional objectives. The WP specifications should include
dependencies on other WPs and a definition of how to evaluate performance and goal
achievement. A task list is a list of actions to be carried to complete each work package
379
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
and includes assigned responsibilities and deadlines. The task list aids the individual
project team members in operational planning and scheduling, that when merged
together forms a project schedule. Project schedules are work documents containing
the start and finish dates, percentage completed, task dependencies, and resource
names of individuals planned to work on tasks.
D is incorrect – Qualitative Analysis of Risks is a part of project planning.
901. During risk management process, how is risk assessed and evaluated?
A. Creating an inventory of possible risk
B. Quantify the likelihood and impact of risk
C. Create a risk management plan
D. Discover risk that materializes
KEY B
B is correct - Assess and evaluate risk: Quantify the likelihood (expressed as a
percentage) and the impact of the risk (expressed as an amount of money). The
“insurance policy” (total impact) that needs to be in the project budget is calculated as
the likelihood multiplied by the impact.
A is incorrect – This step is to identify the risk\
C is incorrect – This is a part of managing the risk after it has been assessed
D is incorrect – This forms a part of monitoring the risk process
902. Which of the following is the feature of a waterfall model?
A. The designers create an initial base model and give little or no consideration to
internal controls, but instead emphasize system characteristics such as
simplicity, flexibility, and ease of use.
B. Project is divided into sequential phases, with some overlap and splash back
acceptable between phases.
C. This is an iterative model where each iteration helps in optimizing the intended
solution.
D. This model of development helps to ease the traumatic effect of introducing
completely new system all at once
KEY B
B is correct - The characterizing features of the waterfall model have influenced the
development community in big way. Some of the KEY characteristics are:
• Project is divided into sequential phases, with some overlap and splash back
acceptable between phases.
380
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
381
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - Strengths of Prototyping Model:
• It improves both user participation in system development and communication
among project stakeholders.
• It is especially useful for resolving unclear objectives and requirements;
developing and validating user requirements; experimenting with or comparing
various design solutions, or investigating both performance and the human
computer interface.
• Potential exists for exploiting knowledge gained in an early iteration as later
iterations are developed.
• It helps to easily identify, confusing or difficult functions and missing functionality.
• It enables to generate specifications for a production application.
• It encourages innovation and flexible designs.
• It provides for quick implementation of an incomplete, but functional, application.
• It typically results in a better definition of these users’ needs and requirements
than does the traditional systems development approach.
• A very short time period is normally required to develop and start experimenting
with a prototype. This short time period allows system users to immediately
evaluate proposed system changes.
• Since system users experiment with each version of the prototype through an
interactive process, errors are hopefully detected and eliminated early in the
developmental process. As a result, the information system ultimately
implemented should be more reliable and less costly to develop than when the
traditional systems development approach is employed.
A, C and D are incorrect – this is not strength of any of these models
905. Which of the following is a weakness of the spiral model?
A. It is criticized to be Inflexible, slow, costly, and cumbersome due to significant
structure and tight controls.
B. Approval process and control are not formal.
C. Sometimes there are no firm deadlines, cycles continue till requirements are
clearly identified.
D. Problems may arise pertaining to system architecture because not all
requirements are gathered up front for the entire software life cycle.
382
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
KEY C
C is correct – Weaknesses of the spiral model are:
• It is challenging to determine the exact composition of development
methodologies to use for each of the iterations around the Spiral.
• A skilled and experienced project manager is required to determine how to apply
it to any given project.
• Sometimes there are no firm deadlines, cycles continue till requirements are
clearly identified. Hence has an inherent risk of not meeting budget or schedule.
A, B and D are incorrect – These are the weaknesses of the waterfall model, prototype
model and incremental model respectively
906. Which of the following is a KEY feature of Rapid Application Development?
A. fast development and delivery of a high quality system at a relatively low
investment cost,
B. Use of small, time-boxed subprojects or iterations where each iteration forms
basis for planning next iteration.
C. Customer satisfaction by rapid delivery of useful software;
D. Welcome changing requirements, even late in development;
KEY A
A is correct - The KEY features of RAD are:
• KEY objective is fast development and delivery of a high quality system at a
relatively low investment cost,
• Attempts to reduce inherent project risk by breaking a project into smaller
segments and providing more ease-of-change during the development process.
• Aims to produce high quality systems quickly, primarily through the use of
iterative Prototyping (at any stage of development), active user involvement, and
computerized development tools like Graphical User Interface (GUI) builders,
Computer Aided Software Engineering (CASE) tools, Database Management
Systems (DBMS), Fourth generation programming languages, Code generators
and object-oriented techniques.
• KEY emphasis is on fulfilling the business need while technological or
engineering excellence is of lesser importance.
• Project control involves prioritizing development and defining delivery deadlines
or “time boxes.” If the project starts to slip, emphasis is on reducing requirements
to fit the time box, not in increasing the deadline.
• Generally includes Joint Application Development (JAD), where users are
383
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
384
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
C. Agile processes
D. Rapid Application Development
KEY B
B is correct - Reverse engineering is the process of studying and analyzing an
application, a software application or a product to see how it functions and to use that
information to develop a similar system.
A, C and D are incorrect – This is not part of any of these processes
909. How is a product for which software is available and can be implemented without
customisation classified as?
A. Generic products without customisation
B. Commercial product with customisation
C. Outsourced development
D. Commercial product without customisation
KEY A
A is correct - Generic products without customization: Software is available and can
be implemented without customization. These products are also known as Plug-and-
play or COTS (Commercial of the shelf) for example MS Office, MS projects etc.
B is incorrect – Commercial product with customization: Software needs to be
customized like ERP or core banking products or at lower level customization like Tally.
C is incorrect – Outsourced development: Ready-made software as required is not
available. Hence, the organisation intends to outsource development activities based on
cost benefit analysis.
D is incorrect – There is no such classification
910. In achieving the objectives of requirement analysis, the process of understanding
the present system and its related problems comes under which of the following
steps?
A. Fact finding
B. Analysis
C. Requirements of proposed systems
D. Identifying rationale and objectives
385
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - Analysis to understand Present process: Understanding present
system and its related problems helps in confirming the requirements from new
application/software.
A is incorrect – Fact Finding: Application system focuses on two main types of
requirements. The first one is service delivery and second one is operational
requirements. These may include lower operational costs, better information for
managers, smooth operations for users or better levels of services to customers. To
assess these needs, the analysts often interact extensively with stakeholders, to
determine ‘detail requirements’. The fact-finding techniques/tools used by the system
analyst include document verification, interviews, questionnaire and observation.
C is incorrect - Requirements for Proposed Systems: Analysis of functional area and
process, the proposed expectations can be clearly defined considering the issues and
objectives.
D is incorrect – Analysis also include identifying rationale and objectives, inputs and
data sources, decision points, desired outcomes from application, mandatory and
discretionary controls.
911. The process of allotting weight-age for each requirement and then allotting score
to the software that meets that requirement is called as:
A. Point scoring Analysis
B. Agenda based presentations
C. Public evaluation reports
D. Benchmarking solutions
KEY A
A is correct - Point-Scoring Analysis (Functional gap analysis): Point-scoring
analysis provides an objective means of selecting software. This is performed by
allotting weight-age for each requirement and then allotting score to the software that
meets that requirement.
B is incorrect - The agenda-based presentations are scripted business scenarios that
are designed to show how the software will perform certain critical business functions.
Vendors are typically invited to demonstrate their product and follow the sample
business scenarios given to them to prepare.
C is incorrect – Public Evaluation Reports: Organisation may refer to independent
agencies that evaluate various software products of different vendors and publish
comparison along with rating based on various predefined parameters including survey
386
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
of current users. (For example, magic quadrant for similar software product by Gartner,
Forester etc.). This method has been frequently and usefully employed by several
buyers in the past.
D is incorrect – Proof of Concept (PoC) or Benchmarking Solutions: Organisations
may request vendor to provide a proof of concept (by implementing product in small
pilot area within organisation) that the software meets the expected requirements. This
helps organisation in evaluating best product that meets the requirements. This is
particularly useful for products that has high-cost and requires high level of efforts that it
may not be possible to roll back.
912. While preparing the request for proposal, what should an organisation do to
ensure vendor viability and financial stability?
A. Compare product functionalities against requirements
B. Validate vendor claims about their product performance
C. Get feedback from existing customers of the vendor on supporting documents of
the vendor
D. Evaluate what king of support the vendor provides
KEY C
C is correct - Evaluate the vendor's viability with reference to period for which the
vendor is in operation, the period for which the desired product is being used by the
existing customers and the Vendor's financial stability on the basis of the market survey
and the certification from the customers and on certain supporting documentation from
the Vendor
A is incorrect – This is part of software and system requirements
B is incorrect – This is part of customer references
D is incorrect – This is part of vendor support
913. Out of the tests performed on a program unit, what does a performance test
check?
A. whether programs do, what they are supposed to do or not
B. verify the expected performance criteria of program
C. determines the stability of a given system or entity
D. examines the internal processing logic of a software system
387
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
B is correct - Performance tests are designed to verify the expected performance
criteria of program.
A, C and D are incorrect – These are the functions of a function test, stress test and
structural test respectively
914. Which of the following is a feature of top down integration?
A. The testing will start from opening login screen and then login, then selecting
function one by one
B. It is the traditional strategy used to integrate the components of a software
system starting from smallest module/function/program.
C. It consists of unit testing, followed by sub-system testing.
D. Bottom-up testing is easy to implement as at the time of module testing, tested
subordinate modules are available.
KEY A
A is correct - Top-down Integration: This starts with the main routine followed by the
stubs being substituted for the modules which are directly subordinate to the main
module. Considering above example, the testing will start from opening login screen
and then login, then selecting function one by one. An incomplete portion of a program
code is put under a function (called stub) to allow the function. Here a stub is
considered as black box and assumed to perform as expected, which is tested
subsequently. Once the main module testing is complete, stubs are substituted with real
modules one by one, and these modules are tested. This process continues till the
atomic (smallest) modules are reached. Since decision-making processes are likely to
occur in the higher levels of program hierarchy, the top-down strategy emphasizes on
major control decision points encountered in the earlier stages of a process and detects
any error in these processes. The difficulty arises in the top-down method, because the
high-level modules are tested with stubs and not with actual modules.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are the features of bottom up integration
915. With respect to System testing, what is the objective of performance testing?
A. To assess how well the application is able to recover from crashes, hardware
failures and other similar problems
B. To determine that an Information System protects data and maintains
functionality as intended.
C. to determine the stability of a given system or entity based on the requirements
D. to assess various parameters like response time, speed of processing,
effectiveness use of a resources (RAM, CPU etc.), network, etc.
388
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
KEY D
D is correct - Performance Testing: Software performance testing is performed on
various parameters like response time, speed of processing, effectiveness use of a
resources (RAM, CPU etc.), network, etc. This testing technique compares the new
system's performance with that of similar systems using available industry benchmarks.
A,B, C are incorrect – These are the objectives of Recovery Testing, Security testing
and Stress testing respectively.
916. What does User Acceptance Testing focus on?
A. Ensuring that the system is production-ready and satisfies all accepted
(baselined) requirements
B. Conforming to the quality standards of the organisation accepted before
development
C. Documenting specifications, technology employed, use of coding standards
D. Controlling the execution of tests and the comparing of actual outcomes with
predicted outcomes
KEY A
A is correct - User Acceptance Testing (UAT): It is a user extensive activity and
participation of functional user is a primary requirement for UAT. The objective of UAT
is to ensure that the system is production-ready and satisfies all accepted (baseline)
requirements.
B and C are incorrect – These are the features of Quality Assurance Testing
D is incorrect – This is the feature of automated testing
917. In this strategy, implementation can be staged with conversion to the new system
taking place gradually.
A. Phased Changeover
B. Abrupt Changeover
C. Pilot Changeover
D. Parallel Changeover
KEY A
A is correct - Phased Changeover: With this strategy, implementation can be staged
with conversion to the new system taking place gradually. This is done based on
business operations. For example, converting one function (e.g. marketing) on new
system, wait for the same be stabilized and then take another function
(Finance/HR/production etc.)
389
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
390
Systems Development – Acquisition, Maintenance and Implementation
391
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
D is correct - Information Security: System should also need to be evaluated for
information security and privacy controls. This aspect of system evaluation is based on
the security requirements documented during information gathering, security of
infrastructure on which the application is hosted (e.g. hardware baselining, network
security, access controls and vulnerability scanning). Evaluation may also include the
availability aspect required for continuity (e.g. in case of high availability requirements
redundant infrastructure in cluster or replication and readiness of alternate site,
updating of BCP documents etc.)
A, B, C are incorrect – These are the reviews to be done by the auditor as a team
member and during mid project
392
Module 6
Business Application Software Audit
921. In an organisation, business processes and related controls are put in place
through:
A. Business Applications
B. Control Structure
C. Business Cycle
D. Business Model
KEY A
A is correct - “Business Application”, may be defined as applications (meaning
computerized software) used by organisation to run its business. The consideration is
whether the said application covers / incorporates the KEY business processes of the
organisation. Another important consideration is whether the control structure as
available in the Business Application is appropriate to help organisation achieve its
goals. Business applications are where the necessary controls needed to run business
are put in place. The business processes and related controls are put in place through
business applications used by an organisation.
B, C and D are incorrect –
Each business cycle used by an organisation has a defined control structure that has a
direct co-relation to the business model used. Organisations have to document
business processes and identify KEY control points. Organisations have to ensure that
the KEY control points are configured in system.
922. The ICAI has issued standards on Internal Audit in Information Technology
Environment. According to this, an auditor has to:
A. Consider subject matter guidance or direction, as afforded through legislation,
regulations, rules, directives and guidelines issued by government or industry.
B. Establish the expected degree of reliance to be placed on internal control;
C. Determine the nature, timing, and extent of the audit procedures to be performed;
and
D. Consider the extent to which the IT environment is used to record, compile,
process and analyse information
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY D
D is correct - SIA 14, on INTERNAL AUDIT IN INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY
ENVIRONMENT, as issued by ICAI, states that; “The internal auditor should consider
the effect of an IT environment on the internal audit engagement, inter alia:
a. The extent to which the IT environment is used to record, compile, process and
analyse information; and
b. The system of internal control in existence in the organisation with regard to: the
flow of authorised, correct and complete data to the processing centre; the
processing, analysis and reporting tasks undertaken in the installation”.
A, B and C are incorrect – ISACA Standards
ISACA ITAF, 1201 “Engagement Planning”, identifies risk assessment as one of the
KEY aspects and states that IS audit and assurance professionals, have to;
• Obtain an understanding of the activity being audited. The extent of the
knowledge required should be determined by the nature of the enterprise, its
environment, areas of risk, and the objectives of the engagement.
• Consider subject matter guidance or direction, as afforded through legislation,
regulations, rules, directives and guidelines issued by government or industry.
• Perform a risk assessment to provide reasonable assurance that all material
items will be adequately covered during the engagement. Audit strategies,
materiality levels and resource requirements can then be developed.
• Develop the engagement project plan using appropriate project management
methodologies to ensure that activities remain on track and within budget.
ICAI Standards
SA 200 “Overall Objectives of the Independent Auditor and the conduct of an audit in
accordance with standards on Auditing”, Issued by ICAI, requires an auditor to plan an
audit and get following information: “The auditor should plan his work to enable him to
conduct an effective audit in an efficient and timely manner. Plans should be based on
knowledge of the client’s business. Plans should be made to cover, among other things:
a. Acquiring knowledge of the client’s accounting system, policies and internal
control procedures;
b. Establishing the expected degree of reliance to be placed on internal control;
c. Determining and programming the nature, timing, and extent of the audit
procedures to be performed; and
d. Coordinating the work to be performed.
394
Business Application Software Audit
The first step to by an IS auditor is to obtain knowledge about the business of the
organisation, do risk assessment and decide on the specific and additional audit
procedures to complete the audit.
923. What is control risk with respect to risk assessment for a business application?
A. Relates to business risks, country risks and contract risks
B. Failure of a control to prevent or detect a material error that exists in system.
C. risk arising without taking into account a planned action by management
D. failure of an audit procedure to detect an error that might be material
KEY B
B is correct - Control risk is defined as failure of a control to prevent, detect a material
error that exists in system.
A, C and D are incorrect –
Subject matter risk, relates to business risk, country risk, contract risks. These are
important for an IS auditor to consider but merged with inherent risk (discussed later).
2. Audit risk, is define as auditor reaching incorrect conclusion after an audit. The
components of audit risk being control risk, inherent risk and detection risk.
• Control risk is defined as failure of a control to prevent, detect a material error
that exists in system.
• Inherent risk is defined as risk arising without taking into account a planned
action by management to reduce the risk. Simply said it related to nature of
transaction / business.
• Detection risk is defined as failure of an audit procedure to detect an error that
might be material individually or in combination of other errors.
924. Business applications used by entities to manage resources optimally and to
maximize economy, efficiency and effectiveness of business operations is known
as:
A. Accounting Applications
B. Banking Applications
C. ERP Applications
D. Payroll Application
395
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
C is correct -
ERP Application: These have been created a separate category of business
application systems, due to their importance for an organisation. These software called
as enterprise resource planning software are used by entities to manage resources
optimally and to maximize E^3 i.e. economy, efficiency and effectiveness of business
operations.
A is incorrect -
Accounting Applications: Applications like TALLY, TATA EX, UDYOG, used by
business entities for purpose of accounting for day to day transactions, generation of
financial information like balance sheet, profit and loss account, cash flow statements,
are classified as accounting applications.
B is incorrect –
Banking Application: Today all public sector banks, private sector banks, and
including regional rural banks have shifted to core banking business applications
(referred to as CBS). Reserve Bank of India guidelines mandating all co-operative
banks also to shift to core banking applications by December 013, means 95% plus
Indian banks use CBS. CBS used by Indian banks include, FINACLE (by Infosys
Technologies Ltd.), FLEXCUBE (By Oracle Financial Services Software Limited,
formerly called i-flex Solutions Limited), TCS BaNCS (By TCS Limited), and many more
CBS.
D is incorrect –
Payroll Application: Many companies across the world are outsourcing these activities
to professionals. In India also many CA firms are doing good job on payroll outsourcing.
TALLY has a payroll application built into it. ICAI, has made available for its members a
payroll application.
925. Key business requirements for information specify ‘integrity’ as a parameter that
needs to be present in information generated. By integrety we mean:
A. protection of sensitive information from unauthorised disclosure
B. accuracy and completeness of information as well as its validity
C. information being available when required
D. information being delivered in a timely, correct, consistent and usable manner
KEY B
B is correct - Integrity: Relates to the accuracy and completeness of information as
well as to its validity in accordance with business values and expectations
396
Business Application Software Audit
397
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
C. Natural Sciences
D. Virtual Reality
KEY A
A is correct - Cognitive Science: This is an area based on research in disciplines such
as biology, neurology, psychology, mathematics and allied disciplines. It focuses on
how human brain works and how humans think and learn. Applications of AI in the
cognitive science are Expert Systems, Learning Systems, Neural Networks, Intelligent
Agents and Fuzzy Logic
B, C and D are incorrect – Robotics: This technology produces robot machines with
computer intelligence and human-like physical capabilities. This area includes
applications that give robots visual perception, capabilities to feel by touch, dexterity
and locomotion.
iii. Natural Languages.
Being able to 'converse' with computers in human languages is the goal of research in
this area. Interactive voice response and natural programming languages, closer to
human conversation, are some of the applications. Virtual reality is another important
application that can be classified under natural interfaces.
928. What are decision support systems (DSS)?
A. System used for getting valuable information for making management decisions
B. systems that provide interactive information support to managers with analytical
models
C. system which allows buying and selling goods on the internet and involves
information sharing, payment, fulfillment, service and support
D. system intended to capture data at the time and place of a transaction
KEY B
B is correct - DSS are information systems that provide interactive information support
to managers with analytical models. DSS are designed to be ad hoc systems for
specific decisions by individual-managers. These systems answer queries that are not
answered by the transactions processing systems.
A, C and D are incorrect – Data warehousing system is used for getting valuable
information for making management decisions.
Other than buying and selling goods on the Internet, E Commerce (Electronic
Commerce) involves information sharing, payment, fulfillment and service and support.
a PoS is intended to capture data at the time and place of transaction which is being
initiated by a business user. It is often attached to scanners to read bar codes and
magnetic cards for credit card payment and electronic sales.
398
Business Application Software Audit
929. Which of the following should an IS auditor consider while auditing data
warehousing systems?
A. Network capacity for speedy access
B. Accuracy and correctness of outputs generated
C. Validation of receivers details for correctness and completeness
D. Review of exceptional transaction logs
KEY A
A is correct - IS Auditor should consider the following while auditing data warehouse:
1. Credibility of the source data
2. Accuracy of the source data
3. Complexity of the source data structure
4. Accuracy of extraction and transformation process
5. Access control rules
6. Network capacity for speedy access
B is incorrect – IS Auditors role with respect to Decision Support System:
1. Credibility of the source data
2. Accuracy of the source data
3. Accuracy of extraction and transformation process
4. Accuracy and correctness of the output generated
5. Access control rules
C is incorrect – The IS Auditors role with respect to EFT will be with respect to:
1. Authorisation of payment.
2. Validation of receivers details, for correctness and completeness.
3. Verifying the payment made.
4. Getting acknowledgement from the receiver, or alternatively from bank about the
payment made.
5. Checking whether the obligation against which the payment was made has been
fulfilled.
D is incorrect – IS Auditors role for PoS systems:
1. In case there is batch processing, the IS auditor should evaluate the batch
controls implemented by the organization.
399
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
400
Business Application Software Audit
resources. IS audit and assurance professionals shall identify and assess risk relevant
to the area under review, when planning individual engagements. IS audit and
assurance professionals shall consider subject matter risk, audit risk and related
exposure to the enterprise.
A, B and D are incorrect –
Engagement Planning: This includes conclusions on objective(s), scope, timeline and
deliverables, compliance with applicable laws and professional auditing standards, use
of a risk-based approach, where appropriate, engagement-specific issues,
documentation and reporting requirements.
Performance and Supervision: IS audit and assurance professionals shall conduct the
work in accordance with the approved IS audit plan to cover identified risk and within
the agreed-on schedule. IS audit and assurance professionals shall provide supervision
to IS audit staff for whom they have supervisory responsibility, to accomplish audit
objectives and meet applicable professional audit standards. IS audit and assurance
professionals shall accept only tasks that are within their knowledge and skills or for
which they have a reasonable expectation of either acquiring the skills during the
engagement or achieving the task under supervision. IS audit and assurance
professionals shall obtain sufficient and appropriate evidence to achieve the audit
objectives. The audit findings and conclusions shall be supported by appropriate
analysis and interpretation of this evidence. IS audit and assurance professionals shall
document the audit process, describing the audit work and the audit evidence that
supports findings and conclusions. IS audit and assurance professionals shall identify
and conclude on findings.
Evidence: IS audit and assurance professionals shall obtain sufficient and appropriate
evidence to draw reasonable conclusions on which to base the engagement results. IS
audit and assurance professionals shall evaluate the sufficiency of evidence obtained to
support conclusions and achieve engagement objectives.
932. The type of CAAT which is written for special audit purposes or targeting
specialized IT environments is known as:
A. Specialised Audit Software
B. Generalised Audit Software
C. Utility Software
D. Computer Audit Software
KEY A
A is correct - Specialised Audit software, unlike GAS, is written for special audit
purposes or targeting specialized IT environments.
401
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
402
Business Application Software Audit
command sequences and are also useful in performing common data analysis functions
such as searching, sorting, appending, joining, analysis etc. Utilities are extensively
used in design, development, testing and auditing of application software, operating
systems parameters, security software parameters, security testing, debugging etc.
a. File comparison: A current version of a file for example, is compared with the
previous year’s version, or an input file is compared with a processed file.
b. Production of circularisation letters.
934. What is continuous auditing?
A. Process of obtaining evidence directly on the quality of the records produced and
maintained in the system.
B. Process of reviewing the computer logs generated at various points to build an
audit trail
C. Process through which an auditor evaluates the particular system(s) and thereby
generates audit reports on real time basis.
D. Process of reviewing transactions as they are processed and select items
according to audit criteria specified in the resident code
KEY C
C is correct - Continuous auditing is a process through which an auditor evaluates the
particular system(s) and thereby generates audit reports on real time basis. Continuous
auditing approach may be required to be used in various environments. Such
environments usually involve systems that are 4*7 mission critical systems.
A is correct – This forms part of selecting, implementing and using CAAT’s
B and D are incorrect – These are different techniques of continuous auditing
935. Procedure of continuous auditing whereby digital pictures of procedures are
saved and stored in the memory:
A. Snapshot
B. Integrated Test facility
C. System activity file interrogation
D. Embedded audit facilities
KEY A
A is correct - Most applications follow a standard procedure whereby, after taking in the
user input they process it to generate the corresponding output. Snapshots are digital
pictures of procedures of the console that are saved and stored in the memory.
Procedures of the console refer to the application procedures that take input from the
403
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
console i.e. from the keyboard or the mouse. These procedures serve as references for
subsequent output generations in the future. Typically, snapshots are implemented for
tracing application software and mapping it. The user provides inputs through the
console for processing the data. Snapshots are means through which each step of data
processing (after the user gives the input through) is stored and recalled.
B is incorrect - Integrated Test Facility (ITF) is a system in which a test pack is pushed
through the production system affecting “dummy” entities. Hence this requires dummy
entities to be created in the production software. For example, the auditor would
introduce test transactions that affect targeting dummy customer accounts and dummy
items created earlier for this testing purpose.
C is incorrect – Most computer operating systems provide the capability of producing a
log of every event occurring in the system, both user and computer initiated. This
information is usually written to a file and can be printed out periodically. As part of
audit testing of general controls, it may be useful for the auditor to review the computer
logs generated at various points to build an audit trail. Wherever possible, unauthorised
or anomalous activity would need to be identified for further investigation.
D is incorrect – Embedded audit facilities consist of program audit procedures, which
are inserted into the client’s application programs and executed simultaneously. The
technique helps review transactions as they are processed and select items according
to audit criteria specified in the resident code, and automatically write details of these
items to an output file for subsequent audit examination.
936. Compliance testing helps an auditor:
A. substantiate the integrity of actual processing and the outcome of compliance
testing
B. to test for monetary errors directly affecting financial statement balances
C. To obtain evidence of the validity and propriety of accounting treatment of
transactions
D. Determine that controls are applied in a manner that complies with policies and
procedures
KEY D
D is correct - Compliance tests are used to help determine the extent of substantive
testing to be performed, as stated in Statement of Auditing Standards. Such tests are
necessary if the prescribed procedures are to be relied upon in determining the nature,
time or extent of substantive tests of particular classes of transactions or balances.
Once the KEY control points are identified, the auditor seeks to develop a preliminary
understanding of the controls to ensure their existence and effectiveness.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are the features of Substantive Testing
404
Business Application Software Audit
937. While reviewing authorisation procedure before creating user rights, an IS auditor
has to:
A. Evaluate how the user rights have been granted and monitored
B. Check who triggers the request for user rights creation
C. Check Whether there is a proper cross check mechanism to validate the user
rights
D. Check Whether user right alteration process is linked to the job profile of the
individual
KEY B
B is correct - Authorisation procedure before creating user rights?
IS Auditor needs to check whether there is a formal user rights approval
form/document. The question that need to be answered being
a. Who triggers the request for user rights creation? Ideally this request has to be
generated through HR department.
b. Whether the form contains all relevant information for the specific user?
c. Whether the form has been properly filled?
d. Whether the form has valid authorisation?
e. Whether forms are marked once user rights are created in system?
A is incorrect – Who has the authority to create user rights?
IS auditor is also concerned to know the person who has the authority to create users in
system. IS auditor needs to evaluate the rights of persons doing this job and how these
rights have been granted and monitored.
C is incorrect - Validation of user rights created in system?
IS Auditor needs to evaluate the process how user rights created at step (ii) are
validated once they have been put in system. IS Auditor may seek answers to the
following questions.
a. Whether there is a proper cross check mechanism build in organisation to
validate the user rights of employee once they have been created?
b. Whether there is timely validation of user rights and user job profiles? For
example this is a cyclical process to be done once each year to see whether the
job profile of individual is appropriately reflected in his/her user rights?
D is incorrect - Process of alteration of user rights?
IS Auditor is concerned with the process of alteration of rights. The IS Auditor seeks
answers to the following questions.
405
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
a. Whether the user right alteration process is linked to job profile of individual?
b. Who triggers the request for user rights alteration?
938. This is the highest level of database abstraction which is of concern to the users
is:
A. Conceptual or global view
B. Physical view
C. Internal view
D. External or user view
KEY D
D is correct - External or user view: It is at the highest level of the database
abstraction. It includes only that portion of database or application programs which is of
concern to the users. It is defined by the users or written by the programmers. It is
described by the external schema.
A is incorrect – Conceptual or global view: This is reflection of a database is viewed
by database administrator. Single view represents the entire database. It describes all
records, relationships and constraints or boundaries. Data description to render it
independent of the physical representation. It is defined by the conceptual schema,
B and C are incorrect – Physical or internal view: It is at the lowest level of database
abstraction. It is closest to the physical storage method. It indicates how data will be
stored, describes data structure, and the access methods. It is expressed by internal
schema.
939. What control does a ‘view’ function offer with respect to database security?
A. Segregation of duties
B. Addresses conflicts relating to simultaneous access
C. Enables data access limitations
D. Ability to create and reuse SQL code
KEY C
C is correct - Views: Views enable data access limitations. A view is a content or
context dependent subset of one or more tables.
A, B and D are incorrect – Database Roles and Permissions
• Segregation of duties
• Roles & Permissions allow control of operations that a user can perform on
database,
406
Business Application Software Audit
407
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A, C and D are incorrect – Taxation related: TDS, TCS, Excise Duty, Service Tax,
VAT, PF, etc.
XBRL compliance: Looking to the growth of XBRL compliance in India and
governments intention to slowly increase the coverage area of eligible entities, XBRL
compliance shall increase in India. Many business application vendors have already
started making their software capable of generating XBRL reporting.
Accounting Standard related: Accounting standards prescribing the accounting
guidance to transactions. It is important that the business applications used are in
compliance with the applicable accounting standards.
942. What is the responsibility of management with respect to accuracy and
authenticity of reports?
A. Prime responsibility of accuracy of reports generated
B. Whether established controls ensure accuracy of reports
C. Forming opinion based on such reports
D. Respond appropriately to written representations
KEY A
A is correct - The prime responsibility for accuracy of report generated from the
business applications lies with the management.
B, C and D are incorrect – These are the responsibilities of the internal and statutory
auditor
408
Module 7
Business Continuity Management
A. Risk
B. Vulnerability
C. Contingency
D. Emergency
KEY B
Justification
The degree of exposure to any risk or the consequences of risk is termed vulnerability.
The exposure is to a risk & the situation is described as vulnerability. A contingency
expresses the possibility of exposure to risk and an emergency when the risk is actually
likely to occur. Hence, answer at Option B only is correct.
946. What is Minimum Business Continuity Objective?
A. Organization objective to continue doing business despite disruptions
B. Organization objective to continue minimum level of business even during
financial crisis
C. Organization approach to reduce business operations to a minimum level during
crises
D. Minimum level of services/products acceptable during a disruption
KEY D
Justification
MBCO is the minimum level of services and/or products acceptable to the organization
during a disruption, as brought out in Option D. The answers in the other options are
factually wrong.
947. What is Maximum Acceptable Outage ?
A. Maximum loss an organization can afford to absorb on account of a disruption
B. Maximum loss of output an organization can afford on account of a disruption
C. Maximum number of persons an organization can afford to shift out during an
emergency
D. Maximum period of time an organization can tolerate disruption of a critical
business function
KEY D
Justification
MAO is the maximum period of time an organization can tolerate disruption of a critical
business function, as brought out in Option D. The answers in the other options are
factually wrong.
410
Business Continuity Management
411
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY C
Justification
BCP is to ensure recovery of critical functions alone whereas DRP is to have all
operations functioning post an event. Thus, BCP may be the initial response to an event
or disaster when some essential functions alone are revived. DRP, however, will cover
resumption of full-fledged normal operations. The answers in other options are not
correct and answer in Option C is correct.
951. Crisis phase, Emergency response phase & Recovery phase are three of the four
phases that are typical of any disaster scenario. Which is the fourth phase ?
A. Restoration phase
B. Planning phase
C. Multiplication phase
D. Stabilization phase
KEY A
Justification
The fourth phase of Disaster is the Restoration phase. This phase involves restoration
of conditions to normal. Damages to equipment & facilities are normally repaired during
this period. The answers in Options B to D are not correct and answer in Option A is
correct.
952. What are the pre-requisites in developing a Business Continuity Plan (BCP) ?
A. Planning for all phases & making it part of business process
B. Testing of the BCP
C. Waiting for one incident to learn from, before drawing up BCP
D. Having the organization’s strategic long term plan ready
KEY A
Justification
The major pre-requisites for developing a BCP include planning for all phases & making
it a part of business process by assigning responsibility to specific business process
owners. It will not be practicable to wait for one event or disaster to happen; we would
have to depend upon the wisdom of the team members to brain storm, identify possible
scenarios & plan corrective actions. While it would be good to have the organization’s
strategic long term plan ready, it may not be an actual must. Testing of the BCP will be
a subsequent step, post finalization of the BCP.
Hence, answer at Option A is correct & the others wrong.
412
Business Continuity Management
953. What are the key phases prior to development of a Business Continuity Plan
(BCP) ?
A. Maintenance of the BCP
B. Business Impact Analysis & Risk Assessment
C. Testing of the BCP
D. Training & awareness of employees
KEY B
Justification
The KEY phases prior to development of a BCP are Business Impact Analysis & Risk
Assessment. Training and awareness of the employees will happen subsequent to
completion of the drafting of the BCP. Testing and maintenance, too, would happen only
after the plan is ready.
Hence, answer at Option B is correct & the others wrong.
954. What are the key phases post development of a Business Continuity Plan (BCP) ?
A. Testing, training & awareness of employees & maintenance
B. Appointing a project team and steering committee
C. Risk assessment
D. Business Impact analysis
KEY A
Justification
Business impact analysis, risk assessment & appointment of a project team & steering
committee are steps which precede the development of a BCP. Hence, they cannot
handle work relating to post development of the BCP. Testing, training & awareness of
employees and maintenance are the KEY phases to be implemented post development
of a BCP.
Hence, answer at Option A is correct & the others wrong.
955. A Business Impact Analysis (BIA) has the objective of estimating the financial &
intangible operational impacts for each business unit, assuming a worst case
scenario. What other objective does it have ?
A. Address initiatives for speedy recovery from contingency
B. Identify business unit processes & estimated recovery time for each
C. Develop recovery management team
D. Develop crisis management team
413
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY B
Justification
The third major objective of the BIA would be to identify business unit processes &
estimated recovery time for each of them, as indicated in Option A above. Initiatives
towards recovery as also development of recovery/crisis management teams is not part
of the BIA.
Hence, answer at Option B is correct & the others wrong.
956. What is Recovery Time Objective (RTO) ?
A. RTO is a measure of the user’s tolerance to downtime
B. The time period the crisis is expected to last
C. The time required for the team to stem further damage
D. The time required for the crisis management team to respond
KEY A
Justification
The RTO is a measure of the user’s tolerance to downtime. This is the amount of
downtime of the business process that the business can tolerate and still remain viable.
It is not any of the other aspects stated in Options B to D. Hence, answer at Option A is
correct
957. What is Service Delivery Objective (SDO) ?
A. Continuing to give services during a disaster
B. The service level through alternate process till normality is restored
C. Performing a service from an alternate site, owing to disaster
D. Inter-departmental services supporting product deliveries to customers
KEY B
Justification
SDO is the service level through alternate process till normality is restored, as indicated
in Option A above. The other answers are not factually correct. Hence, answer at
Option B is correct.
958. What is Recovery Point Objective (RPO) ?
A. The extent of acceptable data loss to a business owing to node failure
B. The time by which the Crisis management team expects to achieve recovery
414
Business Continuity Management
415
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
B. Medium
C. Depends upon business requirements
D. High
KEY D
Justification
RPO is the extent of acceptable data loss to a business owing to node failure. Hence,
the lower the extent of acceptable data loss, the more critical the situation & the more
expensive the cost of maintaining the environment. Answer in Option D therefore, is the
correct answer.
962. What is the Maximum Tolerable Outage (MTO)?
A. It is the maximum time an organization can support processing in alternate mode
B. It is the maximum time an organization can afford to shut down operations
C. It is the maximum loss of output an organization is able to afford
D. It is the maximum loss of potential sales an organization can afford
KEY A
Justification
MTO is the maximum time an organization can support processing in alternate mode, as
indicated in Option A. The answers in other options are not correct. Answer in Option A,
therefore, is the correct answer.
963. What happens when the Interruption Window is crossed by an organization in
crisis ?
A. A state of business continuity has been achieved
B. Business Impact analysis can no longer be done or effective
C. The progressive losses caused by the interruption become unaffordable
D. The crisis no longer exists & the organization relaxes
KEY C
Justification
The Interruption window is the time the organization can wait from the point of failure to
the point of critical services/applications restoration. Answer in Option C, therefore, is
the correct answer. The answers in the other options are incorrect.
964. A company sells small furniture items exclusively over the Internet. It works with
an Internet service provider for facilitating its online business. In house, it runs
416
Business Continuity Management
the operations with the bare minimum of manpower. Storage of information and
recording of all transactions is carried out using the company’s IT network and
very limited physical documentation is maintained.
Their business is growing fast and their far sighted CEO has asked his managers
to carry out a risk analysis to check and ensure preparedness in the face of any
contingency. How would you rate this company’s tolerance to the risk of failure of
the Internet services ?
A. Vital
B. Critical
C. Sensitive
D. Non-critical
KEY B
Justification
The Company is doing business exclusively online &, hence, dependence on the
Internet is 100 %. It is also indicated that it goes in for very limited physical
documentation of its business. Manning is also Spartan. Hence, the company’s
tolerance to risk is critical. Answer at Option B, therefore, is correct.
965. An large Indian multinational company has its head office located at New Delhi. It
has substantial investments made in this office, including large IT servers which
cater to its global operations which are heavily dependent upon IT (assessed risk
ranking 5). New Delhi happens to be in Seismic Zone 4 and is rated as a ‘High
damage risk zone’ (assessed risk ranking 4). However, the actual occurrence of
earthquakes has been rare (assessed risk ranking 2). What do you think could be
the earthquake risk score for this establishment going by the standard formula for
risk comparison ?
A. 3.66
B. 2.50
C. 10.00
D. 13.33
KEY A
Justification
The risk score for this establishment would be 3.66 as per the formula (Asset cost +
Likelihood + Vulnerability)/3. Answer at Option A, therefore, is correct.
417
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
966. The Head office of a large group of companies is located in a large metro city.
With a view to testing its readiness to face the contingency of a fire, the
organization very meticulously conducts fire drills at least once in a year at its
Head office. It hires an independent professional agency to conduct the drill.
Volunteers from within the organization act also assist in the process. The drill
involves the initiation of a fire alarm, evacuation of all the offices, assembly at a
common point, etc. The process and its outcome are carefully documented &
learnings utilised for tweaking the organization’s safety processes. How would
you classify this fire drill as an element of a Business Continuity Plan ?
A. Structured walk through test
B. Parallel test
C. Unstructured walk through test
D. Simulation test
KEY D
Justification
This would be classified as a simulation test since this is a mock practice session in
response to a simulated disaster. Hence, answer at Option D is correct and the other
answers are wrong.
967. Training in Disaster Recovery Planning (DRP) has two KEY objectives. One is to
train recovery team participants who are expected to act in the event of a
disaster. The other KEY objective would be _____________
A. To understand the calculation of the risk ratio
B. To re-assess the value at risk
C. To train KEY employees on awareness & disaster prevention
D. To train the public at large as a public relations exercise
KEY C
Justification
The other KEY objective would be to train KEY employees on awareness & disaster
prevention as also the need for DRP. The answers in Options B to D may not be totally
irrelevant to the process but would definitely not be top of the mind for any normal
process. Hence, answer at Option C is correct and the other answers are wrong.
968. Scenario workshop & Walkthrough sessions are two of the major methods of
training for disaster recovery & business continuity in general. What is the single,
significant difference between both ?
418
Business Continuity Management
419
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
Incident Response Planning does not focus exclusively on the Incident Response
Team’s preparedness. It also works on preventative measures which can help eliminate
or reduce the occurrence of the incident. Hence, the statement in the stem is false and
the answer in Option A above is correct.
971. Complete the following statement. The three broad categories of incidents are
definite, probable and ________________
A. Uncertain
B. Possible
C. Unfortunate
D. Indefinite
KEY B
Justification
The third broad category of incidents is a possible incident &, hence, the answer in
Option B above is correct.
972. Some possible actual IT incidents could be _____________
A. Presence of unfamiliar files
B. Presence or Execution of unknown program or processes
C. Unusual system crashes
973. Which one of the following could also be a possible actual incident ?
A. Introduction of new software from accredited source
B. Increase in number of licences
C. Unusual consumption of computing resources
D. Recruitment of a new software engineer
KEY C
Justification
Of the choices given, unusual consumption of computing resources could be a possible
actual incident which can cause concern & trigger an incident response. Hence, the
answer in Option C above is correct.
974. Which one of the following could also be a definite indicator of an incident ?
420
Business Continuity Management
421
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
KEY A
Justification
It is the Incident Response team which would appear first on the scene when an
incident occurs. If this team is unable to make headway, the Disaster Recovery team is
called in. If the Disaster Recovery team finds the impact of the crisis as very high, they
draw in the Business Continuity Plan team in addition. Hence, the answer in Option A
above is correct.
977. State True or False. The Disaster Recovery Plan should contain details about the
Disaster Recovery Management Team and its sub-teams like Administration,
Supplies, Public Relations, etc. as also their respective responsibilities. The idea
is to decide on these well in advance and not waste precious time arriving at the
right choice of people, roles and responsibilities at the time of the actual crisis.
A. False
B. True
KEY B
Justification
The very purpose of a Disaster Recovery Plan is to minimize the losses which a
business may incur on account of a crisis. The single most important factor in such a
situation is time and prior identification of the appropriate persons to take on the
emergency roles is critical for speedy and effective disaster recovery efforts. Hence, the
answer in Option B above is correct.
978. The Business Continuity Plan Manual comprises basically the _________
A. Business Continuity Plan alone
B. Business Continuity Plan and the Disaster Recovery Plan
C. Business Continuity Plan and the Incident Response Plan
D. Business Continuity Plan and the Contingency Response Plan
KEY B
Justification
The BCP manual is expected to give reasonable reassurance to the senior
management of the business’ capability to spring back from a disaster through a
process of identifying potential crises as also plans for recovery from the crises. Hence,
the BCP Manual comprises both the BCP and the DRP as indicated in Option B. The
answers in the other Options are not factually correct.
979. Restoring from a Differential Back-up involves ________________
422
Business Continuity Management
A. Restoring from last full back-up & then every incremental back-up
B. Restoring from full back-up alone
C. Restoring from last full back-up & then the differential back-up
D. Restoring from differential back-up alone
KEY C
Justification
Restoring from a Differential Back-up involves restoring from the last full back-up and
then the differential back-up, as indicated in Option C above. The other answers in
other options are incorrect.
980. What is one of the most popular back up measures for wide-area data
communication networks in an emergency ?
A. Dial-up in lieu of the normal leased/broad band lines
B. Circuit extension techniques
C. Micro-wave communications
D. On-demand carrier services
KEY A
Justification
Dial-up facilities are one of the most popular back up measures for wide-area
communication networks in the event of an emergency. The other options can also
serve as back-up facilities but come with their own limitations / specialized uses. Eg.
Circuit extension techniques are normally used with high speed leased lines, involving
effective duplication of equipment/facilities. Similarly, on-demand services would
depend upon the carrier’s capability & willingness. Hence, answer in Option A is correct.
981. A leading e-commerce provider is entering into the Indian market and is keen that
the business is built on firm foundations to ensure its credibility to customers.
Appreciating the importance of ensuring 100 % back-up for its Internet
operations, it approaches a reputed vendor for advice on back-up facilities. The
vendor analyses the customer’s requirements and comes up with a solution. The
vendor offers the customer a ready-to-use back-up facility based upon
subscription & membership. Virtually every equipment / facility which the
customer has in his main facility, including air-conditioning, would be replicated
at the vendor’s back-up location and it would be ready for instantaneous use in
the case of an emergency, providing the customer the very dependable back-up
facilities they seek but at a price. What is such a facility called ?
423
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
A. Mirror site
B. Cold site
C. Hot site
D. Cryogenic site
KEY C
Justification
Such a ready-to-use facility is termed a hot site as indicated in Option C. A mirror site,
on the other hand, is a fully redundant facility maintained by an organization. A cold site
is one which is not fully equipped and would require time to bring it on par with
expectations. There is not facility called as cryogenic site in this context.
982. What is a Hybrid Online Backup ?
A. Involves Local backup for recent data & Offsite backup for archived data
B. Cryogenic site
C. Back up through combination of manual as well as electronic storage
D. Remote cloud as well as physical location storage
KEY A
Justification
A Hybrid Online Backup involves a local backup which can be used for the most recent
data as also an offsite back (perhaps on the cloud) for archived data which is not
required to be accessed frequently. It does not refer to a combination of manual &
electronic storage; nor does it relate to a remote cloud as well as physical location
storage. The term cryogenic site has no relevance in this context. Hence, answer at
Option A is the correct one.
983. What is database shadowing ?
A. Maintenance of two parallel, independent databases
B. Maintenance of a parallel database with the essential information alone
C. Involves live processing of remote journaling
D. Having a mirror database on the cloud
KEY C
Justification
Database shadowing is basically processing of remote journaling. i.e. parallel
processing of all data at a remote location. The answer in Option C, hence, is correct.
The other answers are incorrect.
424
Business Continuity Management
984. State True or false. Apart from covering losses on account of damage or loss of
equipment, properties, additional costs incurred to meet the contingency etc., it is
possible to get insurance cover for business interruption & consequent financial
losses including customer claims, delayed cash flows, etc.
a. False
b. True
KEY B
Justification
Business interruption includes a situation involving failure of the IT system &
consequent financial losses/expense incurred by the client. Hence, the answer in
Option B is correct.
985. Which types of torts are excluded from liability insurance cover ?
A. Negligent tort
B. Product liability
C. Intentional torts
D. Service liability
KEY C
Justification
Intentional torts are excluded since it is assumed that they are foreseeable and can be
avoided by the insurer. The other types of torts in Options A,B and D are insurable.
Hence, the answer in Option C is correct.
986. What is an example of Errors and Omissions (E&O) insurance ?
A. Professional liability insurance
B. Marine insurance
C. Business interruption insurance
D. Motor vehicle insurance
KEY A
Justification
E&O insurance is a form of insurance protecting the insured against liability arising from
failure to meet appropriate standard of care for a given profession. Professional liability
insurance is one form of E&O insurance. Marine, motor vehicle & business interruption
insurance are not examples of E&O insurance since it does not fall within the limits of
the definition given above . Hence, the answer in Option A is correct.
425
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual
987. What is the primary goal of audit of a Business Continuity Plan (BCP)?
A. Determining effectiveness of BCP & alignment with organizational goals
B. Identify variations from laid down procedure & report to management
C. Benchmark against practices prevailing in other organizations
D. Compliance with laws & regulations
KEY A
Justification
Any good auditor would obviously be required to note & report deviations from the
stated norms. They are also expected to compare the processes involved with that of
competitors / other organizations. Lastly, the IS auditor would also have to check for
compliance with laws and regulations. While all these could be goals of an audit of a
BCP, they would not be the primary one. On the contrary, determining effectiveness of
BCP & alignment with organizational goals are critical goals which would address most
of the other aspects covered in Options B to D.
Hence, answer in Option A alone is the most appropriate one.
988. What is the first step in the BCP process ?
A. Identifying the weaknesses in the organizations
B. Testing the functioning of the process
C. Checking for compliance with laws & regulations
D. Identifying the mission/business-critical functions
KEY D
Justification
The aspects identified in Options A to C are, indeed, part of the BCP audit process.
However, they do not constitute the critical step. This would basically be identification of
mission / business-critical functions so that the adequacy of the BCP process for these
selected functions are verified as part of the audit process. Hence, answer in Option D
alone is the most appropriate one.
989. State True or False. While it is important to identify all critical missions and
businesses in the business continuity plan, it should be understood that
attempting to cover all the mission or business-critical functions would be a very
expensive affair & not very feasible. It makes better sense to identify the priority
areas which would impact most through their failure.
A. True
B. False
426
Business Continuity Management
KEY A
Justification
Practically speaking it would be best to go by the 80 20 rule as per which a few KEY
issues of the journal would be available for consultation during the morning. Hence,
answer in Option A alone is the more appropriate one.
990. State True or False. While validating the resources that support critical functions,
the IS audit of the BCP process should restrict itself to computer-related matters
which alone are the division’s responsibility.
A. True
B. False
KEY B
Justification
The audit has to cover all resources, whether IT related or not, that support critical
functions. For, the failure of non-computer related resources could equally endanger the
IT aspects of the business. Hence, answer in Option B alone is the most appropriate
one.
991. State True or False. While validating the resources that support critical functions,
the IS audit of the BCP process should restrict itself to computer-related matters
which alone are the division’s responsibility.
A. False
B. True
KEY A
Justification
The audit has to cover all resources, whether IT related or not, that support critical
functions. For, the failure of non-computer related resources could equally endanger the
IT aspects of the business. Hence, answer in Option A alone is the most appropriate
one.
427
DISA Review Questions, Answers
Manual – Module
i
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
DISCLAIMER
The views expressed in this material are those of author(s). The Institute of
Chartered Accountants of India (ICAI) may not necessarily subscribe to the views
expressed by the author(s).
The information in this material has been contributed by various authors based
on their expertise and research. While every effort have been made to keep
the information cited in this material error free, the Institute or its officers do not
take the responsibility for any typographical or clerical error which may have
crept in while compiling the information provided in this material. There are no
warranties/claims for ready use of this material as this material is for educational
purpose. The information provided in this material are subject to changes in
technology, business and regulatory environment. Hence, members are advised
to apply this using professional judgement. Please visit CIT portal for the latest
updates. All copyrights are acknowledged. Use of specific hardware/software in
the material is not an endorsement by ICAI.
ii
Contents
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module Page Nos.
1. Module – 1 1-119
2. Module – 2 120-178
3. Module – 3 179-290
4. Module – 4 291-404
5. Module – 5 405-461
6. Module – 6 462-557
7. Module – 7 558-611
iii
viii
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Module 1 Questions
Q1. The primary function of the CPU is to take care of
A. Input, Output and arithmetic-logic activities
B. Control and Output activities
C. Control and arithmetic-logic activities
D. Input and Control activities
Q3. A major design consideration for local area networks that replaces stand
alone computing in an organisation include:
A. Ensuring sophisticated and state-of-the-art recovery mechanism
B. Ensuring concurrent access control
C. Ensuring seamless integration
D. Allowing distribution processing
1
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q7. The most appropriate concurrent audit tool whose complexity is very
high and useful when regular processing cannot be interrupted is :
A. SCARF/EAM
B. ITF
C. Snapshot
D. Audit hooks
2
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q9. Which of the following converts digital pulses from the computer into
frequencies within the audio signals
A. multiplexor
B. protocol converter
C. modem
D. concentrator
Q11. While conducting the audit, the auditor shall allocate the audit resources
to
A. Sequentially selected areas
B. Prioritised areas
C. Randomly selected areas
D. All areas subject to audit
Q12. In data processing, which of the following causes the maximum losses
A. poor computer centre design
B. theft of machine time
C. errors and omissions
D. machine room fires
3
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q13. An MIS Manager has only enough resources to install either a new
payroll system or a new data security system, but not both. Which of
the following actions is most appropriate?
A. Giving priority to the security system
B. Leaving the decision to the MIS manager
C. Increasing MIS staff output in order for both systems to be
installed
D. Having the information systems steering committee set the priority
Q16. Which of the following utilities can be used to directly examine the
quality of data in the database:
A. Pointer validation utility
B. HIPO charter
C. Terminal simulator
D. Decision- table preprocessor
4
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q17. Which one of the following controls would protect the production libraries
without compromising the efficiency of open access?
A. Restrict updating and read access to one position
B. Permit updating and read access for everyone in IS
C. Permit updating for everyone in IS but restrict read access to
source code to one position
D. Restrict updating to one position but permit read acccess to
source code for everyone in IS
5
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
6
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
7
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q30. Of the following, the most critical component in a LAN is likely to be the:
A. LAN cables
B. parallel port
C. file server
D. user workstations
8
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q34. The following message service provides the strongest protection about
the occurrence of a specific action:
A. delivery proof
B. submission proof
C. authentication messages origin
D. non-repudiation
Q36. The success of Control Self Assessment (CS depends on culture of the
organisation, project leader and the skills of the people involved in CSA.
While implementing, the pitfall to be avoided is
A. Generalisation of the planning process
B. Implementation on small projects
C. Management support
D. Broadening the focus of CSA s effectiveness
Q37. Which of the following requires the creation of a dummy entity for
Concurrent Auditing Techniques?
A. Snapshot/ Extended Record
B. Continuous and Intermittent Simulation (CIS)
C. Integrated Test Facility (ITF)
D. System Control Audit Review File (SCARF)
9
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q39. Access may be filtered by a firewall access control list based on each
of the following EXCEPT:
A. network interface card (NIC)
B. port
C. service type
D. Internet Protocol (IP) address
Q40. The media that is rarely used in present day LANs is:
A. Fibre optics cable
B. Twisted-pair (shielded) cable
C. Twisted-pair (unshielded) cable
D. Coaxial cable
Q41. While appointing an auditor to conduct the IS audit the company need
not look into ________ of the auditor?
A. Legal capability
B. Experience
C. Proficiency in different computer languages
D. Secrecy bond, if penetration test is to be done
10
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q42. You are planning to use monetary-unit sampling for testing the rupee
value of a large inventory population. The advantages of using
monetary-unit sampling include all of the following except
A. It is an efficient model for establishing that low error rate
population is not materially misstated
B. It does not require the normal distribution approximation required
by variable sampling
C. Since the sampling units are homogenous it can be applied to a
group of accounts
D. As errors increase, it results in a smaller sample size than that
required when using classical sampling.
Q44. An audit technique used to select items from a population for audit
testing purposes based on the characteristics is termed as
A. Continuous Sampling
B. Discrete Sampling
C. Attribute Sampling
D. Statistical Sampling
11
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q47. Which one of the following standards is relevant for a company dealing
with inspection and final testing?-
A. ISO 9000
B. ISO 9001
C. ISO 9002
D. ISO 9003
12
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q51. Which one of the following audit techniques would likely provide an
Systems Auditor assurance about the effectiveness and efficiency of a
system operators work?
A. Interviewing the system operator
B. Reading the operators manual
C. Observing the system operators work
D. Interviewing the system operators supervisor
13
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q54. At what stage the risk assessment should be included in the security
program in event of new system additions or modification of the old
system?
A. When the new system is added or old system is modified
B. At the end of the year along with all other additions or
modifications during the year
C. Need not be done
D. After a defined period say every 3 months
14
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q58. A LAN policy should define which of the following persons should be
made responsible for reporting maintenance problems or disk errors
A. Network administrator
B. Users
C. Security officer
D. Systems administrator
Q61. “In its truest sense, which of the following applications is a real time
application ?
A. Missile launching system
B. Railway Reservation System
C. Banking application
D. Financial Accounting system
15
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
16
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q67. “If a program is written using mnemonics and op-codes then the
program is in
A. Machine language
B. Assembly Level Language
C. Procedural Language
D. Non-procedural language
17
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Packet Switching
D. Junction Switching
Q73. Which of the following actions provides the IS Auditor with the greatest
assurance that certain weaknesses in internal control procedures have
been corrected by the management?
A. Discussing with the management the corrective procedures that
were implemented to strengthen the internal controls.
B. Obtaining a letter of representation from management stating that
the weakness has been corrected.
C. Performing compliance tests and evaluating the adequacy of
procedures that were implemented by the management to correct
the weaknesses.
D. Reviewing management’s response to the weaknesses in their
formal report to the Board of Director’s audit committee.
18
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. CD-ROM
D. None of the above
19
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q82. While reviewing the outsourcing agreement with an external agency, the
IS auditor would be LEAST interested in verifying the clause containing
:
A. Continuity of service by the agency in case of a happening of a
disaster.
B. Statement of due care and confidentiality.
C. Detailed specifications of the vendor’s hardware.
D. The ownership rights for the programs and files.
20
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q84. An Invitation to Tender (ITT) does not address which of the following?
A. Availability of service personnel
B. Application portfolio and transaction volumes
C. Budget for the project
D. Compatibility of the new systems with the existing ones
21
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Star
D. Mesh
Q88. “Which of the following can a local area network (LAN) administrator
use to protect against exposure to illegal or unlicensed software usage
by the network user?
A. Software metering
B. Virus detection software
C. Software encryption
D. Software decryption
22
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Network model
D. Relational model
Q92. “Which of the following translates e-mail formats from one network to
another so that the message can travel through all the networks?
A. Gateway
B. Protocol converter
C. Front-end communication processor
D. Concentrator/multiplexer
Q93. “An IS auditor who intends to use penetration testing during an audit of
Internet connections would:
A. Evaluate configurations.
B. Examine security settings.
C. Censure virus-scanning software is in use.
D. Use tools and techniques that are available to a hacker
23
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q98. The network of the company must be protected from remote access that
may damage the company’
A. All employees
B. Vendors
C. Contractors
D. All the above
24
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q104. When a store uses a point of sale device to record the sale of an item,
which of the following sequences of activities best describes the input
process:
A. data preparation, data capture, data input
B. data capture, data preparation, data input
25
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q105. Which of the following controls may not be associated with point-of-sale
equipment?
A. edit
B. data validation
C. batch
D. access
Q108. All of the following are true relating to the use of fiber optics EXCEPT:
A. Data is transmitted rapidly
B. Fiber optic cable is small and flexible
C. They are unaffected by electrical interference
D. They provide the highest level of signal attenuation
26
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
27
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q115. “Which of the following is the best option with regard to an Information
Processing Facility (IPF)?
A. High MTBF and Low MTTR
B. Low MTBF and High MTTR
C. Low MTBF and Low MTTR
D. High MTBF and High MTTR
28
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q119. “In which of the following, tags are placed within text to accomplish
document formatting, visual features such as font size, italics and bold,
and the creation of links:
A. FTP
B. HTTP
C. Telnet
D. ActiveX
Q120. One main reason for using Redundant Array of Inexpensive Disks
(RAID) is :
A. all data can still be reconstructed even if one drive fails
B. all data are split evenly across pairs of drives
C. snap shots of all transactions are taken
D. write time is minimised to avoid concurrency conflicts
29
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q121. Output controls ensure that output is accurate, complete and produced
when required. The auditor during the course of his audit of output
controls does not look into which of the following:
A. All pages of the report are numbered consecutively
B. Comparison between the actual data totals and totals of record
counts is done at regular interval
C. Proper procedure for classification of output exists
D. Output of test runs and procedure runs are kept separately
Q122. “Which of the following tool would be used when program coding has
to be done?
A. Compiler
B. Editor
C. Loader
D. Linker
Q124. “The database administrator is NOT responsible for which one of the
following functions?
A. Physical design of a database
B. Security of a database
C. Coordinate and resolve conflicting needs and desires of users Iin
their diverse application areas
D. Logical design of a database
30
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q125. Which of the following OSI layers communicates with the user
programs?
A. Physical
B. Application
C. Presentation
D. Session
31
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q130. Which of the following is not true with regard to the establishment of a
security management structure?
A. Security management should have authority in accordance with
the responsibility
B. Security management should have the overall responsibility of
security
C. Security management structure should be approved by all the
employees
D. Security management should have the required independence
Q131. “When the computer is switched on, the system performs some tasks
before loading the operating system. Such ROM chips can be classifed
as:
A. Hardware
B. Software
C. Firmware
D. None of the above
32
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q134. “An electronic device that combines data from several low speed
communication lines into a single high speed line is called “
A. Modem
B. Multiplexer
C. Channel
D. Link Editor
33
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q137. Which of the following actions should be undertaken when plastic debit/
credit cards are issued:
A. mail the cards in an envelope that identifies the name of the
issuing institution
B. make the same groups responsible for the mailing of cards and
the investigation of returned cards
C. communicate the PIN to the cardholder over phone
D. mail the card and PIN mailer separately in registered envelopes
Q138. “Which one of the following is the most essential activity for effective
computer capacity planning? “
A. “Doing the process of liaison with the management and hardware
suppliers “
B. “Talking to security administrator for incorporating security
procedures “
C. “To perform the process of Disaster Recovery Planning and
Business Continuity Planning “
D. Determining the workload of applications
34
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q141. “Which of the following allow users on the Internet to communicate with
each other by typing text mode in real time:”
A. IM
B. RFC
C. FYI
D. FAQ
Q143. “A manufacturer has been purchasing materials and supplies for its
business through an e-commerce application. Which of the following
should this manufacturer rely on to prove that the transactions were
actually made? “
A. Reputation
B. Authentication
C. Encryption
D. Non-Repudiation
35
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q147. Which of the following a company need not prepare or decide upon after
appointing an IS auditor?
A. Documents related to processes or procedures
B. Area of surprise audit
C. Letter foregoing legal course of action related to penetration
testing
D. Number of days the audit should be carried out
36
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
D. It provides a means for assessing the risk that the sample results
will not accurately represent the population characteristics.
37
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Gray Code
D. Excess - 3 Code
Q154. “One feature provided by the OS is to store all the data and program in
the auxiliary memory and bring only selective and needed portions into
the main memory for processing. This feature is termed as:”
A. Spooling
B. Multiplexing
C. Caching
D. Paging
Q157. “With regard to a DSS, which of the following statements are TRUE: i) It
deals with semi-structured problems ii) It tackles problems dealing with
uncertainity iii) Permits ‘What-if” analysis “
A. i & ii
B. ii & iii
C. i & iii
D. i & ii & iii
38
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q158. “The device primarily used to extend the network that must have the
ability to act as a storage and forwarding device is a: “
A. Router
B. Bridge
C. Repeater
D. Gateway
Q159. “All the following are phases in the establishment of a Switched Virtual
Circuit EXCEPT “
A. Circuit termination
B. Data transfer
C. Circuit expansion
D. Circuit establishment
39
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q164. “A major problem in networking is the slow rate of data transfer. Which
of the following would help counter this problem? “
A. Data formatting
B. Allocating adequate bandwidth
C. Centralized control
D. All of the above
Q165. Which of the following is NOT a function of the kernel of the OS?
A. To determine which processes are to be executed
B. To prepare the access matrix for accessing resources.
C. To allocate quantum of main memory for each and every user.
D. To overcome the problem of deadlock
40
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q169. “A firewall access control list may filter access based on each of the
following parameters EXCEPT: “
A. Port
B. Service type
C. Network interface card (NIC)
D. Internet protocol (IP) address
41
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q172. Which of the following activities is NOT within the scope of a DBA?
A. Defining the conceptual schema
B. Performing the task of database tuning
C. Determining the storage capacity for applications
D. Granting and revoking rights of users
Q174. “Which of the following is most often used for collecting statistical
and configuration information about network devices such as
computers,hubs, switches, routers, etc.? “
A. Simple Network Management Protocol
B. Online reports
C. Downtime reports
D. Help desk reports
42
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q179. Which sampling plan will be used to find evidence of at least one
improper transaction in the population?
A. Discovery sampling
B. Acceptance sampling
C. Dollar unit sampling
D. Attribute sampling
43
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q181. Network performance monitoring tools will MOST affect which of the
following?
A. accuracy
B. completeness
C. secrecy
D. availability
44
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q184. The auditor during the course of audit takes into consideration the
materiality of the transaction. Which of the following would not be
considered by the auditor to assess the materiality in case of non-
financial transaction
A. Cost of system or operations
B. Cost of errors
C. Activities supported by system or operations
D. Cost of providing physical access controls to the system
Q186. The first step the IS Internal Audit manager should take, when preparing
the Annual audit plan is to:
A. Meet the audit committee members to discuss the IS audit plan
B. Ensure that the audit staff is competent in the areas to audited
and wherever required to provide for appropriate training.
C. Priorities the audit area by performing risk analysis.
D. Begin with previous year‘s IS audit plan and carry over any IS
audit that had not been accomplishe
Q187. Due to an important work, the senior computer operator has gone on a
leave for ten days. In his place, the security officer has been asked to
officiate. In this scenario, as an IS auditor which of the following would
be the most appropriate.
A. Inform the top management of the complexities and risks in doing
so.
B. Develop a small program that will give a picture of what is
happening during the absence of the operator
45
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q188. Internal controls are not designed to provide reasonable assurance that:
A. Irregularities will be eliminated
B. logical access is permitted only in accordance with authorization
C. Segregation of duties is maintained
D. IS operations are performed in accordance with appropriate
authorizations
Q190. The class of control used to overcome problems before they acquire
gigantic proportions is :
A. Preventive
B. Detective
C. Corrective
D. Suggestive
46
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q194. Which of the following applet intrusion issues poses the GREATEST risk
of disruption to an organisation?
A. applets damaging machines on the network by opening
connections from the client machine
B. a program that deposits a virus on a client
C. applets recording keystrokes made by the client and, therefore
passwords
D. downloaded codes reading files on the client’s hard disk
47
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q197. Which of the following steps provide the highest assurance in achieving
confidentiality, message integrity and non-repudiation by either sender
or recipient?
A. the recipient uses his/her private key to decrypt the secret key.
B. the recipient uses the senders public key, verified with a
certificate authority, to decrypt the pre-hash code
C. the encrypted pre-hash code and the message are encrypted
using a secret key
D. the encrypted pre-hash code is derived mathematically from the
message to be sent
Q198. Several risk are inherent in the evaluation of evidence that has been
obtained through the use of statistical sampling .A beta or type II error
related to sampling risk is the failure to :
A. Properly define the population
B. Draw a random sample from the population.
C. Reject the statistical hypothesis that value is not misstated when
the true value is materially misstated.
D. Accept the statistical hypothesis that value is not materially
misstated when the true value is not materially misstate
Q199. The following statement about controls over computer operators is true:
A. segregation of operator duties is not a very effective control
B. If operators are given access to the system documentation, they
may help in tracing the cause of a potential error
48
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q202. The risk that the conclusion based on a sample might be different from
the conclusion based on examination of the entire population is called
A. Confidence risk
B. Sampling risk
C. Statistical sampling
D. Tolerable rate and the expected deviation rate.
49
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q208. Which one of the following is ideally suited for multimedia applications?
A. Integrated services digital network (ISDN) and broadband ISDN
B. Broadband ISDN, fiber optics, and ATM
50
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
51
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q215. Which of the following are considered while determining the sensitivity
of information-
A. Availability and integrity
B. Integrity and Confidentiality
C. Availability and Confidentiality
D. Availability, Integrity and Confidentiality
52
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q218. The initial validation control for a credit card transaction capture
application would MOST like be to:
A. check that the transaction is not invalid for that card type
B. ensure that the transaction amount entered is within the
cardholders credit limit
C. verify the format of the number entered and then locate it on the
database
D. confirm that the card is not listed as hot
Q219. Which of the following utilities can be used to directly examine the ability
of the program to maintain data integrity?
A. Data dictionary
B. Macro
C. Output analyser
D. Code optimiser
53
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q220. Due diligence of third party service providers need not cover
A. Evaluation of testimonials
B. Evaluation of infrastructure
C. Evaluation of experience
D. Evaluation of ownership
Q222. “Which of the computer assisted audit techniques and tools help the
auditor to identify the impact of delays and rescheduling audit plans”
A. Planning and scheduling
B. Project management and audit tracking
C. Inventory of the audit universe
D. Risk analysis
Q223. Which of the following is NOT TRUE with regard to network reliability
enhancement:
A. Redundant switching equipment
B. Parallel physical circuits
C. Licensed software
D. Standby power supplies
54
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
55
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q230. Which of the following would NOT be a reason for IS Audit involvement
in information systems contractual negotiations?
A. Often hardware does not interface in an acceptable manner
B. Many information systems projects incur additional costs over the
contract cost
C. Vendors may go out of business and discontinue service support
on their products
D. Only the IS Auditor can determine whether the controls in the
system are adequate
56
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q234. To examine the existence of the entities described by the data , which
of the functional capabilities in the generilise audit software would be
used:
A. File assess capabilities
B. Analytical review capability
C. Stratification and frequency analysis capability
D. Statistical sampling capabilities
57
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
58
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q242. In which phase of a system development life cycle would you perform
Mutation analysis?
A. Requirements
B. Design
C. Implementation
D. Maintenance
59
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q245. The auditor should ensure that the policy has been formulated and
communicated by
A. Asks employees for related documents that they have in hand
B. Identifies areas where relevant information has not been
communicated
C. Assesses the commitment of the management
D. Identifies its misuse
Q246. To ensure the operating system integrity the web server configuration
should be monitored. Which of the following is not necessary to achieve
this objective?
A. Baseline for the configuration
B. Periodical review of the web configuration and where needed a
secondary review of the same
C. Internal web sites are inside the company
D. All internal communication must be digitally signed
60
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q249. User controls are designed to ensure that data collected and entered
into the system is
A. Authorised
B. Accurate
C. Complete
D. All of the above
Q251. Echo Check belongs to hardware controls, which usually are those built
into the equipment. Echo Check is best described as:
A. a component that signals the control unit that an operation has
been performed
B. two units that provide read-after-write and dual-read capabilities
C. double wiring of the CPU and peripheral equipment to prevent
malfunctioning
D. validations logic to fields and records based o their
interrelationships with controls established for the batch.
61
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
62
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q258. In order to prevent the loss of data during the processing cycle, the First
point at which control totals should be implemented?
A. in transit to the computer
B. during the return of the data to the user department
C. during the data preparation
D. between related computer runs
Q259. In the System Development life Cycle (SDLC) the user should be
involved in (1) design (2) development (3) implementation of new
system and changes to the existing system. Which of the following is
true?
A. 1, 2
B. 2, 3
63
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. 1, 3
D. 1, 2, 3
Q260. If fraud or errors are suspected in the population , the auditor would
use:
A. Attribute sampling
B. Discover sampling
C. Dollar – unit sampling
D. Ratio and difference estimation.
64
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q264. The auditor during the course of his audit of IT steering committee
interviews the members of the committee. This process helps the
auditor to ascertain
A. Members of the committee are the persons who have more
number of years of experience in the company
B. Members are appointed by the IS project sponsor
C. Committee is in charge of allocation of resources and prioritising
the projects
D. The organisation culture is in no way influencing the committee
and its management practices
65
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q267. When the Auditor uses generalised audit software to access a data
maintained by a database management system, which file structure is
most likely to be difficult to assess:
A. A tree structure
B. A sequential file structure
C. A random structured
D. A index sequential
Q268. Which is the primary reason for replacing cheques with Electronic Funds
Transfer (EFT) systems in the accounts payable area?
A. to ensure compliance with international EFT standard
B. to decrease the number of paper-based forms
C. to increase the efficiency of the payment process
D. to eliminate the risk that unauthorised changes may be made to
the payment transactions
66
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q273. Which one of the following poses a major threat in using remote
workstations?
A. Standard software packages
B. Response time
C. Data transfer speed
D. Security
67
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
68
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q279 The best method to detect and correct errors is before the data are
entered into an application system. But this is not always possible. In
that case the best alternative approach for ensuring data integrity?
A. Test data generator
B. Having monitoring modules
C. Use of generalised audit software
D. Expert systems
Q282. In determining the sample size for a test of control using attribute
sampling, a System Auditor would be least concern with the
A. Expected rate of occurrence
B. Precision limit
C. Result of substantive audit procedure
D. Assessing control risk too high
69
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q284. The IT auditor considers the controls that are present for the evaluation
of the internal controls. Which of the following controls cuts across the
hierarchical line and follow the data as it flows in the organisation?
A. Corrective controls
B. Management controls
C. Application controls
D. Detective controls
Q286. A decision table is used for testing the test data. The purpose of the
results stub in the decision table:
A. Exhibits the expected and actual results
B. Document the conditions that lead to a particular action.
C. Exhibits the rules for different conditional value
D. Indicates the action to be taken when a rules is saisfie
70
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q289. The weakness that the IS auditor would be LEAST concerned with while
reviewing an access control review in an organisation is:
A. The application programmers have the access rights to the live
data environment.
B. There is no provision for enabling the audit trails in the package.
C. Initiating transactions and changing the related parameters could
be done by a single user.
D. Group login access is being used for accessing critical functions.
71
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q291. To enforce the email policy, the management in order need not:
A. Educate employees
B. Educate third parties
C. Take prompt action in case of misuse or complaints
D. Prohibit subscription to e-newspapers and e-groups
Q294. When the company acquires custom made software it enters into a
custom software agreement with the vendor. What should company not
consider before entering into such agreement?
A. Present and future demands of the company
B. Contingency plan of the vendor
C. Frequency at which the vendor updates the software
D. Number of users of the software
72
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
73
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q302. An IS auditor came across instances where the users failed to review
the invoices prior to submitting them for processing since discounts
from vendors could be availed only within three business days of the
invoicing. Which of the following should the IS
A. Confirm that copies of invoices are compared with edit reports
with detail of invoice value and discount prior to releasing the
payment.
74
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
75
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
76
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
77
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
78
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q317. Implementation and maintenance of new and existing systems with the
aid of programmers and analysts is the responsibility of the:
A. Database administrator.
B. Systems development manager.
C. Operations Manager.
D. Quality assurance manager.
79
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
80
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Correcting
D. Recording
81
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
82
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
83
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q338. Service level agreements ensure that effective and efficient computer
services are provided to users. Which of the following is correct with
respect to service level agreements:
A. They are limited to certain IT resources
B. They are static agreements
C. They are arrangements between users and computer operation
facilities
D. It is the responsibility of user department to provide a framework
for each service level agreement
84
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
85
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
86
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q348. The BEST and reliable form of evidence that assists the IS auditor to
develop audit conclusions is :
A. Control Self Assessment assurance received on the working of
the application from a line management personnel.
B. A Letter of confirmation received from an outsider regarding the
account balance.
C. An analytical review of the ratios by the IS auditor from the
information received from the internal line management.
D. Internet trend analysis of the industry’s performance.
Q349. The BEST and the most reliable form of evidence that an IS auditor
would look for in audit of an IS environment is
A. The IS auditor’s test results
B. The auditee’s oral explanation / statement of the evidence
C. A confirmation letter received by the IS auditor directly from an
outside source
D. A report generated by the accountant from internal evidence
Q350. The BEST method of detecting the copying of illegal softwares onto a
network is by:
A. Periodically checking all the hard disks.
B. Using diskless workstations.
C. Framing policies for immediate termination of service of the
employee if he violates.
D. Always using an updated version of an anti-virus software
package.
Q351. The BEST set of attribute of Functionality in evaluating the quality of the
software product during its lifecycle is:
A. Relationship between the amount of resources used and the level
of performance of the software.
B. Ability of the software in maintaining its quality of performance
under various conditions.
87
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
88
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q359. The duty and responsibility of the security administrator without affecting
the interests of the organisation CAN be combined with that of the:
A. Computer operator
B. Systems Analyst
C. Systems programmer
D. Quality assurance
89
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q361. The FIRST and preliminary step in the process of information security
program establishment is :
A. Acquisition of a software for the purpose of controlling the
security access.
B. Framing and adherence of a Corporate IS policy statement
C. Developing and implementing an IS security standards manual
D. The IS auditor conducting a comprehensive security control study.
Q363. The FIRST step in the review of an IT strategic plan is the review of
the:
A. Business plan of the organisation.
B. Information technology environment available at present.
C. Recent trends in the technology.
D. IT budget approved in the latest meeting of the Management.
90
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
91
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q368. The LAN policy describes the job of persons who work on the network.
The duties of a network administrator are
A. Monitoring security violations
B. Password administration
C. Configuring and optimising storage systems
D. Monitoring network environmental conditions
Q370. The main difference in terms of control between a manual system and
a computer system is:
A. there is a difference in the internal control principles
B. the methodology for implementing the controls is not the same in
both
C. there is a perceptible difference in the basic control objectives
D. the control objectives pose more problems for implementing
92
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q372. The MOST critical situation that an IS auditor should report when he
observes a computer operator also performing the duties of a backup
tape librarian and security administrator is:
A. It is not necessary to report these situations to the senior
management.
B. Computer operators acting as a tape librarian and security
administrator.
C. Computer operators acting as security administrators.
D. Computer operators acting as tape librarians.
93
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q375. The objective of using System Control Audit Review File (SCARF within
the application is for collecting following information except:
A. Statistical sampling
B. Policy and procedural variations
C. Application system errors
D. Lack of internal program documentation
Q377. The quality that should be determined by the IS auditor while reviewing
the functions of a Database administrator is
A. The database administrator has strong systems programming
capabilities.
B. The IS auditor’s audit software has the efficiency in accessing the
database.
C. The job responsibilities of the function are clearly defined.
D. The function reports to the data processing operations.
Q378. The quantification of the sample size depends on which of the following
criteria.
A. The sample size decreases as the precision amount decreases.
B. The expected population error rate does not affect the sample
size.
C. The sample size decreases with a decrease in the standard
deviation.
D. The confidence level increases as the sample size decreases.
94
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q379. The reason for the IS auditor NOT preparing a formal audit program
is :
A. To structure the IS auditor’s own planning.
B. Guiding the assistants in performing planned procedures.
C. Overall risk assessment of operations in the organisation.
D. Providing audit documentation for review and reference.
95
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Non-Repudiation
D. Selection
Q386. System software that informs the computer how to use a particular
peripheral device is known as
A. Loader
B. Linker
C. Device Driver
D. Compiler
96
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q388. Which of the following IP address class has maximum hosts in its
network?
A. Class A
B. Class B
C. Class C
D. Class D
Q392. The voice data is transformed from analog to digital mode or vice-versa
by:
A. Internet Service Provider
B. Internet Service Provider
97
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
98
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q398. A specialized network device that determines the next network point to
which a data packet is forwarded toward its destination is called:
A. Gateway
B. Router
C. Firewall
D. Hub
Q400. Switch is a:
A. Phyical Layer device
B. Data Link Layer device
C. Network Layer device
D. Transport Layer device
99
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q403. Which of the following is not a protocol in the Application Layer of TCP/
IP suite?
A. SMTP
B. DNS
C. UDP
D. TELNET
Q407. Which one of the following is not true about DDR2 RAM?
A. It runs twice as fast as DDR
B. It is known as Dynamic Data Rate Two RAM
C. It is know as Double Data Rate Two RAM
D. It is volatile
100
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q409. Property that does not permit any person who signed any document to
deny it later is called:
A. Integrity
B. Validation
C. Maintenance
D. Non-Repudiation
101
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Relational model
D. Object-oriented models
102
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q417. The following device is used to connect one type of IEEE 802.x LAN to
another
A. Router
B. Repeater
C. Bridge
D. No device is necessary as they are all compatible and are hence
grouped under 802 series
Q418. The operating system is not responsible for which of the following
activities in connection with the process management
A. Creating and deleting both user and system processes.
B. Suspending and resuming processes.
C. Storage allocation.
D. Providing mechanism for deadlock handling
Q419. 127.0.0.1 is
A. Broadcase address
B. Loopback address
C. is default routing address
D. None of above
Q420. Which of the following is a feature of ActiveX controls that can both be
used as well as misused?
A. ActiveX controls can be reused
B. ActiveX controls can access system resources
C. Many pre-developed controls for performing many tasks are
available
D. Execution of ActiveX controls can be controlled using Internet
Explorer security settings
103
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q422. When data is accessed through both sequential and direct access
methods the process is called:
A. Sequential storage and retrieval
B. Direct access and retrieval
C. Indexed sequential storage and retrieval
D. None of the above
Q423. A computer that is exeremly fast and used for specialized applications
requiring immense mathematical calculations is:
A. Mainframe computer
B. Mini Computer
C. Super Computer
D. Hand held Device
Q424. Which one of the following is not a key issues in data and capacity
management?
A. How to effectively manage rapidly growing volume of data?
B. How to leverage data and storage technology to support business
needs?
C. What is the best data and storage management framework for an
enterprising business environment?
D. How to maintain the performance of a sytem?
104
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q425. What is not true about Open System Interconnection (OSI) model:
A. is a reference model
B. describes how information from a software application in one
computer moves through a network medium to a software
application in another computer
C. is a seven layered model
D. is a communication protocol.
105
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
106
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q435. When sending a signed message under a public key infrastructure, the
message is encrypted using the:
A. receiver’s private key
B. sender’s private key
C. receiver’s public key
D. sender’s public key and receiver’s private key
107
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q440. Where are the additional data and programs not used by the processor
stored?
A. Secondary storage
B. Input units
C. Output units
D. The CPU.
108
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. FTP security
D. None of the mentioned
Q447. The term used to describe the placement of the data entry function at
the scattered locations where the transactions occur is:
A. Distributed data entry
B. Distributed database
C. Distributed computing
D. Distributed risk management
109
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q448. In which way does the Combined Encryption combine symmetric and
assymmetric encryption?
A. The secret key is asymmetrically transmitted, the message itself
symmetrically.
B. First, the message is encrypted with symmetric encryption and
afterwards it is encrypted asymmetrically together with the key.
C. The secret key is symmetrically transmitted, the message itself
asymmetrically.
D. First, the message is encrypted with asymmetric encryption and
afterwards it is encrypted symmetrically together with the key.
110
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q452. Where are the additional data and programs not used by the processor
stored?
A. Secondary storage
B. Input units
C. Output units
D. The CPU.
111
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
C. Teleprocessing system
D. Centralized processing system
Q458. Microwave transmission, coaxial cables, and fiber optics are examples
of
A. Communication links
B. protocols
C. Internet working
D. Frames
Q459. The technique in shared programs that avoids interspersed printout from
several programe is:
A. Spooling
B. Queuing
C. Paging
D. Slicing
Q460. The term used to describe the placement of the data entry function at
the scattered locations where the transactions occur is:
A. Distributed data entry
B. Distributed database
C. Distributed computing
D. Distributed risk management
112
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q461. The effective size of the primary storage available for programs may
appear to be unlimited when the following concept is used:
A. Virtual storage
B. Memory caches
C. Buffering
D. Mirroring
Q463. In which way does the Combined Encryption combine symmetric and
assymmetric encryption?
A. The secret key is asymmetrically transmitted, the message itself
symmetrically.
B. First, the message is encrypted with symmetric encryption and
afterwards it is encrypted asymmetrically together with the key.
C. The secret key is symmetrically transmitted, the message itself
asymmetrically.
D. First, the message is encrypted with asymmetric encryption and
afterwards it is encrypted symmetrically together with the key.
113
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
Q465. The effective size of the primary storage available for programs may
appear to be unlimited when the following concept is used:
A. Virtual storage
B. Memory caches
C. Buffering
D. Mirroring
Q466. Microwave transmission, coaxial cables, and fiber optics are examples
of
A. Communication links
B. protocols
C. Internet working
D. Frames
Q467. The technique in shared programs that avoids interspersed printout from
several programe is:
A. Spooling
B. Queuing
C. Paging
D. Slicing
114
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
115
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
116
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
117
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
118
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 1
119
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Module 2 Questions
Q470. Which one of the following requirements of Virtual reality is concerned
with synchronisation?
A. User input
B. Visual perception
C. Spatiotemporal realism
D. Sound perception
Q472. Which stage in the software lifecycle does not require any maintenance?
A. Development or pre-delivery phase
B. Early operational phase
C. Mature operational phase
D. Evolution/replacement phase
120
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q478. While auditing the environment controls the auditor should confirm that
A. LAN file server facility has dust, smoke and other particulate
matters
B. Consumption of food, beverage and tobacco is allowed
121
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q481. Which of these enable a super computer’s CPU to share operations for
enhanced performance?
A. Pipelining
B. Parallelism
C. RISC
D. SMP
Q482. Which term often means a piece of code left behind in the system that
will allow the original programmer back into the system?
A. Trap Door
B. Flap Jack
C. Unicode
D. Stealth Code
122
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q483. Which of the following terms describes a form of dial-up access control
whereby the user dials the desired phone number, authenticates with
the server, hangs up, and then the server dials the client, establishing
the connection?
A. Dial Back
B. Redialing
C. Call Waiting
D. Call Forwarding
Q484. Which of the following gas-based fire suppression system would you
find in an unmanned computer facility?
A. Argon
B. Halon
C. Carbon-dioxide
D. Oxygen
Q485. In an ideally equipped data centre, the wall, ceiling, etc should be made
of fire resistant materials. For how long is it recommended that they
should resist a fire?
A. 2 Hours
B. 1 Hour
C. 30 Minutes
D. 3 Minutes
123
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q490. Which of the following need NOT be considered before hosting a new
online privacy policy?
A. Business practices
B. Business partners
124
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Proposed users
D. Nature of the site
125
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
126
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Password secrecy
D. Password storage
127
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q504. Which of the following types of database access control is the most
difficult to enforce?
A. Name-dependent access control
B. History-dependent access control
C. Content-dependent access control
D. Context-dependent access control
Q505. For physical and environmental security, in which of the following areas
should policies and procedures be framed?
A. Independent (third-party) assurances
B. Layout of facilities
C. System Development Life Cycle (SDLC)
D. None of the above
Q507. “If a thief steals an ATM card and tries to break the PIN number by
trying all combinations, what type of attack will it be classified as? “
A. Keystroke logging
B. Man in the middle
C. Biometric
D. Bruteforce
128
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q508. “Which of the following feature may seriously affect or nullify the utility
of audit trails? “
A. Passwords are not recorded in the audit trail.
B. Security administrator cannot amend the details in the audit trail.
C. Audit trail records can be amended by the users
D. Date and time stamps are recorded automatically.
129
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q512. “Identify the correct statement with respect to guidelines for data-entry
screens? “
A. Both bright colours and automatic tabbing are to be avoided
B. Both bright colours and automatic tabbing should be used as
often as possible
C. Bright colours should be avoided and automatic tabbing should
be used as often as possible
D. Bright colours should be used as often as possible while
automatic tabbing should be avoided.
Q513. A check to ensure that the same data is not keyed twice is called:
A. Sequence checks
B. Limit check
C. Missing data check
D. Duplicate check
130
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q516. In context of expert systems, moving down to the symptoms from a fault
is called as
A. Forward chaining
B. Forward integration
C. Backward chaining
D. Backward integration
Q517. “To prevent the unauthorized use of floppy drives, which of the following
controls is suitable? “
A. Switch controls
B. Cable locks
C. Port controls
D. Biometric mouse
131
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q520. Which of the following provides error detection and error correction?
A. Cyclic Redundancy Check
B. Checksum
C. Parity check
D. Hamming code
132
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
name is removed from the payroll, the program will activate another
piece of code to destroy vital files on the organi”
A. ActiveX
B. Logic Bomb
C. Virus
D. Denial of Service
133
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q529. Viruses that can change their appearance are known as:
A. Polymorphic virus
B. Boot sector virus
C. Stealth virus
D. Macro virus.
Q530. “If the series of data bits, 11001011, is received as 11001000 then it is
called a: “
A. Single bit error
B. Multiple-bit error
C. Burst error
D. Parity error
134
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Intangible losses
D. All of the above
135
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q540. “If the product number A5723 is coded as A5753, this is an example of
a: “
A. Truncation error
B. Double transposition error
C. Random error
D. Transcription error
136
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
137
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
138
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q550. “Which of the following would NOT protect a system from computer
viruses? “
A. Write protect all diskettes once they have been virus checked
B. Scan any new software before it is installed
C. “Do not allow vendors to run demonstration on company owned
machines “
D. Boot only from diskettes that were initially checked for viruses
139
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
140
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Physical design
D. Testing
141
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q564. Which of the following does not fall under the category of operational
controls?
A. Personnel security
B. Logical access control
C. Physical protection
D. Environmental protection
142
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. MPEG video
D. Virtual reality
Q570. Which of the following Embedded Operating Systems has a wide set of
features for networking?
A. Windows CE
B. Windows NT embedded
C. Embedded Linux
D. Palm OS
143
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q574. Which of the following image formats is for the Apple Macintosh range
of Computers?
A. GIF
B. JPEG
C. PICT
D. TIFF
Q575. In a Mouse, there are three rollers that can rotate. How many rollers
are actually responsible for the movement of the curser?
A. One
B. Two
144
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Three
D. None
Q576. A brokerage firm is moving into new office premises already equipped
with extensive telephone wiring. The firm is planning to install a PBX to
connect computers and office devices such as photocopiers, printers,
and facsimile machines. A limitation of usi
A. the firm would be dependent on others for system maintenance
B. coaxial cabling would have to be installed throughout the building
C. the system cannot easily handle large volumes of data
D. relocating devices in the office is an expensive and difficult task
Q577. A company uses a wide area network (WAN) to allow salesmen in the
field to remotely log onto to the office server using notebook computers
and dial-in modems. Which of the following methods would provide best
data security in such a situation?
A. end to end data encryption
B. dedicated phone lines
C. call-back features
D. enforcing regular password changes
145
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
146
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
147
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q589. Which of the following terms is commonly used for the agreement about
packaging and interpreting both data and control information, when two
devices in a data communications system are communicating?
A. Asynchronous communication
B. Synchronous communication
C. Communication protocol
D. Communication channel
148
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q592. Which of the mail processing technologies given below affects message
storage at the client end?
A. POP (Post Office Protocol)
B. MAPI (Messaging Application Programming Interface)
C. IMAP (Internet Message Access Protocol)
D. SMTP Simple Mail Transfer Protocol)
149
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q596. Artificial Intelligence is now being used in every sphere of life. Which of
the following options justifies the statement?
A. Ability to work in hazardous places
B. Ability to think like human beings
C. Ability to work in artificial environments
D. None of the above
Q598. Given below are major types of storage devices 1) Cache 2) Magnetic
disk 3) Flash 4) Main Memory 5) Tape Storage 6) Optical Storage Rank
them in the increasing order of their reading/writing capability.
A. 1,2,3,4,5,6
B. “5,6,2,3,4,1“
C. 6,5,4,3,2,1
D. 2,5,3,1,6,4
150
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q602. Single copy of a software product installed on the server and used by
all the connected clients is an example of:
A. End user piracy
B. Industrial Piracy
C. Corporate Piracy
D. Copyright Infringement
151
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q604. The Fibre Distributed Data Interface (FDDI) is a dual ring LAN that uses
a fibre optic cable. The ring is segmented when
A. One ring fails
B. One station fails
C. Two rings fail
D. Two rings fail
Q607. When planning a software audit, the management does not consider:
A. The timing of the audit
B. Persons who should conduct the audit
C. Keeping the audit objective secret
D. Providing access to the required facilities
152
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q608. Which is the function that the audit software does not perform?
A. Scan each machine separately
B. Decide on the sampling method to be used
C. Report the program that it does not recognise
D. Identify software that is loaded, completely or partially
153
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
154
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Inheritance
D. Polymorphism
Q619. Which of the following do not come under the Workload Operational
Policy?
A. Backup and disaster recovery systems
B. Naming conventions
C. Job specification design
D. Training and support functions
Q620. Which of the following data items is most likely to appear in the
operations audit trail and not the accounting audit trail for the
communication subsystem?
A. image of message received at each node traversed in the
network
B. unique identifier of the source node
C. message transit time between nodes and at nodes
D. unique identifier of the person/process authorising dispatch of the
message
155
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q623. Which of the following is not a true statement, with respect to the
implementation of an automated job scheduling system in the computer
center?
A. it ensures that all jobs are run
B. it ensures that jobs run in sequence
C. it prevents jobs from being delayed
D. it ensures the elimination of job definition and job set-up errors
156
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q625. Which of the following is not an important control step of the input/output
control group?
A. verifying input authorisation
B. identifying questionable data
C. verifying control totals
D. establishing control over output
Q626. Which of the following is not an objective in the analysis and planning
of storage management?
A. To store and manage large amounts of data efficiently
B. To speed up data retrieval
C. To decide on software that has to be loaded on the server
D. To bring down the cost of data storage, while keeping risk under
manageable limits
Q627. Which of the following is true with regard to a good Intrusion Detection
System Software?
A. It can investigate intrusions without human intervention
B. It can compensate for exploits based on errors in network
protocols
C. It is able to resist unauthorised modifications to itself
D. It is able to analyse all of the traffic on a busy network
157
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q629. Which of the following is true with regards to system and application
software?
A. System software uses application software to interact with
computer hardware
B. Application software uses system software to interact with
computer hardware
C. Both system and application software independently interact with
computer hardware
D. None of the above
Q631. Which of the following risks is not greater in an electronic funds transfer
(EFT) environment than in a manual system using paper transactions?
A. higher cost per transaction
B. unauthorised access and activity
C. duplicate transaction processing
D. inadequate backup and recovery capabilities
Q632. Which of the following statements is (are) correct regarding the Internet
as a commercially viable network?
A. companies must apply to the Internet to gain permission to create
a home page to engage in electronic commerce
158
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
159
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Password capturing
D. Password spoofing
160
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q644. While classifying controls on the basis of the operations involved, input
control can be classified as -
A. Organisation control
B. General control
C. Processing control
D. Application control
Q645. Which of the following logical access exposures involves changing data
before, or as it is entered into the computer?
A. Data diddling
B. Trojan horse
161
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Worm
D. Salami technique
Q646. While reviewing firewall logs, the auditor does not attempt to keep track
of:
A. Unsuccessful logins
B. Successful logins
C. Unsuccessful logins
D. Unsuccessful logouts
162
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q651. During a review of system access rules, an IS Auditor noted that the
System Administrator has unlimited access to all data and program files.
Such access authority is:
A. Appropriate, but all access should be logged.
B. Appropriate, because System Administrator has to back up all
data and program files.
C. Inappropriate, since access should be limited to a need-to-know
basis, regardless of position.
D. Inappropriate, because System Administrator has the capacity to
run the system.
163
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
C. Trap doors
D. Trojan horses
Q654. Access to the work area restricted through a swipe card or only
through otherwise authorised process and when visitors enter the work
area they are issued a pass and escorted in and out by a concerned
employee. These type of controls are called -
A. Organisational controls
B. Physical access controls
C. Logical access controls
D. Operational controls
Q655. Which of the following concerns associated with the World Wide Web
would be addressed by a firewall?
A. Unauthorized access from outside the organization
B. Unauthorized access from within the organization
C. Delay in Internet connectivity
D. Delay in downloading using file transfer protocol
164
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q659. For a high security installation the most effective physical access control
devices is:
A. User ID and password
B. Magnetic Card reader
C. Bio-metric devices
D. Laser activated photo identification.
Q660. A firewall access control list may filter access based on each of the
following parameters EXCEPT:
A. Port.
B. Service type.
C. Network interface card (NIC).
D. Internet protocol (IP) address.
165
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q662. During a fire in a data center, an automatic fire suppression would First:
A. Cut power to data processing equipment
B. Sound an alarm and begin a timed countdown
C. Discharge the fire suppression gas
D. Disengage the uninterruptible power supply
166
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
167
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q670. The scope of a logical access controls review would include the
evaluation of:
A. effectiveness and efficiency of IT security and related controls.
B. confidentiality, integrity and availability of information to authorized
users.
C. access to systems software and application software to ensure
compliance with the access policy.
D. access to user authorization levels, parameters and operational
functions through application software.
168
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q674. An IS auditor is assigned to help design the data security, data integrity
and business continuity aspects of an application under development.
Which of the following provides the MOST reasonable assurance that
corporate assets are protected when the appl
A. A certification review conducted by the internal auditor.
B. A certification review conducted by the assigned IS auditor.
C. Specifications by the user on the depth and content of the
certification review.
D. An independent review conducted by another equally experienced
IS auditor.
Q676. Tools used to identify risks include all of the following, except
A. Audit workflow software
B. Risk analysis questionnaire
C. Flowchart of operations
D. Insurance policy checklist
169
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q678. Which IT audit area involves formal statements that describe a course
of action that should be implemented to restore or provide accuracy,
efficiency, or adequate control of audit subject?
A. Recommendations an audit report
B. Conclusion of an audit report
C. Audit tests
D. Findings of the audit reports
Q680. Compliance with laws and regulations is a key business risk because
of
A. The sheet number of laws and regulations
B. The controls outlines in COBIT
C. The impact on security of an organization
D. The automation of financial processes
170
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q682. Risk retention (self-insurance) methods should meet all the following
criteria, except
A. Develop an internal risk management group to monitor exposures
B. Risk should be spread physically to distribute exposure across
several locations
C. Determine whether a self-insurance reserve should be established
to cover a possible loss
D. Determine the maximum exposure to loss
171
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q686. Cyberlaw is
A. Law governing use of the computer and the Internet
B. State law
C. Central law
D. International law
Q687. Which IT audit area involves formal statements that describe a course
of action that should be implemented to restore or provide accuracy,
efficiency, or adequate control of audit subject?
A. Recommendations an audit report
B. Conclusion of an audit report
C. Audit tests
D. Findings of the audit reports
172
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q692. Compliance with laws and regulations is a key business risk because
of
A. The sheet number of laws and regulations
B. The controls outlines in COBIT
C. The impact on security of an organization
D. The automation of financial processes
173
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q694. Risk retention (self-insurance) methods should meet all the following
criteria, except
A. Develop an internal risk management group to monitor exposures
B. Risk should be spread physically to distribute exposure across
several locations
C. Determine whether a self-insurance reserve should be established
to cover a possible loss
D. Determine the maximum exposure to loss
174
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
Q700. Tools used to identify risks include all of the following, except
A. Audit workflow software
B. Risk analysis questionnaire
C. Flowchart of operations
D. Insurance policy checklist
Q702. Cyberlaw is
A. Law governing use of the computer and the Internet
B. State law
C. Central law
D. International law
175
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
176
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
177
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 2
178
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Module 3 Questions
Q703. Which of these options is not a feature of VPN?
A. Uses Internet
B. Uses intranet
C. Uses extranet
D. Uses common standards
Q705. What are the categories under which X.25 devices fall?
A. DCE only
B. DTE and PSEs
C. DTE and DCE only
D. DTE, DCE and PSEs
179
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q710. Which one of the following local area network devices functions as a
data regenerator?
A. Network interface card
B. Switch
C. Repeater
D. Modems
180
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Relational model
D. Object-oriented models
181
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q717. A concept in geometry, that gives you the location of a point, given its
distance from three other points is-
A. GPS
B. Trilateration
C. Pseudo random code
D. Satellite Signals
182
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Error detection
D. Error correction
Q722. “The prototyping approach does not assume the existence of: “
A. Reusable software
B. Formal specifications languages
C. Detail requirements document
D. Fourth-generation programming languages
183
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
184
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
185
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q734. “Which one of the following methodologies requires effi cient system
requirement analysis? “
A. Reverse engineering
B. The Delphi Design (JAD)
C. Joint application Design (JAD)
D. Traditional system development life cycle.
186
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
187
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Implementation
D. Maintenance
Q744. Electronic methods of data transfer are involved in all of the following
except:
A. remote batch processing
B. stand alone data processing
C. message switching
D. time sharing
Q745 “An IS auditor who plans on testing the connection of two or more
system components that pass information from one area to another
would use: “
A. Pilot testing.
B. Parallel testing.
C. Interface testing.
D. Regression testing.
188
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q748. Which among the following hacking techniques DOES NOT facilitate
impersonation?
A. Forging the signature
B. Packet replay
C. Interception
D. Relay
Q750. “In which of the following SDLC (System Development Life Cycle)
phases, is the IS auditoSection 1s participation unnecessary? “
A. Feasibility study
B. User requirements
C. Programming
D. Manual specifications
Q751. “In a system development project, the formal change control mechanism
is begun after: “
A. Completing the system planning document
189
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
190
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q756. Which of the following would NOT normally be part of a feasibility study?
A. Identifying the cost savings of a new system.
B. Defining the major requirements of the new system.
C. Determining the productivity gains of implementing a new system.
D. Estimating a pay-back schedule for cost incurred in implementing
the system.
191
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q764. The least commonly used medium for local area network (LAN)
environment is:
A. Fiber optics cable
B. Twisted-pair (shielded) cable
C. Twisted-pair (unshielded) cable
D. Coaxial cable
192
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
193
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
194
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q773. “ PC† based analysis and design tools are used along with mainframe
computer-based tools. Identify the CASE tool that is required in this
situation. “
A. Diagramming tools
B. Simulation tools
C. Export / import tools
D. Diagram checking tools
195
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q779. “An auditor evaluating a software package purchase contract will NOT
expect the contract to include. “
A. License cost
B. Maintenance cost
C. Operational costs
D. Outage costs
196
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
197
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q787. “Which of the following project completion paths represents the critical
path? “
A. PUW
B. PTVW
C. RVW
D. QSVW
198
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
199
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q793. “For which of the following does the IS auditor NOT take part in the
development team deliberations? “
A. Ensuring adequacy of data integrity controls.
B. Ensuring adequacy of data security controls.
C. Ensuring that there are no cost and time overruns
D. Ensuring that documentation is accurate life cycle project?
Q794. “An IS auditor involved as a team member in the detailed system design
phase of a system under development would be MOST concerned with:
A. Internal control procedures.
B. user acceptance test schedules.
C. Adequacy of the user training program.
D. Clerical progress for resubmission of rejected items.
Q796. ____________ do not have an address table when they are first
installed
A. Simple bridges
B. Multiport bridges
C. Transparent bridges
D. None of the above
200
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
201
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
202
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Spoofing attack
D. Disabling of network.
203
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q810 For ensuring adequate security of LAN, the auditor must exercise control
over
A. Password
B. Policies
C. Firewall
D. Applets
Q811 An electronic device that combines data from several low speed
communication lines into a single high-speed line is a :
A. modem
B. multiplexer
C. channel
D. Link editor
204
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q815. While auditing the logical access control, the auditor need not review:
A. Authorisation of dial in access
B. Audit trail
C. Bugs in the firewall
D. Password management
205
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q819. Which RAID (Redundant Array of Independent Disks) type makes use
of embedded operating systems?
A. RAID-3
B. RAID-6
C. RAID-53
D. RAID-7
206
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Coaxial cable
D. Ethernet
207
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Server control
D. All of the above
Q831. While reviewing firewall logs, the auditor does not attempt to keep track
of:
A. Unsuccessful logins
B. Successful logins
C. Unsuccessful logins
D. Unsuccessful logouts
208
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q832. Normal Post Office Protocol (POP) session has three different stages:1)
Transaction state 2) Update state 3) Authorisation state.The correct
sequence is
A. 1,2,3
B. 3,2,1
C. 3,1,2
D. 2,3,1
Q833. Which of the following features is least likely to be found in a real time
application?
A. User manuals
B. Preformatted screens
C. Automatic error correction
D. Turnaround documents
Q834. The voice data is transformed from analog to digital mode or vice-versa
by:
A. Internet Service Provider
B. Gateway Server
C. VoIP Service Provider
D. PSTN Station
Q836. Security problem(s) that a PC can create in a Local Area Network are:
A. Multiplication Factor
B. Channel Factor
209
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Both and
D. Division Factor
Q840. Which SAN (Storage Area Network) architecture is most widely used?
A. Optical fibers
B. Fiber loop
C. Mainframes
D. Network attached storage
210
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q841. Under normal conditions, which of the following offers the fastest
connection to the Internet?
A. Analog connections
B. ISDN
C. DSL
D. Cable
211
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. The landscape
D. The subscriber’s conversation time
Q847. #NAME?
A. PGP (Privacy Good Policy)
B. S/MIME (Secure/Multipurpose Internet Mail Extension)
C. PEP (Privacy Enhance Mail)
D. MIME Object Security Services
212
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q850. ________ are self replicating malicious code that bring down the speed
of the processor on entering a network, and are not dependent on the
action of the user
A. Viruses
B. Worms
C. Trojan Horse
D. Spoofing
Q851. __________ are Wireless LAN devices that act like the
“hubs” in traditional LANs and provide connectivity to
the user irrespective of his location.
A. Data carriers
B. Transmitters
C. Receivers
D. Access Points
Q852. A computer can call into primary storage only that portion of a program
and data needed immediately while storing the remaining portions in an
auxiliary storage device. This feature is commonly known as:
A. compiling
B. multiplexor channeling
C. virtual storage
D. on-line processing
213
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q854 A major problem in networking is the slow rate of data transfer. Which
of the following would help counter this problem?
A. Data formatting
B. Decentralised control
C. Allocating adequate bandwidth
D. All of the above
Q855 A major way in which modern quality systems used to support the
information systems function differ from traditional quality systems is:
A. modern quality systems focus on customer satisfaction as the
primary goal
B. modern quality systems focus on the production of zero-defect
software as the primary goal
C. traditional quality systems fail to recognise the inherent conflict
that can exist among some goals established for an information
systems project
D. traditional quality systems do not take into account the need for
an independent QA group and independent testing
214
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
215
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q862. Which one of the following transmission media is unsuitable for handling
intrabuilding data or voice communications?
A. Unshielded Twisted pair
B. Microwave transmission
C. Shielded Twisted pair
D. Optical fiber
Q865 While down sizing a material inventory system, data center personnel
considered redundant array of inexpensive disks (RAID for the inventory
database. One reason to use RAID is to ensure that :
A. all data can still be reconstructed even if one drive fails
B. all data are split evenly across pairs of drives
C. snap shots of all transactions are taken
D. write time is minimised to avoid concurrency conflicts
216
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q868. LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocols) has an edge over X.500
in Directory Enabled Networks (DEN), because it supports:
A. Static routing
B. Dynamic routing
C. Both
D. None
Q869. Which of the following statements regarding security concerns for lap
top computers is NOT false?
A. Decentralised controls over the selection and acquisition of
hardware and software is a major concern
B. The primary methods of controls usually involves general controls
217
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q870. Which of the following tool allots a specific amount of space to packets
to handle traffic effectively?
A. Priority Queuing
B. Custom Queuing
C. Weighted Flow Queuing
D. FIFO, Basic store and forward capability
Q872. Which of the following would not normally be considered a typical file
structure for a database management system:
A. Hierarchical structure
B. Batched sequential structure
C. Network structure
D. Relational structure
218
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q875. Which of these wireless technologies deploys Radio Frequency (RF) for
a WLL (Wireless Local Loop)?
A. Analog Cellular
B. Digital Cellular
C. Personal Communication system (PCS)
D. Proprietary systems
Q877. Which one of the following computer systems is best to provide parallel
processing of documents in a business environment?
A. Network Management systems
B. Database Management systems
219
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Workflow systems
D. Imaging and Mirroring systems
220
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q883. Which one of the following is NOT true relating to the use of fiber optics:
A. Data is transmitted rapidly
B. Fiber optic cable is small and flexible
C. They are unaffected by electrical interference
D. It has high risk of wire tapping
Q884. Which one of the following is the most essential activity for effective
computer capacity planning:
A. Scheduling of documents
B. Planning of adequate security and controls in the computer center
C. Estimating electrical load
D. Workload forecasting
221
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q886. Which one of the following network types will play an important role in
implementing E-commerce?
A. Local area network
B. Wireless Local area network
C. Value-added network
D. Internet Servers Providers’ network
Q887. Which one of the following pair of items is a primary cause of signal
distortion in data communications?
A. Sudden change in weather and temperature
B. Attenuation and propagation delay
C. Phase hits and amplitude jitter
D. Number of concurrent users
Q888. Which one of the following pairs of protocols greatly conflict with
each other in the same pair of protocols? (TCP/IP is transmission
control protocol/Internet protocol, ISO/OSI is international standards
organization /open systems interconnection, SNA is
A. ISO/OSI and GOSIP
B. TCP/IP and ISO/OSI
C. ISO/OSI and SNA.
D. SNA and TCP/IP
Q889. Which one of the following statement is true with respect to VSAT?
A. Usage is restricted to geographical boundaries
B. Very high cost due to the usage of fibre optic cables
C. Though quality of data is high,it doesn’t support high bandwidth
D. It operates in two frequency bands namely Ku and C
222
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
223
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Mbone
D. Backbone
Q895. All computers have a central processing unit (CPU) that works in
conjunction with peripheral devices. The function of the CPU are:
A. Input, Output and arithmetic-logic
B. Control and Output
C. Control and arithmetic-logic
D. Input and Control
Q896. An agreement between two computer systems on the ways in which the
data to be transmitted between them shall be packed and interpreted is
called
A. Communication channel
B. Communication protocol
C. Synchronous mode of transmission
D. Asynchronous mode of transmission
224
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q898. Analyzing data protection requirements for installing a local area network
(LAN) does not include:
A. Uninterruptible power source
B. Fault tolerance
C. Operating systems
D. Destruction of the logging and auditing data
225
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
226
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q906. Which of the following statements is not a benefit for using the Voice-
over-Internet protocol?
A. High quality voice
B. Security
C. Use of vocoder
D. Use of TDMA
Q907. The IP address 135.0.0.2 (in decimal octet notation) belongs to which
IP addressing class?
A. Class A
B. Class B
C. Class C
D. Class E
227
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q910. Different controls are required in the software whether they are re
purchased, customised or developed. The auditor while auditing the
LAN determines that
A. There exists a license agreement for purchased software
B. All the users have contact number of the vendor
C. Users can ask the vendor to customize the software as required
by them
D. All the software used by the company is accessible by everybody
on the LAN
228
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q915. Extensible Markup Language or XML differs from HTML in the sense
that
A. It has predefined tags and semantics
B. It allows the applications to define its own tags and semantics
C. It has a larger set of predefined tags and semantics
D. None of the above
Q916. Hardware controls usually are those built into the equipment by the
manufacturer. One such control, an echo check , is best described as:
A. a component that signals the control unit that an operation has
been performed
B. two units that provide read-after-write and dual-read capabilities
C. double wiring of the CPU and peripheral equipment to prevent
malfunctioning
D. validations logic to fields and records based o their
interrelationships with controls established for the batch.
229
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q918. If a web site using the Internet Information Server from Microsoft does
not run dynamic scripts, which of the following tools can harden the
Web Server?
A. IIS Lockdown
B. CGI
C. URLScan
D. Microsoft Management Console
Q919. If possible, the quality goals for specific information systems project
should be formulated by:
A. the sponsor of the project
B. the project’s quality control group
C. QA personnel
D. the project leader
230
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q921. In 802.5 Token Ring LAN, when a data frame is in circulation, where is
the token?
A. At the receiving station
B. At the sending station
C. With a special station called Monitor station
D. Both the sending and receiving stations have a copy of the token
231
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q928. In the audit of LAN, inventory control helps the auditor in determining
the effectiveness of IS operations. Which of the following is not correct
with respect to inventory control?
A. Identify the person responsible for disposing obsolete or badly
damaged LAN equipment
B. Inventory control is maintained of all LAN software
C. Hardware components are marked with identification number
which cannot be erased or removed
D. Virus checking software is in use
232
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q929. In today’s business environment one can hardly find a company without
a computer. But an IPF (Information processing facility is typically a
large expense, in planning the physical location of the computer, the
primary consideration for selecting a site i
A. minimise the distance that data control personnel must travel to
deliver data and reports
B. provide security
C. be easily accessible by a majority of company personnel
D. be in the top floor
Q931. In which of the following services is Public Key Infrastructure (PKI) and
Digital certification not a useful feature.
A. Virtual Private Networks
B. Web Authentication
C. File Encryption
D. Circuit Switching
233
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
234
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q937. Most computer systems have hardware controls that are built in by the
computer manufacturer. Common hardware controls are :
A. duplicate circuitry, echo checks, tape file protection and internal
header labels
B. duplicate circuitry, echo check and internal header labels
C. tape file protection, cryptographic protection and limit checks
D. duplicate circuitry, echo checks and dual reading
Q939 To which of the following resource type are the most complex action
privileges assigned?
A. hardware
B. software
C. commodity
D. data
235
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
236
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q947. Organizations which are unable to create and maintain their own private
networks are more likely to use
A. a wide area network
B. vendor delivered electronic mail system
C. fast-packet switching
D. public switched network
237
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q948. Out of the following pairs of services, which provides an access control
over a network of computers
A. Identification and authentication
B. Certification and accreditation
C. Access control lists and access control privileges
D. Accreditation and assurance
Q949. Personal Computers and Laptops have both a floppy disk drive and a
hard disk drive. The major difference between the two types of storage
is that a hard disk :
A. Has much larger storage capacity than a floppy disk and can also
access information much more quickly
B. is a direct access storage medium whereas a floppy disk is a
sequential access storage medium
C. provides an automatic audit trail, whereas a floppy disk does not
D. is suitable for an online system whereas a floppy disk is not
238
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
239
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q956. Short Message Service (SMS) cannot be used to provide which of the
following services?
A. Notify a user if new email comes to user’s email account
B. Inform a user about news headlines or weather
C. Provide transmission of short messages between two users
D. Display a graphic-rich web page
Q957. Simple Software has just purchased a minicomputer. The make and
module selected will allow the company to attach additional units as
its needs expand. The company has taken advantage of a concept in
hardware design known as :
A. Emulation
B. Networking
C. Modularity
D. Standardisation
240
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q959. The auditor while reviewing the local area network (LAN) takes into
consideration the purpose and processing environment. In the pre-audit
phase the auditor
A. Considers LAN utilities which are used by the company and take
training on the same
B. Ensures whether the hardware inventory contains a unique
identification number
C. Ensures whether the procedure exists for operation staff to
manage change control
D. Review the problem resolution log to determine if the problems
are recurring
Q960. The best control to ensure that a customer uses a debit/credit card
carefully is:
A. to make the customer liable if the careless use of a card leads to
a fraud,
B. blocking a card if it is not used for a period of 3 months
C. to educate the customer about the importance of card security
D. enforced periodic change of the PINs
Q961. The database administrator is not responsible for which one of the
following functions?
A. Physical design of a database
B. Security of a database
C. Coordinate and resolve conflicting needs and desires of users in
their diverse application areas
D. Logical design of a database
Q962. The following device is used to connect one type of IEEE 802.x LAN to
another
A. Router
B. Repeater
241
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Bridge
D. No device is necessary as they are all compatible and are hence
grouped under 802 series
Q963. The following method of obtaining customer selected PINs does not
require the cryptographic generation of a reference number, to initially
associate the PIN with the customer’s account number?
A. entry via phone
B. PIN entry at the issuer’s premises
C. PIN entry via a secure terminal
D. PIN entry at acquirer’s premises
Q964. The following method of PIN validation seems to result in the fewest
control problems?
A. allow the customer to make a small number of PIN entry
attempts, close the account after the limit has been reached, and
retain the card
B. allow the customer to make a small number of PIN entry
attempts, do not close the account after the limit has been
reached, but retain the card
C. allow a reasonable number of PIN entry attempts, close the
account after the limit has been reached, but do not retain the
card
D. allow a reasonable number of PIN entry attempts, close the
account after the limit has been reached, and retain the card
242
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q967. The internal auditor’s first job while trying to identify the components of
a telecommunication system posing the GREATEST threat, shall be
A. Identify the business objectives of the network
B. Review the network with reference to the ISO/OSI model of seven
layers
C. Identify the various layers of ISO/OSI model to which each
component belongs
D. Estimate the operating costs of the communication subsystem
243
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q969. The major reason why quality metrics need to be chosen for a specific
information systems project is:
A. to alleviate conflict between stakeholders
B. to reduce the amount of monitoring of compliance with standards
that QA personnel will have to undertake
C. to clarify the basis on which QA personnel will evaluate whether
quality goals have been met
D. to alleviate conflict between the Statutory Auditors and Information
Systems Auditors
Q970. Which feature of the Interior Gateway Routing Protocol (IGRP) prevents
large loops of routers?
A. Poison-reverse updates
B. Split-horizon updates
C. Hold down
D. Composite metric
244
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
245
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q979. The relationship with vendors is important from the view of maintenance
of the systems and servicing. The auditor in his review of LAN ensures
that software meets the demand of the company and
A. The vendor reliability is not important
B. The license agreement exists
C. The vendor support for the installation,training need not exist
D. The software is purchased without approval of the senior officials
246
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q982. The use of programming aids, data and instructions that are prepared
for one computer and can be used on another computer without
conversion or program modifications are examples of :
A. Modularity
B. Interfacing
C. Sequencing
D. Portability
Q983. To connect to an FTP site without being a registered user, one needs
to enter:
A. login name=anonymous : password=email address
B. login name=email address ; password=anonymous
C. login name=anonymous ; password=anonymous
D. cannot log on without being a registered user
247
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q987. Use of a local area network has its own restrictions when compared to
a wide area network. Which one of the following is not a restriction?
A. The number of workstations that can be connected to a network
B. The length of cable to connect a workstation to the network
C. A single link failure, a repeater failure, or a break in the cable
could disable a large part or all of the network.
D. The ability of a personal computer to act as a data terminal
248
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q990. What does NAT mean in the context of Firewalls and Security?
A. NAT (Network Attack Terminator) and is a program used to hunt
and destroy malicious packets.
B. NAT, Network Administration Terminal,is an application-proxy
firewall and inspects incoming packets
C. NAT, Network Address Translation, hides the internal addressing
scheme in the network
D. NAT, Network Authentication tool,identifies authorised users and
allows them remote access
249
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q992. What happens when the Session Manager opts for a persistent session?
A. Session data is stored permanently in the database
B. Session data for each transaction is stored in the database
C. Session data is stored in the memory for a limited time
D. Session data is not related to a persistent session
Q995. “What is the similarity between a GSM (Global System for Mobile
Communication) network and EDGE (Enhanced Data for GSM
Environment)?“
A. Both use the TDMA frame structure
B. Both deliver a data rate of 384 Kbps
C. Both use the same transceiver unit
D. Both use phase shift modulation
250
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q996. When three or more nodes are linked together through a single
communication medium it is termed as,
A. Ring Logical Topology
B. Point-to-Point Topology
C. Multipoint Topology
D. Bus Logical Topology
Q999. When data is accessed through both sequential and direct access
methods the process is called:
A. Sequential storage and retrieval
B. Direct access and retrieval
C. Indexed sequential storage and retrieval
D. None of the above
251
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1000. When emails are exchanged over the Internet, one server handles
incoming mails and the other outgoing. With respect to this, which of
the following options is true?
A. SMTP handles incoming mails and POP3 handles outgoing.
B. POP3 handles incoming mails and SMTP handles outgoing.
C. Microsoft Outlook handles incoming mails and Outlook Express
handles outgoing.
D. Outlook Express handles incoming mails and Microsoft Outlook
handles outgoing.
Q1001. When sending a signed message under a public key infrastructure, the
message is encrypted using the:
A. receiver’s private key
B. sender’s private key
C. receiver’s public key
D. sender’s public key and receiver’s private key
Q1002. When the exchange of information is the primary purpose for installing a
computer system, with an information repository accessible to its users,
the BEST system is:
A. Electronic Bullet Board System
B. Electronic Mail System
C. Private Branch Exchange (PBX)
D. Fax/modem software
252
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1004. When users of an information system are dispersed over a wide area
and are authorized to use dial-up lines for getting access to confidential
data, the BEST form of control for data security and confidentiality is
A. forced change of password after every day
B. end-to-end encryption
C. dial-disconnect-callback features
D. dedicated telephone lines
Q1006. Which among the following is a distinct benefit of installing a Local Area
Network (LAN ?
A. LANs enable sharing of resources like hardware, software and
data
B. LANs prevent virus attack
C. LANs provide better change management control
D. LANs provide greater confidentiality of data than other systems
Q1007. Which area of the ISO Network management Model is responsible for
identifying problems, logging reports and notifying the users, so that the
network runs effectively?
A. Performance Management
B. Accounting Management
C. Fault Management
D. Configuration Management
253
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1009. Which feature gives Time Division Multiple Access the edge over other
spread spectrum technologies?
A. Hierarchical cell structures
B. Extended TDMA
C. Elimination of interference
D. Reduced infrastructure costs
254
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1012. Which of the following activities should not be permitted when operators
use a communications network control terminal:
A. Monitoring network activity levels
B. down line loading a program
C. transmitting system warning and status messages
D. altering the audit trail to correct an error
Q1014. Which of the following requires two different keys for encryption and
decryption:
A. Symmetric Cryptography
B. Asymmetric Cryptography
C. Cryptanalysis
D. Cryptology
255
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1016. Which of the following best describes the role of QA management with
respect to the information systems function?
A. Carrying out a post implementation audit/review of the application
systems of a information systems function
B. monitoring IS activities for compliance with IS standards
C. advising information systems development staff on the quality of
the requirements specification an design specification that they
have prepared
D. working with internal auditors to devise a program of compliance
testing and substantive testing activities for the information
systems function
Q1017. Which of the following characteristics is not associated with a public key
cryptosystem?
A. the encryption key can be known to all communication users
B. the processing time required in private key cryptosystem is faster
than that of public key cryptosystem
C. the decryption key should be kept a secret
D. the decryption key is the same as the encryption key
Q1019. Which of the following decisions most likely cannot be made on the
basis of performance monitoring statistics that are calculated:
A. whether new hardware/system software resources are needed
B. whether unauthorised use is being made of hardware/system
software resources
256
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1020. Which of the following decisions most likely could not be made on the
basis of reports prepared from the maintenance log:
A. whether to move files from one storage medium to another to
reduce read/write errors
B. whether only valid and authorised transactions were processed
C. whether a storage medium should be retired
D. whether a master file should be stored on a particular storage
medium
Q1021. Which of the following does not reflect good control over use or
removable storage media?
A. Personnel at off-site locations should receive and issue backup
files only in accordance with an authorised schedule or a signed
requisition
B. project managers should maintain records of media use
associated with the application systems over which they have
responsibility
C. sensitive files and non sensitive files should be stored on the
same removable storage medium
D. backup for all media except diskettes should be kept off site and
access to them must be restricted
257
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. resources provided/denied
D. modifications to private keys
Q1024. Which of the following features in Internet Information Server (IIS) 5.0
from Microsoft logs the CPU resources consumed by Web Services?
A. Application Protection feature
B. Centralised Administration
C. Kerberos
D. Process Accounting
Q1025. Which of the following features is not a part of DSL but of ADSL?
A. Use of Plain Old Telephone Service (POTS)
B. Use of copper wire as transmission medium
C. Facilitates more downstream rather than upstream transfer
D. Provides more bandwidth for voice
258
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1027. Which of the following incidents can seriously damage a digital signature
system?
A. compromise of a key server’s private key
B. compromise of a receiver’s private key
C. compromise of a sender’s private key
D. use of a fake public key
Q1030 Which of the following is considered the greatest threat to the corporate
network, as far as cyber theft is concerned:
A. Business partners who have authorised access to the network
B. External parties not having authorised access to the network
C. Suppliers and customers who have authorised access to the
network
D. Employees who are connected to the corporate network
259
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
260
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
261
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1038. Which of the following is not a part of the Global System for Mobile
Communication (GSM) network?
A. Telecommunication standard Institute (ETSI)
B. Switching System (SS)
C. Base Station System (BSS)
D. Operation and Support System (OSS)
262
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1042. Which of the following is not an audit objective in the review of hardware
acquisition?
A. ensuring that adequate information for sound management
decision making is available prior to contracting for the purchase,
rent or lease of new equipment
B. ensuring that the vendors are provided with appropriate and
uniform data for submission of bids according to management
approved specifications and guidelines
C. Ensuring that provisions are made to minimise damage or abuse
to hardware and to maintain the hardware in good operational
condition
D. Ensure that management’s hardware acquisition plan has taken
into consideration technological obsolescence.
263
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
264
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1049. Which of the following provides mobile user network access over an air
interface in Wireless IP?
A. Core network
B. End-user Services Network
C. Radio Access Network
D. GSM
265
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1055. Which of the following principles should guide the ways in which QA
personnel monitor compliance with information systems standards?
A. QA personnel should use automated tools to ensure compliance
with information systems standards
B. QA personnel should seek to understand the reasons for a
compliance failure so that they can advise management
266
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1056. Which of the following principles should not guide the way in which QA
personnel report to management?
A. the recommendation that QA personnel make should be backed
up by concrete facts
B. stakeholders should be informed of the contents of reports before
they are released to management
C. the recipients of project based reports should be agreed upon at
the start of a project
D. QA report must degenerate into a long list of defects that have
been identified
Q1057. Which of the following security practices are supported by most remote
control program products when accessing a host workstation on a local
area network?
A. Matching user ID and name with password
B. Principle of highest privilege should be implemented to perform
the file backup function
C. Limiting access to local drives and directories
D. Controlling file-transfer rights
267
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
268
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. Design bugs
D. Data bugs
269
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1069. Identify the one that is NOT a key concept of object-oriented technology.
A. Encapsulation
B. Idempotence
C. Polymorphism
D. Inheritance
270
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1075. Feasibility study may not cover the ___________ aspects of a project:
A. Economic
B. Technical
C. Legal
D. Personal
271
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1076. Risk analysis is MOST useful when applied during which phase of the
system development process?
A. Project initiation
B. System Construction
C. Acceptance Testing
D. Implementation Planning
Q1080. A type of SDLC model where a time box can be used to limit the time
available for producing a working system.
A. Prototype
B. Spiral
272
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
C. RAD
D. Waterfall
Q1082. Person responsible for overall cost and time lines of a project is:
A. Project Manager
B. Network Engineer
C. Team Leader
D. Systems Analysts
Q1085. Which of the following is true with regard to White Box Testing?
A. Output of the program code is not required before the beginning
of the code.
273
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1086. Artificial Intelligence is now being used in every sphere of life. Which of
the following options justifies the statement?
A. Ability to work in hazardous places
B. Ability to think like human beings
C. Ability to work in artificial environments
D. None of the above
Q1088. During the detailed design phase of SDLC, which one of the following
tasks performed?
A. Defining control, security, and audit requirements
B. Developing screen flows with specifications
C. Identifying major purpose(s) of the system
D. Developing system justification
274
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1092. In which testing is done by using the same test data in the new and old
system, and the output results are compared.
A. Unit Testing
B. Parallel Testing
C. Penetration Testing
D. All of the above
275
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1094. With respect to various phases in the SDLC which of the following is
least likely to vary ?
A. Conduct of each phase
B. Sequence in which phases are performed
C. Presence of each phase
D. Resources needed to perform each phase
Q1097. A project manager has asked that you advise him of the potential risk
associated with the use of timebox development techniques in a system
development project. Which of the following would NOT be good
advice?
A. That the timebox technique should only be applied to projects that
can be completed within a reasonable timeframe.
B. For the timebox approach to be effective, end-users and
management should have agreed to core functionality to be
developed in the timebox.
276
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1100. Which one of the following is not true about emergency changes?
A. They are Required to resolve system problems and enable critical
processing to continue
B. It Involves the use of special logon-IDs that grant temporary
access to production environment during emergency situation.
C. Emergency IDs used for making emergency changes have
special privileges hence their usage should be logged & carefully
monitored
D. Passwords of emergency IDs used for making emergency
changes should never expire.
277
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1104. The desire for more accountability of public sector organizations has
resulted in:
A. An increased proportion of independent members on governing
bodies
B. Pressure on all public sector organizations to be operated on a
profit making basis
C. Public sector managers to become more professional
D. Public sector organizations to develop plans for their strategic
development
278
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
279
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1110. Ethical issues concerning business and public sector organizations exist
at three levels:
A. Macro; Corporate: Individual
B. Corporate; Business; Functional
C. Corporate; Functional; Individual
D. Business; Family; Individual
280
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
281
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1119. The desire for more accountability of public sector organizations has
resulted in:
A. An increased proportion of independent members on governing
bodies
B. Pressure on all public sector organizations to be operated on a
profit making basis
C. Public sector managers to become more professional
D. Public sector organizations to develop plans for their strategic
development
282
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
283
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
Q1125. Ethical issues concerning business and public sector organizations exist
at three levels:
A. Macro; Corporate: Individual
B. Corporate; Business; Functional
C. Corporate; Functional; Individual
D. Business; Family; Individual
284
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
285
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
286
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
287
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
288
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
289
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 3
290
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Module 4 Questions
Q1131. “Insurance cover that reimburses a company for expenses incurred to
avoid or minimize the suspension of business is called: “
A. Business Interruption Insurance
B. Equipment and Facility Insurance
C. Data Reconstruction
D. Extra expense insurance
Q1132. “The IS auditor should ensure that insurance coverage is adequate and
reflects the actual cost of recovery. It is important that the organisation
not only covers the loss of property but also: “
A. Covers the health of the employees
B. Covers the cost of data reconstruction.
C. Covers employee fidelity
D. Covers the loss of revenue stream arising from that property
Q1133. “Insurance that protects the company in the case of a claim against
the company for negligence, errors, omissions, or wrongful acts in the
performance of the compan⁹Section 1s duties is called: “
A. Business Interruption Insurance
B. Equipment and Facility Insurance
C. Professional Liability Insurance
D. Extra expense insurance
Q1134. Which of the following terms best define a computer program looking
“normal” but containing harmful code?
A. Trojan horse
B. Trapdoor
291
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Worm
D. Time bomb
Q1135. At which stage of the data process flow, from source to warehouse, is
detective controls implemented?
A. Data migration
B. Transformation
C. Loading
D. Reconciliation
292
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1139. Which one of the following is not an application control to assure data
accuracy?
A. Crossfooting
B. Control total
C. Limit and reasonableness test
D. Echo checking
Q1142. Which of the following will least important basis for access control
A. What the user knows
B. What the user wants
C. What the user is
D. What the user has
293
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1146. The BEST transmission control that can be employed to protect data
during data transfer is –
A. Applying parity check
B. Data encryption
C. File header encryption
D. Use of standard protocol
Q1148. Which of the following worms does the friendly “Cheese worm”
counteract?
A. Adore worm
B. Sadmind/ IIS worm
294
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Ramen worm
D. 1i0n worm
Q1151. The feature of Linux that allows changing password without altering or
recompiling any utility is:
A. Shadow password
B. Pluggable Authentication Module (PAM)
C. LILO
D. Dual booting
Q1152. The BEST method to verify the data values through the various stages
of processing
A. Check digits
B. Hash totals
C. Run-to-run totals
D. Automated controls
295
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1153. “Which of the following media has the least backup capacity? “
A. Removable Cartridges
B. Floppy Diskettes
C. Compact Disk
D. Tape Drives
296
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1158. “Data or documentation that must be retained for legal reasons, for use
in key business processes, or for restoration of minimum acceptable
work levels in the event of a disaster is classified as: “
A. Desirable
B. Vital
C. Essential
D. Critical
Q1160. “With respect to a BCP, the auditor should test check contact information
(of vendors, employees) to ensure: “
A. They will honour their contractual agreements.
B. That they are current.
C. They are physically close by.
D. They are registered with tax authorities.
297
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
298
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1166. “Any force or phenomenon that could degrade the availability, integrity
or confidentiality of an Information Systems resource, system or network
is called a: “
A. Threat
B. Risk
C. Vulnerability
D. Threat-source
Q1167. “With respect to BCP testing, which of the following type of test will
involve considerable expenditure of time, effort and resources? “
A. Checklist
B. Structured walk-through
C. Full-interruption
D. Simulation
299
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
300
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1173. “Which of the following is the MOST reliable strategy for centralized
systems? “
A. Cold site
B. Reciprocal Agreement
C. Hot Site
D. Mirror site/Active Recovery Site
Q1174. “ Which of the following is the LEAST reliable strategy for centralized
systems? “
A. Mobile Site
B. Hot Site
C. Reciprocal Agreement
D. Mirror site/Active Recovery Site
Q1175. “Data that can be reconstructed fairly readily but at some cost is
classified as: “
A. Critical
B. Essential
C. Sensitive
D. Essential
301
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1178. “The auditor should evaluate the security of an offsite facility to ensure
that it has logical, physical and environmental controls. Ideally,these
controls should be: “
A. On par with that provided at the primary facility.
B. Less than that provided at the primary facility.
C. More than that provided at the primary facility.
D. Different from that provided at the primary facility.
Q1179. “With respect to BCP testing which is the most rigorous way to test a
business continuity plan? “
A. Full-interruption
B. Parallel
C. Simulation
D. Structured walk-through
Q1180. Business functions that can be performed manually but only for a brief
period of time are usually classified as:
A. Vital
B. Essential
C. Desirable
D. Critical
302
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1181. “Banks must demonstrate that they have an overall data architecture
that integrates the various business functions from operations to finance
to risk management if they are to achieve compliance with: “
A. ISO/IEC 17799:2000
B. SAS 70
C. Basel Committee’s principles for electronic banking
D. Basel II Capital Accord
Q1183 “With respect to BCP testing, in which type of test is processing done
at both the primary and alternate location? “
A. Full-interruption
B. Parallel
C. Simulation
D. Structured walk-through
Q1184. “Which of the following technical methods for Backup does not require
restoration? “
A. Electronic Vaulting
B. Networked Disk
C. Tape Drives
D. Remote Mirroring
303
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1185. “Which of the following type of system backup would require the
maximum storage? “
A. Incremental
B. Sequential
C. Full
D. Differential
Q1186 Auditor should verify that the recovery strategies adopted by the
company are:
A. In line with audit objectives
B. In line with costs
C. In line with the priorities
D. In line with that of major competitors
304
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1192 “Within any complex system, there are usually components or processes
that, if not replicated or otherwise backed up by redundant capabilities,
represent points of failure for the entire system. These are called “
A. Multiple points of failure
B. Cascading points of failure
C. Linear points of failure
D. Single points of failure
305
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1193. “When backups of data and system files are taken together, they are
often called: “
A. Systems backup
B. Data backup
C. Incremental backup
D. Differential backup
306
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1197. “The plan that addresses the restoration of business processes after an
emergency, but which lacks procedures to ensure continuity of critical
processes throughout an emergency or disruption is called a: “
A. Business Continuity Plan
B. Crisis Communication Plan
C. Business Resumption Plan
D. Continuity of Operations Plan
Q1199. “An IT-focused plan designed to restore operability of the target system,
application, or computer facility at an alternate site after an emergency
is called a: “
A. Disaster Recovery Plan
B. B. Business Resumption Plan
C. C. Continuity of Operations Plan
D. D. Cyber Incident Response Plan
Q1200. A malicious user can change an application to get the full database. This
is a pitfall in which type of database security measure ?
A. Passwords
B. User Accounts
C. Isolation
D. Backup
307
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1202. “ The order of steps in the process of risk assessment for the purpose
of BCP is: “
A. “Asset identification and prioritization, Threat identification,
Exposure assessment, Objective formulation. “
B. “Objective formulation, Threat identification, Exposure
assessment, Asset identification and prioritization. “
C. “ Asset identification and prioritization, Exposure assessment,
Threat identification, Objective formulation. “
D. “Objective formulation, Asset identification and prioritization,
Threat identification, Exposure assessment. “
Q1203. “The maximum amount of time allowed for the recovery of the of the
business function is called the “
A. Maximum Recovery Time Period
B. Critical Recovery Time Period
C. Minimum Recovery Time Period
D. Vital Recovery Time Period
308
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1206. Which of the following data items is MOST LIKELY to have its integrity
protected by controls over standing data?
A. Pay rate
B. Raw material receipts
C. Customer’s address
D. Quantity sold
Q1209. All the following application system controls are considered preventive
in nature except:
A. Batch control totals
B. Authorization
309
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Preprinted forms
D. Passwords
310
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1214. Which access control mechanism does security label fit into?
A. Logical access control
B. Discretionary access control
C. Physical access control
D. Mandatory access control
Q1215 A data unit 01000101 sent from the source was received as 01111101.
What is the type of error?
A. Single-bit error
B. Byte error
C. Burst error
D. Spike error
Q1216. Which of these biometric tools use thermal sensors along with infrared
rays for identification?
A. Key stroke dynamics
B. Iris/Retinal scan
C. Speech recognition
D. Fingerprint scanning
Q1218. Hackers cover their tracks by masking their IP address. This is done
through:
A. Proxy Chaining
B. Denial of Service
311
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1219. The control procedure of installing the anti-virus software in the system
is called -
A. Preventive control
B. Compensating control
C. Detective control
D. Corrective control
Q1221. The logical access exposure involving data changing before and/or while
being entered into the computer is called -
A. Virus
B. Logical bombs
C. Trojan Horse
D. Data Diddling
Q1222. The general control that concern the proper segregation of duties and
responsibilities is called -
A. An output control
B. An access control
C. Organisation control
D. A Processing control
312
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1225. The following are the checks used to determine if a field contains data
and not zeros and blanks, EXCEPT -
A. Parity bits
B. Check digits
C. Batch headers
D. Trailer records
Q1226. Physical access control does not depend upon which of these factors?
A. Working environment
B. Hiring procedure
C. Public key infrastructure
D. Access privileges
313
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1228. Viruses that can change their appearance and use encryption are known
as:
A. Boot sector virus
B. Polymorphic virus
C. Stealth virus
D. Multipartite virus
314
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1233. Which of the following is NOT a security concern while using Java?
A. Intrusion of Privacy
B. Message digests
C. Denial of Service
D. Irritations
Q1234. What is the methodology used in the Novell Netware Operating System
to implement the concept of Access control Lists?
A. File Rights
B. Trusteeship
C. Authentication
D. Property Rights
Q1235. The unauthorised use of data files can be best prevented by using -
A. hardware lock
B. library control software
C. tape librarian
D. access control software & procedures
Q1236. Which of the following primarily assists in detecting real memory errors?
A. Valid character checks
B. Parity-based hamming code check
315
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1238. The best way to delete a highly confidential file from a microcomputer
would be by using which of the following:
A. Security card
B. Encryption routine
C. Disk utility
D. Multiplexor
Q1240. Dial back modem uses which of the following feature for external access
control?
A. SLIP protocol
B. “Port protection“
C. Point-to-Point Protocol
D. Blue boxes
316
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1243. Which is the most important step that can save a company from social
engineering attacks?
A. Creation of helpdesk rules
B. Making people accountable for jobs
C. Including social engineering in the social policy
D. Using Id cards
317
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
318
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1251. A control procedure that checks that data was entered and does not
contain blank or zeros is called -
A. A mathematically calculated check digit
B. Control check to verify the data existence agrees to a
predetermined criteria
C. Completeness check
D. Reasonableness check
Q1252. A Data Base Management System locks out a record used by one user,
when it is simultaneously accessed by another user for updating. This
control is primarily intended to prevent:
A. Duplicate processing of transactions
B. LAN Server Overload
319
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1254. A fraud involving accessing data by using other’s password and altering
the same for gain, was detected and investigated. The IS Auditor, during
investigation will be in a position to provide information about all the
following except –
A. details of access control procedures in use
B. administration of password security
C. the hurdles crossed by the perpetrator of the fraud
D. preventive methods to avoid similar attempts/
Q1255. A hacker changes data stored in hidden form fields to reduce the price
in online shopping. This type of attack is called:
A. Denial of Service
B. Dynamic Scripting
C. Data Manipulation
D. Identity Spoofing
320
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1260. A newly released virus was enabled into LAN, from a floppy drive in one
of the workstations connected to the LAN. The existence of such virus
in the LAN will be revealed effectively by which of the following?
A. ensuring compulsory scanning of all floppy disks before use
321
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1261. Access control list of a firewall can have the following parameters, on
the basis of which it may filter access, EXCEPT one.
A. IP address
B. Activity/service type
C. Port
D. Network interface card
322
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1264. A remote dial up order entry system using portable computers for sales
man to place order should have the following control system to prevent
it from misuse.
A. Modem equalisation
B. A call back procedure
C. An error-correcting code
D. Frequent access code revalidation
Q1265. A risk associated with the use of laptop computers is their loss or theft
and consequent disclosure of confidential information stored on them.
Which one of the following control measures is most effective and
inexpensive to protect the information stored
A. Briefings of users
B. Removable data storage media
C. Screen saver passwords
D. Encryption of data files on stored media
323
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
324
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1272. Which one of the following threats would cause the greatest concern to
an auditor auditing the data centre of a client organization?
A. Gun powder is stored in the basement of the building where the
data centre is also located
B. The data centre is located near airport.
C. The data centre is in close proximity (i.e., between one and
two miles) to one engaged in the refinement of highly explosive
chemicals or combustible and volatile products
D. The data centre is five to ten miles away from a nuclear power
plant
Q1273. The control and the procedure used in a program before data is
processed in a program is called -
A. Edit controls
B. Detective controls
C. Corrective controls
D. Compensating controls
Q1274. While classifying controls on the basis of the operations involved, input
control can be classified as -
A. Organisation control
B. General control
C. Processing control
D. Application control
325
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1276. While carrying out an IS security review, the IS auditor observed the
following controls present in the client’s IS security system. Which of
these controls may detect that an IS security violation has occurred?
A. Terminals are disabled after three failed login attempts
B. Passwords are changed periodically
C. Log book are reviewed by security personnel
D. Employee ID cards are in use
Q1277. While carrying out IS Audit, you have discovered a Trojan Horse
program in the computer system. Which of the following actions you will
take FIRST?
A. Start an investigation to find its author
B. Immediately remove the code containing the portion of “ TROJAN
HORSE”
C. Investigate the underlying threat if any
D. Install a compensating control
326
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1282. While reviewing the file identification standards in a client, the IS auditor
may not be concerned with which of the following:
A. Retention period standards
327
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1284. Within an EDI system which of the following is used to determine non-
repudiation?, Only Digital signautres can ensure non-repudiation of
messages, since the messages are signed by the private key of the
sender which is known only to the sender.
A. Private key cryptosystem.
B. Digital Signatures.
C. Spoofing.
D. Terminal ID and passwor
328
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1286. Which of the following terms best describes the purpose of control
practice over the input -
A. Authorisation of access to data files
B. Authorisation of access to program files
C. Completeness, accuracy and validity of update
D. Completeness, accuracy and validity of input
329
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1290. Which of the following, is the BEST procedure to find out whether
program documentation access is restricted only to authorized persons?
A. Back up and recovery procedure evaluation
B. Interview the programmers about the procedures currently
followed and if possible conduct a physical inspection of actual
access procedures
C. Programme library utilisation record verification
D. Review the detective control logs
330
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1295. Which one of the following computer fraud methods relates to obtaining
information that may be left in or around a computer system after the
execution of a job.
A. Scavenging
B. Data diddling
C. Salami technique
D. Piggybacking
Q1297. Which one of the following statement is not true with regard to physical
security?
A. Examining the age of the cabling is not significant
B. Lack of proper cooling facility may cause hardware failure
C. Locked gates, entrances, parking places are properly lit
D. Employees have to undergo training in physical security
331
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1299. Which one of the following statements is not true about audit trails?
A. If a user is impersonated, the audit trail will establish events and
the identity of the impersonator.
B. There is an interdependency between audit trails and security
policy.
C. Audit trails may assist in recovery in case of certain types of
processing failure.
D. Audit trails can be used to identify breakdowns in logical access
controls.
332
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1302. Access to the work area restricted through a swipe card or only
through otherwise authorised process and when visitors enter the work
area they are issued a pass and escorted in and out by a concerned
employee. These type of controls are called -
A. Organisational controls
B. Physical access controls
C. Logical access controls
D. Operational controls
Q1305. After you enter a purchase order in an on-line system, you get the
message, “The request could not be processed due to lack of funds in
your budget”. This is an example of error
A. Detection
B. Correction
333
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Prevention
D. Recovery
Q1307. All the following features help discover a valid password, EXCEPT -
A. the nature and character of the password content
B. the No. of letters in a password
C. the no. of times attempts are allowed before disconnection due
to incorrect password.
D. The complexity of construction and special characters used for
construction.
Q1308 All the following statements are true regarding a water-based fire
extinguishing system except:
A. Water cools the equipment relatively quickly
B. The release of water can be localized to where it is needed
C. Water and Halon gas systems cannot co-exist
D. Jet sprayers can be an alternative to water sprinklers
334
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
335
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1316. An IS auditor carrying out review of logical access control, shall have
the PRIMARY OBJECTIVE of
A. ensuring that access is given in accordance with the
organisations authorities
B. reviewing the software based access controls
C. carrying out personal examination of the existing physical access
environment
D. using CAAT techniques to know the access provided in the
software
336
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1317. The most common concern regarding physical access to a data centre
is:
A. Piggybacking
B. Locks and keys
C. Fire suppression system
D. Electronic access control system
337
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1322. An on-line data entry program is used for original entry of vendor
invoices. Subsequently a batch cheque-writing program is used to
prepare cheques; occasionally it is found that a cheque for a vendor
not yet included in the vendor file is prepared with n
A. A record lookup for vendors during data entry of vendor invoices
B. A batch control total check on vendor payments
C. A completeness test on fields in the cheque-writing program
D. A verification of vendors in the cheque-writing program
Q1323. An on-line teller application abruptly shuts down while some transactions
are in process. The best control to ensure that each unfinished
transaction is completed successfully when the system resumes
operation is:
A. Automatic restart that prompts tellers to complete in-process
B. Manual reconstruction of in-process transactions by tellers
C. Computer reconciliation of accepted-item totals
D. Manual reconciliation of accepted-item totals
338
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1326. Because of the sensitivity of its data, a database system for business
forecasting was implemented with access control at different levels.
Users’ initial log-in would be controlled by
A. Integrated Test Facility
B. Database authorizations
C. Application software
D. Operating System
Q1327. Before disposing off the PC used for storing confidential data the most
important precautionary measure to be taken is -
A. mid-level formatting of hard disk
B. deleting all the files in the hard disk
C. deleting all the data on the hard disk
D. demagnetising the hard disk
339
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1328. Changes made on line to important master records will not be noticed
by which of the following controls ?
A. proper authorisation of updates before the actual entry of the
update in the system
B. the complete listing of all updates made are daily taken and
verified by independent supervisor
C. data entry operators are not authorised to operate the update
command, which shall be executed by an independent supervisor
after verification
D. access to master records denied to data entry operators, but
given only to independent supervisor
340
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1332. Data once input into the computer system cannot be changed in an
unauthorised manner. The controls established to achieve the above
objective is called –
A. data security controls
B. detective controls
C. compensating controls
D. operations controls
Q1333. Data security function review examines the following areas EXCEPT –
A. Security policy and responsibility for implementation
B. Application controls
C. Access controls
D. Password administration controls
341
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1337. During a review of system access rules, an IS Auditor noted that the
System Administrator has unlimited access to all data and program files.
Such access authority is:
A. Appropriate, but all access should be logged.
B. Appropriate, because System Administrator has to back up all
data and program files.
C. Inappropriate, since access should be limited to a need-to-know
basis, regardless of position.
D. Inappropriate, because System Administrator has the capacity to
run the system.
342
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1339. Which of the following is a special signal sent by the different hardware
devices to the Operating System (OS)?
A. Process
B. Threads
C. Interrupts
D. Applications
343
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1344. Exposure that could have been caused by the line - grabbing technique
is -
A. excessive usage of the hard disk space
B. blocking of CPU functions
C. transmission delay
D. unauthorised access to data
344
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1347. For a high security installation the most effective physical access control
devices is
A. User ID and password
B. Magnetic Card reader
C. Bio-metric devices
D. Laser activated photo identification.
Q1348. For a stand alone system, the best security control is to have -
A. User ID and passwords
B. Detailed logical access control procedures
C. Restricted physical access
D. Regular back ups taken at periodical intervals
345
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1350. The malicious program which put a constraint on server’s activities over
Network is:
A. Virus
B. Trojan horses
C. LOgic bombs
D. Worms
Q1351. For reviewing the physical security of the IPF facility, the necessity of
the following document is the LEAST -
A. Complete details of the IPF floor plans
B. SDLC procedure statement
C. List of all authorised users of IPF
D. Detailed organisation chart
Q1352. For secure exchange of data, database has to ensure ACID properties.
A property of database that avoids conflict between two or more
transactions running simultaneously is:
A. Atomicity
B. Consistency
C. Integrity
D. Durability
346
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1354. For which of the following audit tests, parallel simulation would be an
appropriate approach:
A. Testing for the presence of authorized signatures on documents
B. Summarizing the results of accounts receivable confirmation work
C. Scanning the general ledger file for unusual transactions
D. Re-calculating amounts for declining balance depreciation charges
Q1355. For which of the following options does the Demilitarised Zone (DMZ)
Security in e-commerce work as a protection technique?
A. Network protection
B. “Application-level protection“
C. Platform protection
D. Database protection
Q1356. Hackers avoid detection of attacks by changing the URL such that it is
difficult to write programs to detect the attacks. This is done through:
A. Spoofing
B. Physical attacks
C. Smurfing
D. Hexadecimal encoding of URLs
Q1357. Host 1 wants to prove its identity to Host 2. Host 2 is also authenticating
Host 3, but by mistake uses Host 1’s credentials. This is possible in
which type of authentication?
A. Zero Knowledge Proofs
B. Message Digests
C. Kerberos
D. Token Authentication
347
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1358. How the control in a loan processing edit program which ensures a
logical relationship between the amount advanced, the number of
repayments and the installments could be classified:
A. A format check
B. An existence check
C. A dependency check
D. A sequence check
Q1361. Implementing a firewalls is not the best solution for Virtual Private
Networks because:
A. Firewalls cannot detect spoofing attacks.
B. “Firewalls cannot be installed on VPNs“
C. Firewalls cannot alter data over a network
D. All of the above
348
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1363. In a central computer system users specify where their output is printed,
but some users give the wrong destination code and tie up other
departments’ printers. The best approach to ensure that printing occurs
on an appropriate device is to:
A. Centrally monitor the print queues for correct destinations
B. Create destination defaults for printing based on each employee’s
departmental affiliation.
C. Centrally print and distribute the outputs.
D. Train current users in how to specify the right destination codes
for their printing.
349
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1366. In a Denial of Service attack, a TCP SYN flood attack is an example of:
A. Network Resource exhaustion
B. Memory consumption
C. Exploiting of the targets own resources
D. Configuration information alteration
Q1368. In a network using Novell Netware, a user has full rights to a directory.
The user, however, must not access one file in that directory. What
feature of Netware can be used to achieve this?
A. Inheritance
B. Inherited Restriction Filter
C. Attributes
D. Security Equal To
350
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1370. In an accounting audit trail for online output, which of the following
information is LEAST LIKELY to be stored?
A. The time at which the output was received
B. The contents of the output
C. The persons who received the output
D. The resources consumed to produce the output
Q1372. In an accounts payable system, clerks who enter invoices for payment
also maintain the file containing valid vendor codes. This practice
increases the risk that:
A. The vendor table will not contain current information.
B. Clerks will enter an incorrect but valid code for payment.
C. Vendors not in the table file will be paid.
D. Unauthorized vendors’ invoices will be pai
351
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
352
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1378. In deciding about the “ need to know “ basis access for the following,
the data classification plays an important role :
A. Test programs and data
B. Production programs and data
C. Test and production programs
D. Production and test data and programs
Q1380. In general, output controls over reports of batch systems would be more
compared with that of online systems because:
A. Batch output is more detailed than online output.
B. There are more intermediaries involved in producing and
distributing batch output.
C. Only managers typically receive online reports so less misuse is
likely.
D. The only way to breach the privacy of online reports is to wiretap
the communications line
353
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1383. In relation to an out put recovery process, which of the following factors
makes the recovery process EASIER?
A. In-place update rather than batch update is used
B. Avoidance of use of checkpoint facilities
C. Transaction data to be recovered instead of status data
D. Lack of use of spooling or printer files
354
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1387. In the case of online output, which of the following is LEAST LIKELY to
be an exposure covered by disposition controls?
A. Unauthorised copying of online output to diskettes
B. Unauthorised viewing of confidential data displayed on a screen
by a passerby
C. Failure to forward e-mail received in a general mailbox to persons
responsible for addressing the matters mentioned in the e-mail
D. Forwarding of confidential e-mail to unauthorised parties
Q1389. Inaccurate data input can NOT be detected by the employment of which
of the following controls ?
A. Reasonableness checks
B. Validity checks
355
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Completeness checks
D. Hash totals, and run to run totals.
Q1391. IS Auditor performing a security review will perform all the following
steps. However he will begin with -
A. Test of evidence of physical access at suspected locations
B. An overview understanding of the functions being audited and
evaluate the audit and business risk
C. Determine the risks/threats to thedata center site
D. Interviewing people at the site for the specific tasks performed by
them.
Q1392. IS security policy of an organisation will not contain details about the
following:
A. the overall security philosophy of the organisation
B. the authorisation procedure for accessing data
C. security awareness programme
D. highlights and identity of the sensitive security features
356
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
357
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1399. Many users on a network want to use a single Operating System (OS)
to perform their tasks. Which of the following operating systems can be
used in this situation?
A. Real-time Operating System (RTOS)
B. Single-User Operating System
C. Multi-tasking Operating System
D. Multi-user Operating System
358
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1403. Notebook computers are portable and used to access the company’s
database while the executives are on travel. Which of the following
would provide the least security for sensitive data stored on a notebook
computer?
A. Encryption of data files on the notebook computer.
B. Setting up a password for the screensaver program on the
notebook computer.
C. Installing an access control software.
D. Using a locking device that can secure the notebook computer to
an immovable object.
Q1405. On June 23, 2000, an accounting clerk prepared an invoice dated June
33, 2000 and sent it to data entry as part of a batch of invoices. The
input control most likely to detect this error is:
A. Completeness (field) test
359
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
B. Size check
C. Hash total
D. Range check
Q1406. One of the advantages of using naming convention for access control
is that -
A. ambiguity in the resource name is avoided
B. rules for protecting resources can be minimised
C. naming convention gives a unique identity to the resources
D. fancy and international names can be used
360
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1410. One of the production supervisors who has got access to the corporate
database sold sensitive product pricing information to a competitor.
Which of the following controls would best prevent such a situation?
A. Software configuration management is established and enforced
B. User access to the corporate database is controlled by passwords
C. Data ownership resides with the most appropriate users
D. Access privileges are established on a need-to-know basis
Q1412. Overall responsibility to protect and control the database and monitor
and improve the efficiency of the database are the job of -
A. Security administrator
B. Data owner
C. Data custodian
D. Database administrator
361
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
362
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1418. Select the BEST control to mitigate the risk of creation of duplicate user
name and password during sign on procedures, if encountered during
an audit of an IS configuration.
A. security policy should be modified
B. users should be educated about weak password
C. proper validation procedures to be built in during user creation
and password change
D. require a periodic review of matching of user ID and passwords
for detection and correction
Q1420. Specify the IS application control in the following, while others are
general controls -
A. the security policy of the company and the organisaiton and
control of security activity
B. all the physical access control routines
C. control over the systems installed
D. Hash totals and batch totals
363
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1424. “The auditor before commencing audit of access controls should obtain
the following information by interviewing the organisation’s staff“
A. IT organisation structure
B. Key business activities
C. Significant changes to network
D. Method of authorising access
364
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1425. The Best information about Unauthorized input from a terminal can be
derived from which of the following?
A. Printout of the Console log
B. Transaction journal
C. Error report
D. Listing of all suspence file generated automatically
Q1426. Which of the following is a passive measure for securing the Linux
Operating System?
A. Restricting administrator access
B. Logging
C. Running only necessary services
D. Application auditing
365
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
366
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1435. The following control procedure helps us verify data values through
various stages of application processing, ensuring that data read into
the computer was accepted and then applied to the updating process
A. Edit checks
B. Run-to- run totals
C. Completeness checks
D. Reasonableness checks
367
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1437. The following measures will protect the computer systems from virus
attack EXCEPT:
A. once the diskettes are checked for virus and cleaned, write
protect them
B. all new software before loaded should be scanned for viruses and
cleaned
C. no demonstration packages should be allowed to be run on the
company owned machines
D. always boot from the diskettes
368
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1442. The management must take various security measures to mitigate the
risk. Which of the following measure aims to minimise the damage and
prevent the reoccurrence of incident?
A. Reductive measure
B. Detective measure
C. Repressive measure
D. Corrective measure
Q1443. The most appropriate audit strategy for a large organisation which relies
on comprehensive user controls over the micro computer usage is -
A. Tests of user controls
B. Edit checks of data entered
C. Tests of general controls
D. Substantive tests of executed program logic
369
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1446. The person responsible for providing access rights to each of the user
and access profile for each data element stored in the computer system
is -
A. Data Custodian
B. Security administrator
C. Data owner
D. The database administrator
370
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
B. Random sampling
C. Use of a test deck
D. Parallel simulation
Q1449. The public audit trail of a Digital Signature system will not contain which
of the following?
A. Public Key registrations
B. Signature registrations
C. Key compromise notifications
D. Private key modifications
Q1450. The salient features of the data file access control shall address the
following EXCEPT –
A. Access by computer data entry operators
B. Access through terminals
C. Access by production programs
D. Access to physical resources
Q1451. The technical support personnel should have unlimited access to all
data and program files to do their job. Which of the following is the right
prescription for proper access authority devolution.
A. Such access authority is appropriate, if they are logged
completely.
B. Such access authority is appropriate because they have the full
knowledge and understanding about the entire system.
C. Such access authority is inappropriate because it violates the
principle of “access on need - to - know basis, irrespective of
position
D. Such access authority is inappropriate because they have the full
knowledge and understanding about the system
371
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1452. The test of access control, over a distributed database, can be carried
out by -
A. Reconciliation of batch control totals
B. Examination of logged activity
C. Prohibition of random access
D. Analysis of system generated core dumps
372
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1457. To prevent virus attack effectively in an IS environment, the first and the
foremost step to be taken is -
A. formulating and adopting a detailed anti-virus policy for the
organisation as a whole and appraising all users about the same
and implementing it.
B. Installing the latest anti-virus software regularly
C. Prohibiting the usage of disk drives in workstations
D. Have a proper and highly secured physical access control
environment
Q1459. To protect computer systems from short term power fluctuations, the
best environmental control is -
A. an alternative source of power
B. a dedicated power generator
373
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
374
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1466. What does the Automated Security Access Tool (ASET) (provided by
Solaris) in Medium setting, do?
A. Checks for file permissions and makes sure standard permissions
are set
B. It modifies permissions of certain system files such as ttytab etc)
and restricts access
375
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1467. What feature of Linux allows a secure connection between client and
server for generally insecure services such as Telnet?
A. Password Protection
B. Logging
C. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)
D. Secure Shell (SSH)
Q1469. What feature of the Windows 2000 Operating System provides a single,
centralised security administration capability?
A. Active Directory Integration
B. Flexibility in Authentication
C. Consistently enforcing Authorisation
D. Public Key Infrastructure
Q1470. When the account number is entered into an online banking system, the
computer responds with a message that reads: “Account number that
you entered is not assigned to an active number. Please reenter”. What
technique is the computer using.
A. Existence check
B. Dependency check
376
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Format check
D. Check digit
Q1471. When the results of production data files processing with a generalized
audit software do not agree with the total balance according to the
inventory application reports, what should the IS Auditor do first?
A. Tell data processing that the inventory application has a bug in it.
B. Review the data field definitions and logic in the audit software.
C. Rerun the audit software against a backup of the inventory
master file.
D. Process the data using a different generalized audit software.
Q1473. When transmitting online output through Internet, which of the following
controls is likely to offer MOST protection?
A. Symmetric cryptography
B. Asymmetric cryptography
C. File compression algorithms
D. Message routing protocols
377
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
following control is used to ensure that transactions are not lost during
processing.
A. controls for validating data
B. checking of internal credibility
C. manual control procedures
D. balancing procedures through the system itself automatically
Q1475. Which component in the Java Virtual Machine checks the compiled
code to see if it matches all the rules and specifications of the Java
language?
A. Class Loader
B. Security Manager
C. Byte code Verifier
D. Garbage collector
Q1477. Which of the following allows the most granular access control
mechanism for database security ?
A. System and Object Privileges
B. Database Integrity mechanisms
C. Data Encryption
D. Row-Level Security
378
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1480. Which of the following control objectives is violated when the theft of
proprietary software or corporate data is stolen:
A. preserving data integrity
B. ensuring system efficiency
C. achieving system effectiveness
D. safeguarding the assets
Q1481. Which of the following controls is the most basic and simple login
control?
A. Logging unsuccessful login attempts
B. Validating user-name and password
C. Sending alerts to the Security Administrator
D. Disabling accounts when a break-in occurs
379
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1482. Which of the following controls would address the concern that data
uploaded from a microcomputer to the company’s mainframe system in
batch processing may be erroneous.
A. The mainframe computer should be backed-up on a regular basis.
B. Two persons should be present at the microcomputer when it is
uploading data.
C. The mainframe computer should subject the data to the same
edits and validation routines that on-line data entry would require.
D. The users should be required to review a random sample of
processed data.
Q1484. Which of the following data base environment controls enforces access
rules in addition to maintaining standardized definitions?
A. Active data dictionary system
B. Passive data dictionary system
C. Deadlock resolution
D. Record locking
380
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1486. Which of the following feature may seriously affect or nullify the utility
of audit trails for an application system ?
A. User ids are not recorded in the audit trail
B. Security administrator can amend the details in the audit trail
C. Date and time stamps are not recorded automatically but only
with manual interferance
D. Audit trail records can be amended by the users.
Q1487. Which of the following is a feature of ActiveX controls that can both be
used as well as misused?
A. ActiveX controls can be reused
B. ActiveX controls can access system resources
C. Many pre-developed controls for performing many tasks are
available
D. Execution of ActiveX controls can be controlled using Internet
Explorer security settings
381
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
382
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1494. Which of the following is the most common type of input validation to
verify the length of a number entered by a user in a numeric field?
A. Form-Level
B. Validation lists
C. Field-Level
D. Filtering Keyboard Input
Q1495. Which of the following is the most objective and relevant evidence in a
computer system related fraud investigation?
A. Physical examination
B. Computer logs
C. Physical observation
D. Inquiries of people
383
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1498. Which of the following may be the least important factor for
implementing a password control system?
A. Encrypting the password file
B. Purchasing computers with boot level password facilities
C. Limiting the distribution of passwords
D. Not writing down the password
Q1499. Which of the following methods can detect burst errors only if the
number of errors is in each data unit is odd?
A. Vertical Redundancy check (VRC) - even parity
B. Vertical Redundancy check (VRC) - odd parity
C. Longitudinal Redundancy Check (LRC)
D. Checksum
Q1500. Which of the following pairs of items which are related to each other?
A. The segregation of duties principle, the “least privilege” principle
B. The parity check, the reasonableness check
C. The single-key system, the Rivest-Shamir-Adleman (RS) algorithm
D. The two-key system, the Data Encryption Standard DES)
algorithm
384
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1501. Which of the following physical access control devices would be most
effective for a high security installation?
A. Proximity sensing card reader
B. Retina scanner
C. Photo identification card
D. Magnetic card reader
Q1502. Which of the following risks is not associated with utility programs?
A. Unauthorized manipulation of data
B. Incorrect batch totals
C. Override of password checking
D. Bypassing of system controls
Q1504. Which of the following should be the least important criteria for selecting
a security software package
A. The memory and hard disk space used by the package
B. Compatibility with the in-house database management system
C. The financial stability of the software supplier
D. The number of personnel on the software supplier’s staff
385
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. It is an anti-virus package
D. It is a powerful supercomputer
Q1506. Which one of the following recovery strategy has the GREATEST
chance of failure due to systems and personnel changes?
A. Hot site
B. Cold site
C. Reciprocal agreement
D. Redundant site
Q1507. The business impact analysis should critically examine the business
processes looking MOST at their:
A. Composition
B. Priorities
C. Dependencies
D. Service levels
386
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
387
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1516. Which of the following methods would best ensure the adequacy of a
disaster recovery plan?
A. Regular reviews of timeliness of information detailed in the plan
B. Unannounced shut down of the primary installation during quiet
periods
C. Regular recovery exercises using expert personnel
D. Unannounced recovery exercises at regular intervals
388
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1519. Which of the following would best describe a cold backup site?
A. A computer facility with electrical power and HVAC, all needed
applications installed and configured on the file/print servers, and
enough workstations present to begin processing
B. A computer facility with electrical power and HVAC but with
no workstations or servers on site prior to the event and no
applications installed.
C. A computer facility with no electrical power or HVAC
D. A computer facility with electrical power and HVAC and some
file/print servers, although the applications are not installed or
configured and all of the workstations may not be on site or ready
to begin processing
389
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1522. Which of the following pair of phrases is the BEST example of operating
watch words to remember in developing disaster recovery plans:
A. No policy, No procedure
B. No ring, No write
C. No backup, No recovery
D. No security, No protection
390
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
concluded that the recovery was more than the critical time frame that
was necessary. Which of the following actions w
A. Widen the physical capacity to accomplish better mobility in a
shorter time.
B. Shorten the distance to reach the hot site.
C. Perform an integral review of the recovery tasks
D. Increase the number of human resources involved in the recovery
process
Q1527. Which of the following is a continuity plan test that uses actual
resources to simulate a system crash to cost effectively obtain evidence
about the plan’s effectiveness?
A. Paper test
B. Post test
391
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
C. Preparedness test
D. Walkthrough
Q1530. Secured waste, audit checks, and applicant screening all act:
A. Data security
B. Software protection
C. Privacy detection
D. License protection
392
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1532. Which device can limit traffic on a network and allow access onto
specific TCP/IP port numbers when security is a concern?
A. Firewall
B. Hub
C. DNS
D. Modem
Q1536. Both data integrity and system security are required to:
A. Protect a person’s right to privacy
B. Increase the speed of processing
393
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1537. Internal controls are the rules and procedures that are followed to
maintain the integrity and security of:
A. The data, records and financial assets of an organization
B. The hardware and networks in an organization
C. Policies
D. The Internet
Q1538. You have a remote user who can connect to the internet but not to the
office via their VPN client. After determining the problem, which should
be your next step?
A. Make sure the user has the correct VPN address and password
B. Have the client reboot their host
C. Have the client reinstall their VPN software
D. Reboot the router at the corporate office.
394
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1541. Which of the following govern how the network is configured and
operated as well as how people are expected to behave on the
network?
A. Policies
B. Baselines
C. Laws
D. Procedure
Q1542. The “what you are” criteria for computer system access involve:
A. Bio metrics
B. A badge
C. A swipe card
D. A password
Q1543. Secured waste, audit checks, and applicant screening all act:
A. Data security
B. Software protection
C. Privacy detection
D. License protection
Q1545. Both data integrity and system security are required to:
A. Protect a person’s right to privacy
B. Increase the speed of processing
395
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1546. Internal controls are the rules and procedures that are followed to
maintain the integrity and security of:
A. The data, records and financial assets of an organization
B. The hardware and networks in an organization
C. Policies
D. The Internet
Q1548. You have a remote user who can connect to the internet but not to the
office via their VPN client. After determining the problem, which should
be your next step?
A. Make sure the user has the correct VPN address and password
B. Have the client reboot their host
C. Have the client reinstall their VPN software
D. Reboot the router at the corporate office.
Q1549. Which device can limit traffic on a network and allow access onto
specific TCP/IP port numbers when security is a concern?
A. Firewall
B. Hub
C. DNS
D. Modem
396
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
397
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
Q1555. The “what you are” criteria for computer system access involve:
A. Bio metrics
B. A badge
C. A swipe card
D. A password
Q1557. Which of the following govern how the network is configured and
operated as well as how people are expected to behave on the
network?
A. Policies
B. Baselines
C. Laws
D. Procedure
398
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
399
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
400
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
401
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
402
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
403
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 4
404
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Module 5 Questions
Q1558. “The primary objectives for auditing IT change management is to ensure
that: “
A. Only approved changes were made
B. All changes are documented
C. Change control procedure variances are recorded and accounted.
D. Latest version of software is used
405
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
406
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1567. “Which of the following is the basis for providing authorization and
access to employees in an enterprise? “
A. Organization Structure
B. Nature of Business process
C. Type of technology
D. Style of management
407
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
408
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1577. Which one of the following forms a part of transmission control in EDI
control layers?
A. Interchange
B. Functional group
C. Transaction set
D. None of the above
409
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1581. “Which among the following combination of roles results has maximum
risk “
A. Data entry and Operations
B. Librarian and Help Desk
C. Systems Analysis and Quality Assurance
D. Database Administration and Data entry
Q1582. “In auditing outsourcing, which of the following is the IS Auditor most
likely to consider for formulating the audit scope and objectives: “
A. Benefits of outsourcing
410
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
411
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1590. “At the preliminary review stage of IT strategic plan; the most critical
audit procedure involves verification of: “
A. Short-range plan, which has been prepared outlining the specific
project.
412
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
413
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1597. Rapid recovery is MOST crucial in the case of which of the following
applications?
A. Departmental chargeback
B. Corporate planning
C. Point-of-sale
D. Regulatory reporting
414
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1600. Internal controls of EDI should address which of the following risks?
A. Storage errors
B. Transmission errors
C. File errors
D. Accounting errors
415
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1605. Which step comes just before the final approval of the BCP?
A. Collecting data
B. Organising and documenting the plan
C. Testing the plan
D. Writing policies and procedures
Q1607. Which of the following alternate facilities has the GREATEST chance of
failure due to change in systems and personnel?
A. Reciprocal agreement
B. Hot site
416
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. Warm site
D. Cold site
Q1608. Which of the following is not a measurement criterion for the Personal
Software Process?
A. Defects
B. Time
C. Task
D. Lines of codes
Q1610. For getting high speed access in telecommuting, which of the following
connection is used?
A. Internet Connection
B. Ethernet Connection
C. Modem connection
D. None of the above
417
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1613. In the case of a bank teller the access control policy is an example of:
A. User directed policy
B. Role based policy
C. Rule based policy
D. Identity based policy
Q1616. Which of the following systems are MOST important for business
resumption following a disaster?
A. Vital systems
B. Sensitive systems
418
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. Critical systems
D. Non-critical systems
Q1617. Which one of the following is TRUE about Pretty Good Privacy (PGP ,
an electronic mail security program?
A. PGP is a protocol
B. PGP is a standard
C. PGP is a product
D. PGP is not portable
Q1619. A bank performs a backup of its online deposit files each day after all
processing is over and retains it for 7 days. The bank does not retain a
copies of each days transaction. This approach is:
A. Valid, since it minimises the complexity of backup/recovery
procedures if the online file has to be restored
B. Valid, since having a weeks worth of backups permits recovery
even if one backup could not be restored.
C. Risky, since restoring from the most recent backup file would omit
subsequent transactions
D. Risky, since no checkpoint/restart information is kept with the
backup files
419
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
420
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
421
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1629. Which of the following would BEST ensure continuity of a Wide Area
Network (WAN ?
A. A maintenance contract with a service provider
B. Full system back-up taken on a daily basis
C. A duplicate machine alongside each server
D. Built-in alternative routing
Q1630. Which one of the following in NOT true statement about encryption used
in an electronic data interchange (EDI transaction?
A. Encryption ensures data integrity
B. Encryption ensures data availability
C. Encryption ensures data confidentiality
D. Encryption prevents unauthorised viewing of data
Q1632. Which one of the following is NOT true about an electronic data
interchange (EDI) system?
A. Direct or dedicated transmission channels with trading partners
B. Elimination of paper records
422
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
423
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
424
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1639. Audit of LAN disaster backup and recovery plan ensures that business
is restored after a system failure or disaster. Which of the following is
FALSE with respect to such plans
A. Plan identifies the critical hardware and equipments
B. Confidential information is not disclosed in the plan
C. Plan is reviewed and accepted by the management
D. Plan is communicated to the employees
425
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
426
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
427
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. 4,3,1,2
D. 4,3,2,1
Q1652. If outsourcing a hot site is a feasible solution, then which of the following
should be considered while interacting with the vendor?
A. Hardware, software and networking requirements
B. “Location and testing requirements“
C. “Staff expertise“
D. All the above
428
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1656. In residual dumping technique for backup, the records that are backed
up are those that have not undergone any change since
A. the last full dump
B. the last residual dump
C. the second-last full dump
D. the second-last residual dump
Q1658. In the case of electronic funds transfer (EFT) , which one of the
following is MOST vulnerable to fraud and physical attacks?
A. Point-of-sale system
B. Home banking system
C. Automated teller machine system
D. Telephone bill paying system
429
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1659. In the event of a disaster, the crisis management team should first:
A. Inform the stakeholders
B. Assess the impact of disaster on the company
C. Take care of personnel and their dear ones
D. Form an emergency response team
Q1662. It was observed that there is no fire detection and control equipment in
an organisations computer processing area. Which of the following is
MOST important in such circumstances?
A. Offsite storage of transaction and master backup files
B. Adequate fire insurance
C. Fully tested backup processing facility
D. Regular hardware maintenance
430
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
431
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. dynamic equalization
D. attenuation amplification
Q1668. Operations audit trail rather than the accounting audit trail is likely to
show
A. message sequence number
B. queue length at each network node the message traverses before
reaching the destination
C. time and date of dispatch of the message
D. the unique identifier of the sender’s node from which it was sent
Q1669. OSI model of ISO presents a model of seven layers through which data
communication across computers passes. Encryption is NOT done in
any form in
A. Presentation
B. Physical
C. Data Link
D. Transport
432
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1672. Ring topologies have an edge over bus topologies. Which of the
following statements is FALSE?
A. In ring topology, nodes are connected on a point to point basis
whereas it is a multipoint connection in a bus network
B. The connectors in a bus topology attenuate the signals and
distort them, whereas repeaters in a ring topology are relatively
harmless
C. If a connector in bus topology is malfunctioning, the whole
network will not be brought down, whereas malfunctioning
repeaters will bring the network down
D. Encryption is resorted to as a control technique more in bus
topology than ring topology
433
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1675. Rollforward and rollback are two important techniques for backup. Which
among the following should be logged for facilitating rollforward?
A. Afterimages
B. Beforeimages
C. All valid transactions
D. All input transactions
434
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1680. The time required for recovery of information processing facility in the
case of a disaster is based on which of following?
A. Nature of disaster
B. Criticality of the operations affected
C. Mainframe based applications
D. Quality of the data to be processed
435
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1683. Which among the following is NOT a serious problem in a ring topology
based LAN?
A. Corruption of tokens during transmission may occur
B. Collision of tokens during transmission may occur
C. Tokens may be captured by a node and before releasing it the
node may fail
D. The receiver might not have captured the token but it might have
passed the addressee node
436
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1686. Which of the following approach is ideal in order to test the electronic
data interchange (EDI) system for a value added network (VAN) user?
A. Test mailbox
B. System programmer mailbox
C. Production mailbox
D. Application programmer mailbox
Q1687. Which of the following are NOT true about electronic data interchange
(EDI) ?
A. EDIs data is processed by computer application systems without
human intervention
B. Standardisation is not key to EDI transaction
C. EDI concept is different from electronic commerce
D. EDI promotes a paperless environment
437
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1692. Which of the following controls should be introduced in the case of EDI
transaction with a trading partner for efficient data mapping?
A. Manual recalculations
B. Functional acknowledgements
C. Key verification
D. One-for-one checking
438
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1694. Which of the following cryptographic algorithm does both encryption and
digital signature?
A. International data encryption algorithm (IDE)
B. Digital signature standard (DSS)
C. Rivest, Shamir, Adleman (RS
D. Data encryption standard (DES)
439
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1698. Which of the following involves routing of traffic through split or duplicate
cable facilities in providing telecommunication continuity?
A. Long haul network diversity
B. Diverse routing
C. Redundancy
D. Alternate routing
440
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1704. Which of the following is NOT true about a reciprocal agreement for an
alternative processing facility?
A. The reciprocal data centre may not be available during normal
business hours
B. They are expensive to maintain
C. The reciprocal data centre may not have adequate capacity
D. Incompatibilities in the operating software may occur
441
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1706. Which of the following is NOT true about Pretty good privacy (PGP) and
privacy enhanced mail (PEM)?
A. They are both based on public-key cryptography
B. They both have same uses
C. They both encrypt messages
D. They both sign messages
Q1708. Which of the following is the MOST effective and environment friendly
methods of suppressing fire in a data centre?
A. Carbon dioxide gas
B. Wet-pipe sprinklers
C. Halon gas
D. Dry-pipe sprinklers
442
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1709. Which of the following is the BEST disaster recovery plan for the
communication processor for a large chain of shops which has a central
communication processor for connecting with the banking network with
electronic fund transfer (EFT at point-of-sale de
A. Alternate standby processor at another network node
B. Alternative standby processor onsite
C. Installation of duplex communication links
D. Offsite storage of daily backup
Q1710. Which of the following is the LEAST important in the case of backup
and recovery plan?
A. Frequency of the backup
B. Usage of backup tapes
C. Frequency of offsite backup
D. Frequency of restoration of backups to test the backup tapes
443
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1714. Which of the following is TRUE about Electronic Data Interchange (EDI)
application system?
A. Transmits transactions using sophisticated formats and file
definitions
B. Applications, transactions and trading partners supported remain
static over time
C. System that performs based on business needs and activities
D. Provides utility programs for a limited number of application
systems
Q1715. Which of the following is TRUE about most of the business continuity
tests?
A. Address all system components
B. Conducted at the same time as normal business operations
C. Monitored by the IS auditor
D. Evaluate the performance of personnel
Q1716. Which of the following is TRUE in relation to the input controls of EDI ?
A. The data that is entered into the system should have sequence
numbers
B. Data that is entered into the system need not be translated to
EDI standard
C. Parity and redundancy checks should be used
D. Any changes to EDI should be tested before implementation
444
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1717. Which of the following offsite alternative for business recovery would
require the least amount of funds?
A. Cold site facility
B. Reciprocal agreement
C. Warm site facility
D. Hot site facility
Q1718. Which of the following network risk apply to EDI transactions irrespective
of the type of network involved?
A. Failure to detect the recipient
B. Data being transmitted to the wrong recipient
C. Delay in transmission of the data
D. The data being intercepted and disclosed to others without
authorisation
Q1719. Which of the following project scheduling techniques does not provide
information about predecessor and successor relationships –
A. Gantt Charts
B. Critical Path Method
C. Program Evaluation and Review Technique
D. Critical Chain Path Method
445
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1722. Which of the following should find a place in a disaster recovery plan
A. Program coding standards for the organization
B. History of updates to the operating system
C. List of applications under development
D. Responsibilities of each organizational unit
Q1724. Which of the following statement is true with respect to Electronic Fund
Transfer/ Point of Sale transaction?
A. To verify the identity of the cardholder, using signature is more
secure than using the PIN
B. All cards are not checked with hot card numbers
C. A central authority verifies the signature of the person holding the
card
D. Before payment, the cardholder and the merchant agree upon the
amount
446
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1725. Which of the following statements about digital signatures is NOT true?
A. It prevents non-repudiation by the receiver
B. It provides sender authenticity
C. It facilitates repudiation by the sender
D. It prevents repudiation by the sender
447
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. Back-up procedures
D. Audit trails
Q1730. While appointing an auditor to conduct the IS audit the company need
not look into ________ of the auditor?
A. Legal capability
B. Experience
C. Proficiency in different computer languages
D. Secrecy bond, if penetration test is to be done
Q1731. When planning a software audit, the management does not consider:
A. The timing of the audit
B. Persons who should conduct the audit
C. Keeping the audit objective secret
D. Providing access to the required facilities
448
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1735. An audit technique used to select items from a population for audit
testing purposes based on the characteristics is termed as
A. Continuous Sampling
B. Discrete Sampling
C. Attribute Sampling
D. Statistical Sampling
Q1737. While developing a risk based audit program which of the following
would the IS auditor MOST likely focus on
A. Business processes
B. Critical IT applications
C. Corporate objectives
D. Business strategies
449
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1739. When an IS auditor obtains a listing of current users with access to the
selected WAN/LAN and verifies that those listed are active associates,
the auditor is performing a:
A. Compliance test.
B. Substantive test
C. Statistical sample
D. Risk assessment
450
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
451
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1745. In planning attribute sampling of data, which one of the following factors
would be LEAST important?
A. Review and evaluation of internal controls
B. Age of the system being examined
C. Past audit experience and previous test results
D. Expected error rate
Q1746. The people, who have contact with the system such as employees and
customers, are:
A. Users
B. Systems analysis
C. Programmers
D. Clients/Customers
Q1748. The person who fills the role of the change agent is the
A. System analyst
B. Administration
C. Programmer
D. User
Q1749. The kind of interview where all question are planned in advance is
called
A. Structured
B. Unstructured
452
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. Audit program
D. Checklist
Q1750. When the entire new system is used by a portion of the users it is called
A. Pilot conversion
B. Direct conversion
C. Parallel conversion
D. Phased conversion
453
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1754. If a program fails to par a test, the programmer can call for a
………………… program run to check on the status of the registers after
each program operations
A. Trace
B. Mapping
C. Linker
D. Loader
454
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1761. The kind of interview where all question are planned in advance is
called
A. Structured
B. Unstructured
C. Audit program
D. Checklist
455
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
Q1763. The people, who have contact with the system such as employees and
customers, are:
A. Users
B. Systems analysis
C. Programmers
D. Clients/Customers
Q1764. The person who fills the role of the change agent is the
A. System analyst
B. Administration
C. Programmer
D. User
Q1765. When the entire new system is used by a portion of the users it is called
A. Pilot conversion
B. Direct conversion
C. Parallel conversion
D. Phased conversion
456
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
C. Structured interview
D. Observations
Q1769. If a program fails to par a test, the programmer can call for a
………………… program run to check on the status of the registers after
each program operations
A. Trace
B. Mapping
C. Linker
D. Loader
457
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
458
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
459
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
460
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 5
461
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Module 6 Questions
Q1776. “An IS auditor conducting a review of software usage and
licensingdiscovers that numerous PCs contain unauthorized software.
Which of the following actions should the IS auditor perform FIRST? “
A. Personally delete all copies of the unauthorized software.
B. Inform auditee of the unauthorized software and follow-up to
confirm deletion.
C. Report the use of the unauthorized software to auditee
management and the need to prevent recurrence.
D. Take no action, as it is a commonly accepted practice and
operations management is responsible for monitoring such use.
462
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1781. During a review of the controls over the process of defining IT service
levels an IS auditor would MOST likely interview the:
A. Business unit manager.
B. Legal staff.
C. Systems programmer.
D. Programmer.
463
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
464
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
465
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1792. “The Information Technology Act does not apply to all of the following,
except: “
A. e-banking mechanism used instead of a cheque
B. A will
C. Electronic contract for sale of building through electronic means.
D. Notification of documents in the Government Gazette
Q1793. Identify the one that is NOT a key concept of object-oriented technology.
A. Encapsulation
B. Reusability
C. Messaging
D. Inheritance
466
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
467
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1800. Identify the factor that is not part of an expert system architrcture.
A. Knowledge base
B. Computing environment
C. Inference engine
D. End user interface
Q1801. “An IS Auditor has been assigned the task of reviewing the Information
Systems Security of a Sales Database, this refers to evaluation of
Information based on the following criteria: “
A. Effectiveness, Efficiency and Authenticity
B. Confidentiality, Integrity and Availability
C. Availability, Integrity and Reliability
D. Confidentiality, Compliance and Reliability
Q1802. “The risk that an IS auditor uses an inadequate test procedure and
concludes that material errors do not exist when, in fact, they do, is an
example of: “
A. Inherent risk.
B. Control risk.
C. Detection risk.
D. Audit risk.
468
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1804. “The most effective option of using computer programs for testing client
data is: “
A. Use the client’s program
B. Write a program specifically for the purposes of the audit
C. Use a generalized audit software
D. Use a walk-through approach to understanding the process
Q1805. “An auditor plans to use CAATs extensively for conducting an internal
audit of manufacturing operations of an enterprise. CAATs are least
likely to be used for: “
A. Drawing out appropriate samples
B. Interface with production databases to query
C. Report the audit findings with evidence
D. Uncover fraudulent transactions
Q1807. Using Generalised Audit Software for testing application if correct rates
are applied to sales invoices involves
A. Testing the logic and sales data of the auditee
B. Testing the actual sales data from the database of the client
organisation.
C. Testing the auditee’s sales application software
D. Testing the access controls
Q1808. As a basis of determining the size of the project, COCOMO model uses:
A. Function Points
B. Object Points
C. Lines of Code
D. None of the above
470
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1812. Compliance testing could be most effectively used for testing the:
A. Completeness of transactions
B. Accuracy of transactions
C. Implementation of controls as per policy
D. Processing of transactions
471
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1818. “IS audit refers to any audit that encompasses review and evaluation
of:”
A. Efficiency of computing resources and networking technologies
B. Controls in Computerised information systems
C. Risks and controls as regards use of IT for business
D. Automated information processing systems and its interfaces
472
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1821. In SDLC, in which phase would you perform Boundary value analysis?
A. Requirements
B. Design
C. Implementation
D. Maintenance
Q1822. A lower cost software product metric that is used for data collection :
A. Requirements tracing
B. Defect counts
C. Function points
D. Test coverage
473
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
474
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1828. “The most critical control consideration in designing the audit procedures
in a computerized environment is: “
A. Lack of segregation of duties
B. Lack of management control
C. Lack of IT knowledge by IT staff operating the system
D. The online and real time nature of the system
475
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
476
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1836. “The risk assessment approach should ensure that formal agreement
on residual risk. The most critical factor on which this depends is: “
A. Risk identification and measurement
B. Corporate policy
C. Adopting risk assessment approach of that of the competitor
D. Cost effectiveness of implementing safeguards and controls
Q1837. The risk assessment process involves all of the following except:
A. Take steps to reduce risk to an acceptable level
B. Assess probability of occurrence of threats
C. Identify the IT resources
D. Ascertain the risk profile
477
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1840. At which stage of Software Development Life Cycle (SDLC) the program
development work is completed
A. Design specifications
B. “Program specifications
C. System testing
D. Unit testing
478
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
479
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1851. Which would ensure that IS organizations do not take more resources
for less output?
A. Full-scale projects
B. Pilot projects
C. Grand design projects
D. Conversion projects
Q1856. Identify the non-cost factor while analysing feasible system alternatives
for an organisation.
A. Conversion
B. Supplies
C. Maintenance
D. Obsolescence
Q1859. In the Software Capability Maturity Model, the Productivity and Quality
of a software project is measured in:
A. Level 1
B. Level 2
C. Level 3
D. Level 4
Q1862. Identify the element that is not connected with structured design.
A. Coupling
B. Cohesion
C. Objects
D. Structure charts
Q1863. In which phase of SDLC would you use software sneak circuit analysis?
A. Requirements
B. Design
C. Implementation
D. Maintenance
482
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1865. The most efficient stress testing tool used for both front end and
backend applications is:
A. Open STA
B. Microsoft web application stress tool
C. Compuware’s QA load
D. Pureload
Q1867. Which file format requires an acrobat reader to view the file?
A. .zip
B. .pdf
C. .html
D. .arc
483
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1868. Which of the following is done at various testing points in the production
process.
A. Regression Testing
B. Vee Testing
C. Black Box Testing
D. Integration Testing
Q1869. Which one of the following is NOT a part of software quality metrics?
A. Completeness
B. Ergonomics
C. Correctness
D. Reliability
Q1870. Which of the following would greatly affect the project estimate if any
changes made to it while developing a project?
A. Time
B. Scope
C. Quality
D. Resources
Q1871. Software metric that deals with measurement of lines of code is:
A. Requirements metrics
B. Design metrics
C. Code metrics
D. Test metrics
484
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1874. Identify the item that is not a part of performance guarantees in software
contract negotiations.
A. Terms of payment
B. Warranty provisions
C. Package fixes
D. Penalty provisions
Q1875. Which one of the following errors will occur because of overflow
conditions?
A. Requirement errors
B. Design errors
C. Process errors
D. Data errors
485
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1876. The testing process conducted during the “live” application of software
is a ___________
A. Functional test
B. Performance test
C. Beta test
D. Acceptance test
Q1878. Which of the following is the most difficult to manage in a SDLC project?
A. Personnel turnover
B. Changes in hardware
C. Creeping functions
D. Changes in project scheduling
486
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1882. The process of visualising the design of a project that is yet to take
shape is called:
A. data abstraction
B. Data modeling
C. Data transparency
D. Data designing
487
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1886. The cost incurred in collecting data comes under: [a] [b] [c] [d]
A. Prevention cost
B. Appraisal cost
C. Internal failure cost
D. External failure cost
Q1887. The of information design type used for navigational aids and graphs
for geographical use is:
A. Pictogrammatic
B. Diagrammatic
C. Cartographic
D. Hybrid
488
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
489
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
490
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1902. Which one of the following metrics deal with “number of entries/exits per
module” ?
A. Requirements metrics
B. Design metrics
C. Code metrics
D. Test metrics
491
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1908. In the development life cycle model, the place to start software quality
process is:
A. Requirements phase
B. Design phase
C. Coding phase
D. Testing phase
492
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
C. Integration test
D. Configuration test
Q1910. Availability of computer time is taken care of in which part of the Project
Planning and scheduling ?
A. Milestones
B. Deliverables
C. Baseline
D. Assumptions
Q1912. You would NOT use stubs or drivers in which of the following testing
approaches?
A. A top-down approach
B. A bottom-up approach
C. A sandwich approach
D. A big bang approach
493
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
494
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1920. Which of the following software metrics would refer to function points?
A. Requirements metrics
B. Design metrics
C. Code metrics
D. Test metrics
495
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1927. A computer programmer altered the program for Saving Bank accounts
so that his account would be not be listed, when a list of accounts
with over draft was prepared. Following controls would be effective in
preventing or detecting this fraud EXCEPT?
A. a User sign-off for program changes.
B. Special Internal Auditor review of all employee accounts
C. Independent code review following any changes
D. Prohibiting the programmers to move complied programs to
production.
496
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
497
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1932. A software metric will NOT define which one of the following?
A. Number of defects per thousand lines of code
B. Number of defects over the life of a software product
C. Number of customer problems reported to the size of the product
D. Number of customer problems reported per user month
Q1934. Which one of the following will be included in the application software
testing phase for effective controls?
A. Test cases, test documentation
B. Test summaries, test execution reports
C. Activity logs, incident reports, software versioning
D. Test cases rejected, test cases accepted
498
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1937. With respect to the various phases in the system development life cycle,
which of the following is least likely to vary:
A. conduct of each phase as planned
B. sequence in which the phases are performed
C. resources and time needed to perform each phase
D. presence of each phase
Q1938. Which of the following statements is true with regard to Computer Aided
Software Engineering (CASE) workbench?
A. A single CASE tool is more effective when used individually than
when combined with more than two
B. It is very difficult to add a new case workbench or replace an
existing one
C. An organisation has to depend on a single supplier
D. Workbench can be easily managed with the aid of the
configuration management system
Q1939. Which of the following system life factors is most difficult to control by
a user organization?
A. The length of time the system will satisfy the needs of the initial
user
B. The rate at which computer technology is expected to advance
C. The probability of continued availability of system support
D. The time required for subsequent acquisition to meet the
requirement
499
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1941. Which of the following testing approaches will test the system’s ability
to withstand misuse by inexperienced users?
A. Functional testing
B. Unit testing
C. Resiliency testing
D. User acceptance testing
Q1942. Which of the following testing method is used when the loops in a
program are not structured.
A. Flow graphs
B. Graph Matrix
C. Concatenating loop
D. No testing is done until loops are redesigned and structureD.
Q1943. Which of the following tests address the interaction and consistency
issues of successfully tested Parts of a system?
A. Unit testing
B. Acceptance testing
C. Integration testing
D. System testing
500
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1944. Which of the following tests ensures that all the programs in the system
being developed work in concert and their communication among
themselves is as designed?
A. Unit test
B. Interface test
C. Regression test
D. Integration test
Q1946. Which one of the following criteria shall NOT be considered for choosing
an appropriate Computer platform to suit a given application software
system?
A. Database size
B. Data usage
C. System development tools
D. Data storage
Q1947. Which one of the following design approaches would address data
sharing and system access problems in legacy application systems?
A. Develop a shareware application
B. Develop a freeware application
C. Develop an API application
D. Develop a GUI application
501
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1950. Which one of the following graphical user interface (GUI development
approaches would create more user-friendly interactions ?
A. Object-oriented user interfaces
B. Application-oriented user interfaces
C. Screen-oriented manipulation user interfaces
D. Menu-oriented user interfaces
502
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1953. Which one of the following maintenance aspects would greatly ensure
the currency of the plan as time passes?
A. Incorporate into hardware upgrades
B. Incorporate into change management procedures
C. Incorporate into software upgrades
D. Incorporate into revision procedures
Q1956. Which one of the following pairs, when performed simultaneously, would
pose a major Risk?
A. Systems analysis and design
B. System design and programming
C. Programming and testing
D. Test case preparation and test case execution
503
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1957. Which one of the following reasons is the most important to retain a
legacy application system?
A. It meets the needs of the organization
B. Changing the computing platform may not improve the legacy
system
C. resistance to change
D. Low maintenance cost
Q1958. Which one of the following software test methods should invariably
perform Input-tolerance testing?
A. Unit testing
B. Integration testing
C. Production operations acceptance testing
D. User acceptance testing
504
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1964. After which of the following testing , should formal change control
mechanism start?
A. After completion of integration testing
B. After completion of unit testing
C. After completion of systems testing
D. After completion of acceptance testing
505
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1965. All of the following assumptions about legacy application systems are
correct except
A. A legacy system is a mainframe computer-based application
system
B. A legacy system is old and hence no longer good
C. A legacy system uses a proprietary programming language
D. A legacy system is difficult to port to other environments
Q1966. Among the various software analyses listed below, the controlling
functionality against software failure is provided by:
A. Safety analysis
B. Sneak circuit analysis
C. Fault tree analysis
D. Hazard analysis
Q1968. An IS auditor takes part in the development team deliberations NOT for
A. ensuring adequacy of data integrity controls
B. ensuring adequacy of data security controls
C. ensuring that there are no cost and time overruns
D. ensuring that documentation is accurate and complete
506
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
B. the extent of issues pointed out in the user acceptance test and
the unresolved issues
C. the documentation of the test results
D. the log containing the problems reported by the users
Q1972. Auditors gather evidence during the review of the system design of a
software project. Which of the following tools will they NOT depend?
A. Observation of the design process
B. Interviewing the development team
C. Verifying the documented plan
D. Circulating questionnaires among the members of the team for
their self evaluation
507
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1975. Customer details like address changes etc are being used in too many
mainframe application systems calling for a great deal of data entry
redundancy effort. In this situation, which one of the following method
will be useful?
A. Develop “seamless” processes
B. Eliminate mainframe computer processing
C. Develop a data synchronization software
D. Develop a client/server system
508
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1978. Difference between the spiral model and the incremental model is:
A. The former is an evolutionary process, the latter is a classic
process
B. “The former is time consuming, the latter is time saving”
C. The former does not ensure delivery of product after every
iteration, the latter does
D. None of the above
Q1980. Each of the following are preventive controls over the systems
development EXCEPT:
A. Standard methodology
B. Documentation standards.
C. Post implementation reviews.
D. User training program.
509
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
B. provide the basis for carrying out comprehensive system and user
tests
C. determine whether there are any bugs in the new hardware/
system software configuration that has been chosen
D. provide the basis for validating the design and implementation of
the new system
Q1983. During the conduct of a source code review, the examination of the data
processing installation’s programming standards occurs:
A. after the source code listing has been obtained
B. concurrently with the source code review
C. before reviewing the program’s specifications
D. standard may not be reviewed at all
510
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1986. During the problem definition phase, the terms of reference do not
describe:
A. boundaries of the system to be examined
B. proposed objectives of the new system
C. problems of the stakeholders
D. organisational and resource constraints
Q1987. Expert systems are NOT associated with one of the following:
A. Expert systems are aimed at solving problems using an
algorithmic approach
B. Expert systems are aimed at solving problems that are
characterized by irregular structure
C. Expert systems are aimed at solving problems characterized by
incomplete information
D. Expert systems are aimed at solving problems characterized by
considerable complexity
Q1988. Find the CRITICAL PATH among the following paths in a PERT chart?
Path 1: A-D-E-G- 120 MANDAYS, Path 2: A-B-C-D-G- 125 MANDAYS,
Path 3: A-F-G -135 MANDAYS, Path 4: A-B-F-G -137 MANDAYS
A. Path 1
B. Path 2
C. Path 3
D. Path 4
511
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1992. Formal change control mechanism would start after which of the
following in an overall system development project?
A. Completing the system planning document
B. Completing the system requirements document
C. Completing the system design document
D. Completing the program coding work
512
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1996. Identify the cost that does NOT form part of software package
installation or implementation cost?
A. Cost of hardware
B. Cost of file conversion
C. Cost of computer downtime
D. Cost of initial debugging of software
Q1997. Identify the document which is LEAST effective during the acceptance
test of applications software.
A. Program source code
B. System requirements definition
513
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q1998. Identify the technique that mostly prevents a system failure from
occurring or facilitates quick recovery from failures.
A. Component isolation
B. Component modularity
C. Component redundancy
D. Information hiding
Q1999. Identify the test-case design techniques that is used in unit and
integration testing of applications software.
A. White-box, code-based, logic-driven technique
B. Black-box, code-based, data-driven technique
C. White-box, specification-based, logic-driven technique
D. Black-box, specification-based, data-driven technique
514
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
515
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2009. In order to achieve the requirements of the user, the BEST option in
acquiring an off-the-shelf applications software package is
A. Build or buy
B. Purchase and tailor
C. Lease or purchase
D. Rent or purchase
516
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2012. In the system development life cycle approach, which of the following
is MOST likely to be constant?
A. Allocation of resources for purchase of software platforms and
hardware
B. Certain phases can be dropped
C. Each phase will have to be present
D. The sequence of the phases cannot vary
Q2013. In which of following system development life cycle models one phase
has to be completed before starting another phase?
A. Waterfall model
B. Prototyping model
C. Spiral model
D. Incremental model
517
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
C. Operation/Maintenance Phase
D. All the five stages of system development life cycle
Q2016. Information Systems auditors can take part in the system development
life cycle as an independent member is not likely to jeopardize his/her
audit quality. In which of the following stages will the participation will
be the MOST effective?
A. Design phase
B. Requirements definition phase
C. Development phase
D. Testing phase
518
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2020. Many automated tools are designed for testing and evaluating computer
systems. Which one of the following such tools impact the system s
performance with a greater load and stress on the system?
A. Test data generators
B. Statistical software packages
C. Test drivers
D. Network traffic analyzers
Q2022. PC-based analysis and design tools are used alongwith mainframe
computer-based tools. Identify the CASE tool that is required in this
situation.
A. Diagramming tools
B. Simulation tools
C. Export/import tools
D. Diagram checking tools
519
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2024. Project management needs are addressed first and artificial approach
to development is adopted in
A. rapid prototyping model
B. incremental development model
C. evolutionary development model
D. waterfall model or SDLC model
520
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2027. Since it is the end-users who are going to use an application, they
must be consulted and their opinions must be incorporated if found
reasonable. Which of the following principle of User-Interface Design
reflects the above statements?
A. User-Perceptions
B. Context-Sensitivity
C. User Testing
D. Aesthetics
521
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2034. System development controls are designed to prevent all of the following
EXCEPT:
A. Lack of project status reports
B. Implementation of unapproved system
C. Lack of adequate program controls.
D. Unauthorised program modification
522
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2035. The auditor uses a normative model of the system development process
as a basis for:
A. determining what activities are usually undertaken during system
development
B. describing the activities that are to be carried during system
development that would change the distribution of power within
the organisation
C. determining the activities that should be carried out during system
development
D. determining development activities depending on the
circumstances at hand
523
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2040. The Critical path in a program evaluation review technique (PERT) chart
is identified by
A. the project management team looking at the criticality of the
function
B. the maximum slack time carrying path
C. the path containing zero slack time
D. an agreement after discussion among the users and the project
development team
524
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2043. The estimate of time which has the MOST important relevance in
evaluation of the activities in a Program Evaluation Review Technique
(PERT is:
A. Most Likely time
B. Pessimistic time
C. Actual time
D. Optimistic Time
Q2044. The extent to which a newly developed or acquired system meets the
functionality required of it is determined in:
A. Unit testing of the individual program
B. Function test or whole-of-program test
C. User acceptance test (UAT)
D. Interface test
Q2045. The information systems requirements plan is derived directly from the:
A. information systems applications and general controls plan
B. long term master plan
C. organisational strategic plan
D. information systems strategic plan
Q2047. The main focus of the graphical user interface (GUI environments is:
A. Portability guidelines
525
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2050. The most important factor while creating test data for checking a
system, is :
A. Have a sufficient quantity of data for each test case
B. Keep the test data to a minimum to conserve testing time
C. Select a random sample of actual data to ensure adequate
testing
D. Include data which represent conditions that occur in actual
processing
526
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2052. The primary difference between program testing and system testing is:
A. program testing is more comprehensive than system testing
B. system testing is concerned with testing all aspects of a system
including user specification document, design document, job
designs and reward system designs
C. programmers have no involvement in system testing, whereas
designers and users are involved in program testing
D. system testing focuses on testing the interfaces between
programs, whereas program testing focuses on individual
programs
527
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2057. The statement which is NOT false regarding end user computing is:
A. Catering to the user’s requirement is more in such systems.
B. Implementation of change control procedures is easier.
C. Since the respective end users download their required data,
duplication of data does not occur.
D. Due to the programming staff not being involved, segregation of
duties is increased.
Q2058. The System Development Tool which gives the BEST results in an
application maintenance function is:
A. Network control programs
B. Tape Management systems
C. Project Management softwares
D. Test data generators
Q2059. The test approach that includes ALL of the systems requirement, system
design, and systems development documents is :
A. Unit testing
B. Integration testing
C. Systems testing
D. Acceptance testing
528
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2062. To which one of the following issues that an information systems (IS)
auditor participating in a system development life cycle project should
devote more attention ?
A. Technical issues
B. Organizational issues
C. Behavioral issues
D. Contractual issues
529
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2066. What is the control that should have been in vogue so as to enable
detection of a change made in a payroll program by a computer
operator?
A. Output of the payroll journal’s audit trail.
B. Review of the control totals.
C. Review of the payroll by the payroll department on a regular
basis.
D. Review of console logs for attempted / illegal intrusion.
530
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2069. what is the major risk that is faced by a user organization during system
integration projects?
A. Isolated islands of information
B. Processing and computing power
C. Maintenance costs
D. System size and complexity
Q2070. What would you use to enforce integration rules so as to integrate one
component with another?
A. A data flow diagram
B. An entity relationship diagram
C. A state transition diagram
D. A data dictionary
531
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2072. When a software application is acquired from a vendor, the terms of the
purchase order WILL NOT generally contain :
A. annual maintenance contract terms after the warranty period
B. details of software licence fees and other licence terms
C. terms of acceptance testing
D. dates of future updates and the fees for acquiring them
532
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
533
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
534
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2083. Which of the following are not part of the information systems design:
A. design of the data/information flow
B. design of the user interfaces
C. design of the user specification document layout
D. job design
Q2084. Which of the following factors would bring down the risks most in Joint
Application Design (JAD meetings?
A. The right software
B. The right people
C. The right training
D. The right hardware
Q2085. Which of the following CANNOT be used for measuring the progress of
a software development project?
A. Appraisal of the performance of the team members by the
superiors
B. Milestone achievement
C. Review of the codes generated
D. Review of the system design
535
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
C. Object-oriented technology
D. Graphical-user interface (GUI) technology
536
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2092. Which of the following is NOT a constraint while using Computer Aided
Software Engineering (CASE tools running on workstations.
A. Lack of multi-user operations
B. Inability to handle large databases
C. Lack of security controls
D. Lack of tools for source code generation
Q2094. Which of the following is NOT a prerequisite for software system project
planning?
A. Availability of the technical expertise
B. Goals and objectives of the plan
C. The functional requirements
D. Programming area environment and infrastructure
537
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2098. Which of the following is not true with regard to Black Box Testing.
A. It may leave many program paths untesteD.
B. Both the tester and programmer are independent of each other.
C. Requires knowledge of internal working of the program.
D. Tests are designed to know if the system is sensitive to certain
input values.
Q2099. Which of the following is not true with regard to Commercial Off-The-
Shelf (COTS) systems:
A. Commercial Off-The-Shelf are highly secured
B. The cost of developing Commercial Off-The-Shelf is very high
C. There is no possibility of mismatch between Commercial Off-The-
Shelf components
D. The component user has little or no control over the evolution of
component
538
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2100. Which of the following is the most likely sequence of phases in the
system development process:
A. feasibility study, system design, procedures and forms
development, acceptance testing
B. acceptance testing, procedures development, management of the
change process
C. entry and feasibility assessment, problem definition, analysis of
the existing system
D. feasibility study, information analysis, system design, program
development
Q2101. Which of the following is the NOT effective control for program
changes?
A. Independent review of changed program by quality assurance
group
B. Version control
C. Annual reviews of program listing
D. Compilation of source code by IS librarian
Q2103. Which of the following is true with regard to the audit of acquisition risks.
A. Conversion costs need not be included in the cost benefit
analysis of the alternatives.
B. Analysis of each alternative takes into account only quantifiable
benefits.
539
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2104. Which of the following is true with regard to White Box Testing?
A. Output of the program code is not required before the beginning
of the code.
B. It is not very expensive.
C. It may involve testing every line of code.
D. It shows errors caused by omission.
540
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2108. Which of the following software defect prevention activities would ensure
the highest Rate on Investment?
A. Code inspection
B. Reviews with users/customers Design reviews
C. Design reviews
D. Unit test
Q2110. Which of the following system life factors is most difficult to control by
a user organization?
A. The length of time the system will satisfy the needs ofthe initial
user
B. The rate at which computer technology is expected to advance
C. The probability of continued availability of system support
D. The time required for subsequent acquisition to meet the
requirement
541
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
542
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
543
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2121. Which of the following situations would increase the likelihood of fraud
A. Application programmers are implementing changes to production
programs
B. Application programmers are implementing changes to test
programs
C. Operations support staff are implementing changes to batch
schedules
D. Database administrators are implementing changes to data
structures.
544
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2123. A company that has to guarantee zero downtime and 100 percent
functionality would choose which type of backup facility?
A. Redundant
B. Rolling site
C. Cold
D. Warm
Q2125. Which of the following best describes the concept and purpose of BCP?
A. BCPs are created to prevent interruptions to normal business
activity
B. BCPs are used to reduce outage times
C. BCPs and procedures are put in place for the response to an
emergency
D. BCPs guarantee the reliability of standby systems
545
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2127. During the BCP process, which group directs the planning,
implementation, and development of the test procedures?
A. BCP committee
B. Senior business unit management
C. Executive management staff
D. Functional business units
Q2129. Which of the following elements of the BCP process includes the
completion of a vulnerability assessment?
A. Business impact assessment
B. Plan approval and implementation
C. Scope and plan initiation
D. Business continuity plan development
Q2130. Which phase of the BCP process includes project parameter definition?
A. Scope and plan initiation
B. Plan approval and implementation
C. Business impact assessment
D. Business continuity plan development
546
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2134. In disaster recovery, each level of employee should have clearly defined
responsibilities. Which of the following is a responsibility of senior
executives?
A. Oversee budgets and the overall project
B. Develop testing plans
C. Establish project goals and develop plans
D. Identify critical business systems
547
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2136. There are several reasons for a company to develop and implement
a disaster recovery plan. What is the most important goal of disaster
recovery?
A. Protect human life
B. Protect the integrity of the business
C. Protect critical operating systems
D. Protect customer relationships
Q2137. What is the maximum tolerable downtime (MTD) for urgent systems and
functions?
A. 24 hours
B. Minutes of hours
C. 4 to 6 hours
D. 72 hours
Q2138. A company that has to guarantee zero downtime and 100 percent
functionality would choose which type of backup facility?
A. Redundant
B. Rolling site
C. Cold
D. Warm
548
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2140. Which of the following best describes the concept and purpose of BCP?
A. BCPs are created to prevent interruptions to normal business
activity
B. BCPs are used to reduce outage times
C. BCPs and procedures are put in place for the response to an
emergency
D. BCPs guarantee the reliability of standby systems
Q2142. During the BCP process, which group directs the planning,
implementation, and development of the test procedures?
A. BCP committee
B. Senior business unit management
C. Executive management staff
D. Functional business units
549
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2144. Which of the following elements of the BCP process includes the
completion of a vulnerability assessment?
A. Business impact assessment
B. Plan approval and implementation
C. Scope and plan initiation
D. Business continuity plan development
Q2145. Which phase of the BCP process includes project parameter definition?
A. Scope and plan initiation
B. Plan approval and implementation
C. Business impact assessment
D. Business continuity plan development
550
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2148. What is the maximum tolerable downtime (MTD) for urgent systems and
functions?
A. 24 hours
B. Minutes of hours
C. 4 to 6 hours
D. 72 hours
Q2150. In disaster recovery, each level of employee should have clearly defined
responsibilities. Which of the following is a responsibility of senior
executives?
A. Oversee budgets and the overall project
B. Develop testing plans
C. Establish project goals and develop plans
D. Identify critical business systems
551
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
Q2152. There are several reasons for a company to develop and implement
a disaster recovery plan. What is the most important goal of disaster
recovery?
A. Protect human life
B. Protect the integrity of the business
C. Protect critical operating systems
D. Protect customer relationships
552
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
553
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
554
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
555
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
556
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 6
557
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Module 7 Questions
Q2153. In order to provide maximum assurance on user identification the best
method of user authentication should be based on what user
A. is.
B. knows.
C. has.
D. does.
Q2155. The controls in Client-Server architecure first addres the risks arising
out of:
A. Client malfuntion.
B. Ping of death attack.
C. Network failure.
D. Application development.
558
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
559
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
C. corrective control
D. compensating control
Q2163. User found and repaired virus on his work station should first report to:
A. System administrator.
B. Network administrator.
C. Security administrator.
D. Data Base Administrator.
560
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2169. During the audit, control self assessment questionnaire replied by the
local management was made available to IS Auditor. The IS auditor
should:
A. Substantiate the answers.
B. Rely the answers and do nothing.
C. Ignore it since it is out of scope.
D. Ask for previous audit report instead.
561
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2172. In a financial organization the transaction are posted into the Date Base
by the accounts assistant. A member of managerial staff authorizes the
transaction after posting. Which of the following access rights can be
allotted to the member of supervising staff in addition to ‘Update the
data base for confirming authorization of transactions.’?
A. Generate report and query the contents of fields from the
database.
B. Enter the transactions when accounts assistant is on leave.
C. Change the access rights of other staff members.
D. Necessary rights to modify the programs which updates the data
base.
562
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2174. Which of the following control functions will be most effective due to the
use of Biometric Security solutions?
A. Authentication
B. Access
C. Password
D. Smart Cards
Q2175. Which of the following is the MOST likely reason why e-mail systems
have become a useful source of evidence for litigation?
A. Poor housekeeping leads to excessive cycles of backup files
remaining available.
B. Strong access controls establish accountability for activity on the
e-mail system.
C. Data classification is often used to regulate what information
should be communicated via e-mail.
D. Clear policy for using e-mail within the enterprise ensures that the
right evidence is available.
563
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
C. Corrective control.
D. Compensating control.
Q2178. Which of the following is a dynamic analysis tool for the purpose of
testing of software modules?
A. Black box test
B. Desk checking
C. Structured walk-through
D. Design and code
Q2180. The risk that an IS auditor uses an inadequate test procedure and
concludes that material errors do not exist when, in fact, they do, is an
example of:
A. Inherent risk.
B. Control risk.
C. Detection risk.
D. Audit risk.
564
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2182. An internal IS Auditor had been given charter to audit the software
implementation. During preliminary review the auditor found that the
scope of audit need to be enhanced to include review of software
development process. Which of the following should approve this
change?
A. Chief Information Officer
B. Board of Directors
C. Audit Committee
D. Chief Executive officer
Q2183. An IS auditor is assigned to help design the data security, data integrity
and business continuity aspects of an application under development.
Which of the following provides the MOST reasonable assurance that
corporate assets are protected when the application is certified for
production?
A. A certification review conducted by the internal auditor.
B. A certification review conducted by the assigned IS auditor.
C. Specifications by the user on the depth and content of the
certification review.
D. An independent review conducted by another equally experienced
IS auditor.
Q2184. Which of the following controls would BEST serve to effectively detect
intrusion?
A. User creation and user privileges are granted through authorized
procedures.
B. Automatic logoff when a workstation is inactive for a particular
period of time.
C. Automatic logoff of the system after a specified number of
unsuccessful attempts.
D. Unsuccessful logon attempts are actively monitored by the
security administrator.
565
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2188. A feature of a digital signature that ensures that the claimed sender
cannot later deny generating and sending the message is:
A. Provide an audit trail
B. Can be used in a switchboard environment
C. Permit unlimited user mobility
D. Allow call forwarding
566
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2192. While auditing IT infrastructure the IS auditor observed that there were
no procedures defined for the performance monitoring of third-party
567
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
568
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
569
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
C. Sensitive.
D. Non-critical.
Q2200. Which of the following methods of results analysis, during the testing of
the business continuity plan BCP , provides the BEST assurance that
the plan is workable?
A. Quantitatively measuring the results of the test
B. Measurement of accuracy
C. Elapsed time for completion of prescribed tasks
D. Evaluation of the observed test results
570
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2205. Which of the following program change controls is NOT the responsibility
of the user department?
A. Updating documentation to reflect all changes
B. Initiating requests within its scope of authority
C. Approving changes before implementation, based on the results
of testing
D. Approving changes before implementation, based on review of
changes to manual procedures
571
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2209. Which of the following testing methods is MOST effective during the
initial phases of prototyping?
A. System testing
B. Parallel testing
C. Volume testing
D. Top-down testing
572
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
573
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2215. If the decision has been made to acquire software rather than develop
it internally, this decision is normally made during the:
A. Requirements definition phase of the project.
B. Feasibility study phase of the project.
C. Detailed design phase of the project.
D. Programming phase of the project.
Q2218. Which of the following is the FIRST point at which control totals
should be implemented in order to prevent the loss of data during the
processing cycle?
A. During data preparation
B. In transit to the computer
574
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2221. The primary reason for replacing cheques with elect ronic funds transfer
EFT systems in the accounts payable area is to:
A. Make the payment process more efficient.
B. Comply with international EFT banking standards.
C. Decrease the number of paper-based payment forms.
D. Reduce the risk of unauthorized changes to payment
transactions.
575
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2222. A tax calculation program maintains several hundred tax rates. The
BEST control to ensure that tax rates entered into the program are
accurate is:
A. Independent review of the transaction listing.
B. Programmed edit check to prevent entry of invalid data.
C. Programmed reasonableness checks with 20% data entry range.
D. Visual verification of data entered by the processing department.
576
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2228. A general hardware control that helps to detect data errors when data
are communicated from one computer to another is known as a:
A. Duplicate check.
B. Table look up.
577
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
C. Validity check.
D. Parity check.
578
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2235. To ensure continued operations data back-ups are stored off-site where
the redundant processing facilities are stored. Which of the following
statements is FALSE?
A. The site should bear the nameplate in order to identify the place
correctly in case of emergency.
B. The site should have similar physical access restriction as that of
original site.
C. The facilities are to be tested periodically in order to ensure
continued availability.
D. The hardware and software should be compatible
Q2236. In a situation where frequent power failures for varying periods from 6
to 8 hours, which of the following is the BEST possible solution?
A. Installation of UPS.
B. Installation of power generators.
579
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
580
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2241. A systems analyst should have access to each of the following expect
A. Source code
B. Password identification tables
C. user procedures
D. Edit criteria
Q2243. CASE (computer-aided software engineering )is the use of the computer
to aid in the development of computer-based information systems.
Which of the following could not be automatically generated with CASE
tools and techniques?
A. Information requirements determination
B. Program logic design
C. Computer program code
D. Program documentation
581
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2246. Which of the following statements regarding security concerns for laptop
computers is true ?
A. The primary methods of control usually involve general controls .
B. Centralized control over the selection and acquisition of hardware
and software is not a major concern
C. Some traditional controls such as segregation of duties become
more important
D. As their use becomes more sophisticated, the degree of concern
regarding physical security decreases.
Q2247. Which of the following is a control that will prevent accessing the
accounts receivable files from a hardwired terminal located in a
manufacturing department?
A. An echo check.
B. A device authorization table
C. Providing only dial-up terminals
D. Using data encryption .
582
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2250. To increase the security of application software, the internal audit direct
or recommended that programmers be given diskless workstations
Using diskless workstations would increase security by
A. Making theft of programs more difficult
B. Reducing workstation maintenance expense
C. Imposing a stricter level of access control
D. Prompting programmers to work more closely together
583
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2252. Security Policy for Information technology of a Bank specifies that all the
employees should clear the screen of monitor when not working. Which
of the following best describes the reason for this policy?
A. Prevent shoulder surfing.
B. Restrict electronic eavesdropping.
C. Save monitor from damage.
D. Avoid password sniffing.
584
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2259. Which of the following manages the certificate life cycle of public key
pairs to ensure adequate security and controls exist in e-commerce
applications?
A. Registration authority
B. Certificate authority
C. Certification relocation list
D. Certification practice statement
585
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2263. When auditing the proposed acquisition of a new computer system, the
IS auditor should FIRST establish that:
A. A clear business case has been approved by management.
B. Corporate security standards will be met.
C. Users will be involved in the implementation plan.
D. The new system will meet all required user functionality.
586
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2266. Which of the following types of firewalls provide the GREATEST degree
and granularity of control?
A. Screening router
B. Packet-filter
C. Application-gateway
D. Circuit-gateway
587
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
588
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2275. Which of the following is the BEST way to handle obsolete magnetic
tapes before disposing of them?
A. Overwriting the tapes
B. Initializing the tape labels
C. Degaussing the tapes
D. Erasing the tapes
589
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2276. Which of the following data entry controls provides the GREATEST
assurance that data entered does not contain errors?
A. Key verification
B. Segregation of the data entry function from data entry verification
C. Maintaining a log/record detailing the time, date, employee’s
initials/user-id and progress of various data preparation and
verification tasks
D. Check digits
Q2278. How can an enterprise provide access to its intranet i.e., extranet across
the Internet to its business partners?
A. Virtual private network
B. Client/server
C. Dial-in access
D. Network service provider
590
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2281. Most effective preventive control for use against unlicensed software is:
A. Periodic scans.
B. IT Security Policy.
C. Frequent audits.
D. Inventory of licenses.
Q2283. In a web server, a common gateway interface CGI is MOST often used
as an:
A. Consistent way for data transfer to the application program and
back to the user.
B. Computer graphics imaging method for movie and TV.
C. Graphic user interface for web design.
D. Interface to access the private gateway domain.
Q2284. A virtual private network VPN performs which of the following functions?
A. Hides information from sniffers on the net
B. Enforces security policies
591
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
592
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2288. Which of the following is a continuity plan test that uses actual
resources to simulate a system crash to cost-effectively obtain evidence
about the plan’s effectiveness?
A. Paper test
B. Post test
C. Preparedness test
D. Walkthrough
Q2291. The difference between white-box testing and black-box testing is that
white-box testing:
A. Involves the IS auditor.
B. Is performed by an independent programmer team.
593
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2293. Which of the following is most appropriate indication that prompts for
changing operating system?
A. Vendor’s report.
B. Requirements.
C. Obsolescence.
D. Response time.
Q2295. Which of following exposure to the data security occurs before the
computer security can protect the data?
A. Data diddling.
B. Trap Door.
C. Logic Bomb.
D. Trojan Horse.
594
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2299. The need for the modification of validation and editing routines to
improve efficiency is normally indicated by:
A. Excess overrides.
B. An override activity report.
C. Error control and correction.
D. Separation of duties.
595
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2303. A company uses a bank to process its weekly payroll. Time sheets and
payroll adjustment forms e.g., hourly rate changes, terminations are
filled in and delivered to the bank, which prepares checks cheques and
reports for distribution. To BEST ensure payroll data accuracy:
A. Payroll reports should be compared to input forms.
B. Gross payroll should be recalculated manually.
596
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2304. An external auditor was planning for the audit for effectiveness of IT
controls. However only internal auditor’s audit report was available
but not the work papers. The auditor could not determine type of tests
performed by the internal auditor to assure the effectiveness of controls
by internal auditor. The auditor should:
A. Change the scope of audit to include the tests.
B. Refuse to perform audit till work papers were made available.
C. Rely on previous audit report and not work papers.
D. Differ the tests till work papers were made available.
Q2307. Which of the following report is most useful for internal auditor in order
to gain understanding about auditee area?
A. Long term IT plan.
B. Annual financial results
C. Annual financial audit report
D. Minutes of Steering committee meeting
597
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2309. IS auditor observed that some controls defined by security policy were
not implemented by auditee management. What should auditor do next?
A. Compliance testing of implemented controls .
B. Substantive testing of implemented controls.
C. Risk assessment of non-implemented controls.
D. Suspend the audit and report to Management.
598
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2313. While auditing the Business continuity plan for information systems, the
IS auditor should first ensure that the plan:
A. Covers all business processes.
B. Provides for recovery of IT resources.
C. Specifies for insurance cover.
D. Has address of alternate site.
599
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2316. Which of the following will help management in getting feedback about
the achievement of planned IT goals?
A. Key Goal Indicators.
B. Balance Score Card.
C. Critical Success Factors.
D. Key Performance Indicators.
Q2318. Which of the following risk in wireless LAN must be controlled first?
A. Terminals are not connected to server.
B. Unauthorized terminal/client.
C. Possible unauthorized use of LAN.
D. Unauthorized software.
Q2320. During the Business continuity audit an IS auditor found that the BCP
covered only critical applications. The IS auditor should first:
A. Assess the impact on business due to non-availability of
processes not covered.
B. Insist on redesigning the BCP covering all is related processes.
600
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
601
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2327. While auditing Risk Management program, the auditor should first
ensure that:
A. Management accepts all natural risks.
B. Program monitors all residual risks.
C. Risk mitigation does not have preventive controls
D. Program use qualitative measurement standards.
Q2328. Which of the following will help auditor in determining the effectiveness
of help desk operations?
A. Problem aging analysis.
B. Query log maintained by help desk.
C. problem escalation report.
D. awareness level of end users.
602
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
603
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2333. While auditing hardware acquisition the IS auditor should first ensure
that:
A. Request for Proposal is in accordance with requirement analysis.
B. Hardware is selected on the basis of through put.
C. Request for proposal was sent to all vendors.
D. Selected hardware was offered at lowest cost.
Q2334. Which of the following feature of Job Scheduling software will be most
useful in ensuring successful completion of scheduled jobs?
A. Sequencing of processes.
B. Completion and error reporting.
C. Documentation of system.
D. Defined job dependencies.
Q2335. Centralize data base server is being accessed by users from various
geographical locations. Concurrency controls provided in this system
primarily ensures:
A. Integrity of data.
B. Usability of data.
C. Confidentiality of data.
D. Availability of data.
604
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2337. An IS Auditor was asked to audit ERP implementation. The auditor did
not have prior experience of ERP implantation. The auditor should:
A. Take help of independent skilled professional.
B. Refuse the assignment in absence of required skills.
C. Attend the training program on implementation of ERP.
D. Conduct the audit with due professional care.
Q2338. Some organizations have ‘required paid vacation’ facility for its’
employees. The purpose of this facility is :
A. A motivating incentive for hard working employees.
B. Increase the opportunity to discover fraudulent/irregular activities
of the employee.
C. A rest and recuperation refreshes the mind and improves the
quality of life.
D. Give opportunity to spend more time with family.
Q2340. It was decided to introduce the image processing technique for handling
of documents. IS auditor is concerned about the use of this technique.
Which of the following is PRIMARY reason of IS auditors’ concern.
A. The image processing software is very expensive.
B. Inadequate training may result in poor quality of images.
C. Imaging system may change or eliminate the traditional controls.
D. Workflow processes may have to be redesigned.
605
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2341. Which of the following would BEST ensure the proper updating of critical
fields in a master records?
A. Field checks.
B. Control totals.
C. Reasonableness checks.
D. Before and after maintenance report.
Q2342. While auditing the computer installation internal IS auditor found a virus-
infected file. What IS auditor should do FIRST?
A. Report to the IS manager and top management about the
presence of virus.
B. Inform the IS manager about the infection so as to enable him to
take the necessary steps.
C. Disinfect or Erase the infected file and check other computer
systems for infection.
D. Check the other computer systems whether they have similar
infection.
606
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2345. The auditor observed that, in absence of explicit mention in SLA, the
third party has appointed a sub-contractor to perform the outsourced
function. The auditor should FIRST:
A. Look for the auditability option in third party and sub-contractor.
B. Ascertain the control of third party over sub-contractor.
C. Report the absence of mention about sub-contracting in SLA.
D. Report the risk associated in such arrangement.
Q2347. Which of the following would BEST ensure continuity of a wide area
network WAN across the organization?
A. Built-in alternative routing
B. Full system back-up taken daily
C. A repair contract with a service provider
D. A duplicate machine alongside each server
607
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
the following key algorithms decrypt data with the same key used for
encryption?
A. Symmetric key algorithm.
B. Asymmetric key algorithm.
C. Symmetric and public key algorithm.
D. Asymmetric and secret key algorithm.
Q2349. Risk management consists of risk assessment and risk mitigation. Which
of the following is NOT an element of risk mitigation?
A. Measure risk.
B. Select appropriate safeguards.
C. Implement and test safeguards.
D. Accept residual risks.
608
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
Q2352. Your organization has hired a security-consulting firm for testing the
logical access security for dial-up connections. Which of the following
person MOST likely to be hired by the security firm?
A. Hackers.
B. Crackers.
C. Hardware Engineer
D. Software Engineer.
609
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
610
DISA Review Questions, Answers Manual – Module 7
611
1. Which of the following BEST describes the purpose or B. formally document the audit department's plan of
character of an audit charter? action.
A. An audit charter should be dynamic and change often C. document a code of professional conduct for the
to coincide with the changing nature of technology auditor.
and the audit profession. D. describe the authority and responsibilities of the audit
B. An audit charter should clearly state audit's objectives department.
for the delegation of authority for the maintenance 8. Which of the following forms of evidence would be
and review of internal controls. considered to be the MOST reliable when assisting an IS
C. An audit charter should document the audit Auditor develop audit conclusions?
procedures designed to achieve the planned audit A. A confirmation letter received from a third party for
objectives. the verification of an account balance
D. An audit charter should outline the overall authority, B. Assurance via a control self-assessment received from
scope and responsibilities of the audit function. line management that an application is working as
2. Which of the following would NOT be a reason why an IS designed
auditor would prepare a formal audit program? C. Trend data obtained from World Wide Web
A. To structure the IS auditor's own planning (Internet) sources
B. To guide assistants in performing planned procedures D. Ratio analysis developed by the IS auditor from
C. To provide audit documentation for review reference reports supplied by line management
D. To assess the overall risk of operations within the 9. Which of the following forms of evidence would be
organization considered to be the MOST reliable?
3. In a risk-based audit approach, an IS auditor is not only A. An oral statement from the auditee
influenced by risk but also by: B. The results of a test performed by an IS auditor
A. the availability of CAATs. C. An internally generated computer accounting report
B. management's representations. D. A confirmation letter received from an outside source
C. organizational structure and job responsibilities. 10. Which of the following is the MOST likely reason why e-
D. the existence of internal and operational controls. mail systems have become a useful source of evidence
4. The MAJOR advantage of the risk assessment approach for litigation?
over the baseline approach to information security A. Poor housekeeping leads to excessive cycles of backup
management is that it ensures that: files remaining available.
A. information assets are over protected. B. Strong access controls establish accountability for
B. a basic level of protection is applied regardless of asset activity on the e-mail system.
value. C. Data classification is often used to regulate what
C. appropriate levels of protection are applied to information should be communicated via e-mail.
information assets. D. Clear policy for using e-mail within the enterprise
D. an equal proportion of resources are devoted to ensures that the right evidence is available.
protecting all information assets. 11. Which of the following computer-based tools would
5. Which of the following procedures would an IS auditor assist an IS auditor when performing a statistical
NOT perform during pre-audit planning to gain an sampling of financial transactions maintained in a
understanding of the overall environment under review? financial management information system?
A. Tour key organization activities A. Spreadsheet auditor
B. Interview key members of management to B. Parallel simulation
understand business risks C. Generalized audit software
C. Perform compliance tests to determine if regulatory D. Regression testing
requirements are met 12. Which of the following would NOT be a use of
D. Review prior audit reports generalized audit software programs?
6. The use of risk assessment techniques will NOT help to A. Verifying calculations and totals
determine the: B. Performing intricate calculations
A. areas or business functions to be audited. C. Selecting data that an auditor defines as unusual
B. nature, extent and timing of audit procedures. D. Producing multiple reports and machine-readable
C. likely audit findings, conclusions and output files
recommendations. 13. Which of the following BEST describes an integrated test
D. amount of time and resources to be allocated to an facility?
audit. A. A technique that enables the IS auditor to enter test
7. The primary purpose and existence of an audit charter is data into a live computer run for the purpose of
to: verifying correct processing
A. document the audit process used by the enterprise. B. The utilization of hardware and/or software to review
and test the functioning of a computer system
600 Questions Pg 1
C. A method of using special programming options to systems, they are often used to detect control
permit printout of the path through a computer problems in very complex systems.
program taken to process a specific transaction 19. An IS auditor's substantive test reveals evidence of fraud
D. A procedure for tagging and extending transactions perpetrated from within a manager's account. The
and master records that are used by an IS auditor for manager had written his password, allocated by the
tests system administrator, inside his drawer, which was
14. Which of the following statements regarding test data normally kept locked. The IS auditor concludes that the:
techniques is TRUE? A. manager's assistant perpetrated the fraud.
A. It tests only preconceived situations. B. perpetrator cannot be established beyond doubt.
B. It requires the use of a test data generator. C. fraud must have been perpetrated by the manager.
C. It requires a high degree of technical IS knowledge. D. system administrator could have perpetrated the
D. It requires limited computer time and clerical effort. fraud
15. Which of the following statements regarding sampling is
TRUE?
A. Sampling is generally applicable when the population 20. Which of the following statements pertaining to the
relates to an intangible or undocumented control. determination of sample size is TRUE?
B. If an auditor knows internal controls are strong, the A. The larger the confidence level, the smaller the sample
confidence coefficient may be lowered. size "
C. An example of attribute sampling would be to B. The larger the standard deviation, the larger the
estimate the number of obsolete object code modules sample size"
based upon a sample evaluation from the population C. The smaller the precision amount, the smaller the
of object code library. sample size"
D. Variable sampling is a technique to estimate the rate D. Sample size is not affected by the expected error rate
of occurrence of a given control or set of related in the population
controls. 21. Which of the following would NOT normally be
16. Which of the following is NOT an advantage of using performed using CAATs?
CAATs? A. Footing totals
A. Reduces the level of audit risk B. Selecting testing samples
B. Provides broader and more consistent audit coverage C. Reconciling account posting
C. Saves time for source data input D. Testing aging of receivables
D. Improves exception identification 22. To gain a full understanding of a LAN environment, an
17. An important distinction an IS auditor should make IS auditor should document all of the following
when evaluating and classifying controls as preventive, functions EXCEPT:
detective or corrective is: A. LAN topology and network design.
A. the point when controls are exercised as data flows B. technical support/help desk functions.
through the system. C. duties and responsibilities of the LAN administrator.
B. only preventive and detective controls are relevant. D. the various computer applications used on the LAN.
C. corrective controls can only be regarded as 23. During a review of a customer master file an IS auditor
compensating. discovered numerous customer name duplications
D. classification allows an IS auditor to determine which arising from variations in customer first names. In order
controls are missing. to determine the extent of the duplication the IS auditor
18. Which of the following statements regarding an IS would use:
auditor's use of a continuous audit approach is TRUE? A. test data to validate data input.
A. A continuous audit approach is desirable because it B. test data to determine system sort capabilities.
does not require an IS auditor to collect evidence on C. generalized audit software to search for address field
system reliability while processing is taking place, duplications.
thus allowing more flexibility in approach. D. generalized audit software to search for account field
B. When employing a continuous audit approach it is duplications.
important that the IS auditor review and follow up 24. A manufacturing company has implemented a new
immediately on all information collected. client/server system enterprise resource planning (ERP)
C. The use of continuous auditing techniques can system. Local branches transmit customer orders to a
actually improve system security when used in time- central manufacturing facility. Which of the following
sharing environments that process a large amount of controls would BEST ensure that the orders are
transactions. accurately entered and the corresponding products
D. Since continuous audit techniques do not depend on produced?
the complexity of an organization's computer A. Verifying production to customer orders
B. Logging all customer orders in the ERP system
600 Questions Pg 2
C. Using hash totals in the order transmitting process D. compliance testing tests for regulatory requirements,
D. Approving (production supervisor) orders prior to while substantive testing tests validations.
production 32. An IS auditors is expected to use due professional care
25. Which of the following would an IS auditor consider to when performing audits, which requires that the
be the BEST population to take a sample from when individual exercise skill or judgment:
testing program changes? A. commonly possessed by practitioners of that
A. Test library listings specialty.
B. Source program listings B. which includes programming skills in the software
C. Program change requests under review.
D. Production library listings C. relating to the selection of audit tests and evaluation
26. Which of the following tests is an IS auditor performing of test results.
when a sample of programs is selected to determine if D. where an incorrect conclusion based on available
the source and object versions are the same? facts will not be drawn.
A. A substantive test of program library controls 33. An internal audit department, that organizationally
B. A compliance test of program library controls reports exclusively to the chief financial officer (CFO)
C. A compliance test of the program compiler controls rather than to an audit committee, is MOST likely to:
D. A substantive test of the program compiler controls A. have its audit independence questioned.
27. An integrated test facility is considered a useful audit B. report more business-oriented and relevant findings.
tool because it: C. enhance the implementation of the auditor's
A. is a cost efficient approach to auditing application recommendations.
controls. D. result in greater effective action being taken on the
B. enables the financial and IS auditors to integrate their auditor's recommendations.
audit tests. 34. An IS auditor conducting a review of software usage and
C. compares processing output with independently licensing discovers that numerous PCs contain
calculated data. unauthorized software. Which of the following actions
D. provides the IS auditor with a tool to analyze a large should the IS auditor perform FIRST?
range of information. A. Personally delete all copies of the unauthorized
28. The primary reason for enabling software audit trails is software.
to: B. Inform auditee of the unauthorized software and
A. improve response time for users. follow-up to confirm deletion.
B. establish accountability and responsibility for C. Report the use of the unauthorized software to auditee
processed transactions. management and the need to prevent recurrence.
C. improve system efficiency since audit trails do not D. Take no action, as it is a commonly accepted practice
occupy disk-space. and operations management is responsible for
D. provide useful information to auditors who may wish monitoring such use.
to track transactions. 35. The risk that an IS auditor uses an inadequate test
29. When performing a procedure to identify the value of procedure and concludes that material errors do not
inventory that has been kept for more than eight weeks, exist when, in fact, they do, is an example of:
an IS auditor would MOST likely use: A. inherent risk.
A. test data. B.control risk.
B. statistical sampling. C. detection risk.
C. an integrated test facility. D. audit risk.
D. generalized audit software. 36. A primary benefit derived from an organization
30. Data flow diagrams are used by IS auditors to: employing control self assessment (CSA) techniques is
A. order data hierarchically. that it:
B. highlight high-level data definitions. A. can identify high-risk areas that might need a detailed
C. graphically summarize data paths and storage. review later.
D. portray step-by-step details of data generation. B. allows IS auditors to independently assess risk.
C. can be used as a replacement for traditional audits.
31. A distinction that can be made between compliance
D. allows management to relinquish responsibility for
testing and substantive testing is:
control.
A. compliance testing tests details, while substantive
testing tests procedures. 37. An IS auditor's first step when implementing continuous
B. compliance testing tests controls, while substantive monitoring systems is to identify:
testing tests details. A. reasonable target thresholds.
C. compliance testing tests plans, while substantive B. high-risk areas within the organization.
testing tests procedures. C. the location and format of output files.
600 Questions Pg 3
D. applications that provide the highest potential 44. Which of the following is a detective control?
payback. A. Physical access controls
38. Which of the following is an anti-virus detective control? B. Segregation of duties
A. Route all links to external systems via a firewall. C. Back-up procedures
B. Scan all diskettes and CDs brought in from outside the D. Audit trails
company before use. 45. An IS auditor is assigned to perform a post
C. Scan all files on all file server hard disks daily, moving implementation review of an application system. Which
suspect files to a safe area. of the following situations may have impaired the
D. Use anti-virus software to update users' anti-virus independence of the IS auditor? The IS auditor:
configuration files every time they log in. A. implemented a specific control during the
39. Which of the following represents the MOST significant development of the application system.
exposure for an organization that leases personal B. designed an embedded audit module exclusively for
computers? auditing the application system.
A. Accounting for shared peripherals C. participated as a member of the application system
B. Frequent reassignment of hardware project team, but did not have operational
C. Obsolescence prior to lease termination responsibilities.
D.Software licensing issues on leased machines D. provided consulting advice concerning application
system best practices.
40. When reviewing a system development project at the
project initiation stage, an IS auditor finds that the 46. Detection risk refers to a:
project team is not proposing to strictly follow the A. conclusion that material errors do not exist, due to an
organization's quality manual. To meet critical deadlines inadequate test procedure.
the project team proposes to fast track the validation and B. control that fails to detect an error.
verification processes, commencing some elements C. control that detects a high-risk error.
before the previous deliverable is signed-off. Under D. control that detects an error but fails to report the
these circumstances the IS auditor would MOST likely: same.
A.report this as a critical finding to senior management. 47. Information requirement definitions, feasibility studies,
B. accept that different quality processes can be adopted and user requirements are significant considerations
for each project when:
C. report to IS management the team's failure to follow A. defining and managing service levels.
appropriate procedures. B. identifying IT solutions.
D. report the risks associated with fast tracking to the C. managing changes.
project steering committee D. assessing internal IT control.
41. During a review of the controls over the process of 48. Which of the following steps would an IS auditor
defining IT service levels an IS auditor would MOST normally perform FIRST in a security review?
likely interview the: A. Evaluate physical access test results
A. systems programmer. B. Determine the risks/threats to the data center site
B. legal staff. C. Review business continuity procedures
C. business unit manager. D. Test for evidence of physical access at suspect
D. programmer. locations
42. Which of the following sampling methods is MOST 49. Which of the following is the LEAST reliable audit
useful when testing for compliance? evidence?
A. Attribute sampling A. Results of data extractions
B. Variable sampling B. Results of test cases
C. Stratified mean per unit C. Oral representations
D. Difference estimation D. Record of transactions
43. While performing an audit, an IS auditor used an 50. Which of the following types of information would an IS
application software mapping technique and discovered auditor find LEAST valuable when gaining an
an error in system processing. In preparing the audit understanding of the IT process?
report the IS auditor should include: A. IT planning and deployment of documents with
A. a detailed (step-by-step) description of the mapping deliverables and performance results
technique. B. Organization's policies and procedures relating to
B. the detailed steps performed during the audit. planning, managing, monitoring and reporting on
C. a listing of relevant parameters or source code of the performances"
system. C. Prior audit reports
D. an overview of the application software mapping D. Reports of IT functional activities
technique used.
600 Questions Pg 4
51. When an IS auditor obtains a listing of current users D. to complete the entire audit.
with access to the selected WAN/LAN and verifies that 58. The responsibility, authority and accountability of the
those listed are active associates, the IS auditor is information systems audit functions is appropriately
performing a: documented in an audit charter and MUST be:
A. compliance test. A. approved by the highest level of management.
B. substantive test. B. approved by audit department management.
"C. statistical sample. C. approved by user department management.
D. risk assessment. D. changed every year before commencement of IS
52. Ensuring regular password change, assigning a new one- audits.
time password when a user forgets his/hers, and 59. The IS auditor should be able to identify and evaluate
requiring users not to write down their passwords are all various types of risks and their potential effects.
examples of: Accordingly, which of the following risks is associated
A. audit objectives. with trap doors?
B. audit procedures. A. Inherent risk.
C. controls objectives. B. Detection risk.
D. control procedures. C. Audit risk.
53. The FIRST task an IS auditor should complete when D. Error risk.
performing a new audit in an unfamiliar area is to: 60. IS auditors are MOST likely to perform tests of internal
A. design the audit programs for each system or function controls if, after their evaluation of such controls, they
involved. conclude that:
B. develop a set of compliance tests and substantive A. a substantive approach to the audit are more cost-
tests. effective.
C. gather background information pertinent to the new B. the control environment is poor.
audit. C. inherent risk is low.
D. assign human and economical resources. D. control risks are within the acceptable limits.
54. Risk assessments performed by IS auditors is a critical 61. An IS auditor performing an audit of the company's
factor for audit planning. An assessment of risk should information system (IS) strategy would be LEAST likely
be made to provide: to:
A. reasonable assurance that material items will be A. assess IS security procedures.
covered during the audit work. B. review both short and long-term IS strategies.
B. sufficient assurance that material items will be C. interview appropriate corporate management
covered during the audit work. personnel.
C. reasonable assurance that all items will be covered D. ensure that the external environment has been
during the audit work. considered.
D. sufficient assurance that all items will be covered
62. Which of the following organizational goals would
during the audit work.
normally be mentioned in an organization's strategic
55. IS auditors must have a thorough understanding of the plan?
risk assessment process. Risk assessment is a(n): A. Test a new accounting package.
A. subjective process. B. Perform an evaluation of information technology
B. objective process. needs.
C. mathematical process. C. Implement a new project planning system within the
D. statistical process. next 12 months.
56. The BEST time to perform a control self-assessment D. Become the supplier of choice within a given time
involving line management, line staff and the audit period for the product offered.
department would be during the: 63. Which of the following conditions should exist in order
A. compliance tests. for the local selection and purchase of IS products to be
B. preliminary survey. acceptable?
C. substantive tests. A. Local offices are independent and exchange data on
D. preparation of the audit report. an occasional basis.
57. While conducting a control self-assessment (CSA) B. Managers undertake a full cost-benefit analysis before
program, an IS auditor facilitated workshops involving deciding what to purchase.
management and staff in judging and monitoring the C. The same type of data base management system is
effectiveness of existing controls. Which of the following used throughout the organization.
is an objective of a CSA program? D. Acquisitions are consistent with the organization's
A. to enhance audit responsibilities. short- and long-term IS technology plans.
B. to identify problems.
C. to brainstorm solutions.
600 Questions Pg 5
64. The initial step in establishing an information security A. need to change accounting periods on a regular basis.
program is the: B. requirement to post entries for a closed accounting
A. development and implementation of an information period.
security standards manual. C. lack of proper policies and procedures for the
B. performance of a comprehensive security control segregation of duties.
review by the IS auditor. D. need to create/modify the chart of accounts and its
C. adoption of a corporate information security policy allocations.
statement. 71. Which of the following procedures would MOST
D. purchase of security access control software. effectively detect employee loading of illegal software
65. Which of the following documentation would an IS packages onto a network?
auditor place LEAST reliance on when determining A. The use of diskless workstations
management's effectiveness in communicating B. Periodic checking of hard drives
information systems policies to appropriate personnel? C. The use of current anti-virus software
A. Interviews with user and IS personnel D. Policies that result in instant dismissal if violated
B. Minutes of the IS Steering Committee meetings 72. Which of the following is LEAST likely to be associated
C. User department systems and procedures manuals with an incident response capability?
D. Information processing facilities operations and A. Developing a database repository of past incidents
procedures manuals and actions to facilitate future corrective actions.
66. An IS auditor who is reviewing application run manuals B. Declaring the incident, which not only helps to carry
would expect them to contain: out corrective measures, but also to improve the
A. details of source documents. awareness level.
B. error codes and their recovery actions. C. Developing a detailed operations plan that outlines
C. program logic flowcharts and file definitions. specific actions to be taken to recover from an
D. change records for the application source code. incident.
67. Which of the following statements pertaining to ISO D. Establishing multi-disciplinary teams consisting of
9000 is FALSE? executive management, security staff, information
A. The standard covers all aspects of an organization systems staff, legal counsel, public relations, etc. to
that may affect customer satisfaction. carry out the response"
B. The standard covers both internal and external 73. Which of the following should NOT be included in an
business processes. organization's IS security policy?
C. The standard defines a set of quality compliance A. Access philosophy
requirements. B. Access authorization
D. The standard focuses heavily on documentation of C. Importance of security awareness
activities. D. Identity of sensitive security features
68. Which of the following procedures would normally be 74. Which of the following should NOT be a role of the
performed last by an IS auditor who is auditing the security administrator?
outsourcing process? A. Authorizing access rights
A. Assess the business needs of the organization. B. Implementing security rule
B. Perform a cost/benefit analysis including the C. Allocating access rights
assumptions behind it. D. Ensuring that security policies have been authorized
C. Perform a control risk assessment. by management
D. Review contracts with legal counsel. 75. Which of the following is a role of an information
69. A written security policy serves to heighten security systems steering committee?
awareness and should include all of the following key A.Initiate computer applications.
components EXCEPT: B. Ensure efficient use of data processing resources.
A. an index of computer hardware and software. C. Prepare and monitor system implementation plans.
B. management's approved support of the policy. D. Review the performance of the systems department.
C. authorization process for gaining access to 76. Accountability for the maintenance of appropriate
computerized information. security measures over information assets resides with
D. awareness philosophy to security procedures on a the:
need-to-know basis. A. security administrator.
70. The function of general ledger setup in an enterprise B. systems administrator.
resource package (ERP) allows for the setting of C. data and systems owners.
accounting periods in the package. Access to this D. systems delivery/operations group.
function has been permitted to users in finance, 77. An IS auditor performing a review of the MIS
warehouse and order entry. The MOST likely reason for department discovers that formal project approval
granting such broad access is the:
600 Questions Pg 6
procedures do not exist. In the absence of these 83. Which of the following is NOT a responsibility of
procedures the MIS manager has been arbitrarily computer operations?
approving projects that can be completed in a short A. Analyzing system schedules
duration and referring other more complicated projects B. Analyzing user specifications
to higher levels of management for approval. The IS C. Analyzing system degradation
auditor should recommend FIRST that: D. Trouble-shooting teleprocessing problems
A. users participate in the review and approval process. 84. Which of the following functions should NOT be
B. formal approval procedures be adopted and performed by scheduling and operations personnel in
documented. order to maintain proper segregation of duties?
C. all projects are referred to appropriate levels of A. Job submission
management for approval. B. Resource management
D. the MIS manager job description be changed to C. Code correction
include approval authority. D. Output distribution
78. Responsibility and reporting lines cannot always be 85. Which of the following functions is NOT performed by
established when auditing automated systems since: the IS control group?
A. diversified control makes ownership irrelevant. A. Supervision of the distribution of output
B. staff traditionally change jobs with greater frequency. B. Logging of input data
C. ownership is difficult to establish where resources are C. Scrutiny of error listings
shared. D. Correction of errors
D. duties change frequently in the rapid development of
86. Which of the following exposures may result if an
technology.
adequate separation of duties between computer
79. Which of the following criteria would an IS auditor operators and application programmers is NOT
consider to be the MOST important when evaluating the maintained?
organization's IS strategy? A. Inadequate volume testing
A. That it has been approved by line management B. Unauthorized program changes
B. That it does not vary from the IS Department C. Unintentional omissions of data
preliminary budget D. Data loss during program execution
C. That it complies with procurement procedures
87. Which of the following tasks would NOT normally be
D. That it supports the business objectives of the
performed by a data security officer?
organization
A. Developing the data classification methodology
80. Which of the following statements relating to separation B. Implementing security measures (e.g., password
of duties is TRUE? change procedures)"
A. Employee competence does not need to be considered C. Monitoring the effectiveness of security over data
when evaluating an organization's policy on D. Monitoring the completeness and accuracy of the
separation of duties. data
B. An organization chart provides an accurate definition
88. An IS auditor has recently discovered that because of a
of separation of employee duties.
shortage of skilled operations personnel, the security
C. A restrictive separation of duties policy can help
administrator has agreed to work one late night shift a
improve an organization's efficiency and
month as the senior computer operator. The MOST
communication.
appropriate course of action that the IS auditor should
D.Policies on separation of duties in information
take is to:
systems must recognize the difference between logical
A. advise senior management of the risk involved.
and physical access to assets.
B. agree to work with the security officer on these shifts
81. Which of the following tasks is normally performed by a as a form of preventative control.
clerk in the control group? C. develop a computer-assisted audit technique to detect
A. Maintenance of an error log instances of abuses of this arrangement.
B. Authorization of transactions D. review the system log for each of the late-night shifts
C. Control of non-information systems assets to determine whether any irregular actions occurred.
D. Origination of changes to master files
89. Many organizations require an employee to take a
82. Which of the following is NOT a responsibility of a mandatory vacation of a week or more in order to:
database administrator? A. ensure the employee maintains a quality of life, which
A. Designing database applications will lead to greater productivity.
B. Changing physical data definition to improve B. reduce the opportunity for an employee to commit an
performance improper or illegal act.
C. Specifying physical data definition C. provide proper cross training for another employee.
D. Monitoring database usage D. eliminate the potential disruption caused when an
employee takes vacation one day at a time.
600 Questions Pg 7
90. The quality assurance group is typically responsible for: 97. Which of the following is NOT an activity associated
A.ensuring that the output received from system with information processing?
processing is complete. A. Systems analysis
B. monitoring the execution of computer processing B. Telecommunications
tasks. C. Computer operations
C. ensuring that programs and program changes and D. Systems programming
documentation adhere to established standards. 98. A local area network (LAN) administrator is restricted
D. designing standards and procedures to protect data from:
against accidental disclosure, modification, or A. having end-user responsibilities.
destruction. B. reporting to the end-user manager.
91. Which of the following would NOT be associated with C. having programming responsibilities.
well-written and concise job descriptions? D. being responsible for LAN security administration.
A. They are an important means of discouraging 99. Which of the following pairs of functions should not be
fraudulent acts. combined to provide proper segregation of duties?
B. They are often used as tools for use in performance A. Tape librarian and computer operator
evaluation. B. Application programming and data entry
C. They provide little indication of the degree of C. Systems analyst and database administrator
separation of duties. D. Security administrator and quality assurance
D. They assist in defining the relationship between
100. An IS auditor is reviewing the data base administration
various job functions.
function to ascertain whether adequate provision has
92. Which of the following BEST describes the role and been made for controlling data. The IS auditor should
responsibilities of a systems analyst? determine that the:
A. Defines corporate databases A. function reports to data processing operations.
B. Determines user needs for application programming B. responsibilities of the function are well defined.
C. Schedules computer resources C. database administrator is a competent systems
D. Tests and evaluates programmer and optimization programmer.
tools D. audit software has the capability of efficiently
93. Which of the following functions, if combined, would accessing the database.
provide the GREATEST risk to an organization? 101. A long-term IS employee with a strong technical
A. Systems analyst and database administrator background and broad managerial experience has
B. Quality assurance and computer operator applied for a vacant position in the IS audit department.
C. Tape librarian and data entry clerk Determining whether to hire this individual for this
D. Application programmer and tape librarian position should be based on the individual's vast
94. Which of the following statements relating to application experience and:
programmers is FALSE? A. the length of service since this will help ensure
A. They are responsible for maintaining systems in technical competence.
production. B. the individual's age as training in audit techniques
B. They should not move test versions into the may be impractical.
production environment. C. IS knowledge since this will bring enhanced
C. They are responsible for defining backup procedures. credibility to the audit function.
D. They should not have access to system program D. existing IS relationships where the ability to retain
libraries. audit independence may be difficult.
95. Which of the following is NOT an advantage of cross 102. An IS auditor reviewing the key roles and
training employees? responsibilities of the database administrator (DBA) is
A. It provides for succession planning. LEAST likely to expect the job description of the DBA to
B. It decreases dependence on one employee. include:
C. It provides back-up personnel in the event of absence. A. defining the conceptual schema.
D. It allows individuals to understand all parts of a B. defining security and integrity checks.
system. C. liaising with users in developing data model.
96. Responsibility for programmers and analysts who D. mapping data model with the internal schema.
implement new systems and maintain existing systems 103. Which of the following provisions in a contract for
is typically the role of the: external information systems services would an IS
A. operations manager. auditor consider to be LEAST significant?
B. database administrator. A. Ownership of program and files
C. quality assurance manager. B. Statement of due care and confidentiality
D. systems development manager. C. Continued service of outsourcer in the event of a
disaster
600 Questions Pg 8
D. Detailed description of computer hardware used by 109. An IS auditor reviewing an outsourcing contract of IT
the vendor facilities would expect it to define:
104. Is it appropriate for an IS auditor from a company which A. hardware configuration.
is considering outsourcing its IS processing to request B. access control software.
and review a copy of each vendor's business continuity C. ownership of intellectual property.
plan? D. application development methodology.
A. Yes, because the IS auditor will evaluate the adequacy 110. While conducting an audit of management's planning of
of the service bureau's plan and assist his/her IS, what would an IS auditor consider the MOST relevant
company in implementing a complementary plan. to short-term planning for the IS department?
B. Yes, because, based on the plan, the IS auditor will A. Allocating resources
evaluate the financial stability of the service bureau B. Keeping current with technology advances
and its ability to fulfill the contract. C. Conducting control self-assessment
C. No, because backup to be provided should be D. Evaluating hardware needs
adequately specified in the contract. 111. The data control department responsible for data entry
D. No, because the service bureau's business continuity should:
plan is proprietary information to which users' IS A. maintain access rules to data and other IT resources.
auditors are not usually allowed access. B. periodically review and evaluate the data security
105. Which of the following indicators would LEAST likely policy.
indicate that complete or selected outsourcing of C. ensure proper safekeeping of source documents until
computer operators should be considered ? processing is complete.
A. The applications development backlog is greater than D. monitor security violations and take corrective action.
three years. 112. Which of the following IS functions may be performed
B. It takes one year to develop and implement a high- by the same individual, without compromising on
priority system. control or violating segregation of duties?
C. More than 60 per cent of programming costs are spent A. Job control analyst and applications programmer
on systems maintenance. B. Mainframe operator and system programmer
D. Duplicate information systems functions exist at two C. Change/problem and quality control administrator
sites. D. Applications and system programmer
106. A probable advantage to an organization that has 113. Which of the following is the MOST important function
outsourced its data processing services is that: to be performed by IT management within an
A. greater IS expertise can be obtained from the outside. outsourced environment?.
B. more direct control can be exercised over computer A. Ensuring that invoices are paid to the provider
operations. B. Participating in systems design with the provider
C. processing priorities can be established and enforced C. Renegotiating the provider's fees
internally. D. Monitoring the outsourcing provider's performance
D. greater user involvement is required to communicate
114. Which of the following key performance indicators
user needs.
would an IS manager be LEAST likely to systematically
107. Service level agreements establish: report to its board of directors?
A. minimum service levels to be rendered by IS A. Average response time to users requirements
management. B. Cost per transaction
B. minimum service levels to be achieved in the event of C. IS costs per area
a disaster. D. Disk storage space free
C. maximum service levels to be rendered by IS support
115. Employee termination practices should address all of the
services.
following EXCEPT:
D.minimum levels of processing capabilities that can be
A. arrangement for the final pay and removal of the
affected by a disaster.
employee from active payroll files.
108. An organization has outsourced network and desktop B. notification to other staff and facilities security to
support. Although the relationship has been reasonably increase awareness of the terminated employee's
successful, risks remain due to connectivity issues. status.
Which of the following controls should FIRST be C. employee bonding to protect against losses due to
performed to assure the organization reasonably theft.
mitigates these possible risks? D. deletion of assigned logon-ID and passwords to
A. Network defense program prohibit system access.
B.Encryption/Authentication
116. Various standards have emerged to assist IS
C. Adequate reporting between organizations
organizations in achieving an operational environment
D. Adequate definition in contractual relationship
that is predictable, measurable and repeatable. The
600 Questions Pg 9
standard that provides the definition of the 123. A sound information security policy will MOST likely
characteristics and associated quality evaluation process include a:
to be used when specifying the requirements for and A. response program to handle suspected intrusions.
evaluating the quality of software products throughout B. correction program to handle suspected intrusions.
their life cycle is: C. detection program to handle suspected intrusions.
A. ISO 9001. D. monitoring program to handle suspected intrusions.
B. ISO 9002. 124. Who of the following, who is responsible for network
C. ISO 9126. security operations?
D. ISO 9003. A. Users, who periodically change their passwords.
117. Which of the following would provide the LEAST B. Security administrators, who control services and
justification for an organization's investment in a computers.
security infrastructure? C. Line managers, responsible for policies and
A. Risk analysis of internal/external threats procedures.
B. A white paper report on Internet attacks, companies D. Security officers, who administer the security policy.
attacked, and damage inflicted" 125. Which of the following would provide a mechanism
C. A penetration test of the organization's network whereby IS management can determine when, and if, the
demonstrates that the threat from intruders is high activities of the enterprise have deviated from planned,
D. Reports generated internally from use of high-profile or expected levels?
network tools A. Quality management
118. An IS auditor reviewing the organization IT strategic B. IS assessment methods
plan should FIRST review: C. Management principles
A. the existing information technology environment. D. Industry standards/benchmarking
B. the business plan. 126. Which of the following independent duties is performed
C. the present IT budget. by the data control group?
D. current technology trends. A. Access to data
119. Which of the following issues would be of LEAST B. Authorization tables
concern when reviewing an outsourcing agreement in C. Custody of assets
which the outsourcing vendor assumes responsibility of D. Reconciliation
the information processing function? 127. Which of the following situations would increase the
A. The organization's right to audit vendor operations. likelihood of fraud?
B. The loyalty of the third-party personnel. A. Application programmers are implementing changes
C. The access control system that protects the to production programs
outsourcing vendor's data. B. Application programmers are implementing changes
D. The outsourcing vendor's software acquisition to test programs
procedures. C. Operations support staff are implementing changes to
120. A database administrator is responsible for: batch schedules
A. maintaining the access security of data residing on D. Data base administrators are implementing changes
the computers. to data structures
B. implementing database definition controls. 128. Which of the following is the BEST way to handle
C. granting access rights to users. obsolete magnetic tapes before disposing of them?
D. defining system's data structure. A. Overwriting the tapes
121. The security administrator is responsible for providing B. Initializing the tape labels
reasonable assurance over the confidentiality, integrity C. Degaussing the tapes
and availability of information system controls. Another D. Erasing the tapes
duty that could be considered compatible, without 129. An IS steering committee should:
causing a conflict of interest, would be: A. include a mix of members from different departments
A. quality assurance. and management levels.
B. application programming. B. ensure that IS security policies and procedures have
C. systems programming. been properly executed.
D. data entry. C. have formal terms of reference and maintain minutes
122. The development of an IS security policy is the of its' meetings.
responsibility of the: D. be briefed about new trends and products at each
A. IS department. meeting by a vendor.
B. security committee. 130. Which of the following functions would represent a risk
C. security administrator. if combined with that of a system analyst, due to the
D. board of directors. lack of compensating controls?
600 Questions Pg 10
A. Application programming B. It interfaces with the operating system.
B. Data entry C. It operates on the content of the information.
C. Quality assurance D. It is concerned with the correct transmission between
D. Data base administrator two points.
131. Which of the following data entry controls provides the 139. Which of the following is NOT an advantage of an
GREATEST assurance that data entered does not contain object-oriented approach to data management systems?
errors? A. A means to model complex relationships
A. Key verification B. The ability to restrict the variety of data types
B. Segregation of the data entry function from data entry C. The capacity to meet the demands of a changing
verification environment
C. Maintaining a log/record detailing the time, date, D. The ability to access only the information that is
employee's initials/user -id and progress of various needed
data preparation and verification tasks" 140. Which of the following allow programmers to code and
D. Check digits compile programs interactively with the computer from
132. Which of the following would an IS auditor be MOST a terminal?
concerned with when evaluating the effectiveness and A. Firmware
adequacy of a computer preventive maintenance B. Utility programs
program? C. Online programming facilities
A. System downtime log D.Network management software
B. Vendors' reliability figures 141. A data dictionary is an example of software that is used
C. A log of regularly scheduled maintenance to:
D. A written preventive maintenance schedule A. describe application systems.
133. Which of the following provides the MOST effective B. assist in fast program development.
means of determining which controls are functioning C. improve operation efficiency.
properly in an operating system? D. test data quality.
A. Consulting with the vendor 142. Which of the following is NOT an advantage of image
B. Reviewing the vendor installation guide processing?
C. Consulting with the system programmer A. Verifies signatures
D. Reviewing the system generation parameters B. Improves service
134. Which of the following is NOT a common database C. Relatively inexpensive to use
structure? D. Reduces deterioration due to handling
A. Network 143. In a review of the operating system software selection
B. Sequential and the acquisition process, an IS auditor would place
C. Hierarchical more importance in finding evidence of:
D. Relational A. competitive bids.
135. Which of the following computer system risks would be B. user-department approval.
increased by the installation of a database system? C. hardware-configuration analysis.
A. Programming errors D. purchasing department approval.
B. Data entry errors 144. Which of the following line media would be MOST
C. Improper file access secure in a telecommunication network?
D. Loss of parity A. Broad band network digital transmission
136. The input/output control function is responsible for: B. Base band network
A. pulling and returning all tape files. C. Dial up
B. entering and key verifying data. D. Dedicated lines
C. logging batches and reconciling hash totals. 145. What type of transmission requires modems in a
D. executing both production and test jobs. network to be connected to terminals from the
137. Utility programs that assemble software modules computer?
needed to execute a machine instruction application A. Encrypted
program version are: B. Digital
A. text editors. C. Analog
B. program library managers. D. Modulated
C. linkage editors and loaders. 146. Which of the following is NOT a telecommunications
D. debuggers and development aids. control?
138. Which of the following statements pertaining to a data A. Trailer record
communication system is FALSE? B. Common carrier
A. It has multiple layers. C. Diagnostic routine
600 Questions Pg 11
D. Echo check 154. E-cash is a form of electronic money that:
147. An IS auditor needs to link his/her microcomputer to a A. can be used over any computer network.
mainframe system that uses binary synchronous data B. utilizes reusable e-cash coins to make payments.
communications with block data transmission. C. does not require the use of an Internet digital bank.
However, the IS auditor's microcomputer, as presently D. contains unique serial numbering to track the identity
configured, is capable of only asynchronous ASCII of the buyer.
character data communications. Which of the following 155. An organization is about to implement a computer
must be added to the IS auditor's computer to enable it network in a new office building. The company has 200
to communicate with the mainframe system? users located in the same physical area. No external
A. Protocol conversion and buffer capacity network connections will be required. Which of the
B. Network controller and buffer capacity following network configurations would be the MOST
C. Buffer capacity and parallel port expensive to install?
D. Parallel port and protocol conversion A. Bus
148. Which of the following is a telecommunication device B. Ring
that translates data from digital form to analog form and C. Star
back to digital? D. Mesh
A. Multiplexer 156. An organization is about to implement a computer
B. Modem network in a new office building. The company has 200
C. Protocol converter users located in the same physical area. No external
D. Concentrator network connections will be required. Which of the
149. Which of the following is a network architecture following network configurations would be the easiest
configuration that links each station directly to a main for problem resolution?
hub? A. Bus
A. Bus B. Ring
B. Ring C.Star
C. Star D. Mesh
D. Completed connected 157. Congestion control is BEST handled by which OSI layer?
150. Which of the following transmission media would NOT A. Data link
be affected by cross talk or interference? B. Session layer
A. Fiber optic systems C. Transport layer
B. Twisted pair circuits D. Network layer
C. Microwave radio systems 158. Which of the following is NOT an element of a LAN
D. Satellite radiolink systems environment?
151. In Wide Area Networks (WANs): A. Packet switching technology
A. data flow can be half duplex or full duplex. B. Baseband (digital signaling)
B. communication lines must be dedicated. C. Ring or short bus topology
C. circuit structure can be operated only over a fixed D. Private circuit switching technology
distance. 159. Which of the following would an IS auditor NOT review
D. the selection of communication lines will affect when performing a general operational control review?
reliability. A. User manuals
152. Which of the following Local Area Network (LAN) B. Re-run reports
physical layouts are subject to vulnerability to failure if C. Maintenance logs
one device fails? D. Backup procedures
A. Star 160. Which of the following is NOT a function of an online
B. Bus tape management system?
C. Ring A. Indicating which tapes should be cleaned
D. Completely connected B. Maintaining an inventory listing of tapes
153. Neural networks are effective in detecting fraud because C. Allowing external tape labels to contain a serial
they can: number only
A. discover new trends since they are inherently linear. D. Controlling physical access to the tape library area
B. solve problems where large and general sets of 161. Which of the following is NOT related to file
training data are not obtainable. identification?
C. attack problems that require consideration of a large A. Periodic file inventory
number of input variables. B. External label standards
D. make assumptions about the shape of any curve C. Retention period standards
relating variables to the output. D. High-level qualifier restrictions
600 Questions Pg 12
162. An IS auditor has discovered that the organization's totals by matching them against the input data and
existing computer system is no longer adequate for the control totals?
demands being placed on it by data processing, is not A. Batch header forms
compatible with new models and cannot be expanded. B. Batch balancing
As a result, a recommendation is made to use emulation. C. Data conversion error corrections
Emulation involves: D. Access controls over print spools
A. hardware which converts a new computer into an 169. Which of the following tools is NOT used to monitor the
image of the old computer. efficiency and effectiveness of services provided by IS
B. writing the programs in modules which simplify the personnel?
transition to a new computer. A. Online monitors
C. software which translates the old program into one B. Operator problem reports
readable by a new computer. C. Output distribution reports
D. simulating a new computer on the old computer to D. Console logs
produce machine independent code.
170. Which of the following would an IS auditor expect to
163. All of the following are properties of a relational find in a console log?
database EXCEPT: A. Names of system users
A. relational database technology separates data from B. Shift supervisor identification
applications C. System errors
B. operational efficiencies are significantly increased D. Data edit errors
with relational models
171. Which of the following systems-based approaches would
C. relational database models information in the
a financial processing company employ to monitor
structure of a table with columns and rows
spending patterns in order to identify abnormal
D. in a relational model there is always a primary key for
expenditures?
a tuple and there are no duplicate tuples
A. A neural network
164. Which of the following is the operating systems mode in B. Database management software
which all instructions can be executed? C. Management information systems
A. Problem D. Computer assisted audit techniques
B. Interrupt
172. Which of the following is the BEST form of transaction
C. Supervisor
validation?
D. Standard processing
A. Use of key field verification techniques in data entry
165. During a review of a large data center an IS auditor B. Use of programs to check the transaction against
observed computer operators acting as backup tape criteria set by management
librarians and security administrators. Which of these C. Authorization of the transaction by supervisory
situations would be MOST critical to report to senior personnel in an adjacent department
management? D. Authorization of the transaction by a department
A. Computer operators acting as tape librarians supervisor prior to the batch process
B. Computer operators acting as security administrators
173. An IS auditor needs to link his/her microcomputer to a
C. Computer operators acting as a tape librarian and
mainframe system that uses binary synchronous data
security administrator
communications with block data transmission.
D. It is not necessary to report any of these situations to
However, the IS auditor's microcomputer, as presently
senior management
configured, is capable of only asynchronous ASCII
166. Which of the following functions would be acceptable for character data communications. Which of the following
the security administrator to perform in addition to his must be added to the IS auditor's computer to enable it
or her normal function? to communicate with the mainframe system?
A. Systems analyst A. Buffer capacity and parallel port
B. Quality assurance B. Network controller and buffer capacity
C. Computer operator C. Parallel port and protocol conversion
D. Systems programmer D. Protocol conversion and buffer capability
167. Which of the following is a hardware device that relieves 174. Which of the following audit techniques would an IS
the central computer from performing network control, auditor place the MOST reliance on when determining
format conversion and message handling tasks? whether an employee practices good preventive and
A. Spool detective security measures?
B. Cluster controller A. Observation
C. Protocol converter B. Detail testing
D. Front end processor C. Compliance testing
168. Which of the following tools for controlling input/output D. Risk assessment
of data are used to verify output results and control
600 Questions Pg 13
175. Which of the following is NOT a way that executive C. Application of monitoring tools
information systems (EIS) are distinguished from other D. Proxy server trouble shooting
information systems? 182. An IS auditor consulting on a project to develop a
A. EIS are much easier to use than other systems. network management system, would consider all of the
B. EIS normally include user friendly features. following essential features EXCEPT:
C. EIS normally include other features such as e-mail A. the capacity to interact with the Internet for problem
and word processing abilities. solving.
D. EIS focus on broad problems to a specific view. B. a graphical interface to map the topology.
176. An organization is considering installing a local area C. a relational database to store the readings.
network (LAN) in a site under construction. If system D. the ability to gather information from various
availability is the main concern, which of the following network devices.
topologies is MOST appropriate? 183. In protocols like HTTP, FTP, and SMTP, the
A. Ring implementation of the TCP/IP suite is arranged in the
B. Line following manner:
C. Star A. TCP works at the transport layer and handles packets,
D. Bus while IP works at the network layer and handles
177. Capacity monitoring software is used to ensure: addresses.
A. maximum use of available capacity. B. TCP works at the transport layer and handles
B. future acquisitions meet user functionality demands. addresses, while IP works at the network layer and
C. concurrent use by a large number of users. handles packets.
D. continuity of efficient operation. C. TCP works at the presentation layer and handles
178. Receiving an electronic data interchange (EDI) proxies, while IP works at the data link layer and
transaction and passing it through the communications handles applets.
interface stage usually requires: D. TCP works at any of the OSI layers and handles
A. translating and unbundling transactions. circuits, while IP also works at any of the OSI layers
B. routing verification procedures. but handles messages.
C. passing data to the appropriate application system. 184. Public-key infrastructure (PKI) integrates all of the
D. creating a point of receipt audit log. following into an enterprise-wide network security
179. Which one of the following types of firewalls would architecture EXCEPT:
BEST protect a network from an Internet attack? A. public-key cryptosystem.
A. Screened sub-net firewall B. digital certificates.
B. Application filtering gateway C. certificate authorities.
C. Packet filtering router D. password key management.
D. Circuit level gateway 185. All of the following are common problems with firewall
180. A large manufacturing firm wants to automate its implementations EXCEPT:
invoice and payment processing system with its A. inadequately protecting the network and servers from
suppliers. Requirements state that the system of high virus attacks.
integrity will require considerably less time for review B. incorrectly configuring access lists.
and authorization. The system should still be capable of C. logging of connections is either insufficient or not
quickly identifying errors that need follow up. Which reviewed on a regular basis.
approach below is BEST suited in meeting these D. network services destined to internal hosts are passed
requirements? through the firewall unscreened.
A. Establishing an inter-networked system of client 186. When auditing operating software development,
servers with suppliers for increased efficiencies. acquisition or maintenance, the IS auditor would review
B. Outsourcing the function to a firm specializing in system software maintenance activities to determine:
automated payments and accounts receivable/invoice A. fallback or restoration procedures are in place in case
processing. of production failure.
C. Establishing an electronic data interchange (EDI) B. impact of the product on processing reliability.
system of electronic business documents and C. system software changes are scheduled when they
transactions with key suppliers, computer to least impact IS processing.
computer, in a standard format. D. current versions of the software are supported by the
D. Reengineering existing processing and redesigning vendor.
the existing system. 187. While evaluating a file/table design, an IS auditor should
181. Which of the following is widely accepted as one of the understand that a referential integrity constraint
critical components in networking management? consists of:
A. Configuration management A. ensuring the integrity of transaction processing.
B. Topological mappings B. ensuring that data are updated through triggers.
600 Questions Pg 14
C. ensuring controlled user updates to database. 196. Which of the ISO/OSI model layers provides service for
D. rules for designing tables and queries. how to route packets between nodes?
188. One of the responsibilities of the technical support A. Data link
function is: B. Network
A. ensuring job preparation, scheduling and operating C. Transport
instructions. D. Session
B. establishing, enhancing and maintaining a stable, 197. In a TCP/IP based network, an IP address specifies a:
controlled environment for the implementation of A. network connection.
changes within the production software environment. B. router/gateway.
C. defining, establishing and maintaining a standard, C. computer in the network.
consistent and well-defined testing methodology for D. device on the network such as a gateway/router, host,
computer systems. server, etc.
D. obtaining detailed knowledge of the operating system 198. Connection-oriented protocols in the TCP/IP suite are
and other systems software. implemented in the:
189. A universal serial bus (USB) port: A. transport layer.
A. connects the network without a network card. B. application layer.
B. connects the network with an Ethernet adapter C. physical layer.
C. replaces all existing connections. D. network layer.
D. connects the monitor. 199. The device to extend the network that must have storage
190. How can an enterprise provide access to its intranet (i.e., capacity to store frames and act as a storage and forward
extranet) across the Internet to its business partners? device is a:
A. Virtual private network A. router.
B. Client/server B. bridge.
C. Dial-in access C. repeater.
D. Network service provider D. gateway.
191. A hub is a device that connects: 200. In a client/server architecture, a domain name service
A. two LANs using different protocols. (DNS) is MOST important because it provides the:
B. a LAN with a WAN. A. address of the domain server.
C. a LAN with a MAN. B. resolution service for the name/address.
D. two segments of a single LAN. C. resolution on the Internet for the name/address.
192. Which of the following network configuration options, D. domain name system.
contains a direct link between any two host machines? 201. In a web server, a common gateway interface (CGI) is
A. Bus MOST often used as a(n):
B. Ring A. consistent way for data transfer to the application
C. Star program and back to the user.
D. Completely connected (mesh) B. computer graphics imaging method for movie and
193. Which of the following can a local area network (LAN) TV.
administrator use to protect against exposure to illegal C. graphic user interface for web design.
or unlicensed software usage by the network user? D. interface to access the private gateway domain.
A. Software metering 202. Which of the following exposures associated with the
B. Virus detection software spooling of sensitive reports for off-line printing would
C. Software encryption an IS auditor consider to be the MOST serious?
D. Software inventory programs A. Sensitive data may be read by operators.
194. Which of the following controls will MOST effectively B. Data can be amended without authorization.
detect the presence of bursts of errors in network C. Unauthorized report copies might be printed.
transmissions? D. Output would be lost in the event of system failure.
A. Parity check 203. Applying a retention date on a file will ensure that:
B. Echo check A. data cannot be read until the date is set.
C. Block sum check B. data will not be deleted before the date is set.
D. Cyclic redundancy check C. backup copies are not retained after that date.
195. Which of the following types of firewalls provide the D. datasets having the same name are differentiated.
GREATEST degree and granularity of control? 204. Which of the following would NOT be considered a
A. Screening router security threat to Internet web sites?
B. Packet-filter A. Hackers
C. Application-gateway B. Crackers
D. Circuit-gateway C. Virus writers
600 Questions Pg 15
D. Asynchronous attacks 211. Which of the following controls is LEAST likely to
205. An IS auditor is assigned to help design the data discover changes made online to important master
security, data integrity and business continuity aspects records?
of an application under development. Which of the A. Update access to master file is restricted to supervisor
following provides the MOST reasonable assurance that independent of data entry.
corporate assets are protected when the application is B. Clerks enter updates online, but these must be
certified for production? finalized by independent supervisor.
A. A certification review conducted by the internal C. Edit listing of all updates are produced daily and
auditor. reviewed by independent supervisor.
B. A certification review conducted by the assigned IS D. Update authorization form must be approved by
auditor. independent supervisor before clerks enter updates.
C. Specifications by the user on the depth and content of 212. Which of the following is the MOST effective control
the certification review. procedure for security of a stand-alone small business
D. An independent review conducted by another equally computer environment?
experienced IS auditor. A. Supervision of computer usage
206. The MOST effective method of preventing unauthorized B. Daily management review of the trouble log
use of data files is: C. Storage of computer media in a locked cabinet
A. automated file entry. D. Independent review of an application system design
B. tape librarian. 213. Which of the following logical access exposures involves
C. access control software. changing data before, or as it is entered into the
D. locked library. computer?
207. Which of the following would NOT be considered a A. Data diddling
terminal access control? B. Trojan horse
A. Use of dial-up lines only in the event of an emergency C. Worm
B. Disconnection of a terminal after it has been inactive D. Salami technique
for a period of time 214. When investigating a serious security access violation,
C. Validation of passwords and transaction codes by the the IS auditor should NOT:
access control software A. refer the violation to the security administrator since
D. Logging of authorized and unauthorized attempts to he/she may be a party to the violation.
access the computer systems B. contact law enforcement to determine if violations
208. Which of the following factors is LEAST likely to allow a have occurred elsewhere.
perpetrator to discover a valid password? C. recommend corrective measures since this is the role
A. The number of characters in the password of the Security Administrator.
B. The power of the computer used to break the D. perform a security access follow-up to determine if
password code other violations have occurred.
C. The number of incorrect access attempts allowed 215. Which of the following would be considered the BEST
before disconnect example of a proper password for use in system access?
D. The content of the character set from which the A. XWA3
password is composed B. LARRY2
209. Which of the following would be MOST effective in C. TWC2H
establishing access control through the use of sign-on D. YRC45OPB
procedures? 216. Data classification is important when identifying who
A. Authorization and authentication of the user should have access to:
B. Authentication and identification of the user A. test data and programs.
C. Authorization, authentication and location of the B. production data and programs.
user" C. production and test programs.
D. Authorization, authentication, identification and D. test and production data and programs.
location of the user" 217. Naming conventions for access controls are NOT:
210. Which of the following would BEST ensure the proper A. setup by the owners of the data or application.
updating of critical fields in a master record? B. dependent on the importance and level of security
A. Field checks that is needed.
B. Control totals C. established to promote the implementation of
C. Reasonableness checks efficient access rules.
D. Before and after maintenance report D. defined with the assistance of the database
administrator.
600 Questions Pg 16
218. Digital signatures provide data integrity since they 226. Which of the following is NOT an employee security
require the: responsibility?
A. signer to have a public key, and the receiver to have a A. Keeping Logon-IDs and passwords secret
private key. B. Helping other employees create passwords
B. signer to have a private key, and the receiver to have a C. Reading and understanding the security policy
public key. D. Questioning unfamiliar people who enter a secured
C. signer and receiver to have a public key. area
D. signer and receiver to have a private key. 227. Naming conventions for system resources are an
219. Automated teller machines (ATMs) are a specialized important prerequisite for access control because they
form of a point of sale terminal which: ensure that:
A. allow for cash withdrawal and financial deposits only. A. resource names are not ambiguous.
B. are usually located in populous areas to deter theft or B. users' access to resources is clearly and uniquely
vandalism. identified.
C. utilize protected telecommunication lines for data C. internationally recognized names are used to protect
transmissions. resources.
D. must provide high levels of logical and physical D. the number of rules required to adequately protect
security. resources is reduced.
220. Which of the following processes would be performed 228. Passwords should be:
FIRST by the system when logging-on to an online A. assigned by the security administrator.
system? B. changed every 30 days at the discretion of the user.
A. Initiation C. reused often to ensure the user does not forget the
B. Verification password.
C. Authorization D. displayed on the screen so that the user can ensure
D. Authentication that it has been properly entered.
221. Which of the following is a benefit of using callback 229. Logical access controls are used to protect:
devices? A. operator consoles.
A. Provide an audit trail B. computer storage facilities.
B. Can be used in a switchboard environment C. data classification and ownership.
C. Permit unlimited user mobility D. disks and tapes in the back-up library.
D. Allow call forwarding 230. Which of the following is NOT a valid reason for using
222. Having established an application's access control digital signatures to secure e-mail transmissions?
process, an IS auditor's next step is to ensure: A. The signature is unforgeable.
A. passwords are not shared. B. Keys can be used indefinitely.
B. password files are encrypted. C. Signatures cannot be reused.
C. redundant logon-IDs are deleted. D. A signed document cannot be altered.
D. allocation of logon-IDs is controlled. 231. When performing an audit of access rights, an IS auditor
223. In the ISO/OSI model, which of the following protocols is should be suspicious of which of the following if
the FIRST to perform security over the user application? allocated to a computer operator?
A. Session layer. A. READ access to data
B. Transport layer B. DELETE access to transaction data files
C. Network layer C. Logged READ/EXECUTE access to programs
D. Presentation layer D. UPDATE access to job control language/script files
224. A feature of a digital signature that ensures that the 232. An IS auditor who wishes to prevent unauthorized entry
claimed sender cannot later deny generating and to the data maintained in a dial-up fast response system
sending the message is: would recommend?
A. data integrity. A. Online terminals be placed in restricted areas.
B. authentication. B. Online terminals be equipped with key locks.
C. non-repudiation. C. ID cards be required to gain access to online
D. replay protection. terminals.
225. An IS auditor who intends to use penetration testing D. Online access be terminated after three unsuccessful
during an audit of Internet connections would: attempts.
A. evaluate configurations. 233. Which of the following controls would BEST serve to
B. examine security settings. effectively detect intrusion?
C. ensure virus-scanning software is in use. A. User creation and user privileges are granted through
D. use tools and techniques that are available to a authorized procedures.
hacker.
600 Questions Pg 17
B. Automatic logoff when a workstation is inactive for a 240. Which of the following access control functions is
particular period of time. LEAST likely to be performed by a database
C. Automatic logoff of the system after a specified management system (DBMS) software package?
number of unsuccessful attempts. A. User access to field data
D. Unsuccessful logon attempts are actively monitored B. User sign-on at the network level
by the security administrator. C. User authentication at the program level
234. Which of the following control weaknesses would an IS D. User authentication at the transaction level
auditor performing an access controls review be LEAST 241. An IS auditor reviewing operating system access
concerned with? discovers that the system is not properly secured. In this
A. Audit trails are not enabled. situation the IS auditor is LEAST likely to be concerned
B. Programmers have access to the live environment. that the user might:
C. Group logons are being used for critical functions. A. create new users.
D. The same user can initiate transactions and also B. delete database and log files.
change related parameters. C. access the system utility tools.
235. Which of the following audit procedures would an IS D. access the system writeable directories.
auditor be LEAST likely to include in a security audit? 242. An IS auditor conducting an access controls review in a
A. Review the effectiveness and utilization of assets. client/server environment discovers that all printing
B. Test to determine that access to assets is adequate. options are accessible by all users. In this situation the IS
C. Validate physical, environmental and logical access auditor is MOST likely to conclude that:
policies per job profiles. A. exposure is greater since information is available to
D. Evaluate asset safeguards and procedures that unauthorized users.
prevent unauthorized access to the assets. B. operating efficiency is enhanced since anyone can
236. A firewall access control list may filter access based on print any report, any time.
each of the following parameters EXCEPT: C. operating procedures are more effective since
A. port. information is easily available.
B. service type. D. user friendliness and flexibility is facilitated since
C. network interface card (NIC). there is a smooth flow of information among users.
D. internet protocol (IP) address. 243. An IS auditor discovers that programmers have update
237. Which of the following applet intrusion issues poses the access to the live environment. In this situation the IS
GREATEST risk of disruption to an organization? auditor is LEAST likely to be concerned that
A. A program that deposits a virus on a client machine. programmers can:
B. Applets recording keystrokes and, therefore, A. authorize transactions.
passwords. B. add transactions directly to the database.
C. Downloaded code that reads files on a client's hard C. make modifications to programs directly.
drive. D. access data from live environment and provide faster
D. Applets damaging machines on the network by maintenance.
opening connections from the client machine. 244. An IS auditor performing a telecommunication access
238. Which of the following BEST describes the impact that control review would focus the MOST attention on the:
effective firewall design and implementation strategies A. maintenance of access logs of usage of various system
have as an enabler for improved information security? resources.
A. A source of detailed information about network B. authorization and authentication of the user prior to
security. granting access to system resources.
B. A focal point for security auditing, both internal and C. adequate protection of stored data on servers by
external. encryption or other means.
C. A chance to significantly reduce the threat of internal D. accountability system and the ability to properly
hacking. identify any terminal accessing system resources.
D. A chance to root out undocumented connections and 245. An organization wants to introduce a new system to
bring all remote access into line with written policy. allow single-sign-on. Currently, there are five main
239. Which of the following information is LEAST likely to be application systems, and users must sign on to each one
contained in a digital certificate for the purposes of separately. It is proposed that under the single-sign-on
verification by a Trusted Third Party (TTP)/Certification system, users will only be required to enter one user-ID
Authority (CA)? and password for access to all application systems.
A. Name of the TTP/CA Under this type of single-sign-on system the risk of
B. Public key of the sender unauthorized access:
C. Name of the public key holder A. is less likely.
D. Time period for which the key is valid B. is more likely.
C. will have a greater impact.
600 Questions Pg 18
D. will have a smaller impact. C. LANs provide program integrity from unauthorized
246. Sign-on procedures include the creation of a unique changes.
user-ID and password. However, an IS auditor discovers D. LANs provide central storage for a group of users.
that in many cases the user name and password are the 253. Creation of an electronic signature:
same. The BEST control to mitigate this risk is to: A. encrypts the message.
A. change the company's security policy. B. verifies where the message came from.
B. educate users about the risk of weak passwords. C. cannot be compromised when using a private key.
C. build in validations to prevent this during user D. cannot be used with e-mail systems.
creation and password change. 254. Which of the following is a strength of a client/server
D. require a periodic review of matching of user-ID and security system?
passwords for detection and correction. A. Change control and change management procedures
247. The PRIMARY objective of a logical access controls are inherently strong.
review assignment is to: B. User can manipulate data without controlling
A. review access controls provided through software. resources on the mainframe.
B. ensure access is granted per the organization's C. Network components seldom become obsolete.
authorities. D. Access to confidential data or data manipulation is
C. walkthrough and assess access provided in the IT strongly controlled.
environment. 255. Which of the following automated reports measure
D. provide assurance that computer hardware is telecommunication transmissions and determines
adequately protected against abuse. whether transmissions are accurately completed?
248. The scope of a logical access controls review would A. Online monitors
include the evaluation of: B. Down time reports
A. effectiveness and efficiency of IT security and related C. Help desk reports
controls. D. Response time reports
B. confidentiality, integrity and availability of 256. Which of the following statements pertaining to Internet
information to authorized users. security is TRUE?
C. access to systems software and application software to A. Firewalls cannot stop hackers from gaining access to
ensure compliance with the access policy. the corporate network.
D. access to user authorization levels, parameters and B. Firewalls should sit in the most commonly used
operational functions through application software. access point between a corporate network and the
249. Naming conventions for system resources are an Internet.
important prerequisite for access control because they: C. Encrypted corporate data is secure as it transports
A. ensure that resource names are not ambiguous. across the Internet.
B. reduce the number of rules required to adequately D. Not all corporate networks connected to the Internet
protect resources. are subject to attack.
C. ensure that user access to resources is clearly and 257. An Internet secured gateway's domain name service:
uniquely identified. A. prevents users outside a secure network from seeing
D. ensure that internationally recognized names are addresses of secure hosts.
used to protect resources. B. asks a user for the name of the host, and authenticates
250. When a PC that has been used for the storage of it before making contact.
confidential data is sold on the open market, the: C. offers a way to limit user access into or out of a secure
A. hard disk should be demagnetized. network.
B. hard disk should be mid-level formatted. D. provides the ability to administer user names on a
C. data on the hard disk should be deleted. network.
D. data on the hard disk should be defragmented. 258. Which of the following statements is TRUE relating to
251. Which of the following exposures could be caused by a the use of public key encryption to secure data while it is
line-grabbing technique? being transmitted across a network?
A. Unauthorized data access A. Under public key encryption both the key used to
B. Excessive CPU cycle usage encrypt and decrypt the data are made public.
C. Lockout of terminal polling B. Under public key encryption the key used to encrypt
D. Multiplexor control dysfunction is kept private but the key used to decrypt the data is
252. Which of the following is an advantage of using a local made public.
area network (LAN)? C. Under public key encryption the key used to encrypt
A. LANs protect against virus infection. is made public but the key used to decrypt the data is
B. LANs protect against improper disclosure of data. kept private.
D. Under public key encryption both the key used to
encrypt and decrypt the data are kept private.
600 Questions Pg 19
259. Which of the following would NOT protect a system 266. Use of data encryption is applicable to all of the
from computer viruses? following OSI layers EXCEPT:
A. Write-protect all diskettes, once they have been virus- A. physical layer.
checked. B. data link layer.
B. Scan any new software before it is installed. C. application layer.
C. Boot only from diskettes that were initially checked D. network and transport layer.
for viruses. 267. Which of the following is MOST affected by network
D. Do not allow vendors to run demonstrations on performance monitoring tools?
company owned machines. A. Integrity
260. During the audit of a telecommunications system the IS B. Availability
auditor finds that the risk of data interception for C. Completeness
communications with remote sites is very high. The D. Confidentiality
MOST effective control that would reduce this exposure 268. Java applets and ActiveX controls are distributed
is: executable programs that execute in background of a
A. encryption. web browser client. This is a reasonably controlled
B. call-back modems. practice when:
C. message authentication. A. a firewall exists.
D. dedicated leased lines. B. a secure web connection is used.
261. An Internet-based attack on commercial systems using C. the source of the executable is certain.
password sniffing can: D. the host website is part of your organization.
A. enable one party to act as if they are another party. 269. Your organization has been an active Internet user for
B. cause modification to the contents of certain several years and your business plan now calls for
transactions. initiating e-commerce via web-based transactions. You
C. be used to gain access to systems containing have decided to accept payment transactions by
proprietary information. implementing agreements with the major credit card
D. result in major problems with billing systems and companies. They have suggested certain parameters for
transaction processing agreements. your firewall installation. Which of the following
262. Which of the following controls would be MOST parameters will LEAST impact transactions in e-
comprehensive in a remote access network with multiple commerce?
and diverse sub-systems? A. Encryption is required
A. Proxy server B. Timed authentication is required
B. Firewall installation C. Firewall architecture hides the internal network
C. Network administrator D. Traffic is exchanged through the firewall at the
D. Password implementation and administration application layer only
263. Which of the following is NOT a principle applied in 270. Which of the following encrypt/decrypt steps provides
deriving the OSI layers? the GREATEST assurance in achieving confidentiality,
A. Each layer should provide a well-defined function. message integrity and non-repudiation by either sender
B. The integrity of data at each layer should be assured. or recipient?
C. A layer should be created only when a different level A. The recipient uses his/her private key to decrypt the
of abstraction is needed. secret key.
D. The layer boundaries should be chosen to minimize B. The encrypted pre-hash code and the message are
the information flow across layer interfaces. encrypted using a secret key.
264. Which of the following is NOT a common function of C. The encrypted pre-hash code is derived
application layer services? mathematically from the message to be sent.
A. Host to host data integrity D. The recipient uses the sender's public key, verified
B. Application programming interfaces (APIs) with a certificate authority, to decrypt the pre-hash
C. Global directory services to locate resources on a code.
network 271. Which of the following controls would provide the
D. A uniform way of handling a variety of system GREATEST assurance over database integrity?
monitors and devices A. Audit log procedures
265. A decrease in amplitude as a signal propagates along a B. Table link/reference checks
transmission medium is known as: C. Query/table access time checks
A. noise. D. Roll-back and roll-forward database features
B. crosstalk. 272. Use of asymmetric encryption over an Internet e-
C. attenuation. commerce site, where there is one private key for the
D. delay distortion. hosting server and the public key is widely distributed to
the customers, is MOST likely to provide comfort to the:
600 Questions Pg 20
A. customer over the authenticity of the hosting D. protect hardware against long-term power
organization. fluctuation.
B. hosting organization over the authenticity of the 278. Electromagnetic emissions from a terminal represent an
customer. exposure because they:
C. customer over the confidentiality of messages from A. affect noise pollution.
the hosting organization. B. disrupt processor functions.
D. hosting organization over the confidentiality of C. produce dangerous levels of electric current.
messages passed to the customer. D. can be detected and displayed.
273. The database administrator (DBA) has recently 279. Which of the following statements relating to power-off
informed you of his decision to disable certain switches is FALSE?
normalization controls in the database management A. They may need to immediately shut off power to the
system (DBMS) software in order to provide users with computer and peripheral devices.
increased query performance. This will MOST likely B. Two emergency power switches should be installed
increase the risk of: inside the computer room adjacent to exits.
A. loss of audit trails. C. Emergency power-off switches should be clearly
B. redundancy of data. labeled.
C. loss of data integrity. D. Emergency power-off switches should be shielded
D. unauthorized access to data. against accidental activation.
274. Which of the following techniques provides the BEST 280. Which of the following methods of suppressing a fire in
protection of e-mail message authenticity and a data center is the MOST effective and environmentally
confidentiality? friendly?
A. Signing the message using the sender's private key A. Halon gas
and encrypting the message using the receiver's B. Wet-pipe sprinklers
public key. C. Dry-pipe sprinklers
B. Signing the message using the sender's public key and D. Carbon dioxide gas
encrypting the message using the receiver's private
281. Which of the following environmental controls is
key.
appropriate to protect computer equipment against
C. Signing the message using the receiver's private key
short-term reductions in electrical power?
and encrypting the message using the sender's public
A. Power line conditioners
key.
B. A surge protective device
D. Signing the message using the receiver's public key
C. An alternative power supply
and encrypting the message using the sender's private
D. An interruptible power supply
key.
282. Which of the following would be the LEAST important
275. Which of the following is the MOST fundamental step in
item in a business continuity plan?
effectively preventing a virus attack?
A. Redundant facilities
A. Executing the updated anti-virus software in the
B. Relocation procedures
background on a periodic basis.
C. Adequate insurance coverage
B. Buying an effective standard anti-virus software,
D. Current and available business continuity manual
which is installed on all servers and workstations with
hard disks. 283. Which of the following physical access controls would
C. Ensuring that all new software through all media is provide the highest degree of security over unauthorized
first checked for a virus in a separate PC before being access?
loaded into the production environment. A. Bolting door lock
D. Adopting a comprehensive anti-virus policy to B. Cipher lock
protect the organization's computing facilities from C. Electronic door lock
virus attacks and communicating it to all users. D. Fingerprint scanner
276. Confidential PC data is BEST protected by: 284. Which of the following is LEAST likely to be classified as
A. a password. a physical access control?
B. file encryption. A. Access to the work area is restricted through a swipe
C. removable diskettes. card.
D. a key operated power source. B. All physical assets have an identification tag and are
properly recorded.
277. When auditing the security of a data center, an IS
C. Access to the premises is restricted and all visitors
auditor would look for the presence of a voltage
authorized for entry.
regulator to:
D. Visitors are issued a pass and escorted in and out by a
A. protect hardware against power surges.
concerned employee.
B. maintain integrity if the main power is interrupted.
C. maintain immediate power if the main power is lost.
600 Questions Pg 21
285. During the course of a physical verification of assets an C. program security controls.
IS auditor discovered discrepancies in properly "D. computer operations controls.
identifying and recording assets which could be 293. Which of the following is the MOST effective technique
attributed to a lack of related procedures and policies. for providing security during data transmission?
Which of the following would NOT be a resultant A. Communication log
exposure caused by this situation? B. Systems software log
A. Assets do not have an adequate identification tag. C. Encryption
B. Incorrect identification may affect warranty claims. D. Standard protocol
C. Incorrect identification may affect insurance claims.
294. Which of the following is the MOST effective control
D. Assets wrongly recorded may lead to
over visitor access to a data center?
misappropriation.
A. Visitors are escorted
286. Which of the following procedures can a biometric B. Visitor badges are required
system perform? C. Visitors sign in
A. Measure airborne contamination. D. Visitors are spot-checked by operators
B. Provide security over physical access.
295. Which of the following is a technique that could illegally
C. Monitor temperature and humidity levels.
capture network user passwords?
D. Detect hazardous electromagnetic fields in an area.
A. Encryption
287. Which of the following concerns associated with the B. Sniffing
World Wide Web would be addressed by a firewall? C. Spoofing
A. Unauthorized access from outside the organization D. Data destruction
B. Unauthorized access from within the organization
296. All of the following are elements of a security
C. Delay in Internet connectivity
infrastructure EXCEPT:
D. Delay in downloading using file transfer protocol
A. management commitment and support.
288. A digital signature contains a message digest to: B. defined and documented security awareness training
A. show if the message has been altered after programs.
transmission. C. legal notice banners displayed on terminals with
B. define the encryption algorithm. Internet connectivity.
C. confirm the identity of the originator. D. defined and documented security policies and
D. enable message transmission in a digital format. procedures.
289. Which of the following fire suppressant systems would 297. Which of the following is the BEST audit procedure
an IS auditor expect to find when conducting an audit of when examining if a firewall is configured in compliance
an unmanned computer center? with the organization's security policy?
A. Carbon dioxide A. Review the parameter settings
B. Halon B. Interview the firewall administrator
C. Dry-pipe sprinkler C. Review the actual procedures
D. Wet-pipe sprinkler D. Review the device's log file for recent attacks
290. The use of web site certificates achieve all of the 298. All of the following are significant Internet exposures
following objectives EXCEPT: EXCEPT:
A. authenticate the user. A. loss of integrity.
B. authenticate the web site. "B. denial of service.
C. warranty that the terms for transactions are properly C. insufficient resources to improve and maintain
revealed to the users. integrity.
D. ensure that the web site has effective controls to D. unauthorized access.
protect private users' information from entities that
299. When an organization's network is connected with an
are not related to the business.
external network in an Internet client/server model not
291. Which of the following types of transmission media under that organization's control, security becomes a
provide the BEST security against unauthorized access? concern. In providing adequate security in this
A. Copper wire environment, which of the following assurance levels is
B. Twisted pair LEAST important?
C. Fiber optic cables A. Server and client authentication
D. Coaxial cables B. Data integrity
292. Controls designed to ensure that unauthorized changes C. Data recovery
cannot be made to information once it resides in a file D. Data confidentiality
are known as: 300. Programs that can run independently and travel from
A. data security controls. machine to machine across network connections, which
B. implementation controls.
600 Questions Pg 22
may destroy data or utilize tremendous computer and B. password identification tables.
communication resources, are referred to as: C. user procedures.
A. trojan horses. D. edit criteria.
B. viruses. 308. Authentication is the process by which the:
C. worms. A. system verifies that the user is entitled to input the
D. logic bombs. transaction requested.
301. Which of the following would LEAST likely prevent an B. system verifies the identity of the user.
information security failure in a wide area network? C. user identifies himself to the system.
A. Conducting user training and awareness programs D. user indicates to the system that the transaction was
B. Avoiding a single point of failure processed correctly.
C. Developing systems that are free from vulnerabilities 309. The IS auditor has determined that protection of
D. Regular and rigorous monitoring the systems logs computer files is inadequate. Which of the following is
302. All of the following are common forms of Internet LEAST likely to have caused this problem?
attacks EXCEPT: A. Arrangements for compatible backup computer
A. exploitation of vulnerabilities in vendor programs. facilities
B. denial of service attacks. B. Procedures for release of files
C. sending hostile code and attack programs as mail C. Offsite storage procedures
attachments. D. Environmental controls
D. systematic hacker foot-printing of an organization. 310. If inadequate, which of the following would MOST likely
303. The management of an organization has encountered contribute to a denial of service attack?
several security incidents recently and has decided to A. Router configuration and rules
establish a security awareness program. Which of the B. Design of the internal network
following would be the LEAST effective in establishing a C. Updates to the router system software
successful security awareness program? D. Audit testing and review techniques
A. Reward employees who report suspicious events 311. Which of the following is the MOST effective type of
B. Provide training on a regular basis to new employees, anti-virus software?
support staff, users, and managers" A. Scanners
C. Stage mock incidents to see how well users and B. Active monitors
support staff respond C. Integrity checkers
D. Utilize an intrusion detection system to report on D. Vaccines
incidents that occur
312. The technique used to ensure security in virtual private
304. Password syntax rules should include all of the following networks (VPNs) is:
EXCEPT: A. encapsulation.
A. be five to eight characters in length. B. wrapping.
B. shadowed so they are not displayed. C. transform.
C. allow for a combination of alphanumeric characters. D. encryption.
D. not be particularly identifiable with any user.
313. A critical function of a firewall is to act as a:
305. Information for detecting unauthorized input from a A. special router that connects the Internet to a LAN.
terminal would be BEST provided by the: B. device for preventing authorized users from accessing
A. console log printout. the LAN.
B. transaction journal. C. server used to connect authorized users to private
C. automated suspense file listing. trusted network resources.
D. user error report. D. proxy server to increase the speed of access to
306. An IS auditor attempting to determine whether access to authorized users.
program documentation is restricted to authorized 314. During an audit of an enterprise that is dedicated to e-
persons would MOST likely: commerce in the modality of business-to-customer, the
A. evaluate the record retention plans for off-premises IS manager states that digital signatures are used in the
storage. establishment of its commercial relations. The auditor
B. interview programmers about the procedures must prove that which of the following is used?
currently being followed. A. A biometric, digitalized and encrypted parameter
C. compare utilization records to operations schedules. with the customer's public key"
D. review data file access records to test the librarian B. A hash of the data that is transmitted and encrypted
function. with the customer's private key
307. A systems analyst should have access to all of the C. A hash of the data that is transmitted and encrypted
following EXCEPT: with the customer's public key
A. source code.
600 Questions Pg 23
D. The customer's scanned signature, encrypted with the C. logging options.
customer's public key" D. user profiles.
315. Risk of hash compromise is BEST mitigated using: 323. Which of the following would an IS auditor consider a
A. digital signatures. MAJOR risk of using single sign-on?
B. message encryption. A. It enables access to single multiple applications
C. message authentication code. B. It represents a single point of failure
D. cryptoanalysis. C. It causes an administrative bottleneck
316. Secure socket layer (SSL) protocol addresses the D. It leads to a lockout of valid users
confidentiality of a message through: 324. Naming convention for access controls are usually set
A. symmetric encryption. by:
B. message authentication code. A. data owners with the help of the security officer.
C. hash function. B. programmers with the help of the security officer.
D. digital signature certificates. C. system analysts with the help of the security officer.
317. An organization is considering connecting a critical PC- D. librarian with the help of the security officer.
based system to the Internet. Which of the following 325. Which of the following is the MOST secure way to
would provide the BEST protection against hacking? connect a private network over the Internet in a small-to
A. Application level gateway medium-sized organization?
B. Remote access server A. Virtual private network
C. Proxy server B. Dedicated line
D. Port scanning C. Leased line
318. A “dry-pipe” fire extinguisher system is a system that D. Integrated services digital network
uses: 326. The potential for unauthorized system access, by way of
A. water, but in which water does not enter the pipes terminals or workstations within the organization's
until a fire has been detected. facility, is increased when:
B. water, but in which the pipes are coated with special A. connecting points are available in the facility to
watertight sealants. connect laptops to the network.
C. carbon dioxide instead of water. B. users do not write their system passwords on, or near,
D. halon instead of water. their work areas.
319. An enterprise is implementing a business-to-business C. terminals with password protection are located in
(B-to-B) network infrastructure to ensure efficient and unsecured locations.
effective communication and supply chain management D. terminals are located within the facility in small
with all international customers and suppliers. The clusters of a few terminals, each under direct charge
enterprise would like to utilize the network and supervision of an administrator.
infrastructure for secure communication, paperless 327. The BEST defense against eavesdropping into computer
negotiations and agreements and to ensure appropriate networks is:
evidence for all transactions. The MOST appropriate A. encryption.
solution is: B. moving the defense perimeter outward.
A. asymmetric encryption and digital signatures. C. reducing the amplitude of the communication signal.
B. symmetric encryption and digital signatures. D. masking the signal with noise.
C. public key infrastructure (PKI). 328. A virtual private network (VPN) performs which of the
D. message authentication code and digital signatures. following functions?
320. Electronic signatures can prevent messages from being: A. Hides information from sniffers on the net
A. suppressed. B. Enforces security policies
B. repudiated. C. Detects misuse or mistakes
C. disclosed. D. Regulates access
D. copied. 329. Within an e-Commerce transaction through the
321. Confidential data stored on a laptop is BEST protected Internet, the process of applying a digital signature to
by: the data that travels in the network, provides which of
A. storage on optical disks. the following?
B. log-on ID and password. A. Confidentiality and integrity
C. data encryption. B. Security and nonrepudiation
D. physical locks. C. Integrity and nonrepudiation
322. Security administration procedures require read-only D. Confidentiality and nonrepudiation
access to: 330. Which of the following would an IS auditor consider a
A. access control tables. weakness when performing an audit of an organization
B. security log files. that uses a public key infrastructure with digital
600 Questions Pg 24
certificates for its business-to-consumer transactions via D. policy management authority.
the Internet? 337. Which of the following is used to create Web pages on
A. Customers are widely dispersed geographically, but the Internet?
not the certificate authorities (CA). A. HTTP
B. Customers can make their transactions from any B. HTML
computer or mobile device. C. TCP/IP
C. The certificate authority has several data processing D. FTP
subcenters to administrate certificates.
338. Which of the following is a simple networking device
D. The organization is the owner of the CA.
that interconnects two or more local area networks
331. Which of the following implementation modes would (LANs)?
provide the GREATEST amount of security to outbound A. Router
data connecting to the Internet? B. Bridge
A. Transport mode with authentication header (AH) C. Gateway
plus encapsulating security payload (ESP) D. Brouter
B. SSL mode
339. Controls over electronic distribution of software would
C. Tunnel mode with AH plus ESP
not include
D. Triple-DES encryption mode
A. Checksum
332. Which of the following is the MOST reliable sender B. Digital signatures
authentication method? C. Virus scanners
A. Digital signatures D. Intrusion detectors
B. Asymmetric cryptography
340. Analyzing data protection requirements for installing a
C. Digital certificates
LAN does not include:
D. Message authentication code
A. Uninterruptible power supply
333. In the Internet encryption process, which of the B. Back ups
following steps provides the GREATEST assurance in C. Fault tolerance
achieving authenticity of a message? D. Operating systems
A. The pre-hash code is derived mathematically from the
341. The most desirable metrics for system reliability,
message being sent.
availability and responsiveness include (MTBF is mean
B. The pre-hash code is encrypted using the sender's
time between failures, MTTR is mean time to repair,
private key.
EMRT is emergency response time, and MTTF is mean
C. Encryption of the pre-hash code and the message
time to failure):
using the secret key.
A. High MTBF, low MTTR, low EMRT and high MTTF"
D. Sender attains the recipient's public key and verifies
B. Low MTBF, high MTTR, low EMRT and low MTTF"
the authenticity of its digital certificate with a
C. Low MTBF, low MTTR, high EMRT and high MTTF"
certificate authority.
D. High MTBF, high MTTR, high EMRT and low MTTF"
334. An Internet security threat that could compromise
342. A videoconferencing product where individuals work
integrity is:
jointly on an electronic document is called a:
A. theft of data from the client.
A. Workflow application
B. exposure of network configuration information.
B. Multipoint application
C. a trojan horse browser.
C. Spreadsheet application
D. eavesdropping on the net.
D. Whiteboard application
335. An IS auditor performing a review of the implemented
343. In which of the following situations would a
security infrastructure of an organization that provides
checkpoint/restart procedure NOT enable recovery?
business-to-business activities, observes that PKI
A. Experiencing temporary failure of the hardware
services are being used. The auditor's conclusion would
B. Loading tapes out of sequence in a multi-volume file
be that they use:
C. Completing the run of an incorrect version of the
A. personal key information.
program
B. private key infrastructure.
D. Suffering temporary power loss to the Data Center
C. public key infrastructure.
during the run
D. practical kerberos implementation.
344. If a database is restored using before image dumps,
336. In a public key infrastructure (PKI), the authority which
where should the process be restarted following an
is responsible for the identification and authentication of
interruption?
an applicant for a digital certificate (i.e., certificate
A. Before the last transaction
subjects) is the:
B. After the last transaction
A. registration authority (RA).
C. The first transaction after the latest checkpoint
B. issuing certification authority.
D. The last transaction before the latest checkpoint
C. subject certification authority.
600 Questions Pg 25
345. Which of the following is an important consideration in D. need not have the same level of environmental
providing backup for online systems? monitoring as the originating site since this would be
A. Maintaining system software parameters cost prohibitive.
B. Ensuring periodic dumps of transaction logs 352. An advantage of the use of hot sites as a backup
C. Ensuring grandfather-father-son file backups alternative is:
D. Maintaining important data at an off-site location A. the costs associated with hot sites are low.
346. As updates to an online order entry system are B. that hot sites can be used for an extended amount of
processed, the updates are recorded on a transaction time.
tape and a hard copy transaction log. At the end of the C. that hot sites can be made ready for operation within
day, the order entry files are backed up onto tape. a short period of time.
During the backup procedure, the disk drive D. that hot sites do not require that equipment and
malfunctions and the order entry files are lost. Which of systems software be compatible with the primary
the following are necessary to restore these files? installation being backed up.
A. The previous day's backup file and the current 353. An IS auditor reviewing back-up procedures for software
transaction tape need only determine that:
B. The previous day's transaction file and the current A. object code libraries are backed up.
transaction tape B. source code libraries are backed up.
C. The current transaction tape and the current C. both object and source codes libraries are backed up.
hardcopy transaction log D. program patches are maintained at the originating
D. The current hardcopy transaction log and the site.
previous day's transaction file
354. Which of the following control concepts should be
347. Which of the following business recovery strategies included in a comprehensive test of disaster recovery
would require the least expenditure of funds? procedures?
A. Warm site facility A. Invite client participation.
B. Empty shell facility B. Involve all technical staff.
C. Hot site subscription C. Rotate recovery managers.
D. Reciprocal agreement D. Install locally stored backup.
348. Which of the following alternative business recovery 355. Which of the following tests would NOT apply to a
strategies would be LEAST appropriate in a large review of the data center disaster recovery plan?
database and online communications network A. Setting up alternative processing facilities
environment where the critical business continuity B. Testing full functionality of restored applications
period is 10 days? C. Installing key files from those stored in the Media
A. Hot site Library
B. Cold site D. Executing application programs from off site backup
C. Reciprocal agreement copies
D. Dual information processing facilities
356. Which of the following is the business continuity
349. For which of the following applications would rapid planning and reconstruction team that is responsible for
recovery be MOST crucial? updating the applications database working from
A. Point-of-sale terminals at the user recovery site during a
B. Corporate planning reconstruction?
C. Regulatory reporting A. Applications team
D. Departmental chargeback B. Network recovery team
350. An organization's disaster recovery plan should address C. Emergency operations team
early recovery of: D. Data preparation and records team
A. all information systems processes. 357. Which of the following procedures would an IS auditor
B. all financial processing applications. perform to BEST determine whether adequate
C. only those applications designated by the IS Manager. recovery/restart procedures exist?
D. processing in priority order, as defined by business A. Reviewing program code
management. B. Reviewing operations documentation
351. An off-site information processing facility: C. Turning off the UPS, then the power"
A. should have the same amount of physical access D. Reviewing program documentation
restrictions as the primary processing site. 358. A company performs full back-up of data and programs
B. should be easily identified from the outside so that in on a regular basis. The primary purpose of this practice
the event of an emergency it can be easily found. is to:
C. should be located in proximity to the originating site A. maintain data integrity in the applications.
so that it can quickly be made operational. B. restore application processing after a disruption.
600 Questions Pg 26
C. prevent unauthorized changes to programs and data. B. strategic long-range planning.
D. ensure recovery of data processing in case of a C. the probability that a disaster will occur.
disaster. D. alternative procedures to process transactions.
359. An IS auditor conducting a review of disaster recovery 362. The MAIN purpose for periodically testing off-site
planning at a financial processing organization has hardware back-up facilities is to:
discovered the following: A. ensure the integrity of the data in the database.
? The existing disaster recovery plan was compiled B. eliminate the need to develop detailed contingency
two years ago by a systems analyst in the organization's plans.
IT department using transaction flow projections from C. ensure the continued compatibility of the contingency
the operations department. facilities.
D. ensure that program and system documentation
? The plan was presented to the deputy CEO for remains current.
approval and formal issue, but it is still awaiting his
attention. 363. During a business continuity planning review, the IS
auditor discovered that software back-up is being kept
? The plan has never been updated, tested or only by the IT department and that senior management
circulated to key management and staff, though is not aware of where back-ups are being kept. Which of
interviews show that each would know what action to the following recommendations is an IS auditor LEAST
take for their area in the event of a disruptive incident. likely to make?
The IS auditor's report should recommend that: A. Validations in the application software should be
A. the deputy CEO be censured for his failure to approve made to prevent unauthorized access to data.
the plan. B. Off-site security and environmental protection
B. a board of senior managers be set up to review the systems should be similar to the production
existing plan. environment.
C. the existing plan be approved and circulated to all key C. There should be off-site storage of software company
management and staff. data, work product or deliverables in a protected
D. an experienced manager coordinate the creation of a vault for such period as specified.
new plan or revised plan within a defined time limit. D. A comprehensive business continuity plan should be
360. An IS auditor conducting a review of disaster recovery formulated to meet the business needs and provide
planning at a financial processing organization has required capabilities in the event of any failure of IT
discovered the following: systems.
? The existing disaster recovery plan was compiled two 364. A large chain of shops with electronic funds transfer
years ago by a systems analyst in the organization's IT (EFT) at point-of-sale devices has a central
department using transaction flow projections from communications processor for connecting with the
the operations department. banking network. Which of the following is the BEST
? The plan was presented to the deputy CEO for disaster recovery plan for the communications
approval and formal issue, but it is still awaiting his processor?
attention. A. Off-site storage of daily back-ups
? The plan has never been updated, tested or circulated B. Alternative standby processor onsite
to key management and staff, though interviews show C. Installation of duplex communication links
that each would know what action to take for their D. Alternative standby processor at another network
area in the event of a disruptive incident.</ul>The node
basis of the organization's disaster recovery plan is to 365. The following table lists the estimate of the probability of
re-establish live processing at an alternative site a computer system being destroyed in a natural disaster
where a similar, but not identical hardware and the corresponding overall business loss. Which
configuration is already established. system has the greatest exposure to loss?
The IS auditor should:
Likelihood :: Losses (in $)
A. take no action as the lack of a current plan is the only
A. 10% :: 6 million
significant finding.
B. 15% :: 5 million
B. recommend that the hardware configuration at each
C. 20% :: 2.5 million
site should be identical.
D. 25% :: 4 million
C. perform a review to verify that the second
configuration can support live processing. 366. Which of the following would an IS auditor consider to
D. report that the financial expenditure on the be the MOST important to review when conducting a
alternative site is wasted without an effective plan. business continuity audit?
A. A hot site is contracted for and available as needed.
361. Disaster recovery planning for a company's computer
B. A business continuity manual is available and current.
system usually focuses on:
C. Insurance coverage is adequate and premiums are
A. operations turnover procedures.
current.
600 Questions Pg 27
D. Media backups are performed on a timely basis and C. Certification relocation list
stored off-site. D. Certification practice statement
367. Which of the following methods of providing 375. An IS auditor performing a review of the back-up
telecommunication continuity involves routing traffic processing facilities would be MOST concerned that:
through split or duplicate cable facilities? A. adequate fire insurance exists.
A. Diverse routing B. regular hardware maintenance is performed.
B. Alternative routing C. offsite storage of transaction and master files exists.
C. Redundancy D. backup processing facilities are fully tested.
D. Long haul network diversity 376. Which of the following findings would an IS auditor be
368. Which of the following is NOT a feature of an MOST concerned about when performing an audit of
uninterruptible power supply (UPS)? backup and recovery and the offsite storage vault?
A. A UPS provides electrical power to a computer in the A. There are three individuals with a key to enter the
event of a power failure. area
B. A UPS system is an external piece of equipment or can B. Paper documents are also stored in the offsite vault
be built into the computer itself. C. Data files, which are stored in the vault, are
C. A UPS should function to permit an orderly computer synchronized"
shutdown. D. The offsite vault is located in a separate facility
D. A UPS uses a greater wattage into the computer to 377. Which of the following represents the GREATEST risk
ensure enough power is available. created by a reciprocal agreement for disaster recovery
369. Most business continuity tests should: made between two companies?
A. be conducted at the same time as normal business A. Developments may result in hardware and software
operations. incompatibility
B. address all system components. B. Resources may not be available when needed
C. evaluate the performance of personnel. C. The recovery plan cannot be tested
D. be monitored by the IS auditor. D. The security infrastructures in each company may be
370. Which of the following would BEST ensure continuity of different
a wide area network (WAN) across the organization? 378. All of the following are security andcontrol concerns
A. Built-in alternative routing associated with disaster recovery procedures EXCEPT:
B. Full system back-up taken daily A. loss of audit trail.
C. A repair contract with a service provider B. insufficient documentation of procedures.
D. A duplicate machine alongside each server C. inability to restart under control.
371. The MOST significant level of business continuity D. inability to resolve system deadlock.
planning program development effort is generally 379. Losses can be minimized MOST effectively by using
required during the: outside storage facilities to do which of the following?
A. testing stage. A. Include current, critical information in backup files"
B. evaluation stage. B. Ensure that current documentation is maintained at
C. Maintenance stage. the backup facility
D. early stages of planning. C. Test backup hardware
372. An IS auditor reviewing an organization's information D. Train personnel in backup procedures
systems disaster recovery plan should verify that it is: 380. Which of the following BEST describes the difference
A. tested every 6 months. between a disaster recovery plan and a business
B. regularly reviewed and updated. continuity plan?
C. approved by the chief executive officer (CEO). A. The disaster recovery plan works for natural disasters
D. communicated to every departmental head in the whereas the business continuity plan works for non-
organization. planned operating incidents such as technical
373. Which of the following implementations of digital failures.
encryption standard is the simplest implementation? B. The disaster recovery plan works for business process
A. Electronic code block (ECB) recovery and information systems whereas the
B. Cipher block chaining (CBC) business continuity plan works only for information
C. Cipher feedback (CFB) systems.
D. Output feedback (OFB) C. The disaster recovery plan defines all needed actions
to restore to normal operation after an un-planned
374. Which of the following manages the certificate life cycle
incident whereas the business continuity plan only
of public key pairs to ensure adequate security and
deals with critical operations needed to continue
controls exist in e-commerce applications?
working after an un-planned incident.
A. Registration authority
D. The disaster recovery plan is the awareness process
B. Certificate authority
for employees whereas the business continuity plan
600 Questions Pg 28
contains the procedures themselves to recover the D. Adequate feedback to management to assure that the
operation. business continuity plans are indeed workable and
381. Which of the following would warranty a quick that the procedures are current.
continuity of operations when the recovery time window 387. Which of the following principles must exist to ensure
is short? the viability of a duplicate information processing
A. A duplicated back-up in an alternate site facility?
B. Duplicated data in a remote site A. The site is near the primary site to ensure quick and
C. Transfer of data the moment a contingency occurs efficient recovery is achieved.
D. A manual contingency procedure B. The site contains the most advanced hardware
382. Which of the following is MOST important to have in a available from the chosen vendor.
disaster recovery plan? C. The workload of the primary site is monitored to
A. Backup of compiled object programs ensure adequate backup is complete.
B. Reciprocal processing agreement D. The hardware is tested when it is established to
C. Phone contact list ensure it is working properly.
D. Supply of special forms 388. There are several methods of providing
383. At the end of a simulation of an operational contingency telecommunications continuity. The method of routing
test, the IS auditor performed a review of the recovery traffic through split cable or duplicate cable facilities is:
process. The IS auditor concluded that the recovery was A. alternative routing.
more than the critical time frame that was necessary. B. diverse routing.
Which of the following actions would the auditor C. long haul network diversity.
recommend? D. last mile circuit protection.
A. Widen the physical capacity to accomplish better 389. Which of the following offsite information processing
mobility in a shorter time. facility conditions would cause an IS auditor the
B. Shorten the distance to reach the hot site. GREATEST concern?
C. Perform an integral review of the recovery tasks. A. The facility is clearly identified on the outside with the
D. Increase the number of human resources involved in company name.
the recovery process. B. The facility is located more than an hour driving
384. An IS auditor inspects an organization's offsite storage distance from the originating site.
and plans to sample the system and program C. The facility does not have any windows to let in
documentation. The IS auditor is MOST likely natural sunlight.
interested in reviewing: D. The facility entrance is located in the back of the
A. error conditions and user manuals. building rather than the front.
B. application run books. 390. Which of the following is a continuity plan test that uses
C. job stream control instructions. actual resources to simulate a system crash to cost-
D. exception processing instructions. effectively obtain evidence about the plan's
385. While reviewing the business continuity plan of an effectiveness?
organization, the IS auditor observed that the A. Paper test
organization's data and software files are backedup on a B. Post test
periodic basis. Which characteristic of an effective plan C. Preparedness test
does this demonstrate? D. Walkthrough
A. Deterrence 391. An offsite backup facility having electrical writing, air
B. Mitigation conditioning, flooring, etc., but no computer or
C. Recovery communications equipment, intended to operate an
D. Response information processing facility is better known as a:
386. Which of the following disaster recovery/continuity plan A. cold site.
components provides the GREATEST assurance for B. warm site.
recovery after a disaster? C. dial up site.
A. The requirement that the alternate facility be available D. duplicate processing facility.
until the original information processing facility is 392. Which of the following methods of results analysis,
restored. during the testing of the business continuity plan (BCP),
B. User management involvement in the identification of provides the BEST assurance that the plan is workable?
critical systems and their associated critical recovery A. Quantitatively measuring the results of the test
times and the specification of needed procedures. B. Measurement of accuracy
C. Copies of the plan kept at the homes of key decision C. Elapsed time for completion of prescribed tasks
making personnel. D. Evaluation of the observed test results
600 Questions Pg 29
393. A large organization with numerous applications B. the growth of user requirements was inaccurately
running on its mainframe system is experiencing a forecast.
growing backlog of undeveloped applications. As part of C. the hardware system limits the number of concurrent
a master plan to eliminate this backlog, end-user users.
computing with prototyping is being introduced, D. user participation in defining the system's
supported by the acquisition of an interactive requirements is inadequate.
application generator system. Which of the following 400. Which of the following are objectives of using a system
areas is MOST critical to the ultimate success of this development life cycle methodology?
venture? A. Ensuring that appropriate staffing is complete and
A. Data control providing a method of controlling costs and
B. Systems analysis schedules.
C. Systems programming B. Providing a method of controlling costs and schedules
D. Application programming and ensuring communication among users, IS
394. Which of the following general control items would NOT auditors, management and IS personnel.
normally be found in an audit of user programming C. Providing a method of controlling costs and schedules
procedures in an end-user computing environment? and an effective means of auditing project
A. Console log procedures development.
B. Change control procedures D. Ensuring communication among users, IS auditors,
C. Back-up and recovery procedures management and personnel and ensuring that
D. Documentation standards and procedures appropriate staffing is complete.
395. Which of the following represents a typical prototype of 401. A primary reason for an IS auditor's involvement in the
an interactive application? development of a new application system is to determine
A. Screens and process programs that:
B. Screens, interactive edits and sample reports" A. adequate controls are built into the system.
C. Interactive edits process programs and sample B. user requirements are satisfied by the system.
reports C. sufficient hardware is available to process the system.
D. Screens, interactive edits, process programs and D. data are being developed for pre-implementation
sample reports" testing of the system.
396. Which of the following statements relating to the use of 402. In which of the following phases of the system
spreadsheets is FALSE? development life cycle of a new application system is it
A. An essential control feature is the performance of the MOST important for the IS auditor to participate?
adequate testing. A. Design
B. It is important to develop complete and appropriate B. Testing
documentation. C. Programming
C. In the designing process, it is important that data be D. Implementation
limited to one spreadsheet. 403. During a detailed system design, the IS auditor would be
D. The reference area should include the file name, the LEAST concerned with:
version number, and the creation date and time. A. adequacy of audit trails.
397. Which of the following tasks would NOT be performed B. handling of rejected transactions.
by an IS auditor when reviewing systems development C. adequacy of hardware to handle the system.
controls in a specific application? D. procedures to ensure that all transactions are
A. Attend project progress meetings. received.
B. Review milestone documents for appropriate sign-off. 404. Which of the following groups/individuals assume
C. Compare development budgets with actual time and ownership of systems development life cycle projects
dollars spent. and the resulting system?
D. Design and execute testing procedures for use during A. User management
acceptance testing. B. Senior management
398. Which of the following represents the MOST pervasive C. Project steering committee
control over application development? D. Systems development management
A. IS auditors 405. Which of the following statements regarding the
B. Standard development methodologies function of a systems development life cycle steering
C. Extensive acceptance testing committee is FALSE?
D. Quality assurance groups A. Review project progress regularly.
399. A computerized information system frequently fails to B. Report only to senior management on project status.
meet the needs of users because: C. Serve as a coordinator and advisor to answer
A. user needs are constantly changing. questions about system and program design.
600 Questions Pg 30
D. Take corrective action regarding personnel changes A. The finished system normally has strong internal
on the project team. controls.
406. The responsibility of assuring that the systems B. Prototype systems can provide significant time and
development life cycle design adheres to corporate cost savings.
security policies and tests system security prior to C. Change control is often less complicated with
implementation is that of the: prototype systems.
A. security officer. D. It ensures that functions or extras are not added to
B. project manager. the intended system.
C. quality assurance. 413. The use of fourth generation languages (4GLs) should be
D. project steering committee. weighed carefully against using traditional languages
407. An IS auditor who is participating in a systems because 4GLs:
development life cycle project should: A. can lack lower level detail commands necessary to
A. recommend appropriate control mechanisms perform data intensive operations.
regardless of cost. B. cannot be implemented on both the mainframe
B. obtain and read project team meeting minutes to processors and microcomputers.
determine the status of the project. C. generally contain complex language subsets which
C. ensure that adequate and complete documentation must be used by skilled users.
exists for all project phases. D. cannot access database records and produce complex
D. not worry about his/her own ability to produce key Online outputs.
deliverables by the promised dates since work will 414. Which of the following is NOT a feature of structured
progress regardless. programming for defining applications?
408. The phases and deliverables of a systems development A. Programs are written using a bottom-up approach.
life cycle project should be determined: B. Programs are easy to develop and maintain.
A. during the early planning stages of the project. C. Design modules are independent of each other.
B. after early planning has been completed, but before D. Design is accomplished through a series of diagrams,
work has begun. showing relationships.
C. during the work stages as deliverables are determined 415. Which of the following computer aided software
based on risks and exposures. engineering (CASE) products is used for developing
D. only after all risks and exposures have been identified detailed designs, such as screen and report layouts?
and the IS auditor has recommended appropriate A. Super CASE
controls. B. Upper CASE
409. Where a systems development life cycle methodology is C. Middle CASE
inadequate, the MOST serious immediate risk is that the D. Lower CASE
new system will: 416. Which of the following is a characteristic of a decision
A. be completed late. support system (DSS)?
B. exceed the cost estimates. A. DSS is aimed at solving highly structured problems.
C. not meet business and user needs. B. DSS combines the use of models with non-traditional
D. be incompatible with existing systems. data access and retrieval functions.
410. Which of the following is a management technique that C. DSS emphasizes flexibility in the decision making
enables organizations to develop strategically important approach of users.
systems faster while reducing development costs and D. DSS supports only structured decision-making tasks.
maintaining quality? 417. Which of the following statements pertaining to data
A. Function point analysis warehouses is FALSE?
B. Critical path methodology A. A data warehouse is designed specifically for decision
C. Rapid application development support.
D. Program evaluation review technique B. The quality of the data in a data warehouse must be
411. Which of the following is NOT an advantage of using very high.
structured analysis (SA)? C. Data warehouses are made up of existing databases,
A. SA supports CASE tools. files and external information.
B. SA addresses users concerns quickly. D. A data warehouse is used by senior management only
C. SA is more applicable to problem-oriented analysis because of the sensitivity of the data.
than design. 418. The primary role of an IS auditor in the system design
D. SA addresses the issue of structuring systems into phase of an application development project is to:
concurrent tasks. A. advise on specific and detailed control procedures.
412. Which of the following is an advantage of prototyping? B. ensure the design accurately reflects the requirement.
C. ensure all necessary controls are included in the initial
design.
600 Questions Pg 31
D. advise the development manager on adherence to the A. unit testing is more comprehensive.
schedule. B. programmers are not involved in system testing.
419. Which of the following would be considered to be the C. system testing relates to interfaces between programs.
MOST serious disadvantage of prototyping systems D. system testing proves user requirements are
development? adequate.
A. The prototyping software is expensive. 426. Which of the following audit procedures would an IS
B. Prototyping demands excessive computer usage. auditor normally perform FIRST when auditing the
C. Users may perceive that the development is complete. current documented systems development life cycle?
D. The users' needs may not have been correctly A. Determine procedural adequacy.
assessed. B. Analyze procedural effectiveness.
420. An advantage of using sanitized live transactions in test C. Evaluate level of compliance with procedures.
data is that: D. Compare established standards to observed
A. all transaction types will be included. procedures.
B. every error condition is likely to be tested. 427. An IS auditor who has participated in the development
C. no special routines are required to assess the results. of an application system might have their independence
D. test transactions are representative of live processing. impaired if they:
421. An IS auditor's primary concern when application A. perform an application development review.
developers wish to use a copy of yesterday's transaction B. recommend control and other system enhancements.
file from the production process to show that the C. perform an independent evaluation of the application
development can cope accurately with the required after its implementation.
volume is that: D. are actively involved in the design and
A. users may prefer to use contrived data for testing. implementation of the application system.
B. unauthorized access to sensitive data may result. 428. Which of the following tools would NOT be used in
C. error handling and credibility checks may not be fully program debugging during system development?
proven. A. Compiler
D. full functionality of the new process is not necessarily B. Memory dump
tested. C. Output analyzer
422. Many IT projects experience problems because the D. Logic path monitor
development time and/or resource requirements are 429. Which of the following statements relating to structured
underestimated. Which of the following techniques query language (SQL) is TRUE?
would improve the estimation of the resources required A. SQL is harder to use than a programming language.
in system construction after the development of the B. A user must know where the information is located to
requirements specification? gain access.
A. PERT chart C. A user must know how the information is structured
B. Recalibration to gain access.
C. Cost-benefit analysis D. SQL serves as an interface between the client,
D. Function point estimation computer, and server.
423. Which of the following is the MOST important reason 430. A significant problem in planning and controlling a
for the IS auditor to be involved in the system software development project is determining:
development life cycle process? A. project slack times.
A. Evaluate the efficiency of resource utilization. B. a project's critical path.
B. Develop audit programs for subsequent audits of the C. time and resource requirements for individual tasks.
system. D. precedent relationships which preclude the start of
C. Evaluate the selection of hardware to be used by the certain activities until others are complete.
system. 431. Which of the following is NOT a role of a project sponsor
D. Ensure that adequate controls are built into the who is involved in a systems development project?
system during development. A. Provides funding for the project
424. Which of the following is a primary purpose for B. Responsible for data and application ownership
conducting parallel testing? C. Monitors and controls costs and project timetable
A. To determine if the system is more cost-effective. D. Works with the project manager to define success
B. To enable comprehensive unit and system testing. parameters
C. To highlight errors in the program interfaces with 432. Large scale systems development life cycle (SDLC)
files. efforts:
D. To ensure the new system meets all user A. are not affected by the use of prototyping tools.
requirements. B. can be carried out independent of other
425. Unit testing is different from system testing because: organizational practices.
600 Questions Pg 32
C. require that business requirements be defined before D. controls the coding and testing of the high-level
the project begins. functions of the program in the development process.
D. require that project phases and deliverables be 439. Peer reviews that detect software errors during each
defined during the duration of the project. program development cycle resulting in faster
433. Which of the following is a reason to involve an IS implementation, better documentation, easier
auditor in systems design activities? maintenance and higher programmer morale are called:
A. Post-application reviews do not need to be A. emulation techniques.
performed. B. structured walkthroughs.
B. Total budgeted system development costs can be C. modular program techniques.
reduced. D. top-down program construction.
C. It is extremely costly to institute controls after a 440. An IS auditor who plans on testing the connection of two
system becomes operational. or more system components that pass information from
D. The extent of user involvement in design activities is one area to another would use:
significantly reduced. A. pilot testing.
434. Which of the following would NOT normally be part of a B. parallel testing
feasibility study? C. interface testing.
A. Identifying the cost savings of a new system. D. regression testing.
B. Defining the major requirements of the new system. 441. An advantage in using a bottom-up versus a top-down
C. Determining the productivity gains of implementing a approach to software testing is that:
new system. A. interface errors are detected earlier.
D. Estimating a pay-back schedule for cost incurred in B. confidence in the system is achieved earlier.
implementing the system. C. errors in critical modules are detected earlier.
435. Detailed systems specifications do NOT normally D. major functions and processing are tested earlier.
include: 442. During which phase of a system development process
A. overviews of each program in the system. would an IS auditor first consider application controls?
B. program, operations and user documentation. A. Construction
C. a systems flowchart showing the system logic, data B. System design
files and reports of the system. C. Acceptance testing
D. a systems narrative depicting the systems objectives, D. Functional specification
the major functions to be performed and the
443. Which of the following quality mechanisms is MOST
relationships of the major functions.
likely to occur when a system development project is in
436. The purpose of the system development life cycle the middle of the construction stage?
program and procedure development phase is to: A. Unit tests
A. prepare, test and document all computer programs B. Stress tests
and manual procedures. C. Regression testing
B. document a business or system problem to a level at D. Acceptance testing
which management can select a system solution.
444. An IS auditor reviewing a system development project
C. prepare a high-level design of a proposed system
would be MOST concerned whether:
solution and present reasons for adopting a solution.
A. business objectives are achieved.
D. expand the general design of an approved system
B. security and control procedures are adequate.
solution so that programming and procedure writing
C. the system utilized the strategic technical
can begin.
infrastructure.
437. The knowledge base of an expert system that uses D. development will comply with the approved quality
questionnaires to lead the user through a series of management processes.
choices before a conclusion is reached is known as:
445. A large number of system failures are occurring when
A. rules.
corrections to previously detected faults are resubmitted
B. decision trees.
for acceptance testing. This would indicate that the
C. semantic nets.
development team is probably not adequately
D. data flow diagrams.
performing which of the following types of testing?
438. Structured programming is BEST described as a A. Unit testing
technique that: B. Integration testing
A. provides knowledge of program functions to other C. Design walkthroughs
programmers via peer reviews. D. Configuration management
B. reduces the maintenance time of programs by the
446. An organization is developing a new business system.
user of small-scale program modules.
Which of the following will provide the MOST assurance
C. makes the readable coding reflect as closely as
that the system provides the required functionality?
possible the dynamic execution of the program.
600 Questions Pg 33
A. Unit testing D. Post-implementation review
B. Regression testing 454. In the development of an important application affecting
C. Acceptance testing the entire organization, which of the following would be
D. Integration testing the MOST appropriate project sponsor?
447. Which of the following techniques would provide the A. The information systems manager
BEST assurance that the estimate of program B. A member of executive management
development effort is reliable? C. An independent management consultant
A. Function point analysis D. The manager of the key user department
B. Estimates by business area 455. Which of the following is LEAST likely to be included in
C. Computer based project schedule the feasibility study?
D. Estimate by experienced programmer A. Statutory requirements
448. An IS auditor reviewing an organization's test strategy B. Operating system implications
discovers that it is proposed that the test database be C. Control and audit specifications
refreshed weekly from a section of the production D. Hardware capacity considerations
database. Which of the following would MOST likely be 456. Which of the following development methods uses a
affected by this approach? prototype that can continually be updated to meet
A. Completeness of testing changing user or business requirements?
B. Test processing efficiency A. Data oriented development (DOD)
C. Documentation of test results B. Object oriented development (OOD)
D. Integrity of the production data C. Business process reengineering (BPR)
449. Which of the following would be a major D. Rapid application development (RAD)
DISADVANTAGE of using prototyping as a systems 457. Which of the following should be included in a feasibility
development methodology? study for a project to install electronic data interchange
A. User expectations of project timescales may be over- (EDI)?
optimistic. A. The encryption algorithm format
B. Effective change control and management is B. The detailed internal control procedures
impossible to implement. C. The necessary communication protocols
C. User participation in day-to-day project management D. The proposed trusted third-party agreement
may be too extensive.
458. When reviewing the quality of an IS department's
D. Users are not usually sufficiently knowledgeable to
development process, the IS auditor finds that they do
assist in system development.
not use any formal, documented methodology and
450. An IS auditor involved as a team member in the detailed standards. The IS auditor's MOST appropriate action
system design phase of a system under development would be to:
would be MOST concerned with: A. complete the audit and report the finding.
A. internal control procedures. B. investigate and recommend appropriate formal
B. user acceptance test schedules. standards.
C. adequacy of the user training program. C. document the informal standards and test for
D. clerical processes for resubmission of rejected items. compliance.
451. The PRIMARY reason for separating the test and D. withdraw and recommend a further audit when
development environments would be to: standards are implemented.
A. restrict access to systems under test. 459. Which of the following testing methods is MOST
B. segregate user and development staff. effective during the initial phases of prototyping?
C. control the stability of the test environment. A. System testing
D. secure access to systems under development. B. Parallel testing
452. The use of coding standards is encouraged by IS C. Volume testing
auditors because they: D. Top-down testing
A. define access control tables. 460. IS management has decided to rewrite a legacy customer
B. detail program documentation. relations system using fourth generation languages
C. standardize dataflow diagram methodology. (4GLs). Which of the following risks is MOST often
D. ensure compliance with field naming conventions. associated with system development using 4GLs?
453. During which of the following phases in systems A. Inadequate screen/report design facilities
development would user acceptance test plans normally B. Complex programming language subsets
be prepared? C. Lack of portability across operating systems
A. Feasibility study D. Inability to perform data intensive operations
B. Requirements definition
C. Implementation planning
600 Questions Pg 34
461. Which of the following audit procedures would MOST 468. Which of the following BEST describes the necessary
likely be used in an audit of a systems development documentation of an enterprise product reengineering
project? (EPR) software installation?
A. Develop test transactions A. Specific developments only
B. Use code comparison utilities B. Business requirements only
C. Develop audit software programs C. All phases of the installation must be documented
D. Review functional requirements documentation D. No need to develop a customer specific
462. When a new system is to be implemented within a short documentation
timeframe, it is MOST important to: 469. When auditing the requirements phase of a software
A. finish writing user manuals. acquisition, an IS auditor would:
B. perform user acceptance testing. A. assess the adequacy of audit trails.
C. add last-minute enhancements to functionalities. B. identify and determine the criticality of the need.
D. ensure that code has been documented and reviewed. C. verify cost justifications and anticipated benefits.
463. Which of the following should NOT be criteria related to D. ensure that control specifications have been defined.
the decision to acquire system software? 470. A company has contracted an external consulting firm to
A. Hard and soft costs implement a commercial financial system to replace its
B. Integration with the existing environment existing in-house developed system. In reviewing the
C. Similarity of the acquired system software to that proposed development approach, which of the following
currently in use would be of GREATEST concern?
D. Appropriateness of the proposed software to the A. Acceptance testing is to be managed by users.
desired computer environment B. A quality plan is not part of the contracted
464. Which of the following is NOT considered an advantage deliverables.
of packaged software? C. Not all business functions will be available on initial
A. Reduced development cost implementation.
B. Reduced risk of logic error D. Prototyping is being used to confirm that the system
C. Increased processing efficiencies meets business requirements.
D. Increased flexibility due to optional features 471. Which of the following should be in place to protect the
465. Which of the following would NOT be a reason for IS purchaser of an application package in the event that the
Audit involvement in information systems contractual vendor ceases to trade?
negotiations? A. Source code held in escrow.
A. Often hardware does not interface in an acceptable B. Object code held by a trusted third party.
manner. C. Contractual obligation for software maintenance.
B. Many information systems projects incur additional D. Adequate training for internal programming staff.
costs over the contract cost. 472. Change management procedures are established by IS
C. Vendors may go out of business and discontinue management to:
service support on their products. A. control the movement of applications from the test
D. Only the IS auditor can determine whether the environment to the production environment.
controls in the system are adequate. B. control the interruption of business operations from
466. If the decision has been made to acquire software rather lack of attention to unresolved problems.
than develop it internally, this decision is normally made C. ensure the uninterrupted operation of the business in
during the: the event of a disaster.
A. requirements definition phase of the project. D. verify that system changes are properly documented.
B. feasibility study phase of the project. 473. Which of the following system software elements
C. detailed design phase of the project. enables complex system maintenance?
D. programming phase of the project. A. System exits
467. Which of the following is NOT an advantage of B. Special system logon-IDs
concurrent software licensing? C. Network change controls
A. The license is based on the number of users that can D. Bypass label processing
access the software at one time. 474. Which of the following program change controls is NOT
B. Network administrators can identify the need to the responsibility of the user department?
purchase software based on need and use. A. Updating documentation to reflect all changes
C. It is a method that can be used to prevent illegal B. Initiating requests within its scope of authority
duplication of software. C. Approving changes before implementation, based on
D. Users must wait for access, if all concurrent access the results of testing"
sessions are in use. D. Approving changes before implementation, based on
review of changes to manual procedures"
600 Questions Pg 35
475. Which of the following is MOST effective in controlling D. Authoring of user procedure manuals and training
application maintenance? developed during the time that coding begins
A. Informing users of the status of changes 481. Which of the following would NOT represent a strong
B. Establishing priorities on program changes test approach for an organization attempting to solve a
C. Obtaining user approval of program changes year or date problem in a current operating system?
D. Requiring documented user specifications for A. A phased approach for testing and validation that
changes includes unit, integration, systems, and acceptance
476. Which of the following should be tested if an application testing.
program is modified in an authorized maintenance B. Use of a program logic analyzer to assess and identify
procedure? key data paths of critical applications in prioritizing
A. The integrity of the database conversion and testing efforts.
B. The segment of the program which has been amended C. A robust test facility separate from the production
C. The access controls for the applications programmer environment to avoid contamination or interference
D. The complete program, including any interface with the operation of the productions systems.
systems" D. Use of integrated power tools that support testing of
477. A post-implementation review of a new or extensively critical application prototypes and establishment of a
modified system is usually performed by: central repository for requirements coming out of this
A. end-users and IS auditor process.
B. IS auditor and project development team. 482. An advantage to setting a stop or freezing point on the
C. project steering committee and project development design of a new project is to:
team. A. prevent further changes to a project in process.
D. project development team and end-users. B. indicate the point when the design is to be completed.
478. In regard to moving an application program from the C. require changes after that point be reviewed and
test environment to the production environment, the evaluated for cost-effectiveness.
BEST control would be provided by having the: D. provide the project management team with more
A. application programmer copy the source program control over the project design.
and compiled object module to the production 483. All of the following system maintenance controls are the
libraries. responsibility of the user department EXCEPT:
B. application programmer copy the source program to A. initiating requests within its scope of authority.
the production libraries and then have the production B. updating systems documentation to reflect all
control group compile the program. changes.
C. production control group copy the source program C. approving changes before implementation, based on
and compile the object module to the production the results of testing.
libraries. D. approving changes before implementation, based on
D. production control group copy the source program to review of changes to manual procedures.
the production libraries and then compile the 484. If an application program is modified and proper system
program. maintenance procedures are in place, which of the
479. Utilizing audit software to provide code comparisons of following should be tested?
production programs is an audit technique used to test A. The integrity of the database.
program: B. The access controls for the applications programmer
A. logic. C. The complete program, including any interface
B. changes. systems"
C. efficiency. D. The segment of the program containing the revised
D. computations. code
480. Which of the following BEST describes the process used 485. An IS auditor performing an application maintenance
to solve a year or date problem in a current operating audit would review a manually prepared log of program
system? changes to determine the:
A. Development of a requirements definition document A. number of authorized program changes.
and performance of a feasibility study for all critical B. creation date of a current object module.
business functions C. number of program changes actually made.
B. Definition of detailed design specifications for D. creation date of a current source program.
applications based on the general design and user 486. Ideally, stress testing should only be carried out in a:
specifications A. test environment using test data.
C. Testing, verification, and validation of converted or B. production environment using live workloads.
replaced platforms, applications, databases, and C. test environment using live workloads.
utilities" D. production environment using test data.
600 Questions Pg 36
487. When auditing the proposed acquisition of a new 494. For the design and programming of an information
computer system, the IS auditor should FIRST establish system, which is the typical sequence in which
that: participation of these individuals should occur?
A. a clear business case has been approved by A. Technical analyst, functional analyst, programmer"
management. B. Technical analyst, programmer, computer operator"
B. corporate security standards will be met. C. Functional analyst, technical analyst, programmer"
C. users will be involved in the implementation plan. D. Technical analyst, technical support, programmer"
D. the new system will meet all required user 495. In the design of an application system, the IS auditor:
functionality. A. should participate to ensure appropriate controls are
488. Which of the following is an object-oriented technology included in the system.
characteristic that permits an enhanced degree of B. should not get involved because it would affect his/her
security over data? objectivity.
A. Inheritance C. should be able to code some of the control routines
B. Dynamic warehousing that should be included in the programs.
C. Encapsulation D. defines all the controls that need to be included in the
D. Polymorphism system.
489. The objective of software test designs is to provide the 496. Which of the following controls would be MOST effective
highest likelihood of finding most errors with a in ensuring that production source code and object code
minimum of time and effort. Which of the following are synchronized?
methods is LEAST likely to meet the design objective? A. Release-to-release source and object comparison
A. Black box tests which are used to determine that reports
software functions are operational. B. Library control software restricting changes to source
B. White box testing predicated on a close examination code
of procedural detail of all software logical paths. C. Restricted access to source code and object code
C. Regression testing in conducting previous tests to D. Date and time-stamp reviews of source and object
ensure that new errors have not been introduced. code
D. Software test design that provides for unit, 497. Following the development of an application system, it is
integration, systems, and acceptance testing. determined that several design objectives have not been
490. All of the following are used as cost estimating achieved. This is MOST likely to have been caused by:
techniques during the project planning stage EXCEPT: A. insufficient user involvement.
A. PERT charts. B. early dismissal of the project manager.
B. function points. C. inadequate quality assurance (QA) tools.
C. delphi technique. D. non-compliance with defined approval points.
D. expert judgment. 498. During a post-implementation review of an enterprise
491. Which of the following is a dynamic analysis tool for the resource management system an IS auditor would
purpose of testing of software modules? MOST likely:
A. Black box test A. review access control configuration.
B. Desk checking B. evaluate interface testing.
C. Structured walk-through C. review detailed design documentation.
D. Design and code D. evaluate system testing.
492. The primary purpose of a system test is to: 499. An executable module is about to be migrated from the
A. test the generation of the designed control totals. test environment to the production environment. Which
B. determine that the documentation of the system is of the following controls would MOST likely detect an
accurate. unauthorized modification to the module?
C. evaluate the system functionally. A. Object code comparison
D. ensure that the system operators get familiar with the B. Source code comparison
new system. C. Timestamps
493. When implementing an application software package, D. Manual inspection
which of the following presents the GREATEST risk? 500. The use of object-oriented design and development
A. Multiple software versions are not controlled techniques would MOST likely:
B. Source programs are not synchronized with object A. facilitate the ability to reuse modules.
code B. improve system performance.
C. Parameters are not set correctly C. enhance control effectiveness.
D. Programming errors D. speed up the system development life cycle.
501. Once an application's access control process has been
established, an IS auditor should verify that:
600 Questions Pg 37
A. passwords are not shared. B. It is most beneficial to find and quickly correct
B. files and passwords are encrypted. programming errors.
C. profile assignments are controlled by the IS manager. C. The amount of checking should be dictated by
D. there are no functions overlapping in the database available time and budget.
administration. D. Well-defined processes and structured reviews
502. Which of the following is a measure of the size of an should be applied throughout the project.
information system based on the number and 509. Which of the following groups/individuals assume
complexity of a system's inputs, outputs and files? overall direction and responsibility for costs and
A. Program evaluation review technique (PERT) timetables of systems development life cycle projects?
B. Rapid application development (RAD) A. User management
C. Function point analysis (FPA) B. Project steering committee
D. Critical path method (CPM) C. Senior management
503. The purpose for requiring source code escrow in a D. Systems development management
contractual agreement is to: 510. Failure to adequately define or manage the requirements
A. ensure the source code is available if the vendor for a system can result in a number of risks. The
ceases to exist. GREATEST risk is:
B. permit customization of the software to meet A. inadequate user involvement.
specified business requirements. B. inadequate allocation of resources.
C. review the source code for adequacy of controls. C. requirement change during development.
D. ensure vendor complies with legal requirements. D. inadequate estimation of the critical path.
504. Which of the following should be performed FIRST 511. Which of the following methodologies is appropriate for
when acquiring software? planning and control activities and resources in a system
A. Identify data processing requirements project?
B. Compare delivery schedules to requirements A. Critical path methodology (CPM)
C. Negotiate price B. Program evaluation review technique (PERT)
D. Establish business needs C. Gantt charts
505. An IS auditor participating in new software development D. Function point analysis
projects will provide an increased contribution and the 512. One of fourth generation language's (4GL)
organization will experience increased efficiency if: distinguishing features is portability which means?
A. procedures to identify and document needs and A. Environmental independence
requirements of the users are established. B. Workbench concepts (temporary storage, text editing,
B. procedures to store the developed software are etc.)"
defined in the systems development life cycle phases. C. Ability to design screen formats and develop graphical
C. development, test and production environments are outputs
defined separately from each other. D. Ability to execute online operations
D. procedures and formal guidelines are established that 513. An organization has contracted with a vendor for a
identify each system development life cycle phase. turnkey solution for their electronic toll collection
506. The purpose of debugging programs is to: system (ETCS). The vendor has provided its proprietary
A. generate random data that can be used to test application software as part of the solution. The vendor
programs before implementing them. contract should have a clause for:
B. protect valid changes from being overwritten by other A. a backup server to be available to run all ETCS
changes during the programming. operations with up-to-date data in the event of failure
C. define the program development and maintenance of the original ETCS server.
costs to be include in the feasibility study. B. a backup server of a similar configuration as the ETCS
D. ensure that abnormal terminations and coding flaws server and be loaded with all the relevant software
are detected and corrected. and data.
507. The difference between white-box testing and black-box C. systems staff of the organization to be trained to
testing is that white-box testing: handle any eventualities.
A. involves the IS auditor. D. source code of ETCS application software to be kept
B. Is performed by an independent programmer team. under an escrow agreement.
C. examines the program internal logical structure. 514. An IS auditor reviewing systems development in
D. uses the bottom-up approach. Internet determines that the BEST reason why the
508. Which of the following is the BEST way to achieve good system developer is using applets is because:
quality software? A. it is sent over the network from the web server.
A. The primary means is through thorough testing. B. the server does not run the program and the output is
not sent over the network.
600 Questions Pg 38
C. they improve the performance of both the web server C. where applications, transactions and trading partners
and network. supported remain static over time.
D. it is a JAVA program downloaded through the web D. that transmits transactions using sophisticated
browser run on the client machine from the web formats and file definitions.
server. 521. An IS auditor evaluates the test results of a major
515. An enterprise has established a steering committee to modification to a production system module that deals
oversee its e-business program. The steering committee with payments computation. The IS auditor finds that
would MOST likely be involved in the: 50% of the calculations do not match predetermined
A. documentation of software requirements. totals. Which of the following would MOST likely be the
B. escalation of project issues. next step in the audit?
C. design of interface controls between systems. A. Designing further tests of the calculations that are in
D. specification of management reports. error
516. Which of the following is a control to detect an B. Identifying other variables that may render the test
unauthorized change in a production environment? results inaccurate
A. Deny programmer access to production data. C. Examining some of the cases with incorrect
B. Require change requests to include information about calculations to confirm the results
dates, descriptions, cost analysis and anticipated D. Documenting the results and preparing a report of
effects. findings, conclusions, and recommendations"
C. Run a source comparison program between control 522. The use of expert systems:
and current source periodically. A. facilitates consistent and efficient quality decisions.
D. Establish procedures for emergency changes. B. captures the knowledge and experience of industry
517. An IS auditor reviewing the design phase of the program experts.
development life cycle would seek to determine that: C. cannot be used by IS auditors since they deal with
A. program documentation provides little evidence system specific controls.
about the quality of the design approach used during D. improves system efficiency and effectiveness, not
software development. personal productivity and performance.
B. programmers specify the structure and operations of 523. A strength of an implemented quality system based on
a program that will satisfy a requirement's ISO 9001 is that it:
specification. A. guarantees quality solutions to business problems.
C. an object-oriented approach to design is employed B. enhances improvements in software life cycle
when low-level programming languages are used to activities.
develop programs. C. provides clear answers to questions concerning cost-
D. a formal approach to design is not followed when effectiveness.
high-level languages are used to develop programs. D. does not depend on the maturity of the implemented
518. Which of the following statements pertaining to quality system.
business process reengineering (BPR) is TRUE? 524. As a business process reengineering project takes hold it
A. BPR projects cause concern since they often lead to an is expected that:
increased number of people using technology. A. business priorities will remain stable.
B. Significant cost savings are achieved through reduced B. information technologies will not change.
complexity and volatility in information technology. C. the process will improve product, service and
C. BPR leads to weaker organizational structures and profitability.
less accountability. D. input from clients and customers will no longer be
D. Information protection (IP) is a greater risk as it is necessary.
more likely to be in conflict with BPR. 525. Functionality is a characteristic associated with
519. Which of the following is the FIRST point at which evaluating the quality of software products throughout
control totals should be implemented in order to prevent their lifecycle, and is BEST described as the set of
the loss of data during the processing cycle? attributes that bear on the:
A. During data preparation A. existence of a set of functions and their specified
B. In transit to the computer properties.
C. Between related computer runs B. ability of the software to be transferred from one
D. During the return of the data to the user department environment to another.
520. Electronic data interchange (EDI) is an application C. capability of software to maintain its level of
system: performance under stated conditions.
A. that performs based on business needs and activities. D. relationship between the level of performance of the
B. that provides utility programs for a limited number of software and the amount of resources used.
application systems. 526. Which of the following statements relating to business
process reengineering (BPR) is FALSE?
600 Questions Pg 39
A. A key factor in a successful BPR is to define the areas A. Parity bits
to be reviewed and to develop a project plan. B. Check digits
B. An IS auditor is concerned with the key controls that C. Batch headers
exist in the new business process and not those that D. Trailer records
once existed. 535. Which of the following would an IS auditor do FIRST
C. Management is responsible for implementing and after the discovery of a Trojan Horse program in the
monitoring the new process. computer system?
D. Advantages of BPR are usually realized when the A. Investigate the author.
reengineering process appropriately suits the B. Remove any underlying threats.
business and risk. C. Establish compensating controls.
527. Compensating controls are intended to: D. Have the offending code removed.
A. reduce the risk of an existing or potential control 536. Which of the following database administrator activities
weakness. is unlikely to be recorded on detective control logs?
B. predict potential problems before they occur. A. Deletion of a record
C. remedy problems discovered by detective controls. B. Change of a password
D. report errors or omissions. C. Disclosure of a password
528. Anti-virus software should be used as a: D. Changes to access rights
A. detective control. 537. The editing/validation of data entered from a remote site
B. preventive control. would be MOST effectively performed at the:
C. corrective control. A. central processing site after application program
D. compensating control. processing.
529. Which of the following types of data validation and B. central processing site during application program
editing are used to determine if a field contains data, and processing.
not zeros or blanks? C. remote processing site after transmission to the
A. Check digit central processing site.
B. Existence check D. remote processing site prior to transmission to the
C. Completeness check central processing site.
D. Reasonableness check 538. Application controls are NOT designed to control the:
530. Edit controls are considered to be: A. error log.
A. preventive controls. B. user.
B. detective controls. C. transmittal control.
C. corrective controls. D. data processing environment.
D. compensating controls. 539. A basic control in a real-time application system is a(n):
531. Which of the following provides the ability to verify data A. audit log.
values through the stages of application processing? B. console log.
A. Programmed controls C. terminal log.
B. Run-to-run totals D. transaction log.
C. Limit checks on calculated amounts 540. A system user wrote a routine into a payroll application
D. Exception reports that searched his own payroll number. As a result, if this
532. Which of the following is intended to reduce the amount payroll number should ever fail to appear during the
of lost or duplicated input? payroll application run, a special routine would generate
A. Hash totals random numbers that would be placed onto every
B. Check digits paycheck. This routine is known as:
C. Echo checks A. scavenging.
D. Transaction codes B. data leakage.
533. Software that maintains audit trails for an application C. piggybacking.
system may pose control concerns if: D. a Trojan Horse.
A. user-IDs are recorded in the audit trail. 541. Which of the following is NOT an objective of
B. the details cannot be amended by the security application controls?
administrator. A. Detection of the cause of exposure
C. date time stamps are recorded indicating when B. Analysis of the cause of exposure
actions occurred. C. Correction of the cause of exposure
D. users can amend audit trail records when correcting D. Prevention of the cause of exposure
system errors. 542. In order to prevent the loss of data during the processing
534. Which of the following would NOT be used as a cycle, the FIRST point at which control totals should be
completeness check? implemented would be:
600 Questions Pg 40
A. during data preparation. 550. Procedures for controls over processing include:
B. in transit to the computer. A. hash totals.
C. between related computer runs. B. reasonableness checks.
D. during the return of the data to the user department. C. online access controls.
543. A user connected to a LAN has introduced a newly D. before and after image reporting.
released virus to the network while copying files from a 551. A tax calculation program maintains several hundred
floppy disk. Which of the following would be the MOST tax rates. The BEST control to ensure that tax rates
effective control in detecting the existence of the virus? entered into the program are accurate is:
A. Scan of all floppy disks before use A. independent review of the transaction listing.
B. Virus monitor on the network file server B. programmed edit check to prevent entry of invalid
C. Scheduled daily scan of all network drives. data.
D. Virus monitor on user's personal computer C. programmed reasonableness checks with 20% data
544. When installing new anti-virus software it is NOT entry range.
necessary to: D. visual verification of data entered by the processing
A. periodically update the software. department.
B. uninstall older versions of the software. 552. During an audit of the tape management system at a
C. install the new software on subsequently purchased data center an IS auditor discovered that some
machines. parameters are set to bypass or ignore the labels written
D. install the new software on every machine in the same on tape header records. However, the IS auditor did note
configuration. that there were effective staging and job set-up
545. Functional acknowledgements are used: procedures. In this situation the IS auditor would
A. as an audit trail for EDI transactions. conclude that the:
B. to functionally describe the IS department. A. tape header should be manually logged and checked
C. to document user roles and responsibilities. by the operators.
D. as a functional description of application software. B. staging and job set-up procedures are not appropriate
compensating controls.
546. An IS auditor who has discovered unauthorized
C. staging and job set-up procedures compensate for the
transactions and fraud during a review of EDI
tape label control weakness.
transactions is likely to recommend improving:
D. tape management system is putting processing at risk
A. EDI trading partner agreements.
and that the parameters must be set correctly.
B. environmental controls and a tested business
continuity plan. 553. An IS auditor reviewing database controls discovered
C. authentication techniques over sending and receiving that normal processing changes to the database were
messages. handled through a standard set of procedures. However,
D. general program change, operations and systems changes made after normal hours required only an
support controls. abbreviated number of steps. In this situation what
would be considered an adequate set of compensating
547. Which of the following is NOT an application control
controls?
likely to be found in an EDI interface?
A. Use of DBA user account to make the change.
A. Hash totals
B. Use of normal user account with access to make
B. Echo checks
changes to the database.
C. Record counts
C. Use of DBA user account to make changes, logging of
D. Validity checks
changes, as well as before and after image with the
548. Which of the following statements regarding the impact changes being reviewed the following day.
of EDI on internal controls is FALSE? D. Use of normal user account to make changes, logging
A. Security will be increasingly important. of change, as well as before and after image changes
B. Errors must be identified and followed up more being reviewed the following day.
quickly.
554. During a review of the accounts payable (A/P)
C. Fewer opportunities for review and authorization will
department the IS auditor discovered that user
exist.
departments failed to review all invoices prior to
D. IPF management will have increased responsibilities
submitting them for processing. This occurred because
over data center controls.
user departments were required to submit invoices to
549. A company disposing of personal computers that once A/P within three business days in order to take
were used to store confidential data should first: advantage of vendor discounts. Given this fact, which of
A. demagnetize the hard disk. the following control reviews should the IS auditor
B. low level format the hard disk. recommend to ensure that invoices were entered
C. delete all data contained on the hard disk. correctly and that discounts were correctly taken?
D. defragment the data contained on the hard disk. A. Ensure that invoices were reviewed by A/P.
600 Questions Pg 41
B. Ensure invoice copies are reviewed after they had methods is MOST effective to detect these unauthorized
been submitted to A/P. changes?
C. Ensure that invoice copies were compared to edit A. Source code comparison
reports that show invoice detail and discount B. Executable code comparison
information. C. Integrated Test Facilities (ITF)
D. Ensure that invoice copies were compared to edit D. Periodic review of transaction log files
reports that show invoice detail and discount 561. Following a recent reorganization of the company's
information prior to releasing the payment. legacy database, it was discovered that certain records
555. IS management has recently informed the IS auditor of were accidentally deleted. Which of the following
its decision to disable certain referential integrity controls would have MOST effectively detected this
controls in the payroll system to provide users with a occurrence?
faster report generator. This will MOST likely increase A. Range check
the risk of: B. Table look-ups
A. data entry by unauthorized users. C. Run-to-run totals
B. a non-existent employee being paid. D. One-for-one checking
C. an employee receiving an illegal raise. 562. A company has recently upgraded its legacy purchase
D. duplicate data entry by authorized users. system, enabling EDI transmissions. Which of the
556. Which of the following message services provides the following controls should be implemented in the EDI
strongest protection that a specific action has occurred? interface in order to provide for efficient data mapping?
A. Proof of delivery A. Key verification
B. Non-repudiation B. One-for-one checking
C. Proof of submission C. Manual recalculations
D. Message origin authentication D. Functional acknowledgements
557. The primary reason for replacing checks (cheques) with 563. Which of the following would NOT be a specific control
electronic funds transfer (EFT) systems in the accounts aspect in an ongoing applications review of an enterprise
payable area is to: resource planning (ERP) package?
A. make the payment process more efficient. A. Authorization of change management procedures
B. comply with international EFT banking standards. B. ERP functional authorizations match user
C. decrease the number of paper-based payment forms. organizational tasks and responsibilities
D. reduce the risk of unauthorized changes to payment C. Risks associated to the implemented authorizations
transactions. from an internal control point of view
558. An IS auditor recommends that an initial validation D. Appropriate mapping of the organization's business
control should be programmed into a credit card process controls with the ERP package
transaction capture application. The initial validation 564. Sales orders are automatically numbered sequentially at
process would MOST likely: each of a retailer's multiple outlets. Small orders are
A. check that the type of transaction is valid for that card processed directly at the outlets, with large orders sent to
type. a central production facility. The MOST appropriate
B. verify the format of the number entered then locate it control to ensure that all orders transmitted to
on the database. production are received accurately would be to:
C. ensure that the transaction entered is within the A. send and reconcile transaction counts and totals.
cardholder's credit limit. B. have data transmitted back to the local site for
D. confirm that the card was not shown as lost or stolen comparison.
on the master file. C. compare data communications protocols with parity
559. A proposed transaction processing application is highly checking.
complex with many sources of data capture and many D. track and account for the numerical sequence of sales
different routes for output, in both paper and electronic orders at the production facility.
form. To ensure that transactions are not lost during 565. Which of the following is a compensating control to a
processing, the IS auditor is MOST likely to recommend programmer having access to accounts payable
the inclusion of: production data?
A. validation controls. A. Processing controls such as range checks and logic
B. internal credibility checks. edits
C. clerical control procedures. B. Reviewing accounts payable output reports by data
D. automated systems balancing. entry
560. A programmer managed to gain access to the production C. Reviewing system-produced reports for checks
library, modified a program that was then used to (cheques) over a stated amount
update a sensitive table in the payroll database and D. Having the accounts payable supervisor match all
restored the original program. Which of the following checks (cheques) to approved invoices
600 Questions Pg 42
566. Which of the following was NOT a critical or complete C. Data redundancy
step used to solve an organization's Year 2000 (Y2k) D. Data inaccuracy
problem? 572. Which of the following information valuation methods is
A. The Y2k problem must have been brought to the LEAST likely to be used during a security review?
attention and addressed by executive management. A. Processing cost
B. Y2k solutions should have solved internal problems B. Replacement cost
that would have occurred if software supporting C. Unavailability cost
major business applications were not corrected. D. Disclosure cost.
C. Testing to determine which applications would have
573. A sequence of bits appended to a digital document that
been affected and the changes that were needed were
is used to secure an e-mail sent through the Internet is
critical to solving the Y2k problem.
called a:
D. The IS auditor should have taken an aggressive
A. digest signature.
approach to reviewing management's Y2k strategic
B. electronic signature.
goals and planning to ensure the problem has been
C. digital signature.
addressed.
D. hash signature.
567. The use of a GANTT chart can:
574. Application controls ensure that when inaccurate data is
A. assist in project control.
entered into the system, the data is:
B. highlight project checkpoints.
A. accepted and processed.
C. ensure documentation standards.
B. accepted and not processed.
D. direct the post-implementation review.
C. not accepted and not processed.
568. Which of the following tests performed by an IS auditor D. not accepted and processed.
would be the MOST effective in determining compliance
575. The BEST method of proving the accuracy of an
with an organization's change control procedures?
electronically produced tax calculation is by:
A. Review software migration records and verify
A. detailed visual review and analysis of the source code
approvals.
of the calculation programs.
B. Identify changes that have occurred and verify
B. recreating program logic using generalized audit
approvals.
software to calculate monthly totals.
C. Review change control documentation and verify
C. preparing simulated transactions for processing and
approvals.
comparing to predetermined results.
D. Ensure that only appropriate staff can migrate
D. automatic flowcharting and analysis of the source
changes into production.
code of the calculation programs.
569. Which of the following statements pertaining to
576. An IS auditor performing a review of application
program evaluation review technique (PERT) is FALSE?
controls would evaluate the:
A. The initial step in designing a PERT network is to
A. efficiency of the application in meeting the business
define project activities and their relative sequence.
processes.
B. An analyst may prepare many diagrams before the
B. impact of any control weakness discovered.
PERT network is complete.
C. business processes served by the application.
C. PERT assumes a perfect knowledge of the times of
D. optimization in the use of the applications.
individual activities.
D. PERT assumes that activities can be started and 577. In integrated systems, input/output controls must be
stopped independently. reviewed in:
A. systems receiving output from other systems.
570. Given the typical risk ratings below, an IS auditor
B. systems sending output to other systems.
performing an independent risk rating of critical
C. systems sending and receiving data.
systems would rate a situation where functions could be
D. interfaces between the two systems.
performed manually, at a tolerable cost, for an extended
period of time as: 578. During a business process reengineering (BPR) of a
A. critical. financial institution's teller transaction activities an IS
B. vital. auditor should evaluate:
C. sensitive. A. the impact of removed controls.
D. non-critical. B. the cost of new controls.
C. BPR project plans.
571. A retail company recently installed data warehousing
D. continuous improvement and monitoring plans.
client software in multiple, geographically diverse sites.
Due to time zone differences between the sites, updates 579. Data quality in a data warehouse is achieved by:
to the warehouse are not synchronized. This will affect A. cleansing.
which of the following the MOST? B. restructuring.
A. Data availability C. ensuring the credibility of source data.
B. Data incompleteness D. transformation.
600 Questions Pg 43
580. A characteristic of a data warehouse is: A. All amounts are displayed back to the data entry
A. object orientation. clerk, who must verify them visually.
B. subject orientation. B. Prices outside the normal range should be entered
C. departmental specific. twice to verify data entry accuracy.
D. volatile databases. C. The system 'beeps' when price exceptions are entered
581. Which of the following is an implementation risk within and prints such occurrences on a report.
the process of decision support systems? D. A second-level password must be entered before a
A. Management control price exception can be processed.
B. Semi-structured dimensions 588. A general hardware control that helps to detect data
C. Inability to specify purpose and usage patterns errors when data are communicated from one computer
D. Changes in decision processes to another is known as a:
582. Once an organization has finished the business process A. duplicate check.
reengineering (BPR) of all its critical operations, the IS B. table look up.
auditor would MOST likely focus on a review of: C. validity check.
A. pre-BPR process flowcharts. D. parity check.
B. post-BPR process flowcharts. 589. An independent software program that connects two
C. BPR project plans. otherwise separate applications to share computing
D. continuous improvement and monitoring plans. resources across heterogeneous technologies is known
583. All of the following are input controls EXCEPT: as:
A. batch totals. A. middleware.
B. monetary totals. B. firmware.
C. run-to-run totals. C. software.
D. hash totals. D. embedded systems.
584. An IS auditor performing a review of the electronic 590. Using test data as part of a comprehensive test of
funds transfer (EFT) operations of a retailing company program controls in a continuous online manner is
would verify that the customers credit limit is verified called:
before funds are transferred by reviewing the EFT: A. test data/deck.
A. system's interface. B. base case system evaluation.
B. switch facility. C. integrated test facility (ITF).
C. personal identification number generating procedure. D. parallel simulation.
D. operation back-up procedures. 591. Which of the following ensures completeness and
585. A manufacturer has been purchasing materials and accuracy of accumulated data?
supplies for its business through an e-commerce A. Processing control procedures
application. Which of the following should this B. Data file control procedures
manufacturer rely on to prove that the transactions were C. Output controls
actually made? D. Application controls
A. Reputation 592. Access rules and logic are normally included in which of
B. Authentication the following documents?
C. Encryption A. Technical reference documentation
D. Non-Repudiation B. User manuals
586. A company uses a bank to process its weekly payroll. C. Functional design specifications
Time sheets and payroll adjustment forms (e.g., hourly D. System development methodology documents
rate changes, terminations) are filled in and delivered to 593. Which of the following represents the GREATEST
the bank, which prepares checks (cheques) and reports potential risk in an EDI environment?
for distribution. To BEST ensure payroll data accuracy: A. Transaction authorization
A. payroll reports should be compared to input forms. B. Loss or duplication of EDI transmissions
B. gross payroll should be recalculated manually. C. Transmission delay
C. checks (cheques) should be compared to input forms. D. Deletion or manipulation of transactions prior to or
D. checks (cheques) should be reconciled with output after establishment of application controls
reports. 594. The need for the modification of validation and editing
587. Prices are charged on the basis of a standard master file routines to improve efficiency is normally indicated by:
rate that changes as volume increases. Any exceptions A. excess overrides.
must be manually approved. What is the MOST effective B. an override activity report.
automated control to help ensure that all price C. error control and correction.
exceptions are approved? D. separation of duties.
600 Questions Pg 44
595. Which of the following application controls indicate 598. A control that detects transmission errors by appending
failures in input or processing controls? calculated bits onto the end of each segment of data is
A. Process control procedures known as a:
B. Data file control procedures A. reasonableness check.
C. Output control procedures B. parity check.
D. Data integrity tests C. redundancy check.
596. Which of the following translates e-mail formats from D. check digits.
one network to another so that the message can travel 599. Which of the following substantive tests examine the
through all the networks? accuracy, completeness, consistency and authorization
A. Gateway of data?
B. Protocol converter A. Data integrity test
C. Front-end communication processor B. Relational integrity test
D. Concentrator/multiplexor C. Domain integrity test
597. In an EDI process, the device which transmits and D. Referential integrity test
receives electronic documents is the: 600. Which of the following data validation edits is effective
A. communications handler. in detecting transposition and transcription errors?
B. EDI translator. A. Range check
C. application interface. B. Check digit
D. EDI interface. C. Validity check
D. Duplicate check
600 Questions Pg 45
Answers
1 D 56 B 111 C 166 B 221 A 276 B 331 C 386 A 441 C 496 D 551 A
2 D 57 A 112 C 167 D 222 B 277 A 332 C 387 C 442 D 497 A 552 C
3 D 58 A 113 D 168 B 223 A 278 D 333 B 388 B 443 A 498 A 553 C
4 C 59 A 114 D 169 A 224 C 279 B 334 C 389 A 444 A 499 A 554 D
5 C 60 D 115 C 170 C 225 D 280 C 335 C 390 C 445 B 500 A 555 B
6 C 61 A 116 C 171 A 226 B 281 A 336 A 391 A 446 C 501 B 556 B
7 D 62 D 117 B 172 B 227 D 282 C 337 B 392 A 447 A 502 C 557 A
8 A 63 D 118 B 173 D 228 A 283 D 338 B 393 B 448 B 503 A 558 B
9 D 64 C 119 D 174 A 229 C 284 B 339 D 394 A 449 A 504 A 559 D
10 A 65 B 120 B 175 D 230 B 285 A 340 D 395 B 450 A 505 D 560 D
11 C 66 B 121 A 176 A 231 B 286 B 341 A 396 C 451 C 506 D 561 C
12 B 67 B 122 D 177 D 232 D 287 A 342 D 397 D 452 D 507 C 562 D
13 A 68 C 123 A 178 B 233 D 288 A 343 C 398 B 453 B 508 D 563 D
14 A 69 A 124 B 179 A 234 A 289 A 344 A 399 D 454 B 509 B 564 A
15 B 70 C 125 B 180 C 235 A 290 A 345 B 400 B 455 C 510 C 565 D
16 C 71 B 126 D 181 A 236 C 291 C 346 A 401 A 456 D 511 B 566 B
17 A 72 A 127 A 182 A 237 D 292 A 347 D 402 A 457 C 512 A 567 A
18 C 73 D 128 C 183 A 238 C 293 C 348 C 403 C 458 C 513 D 568 B
19 B 74 A 129 C 184 D 239 C 294 A 349 A 404 A 459 D 514 C 569 C
20 B 75 B 130 C 185 A 240 B 295 B 350 D 405 B 460 D 515 B 570 C
21 C 76 C 131 A 186 D 241 A 296 C 351 A 406 A 461 D 516 C 571 B
22 B 77 B 132 A 187 B 242 A 297 A 352 C 407 C 462 B 517 B 572 A
23 C 78 C 133 D 188 D 243 A 298 C 353 C 408 A 463 C 518 A 573 C
24 A 79 D 134 B 189 B 244 B 299 C 354 C 409 C 464 C 519 A 574 C
25 D 80 D 135 C 190 A 245 C 300 C 355 C 410 C 465 D 520 A 575 C
26 B 81 A 136 C 191 D 246 C 301 C 356 D 411 D 466 B 521 C 576 B
27 C 82 A 137 C 192 D 247 B 302 D 357 B 412 B 467 D 522 A 577 C
28 B 83 B 138 C 193 D 248 C 303 D 358 B 413 A 468 C 523 B 578 A
29 D 84 C 139 B 194 D 249 B 304 B 359 D 414 A 469 D 524 C 579 C
30 C 85 D 140 C 195 C 250 A 305 B 360 C 415 C 470 B 525 A 580 B
31 B 86 B 141 A 196 B 251 A 306 B 361 D 416 C 471 A 526 B 581 C
32 A 87 D 142 C 197 A 252 D 307 B 362 C 417 D 472 A 527 A 582 A
33 A 88 A 143 C 198 A 253 B 308 B 363 A 418 C 473 A 528 B 583 C
34 C 89 B 144 D 199 B 254 B 309 A 364 D 419 C 474 A 529 C 584 A
35 C 90 C 145 C 200 C 255 A 310 A 365 D 420 D 475 C 530 A 585 D
36 A 91 C 146 B 201 A 256 C 311 C 366 D 421 B 476 D 531 B 586 A
37 B 92 B 147 A 202 C 257 A 312 A 367 A 422 D 477 D 532 A 587 D
38 C 93 D 148 B 203 B 258 C 313 C 368 D 423 D 478 D 533 D 588 D
39 B 94 C 149 C 204 D 259 C 314 C 369 C 424 D 479 B 534 B 589 A
40 D 95 D 150 A 205 D 260 A 315 A 370 A 425 C 480 C 535 D 590 B
41 C 96 D 151 D 206 C 261 C 316 A 371 D 426 D 481 D 536 C 591 A
42 A 97 A 152 C 207 A 262 D 317 A 372 B 427 D 482 C 537 D 592 A
43 D 98 C 153 C 208 B 263 B 318 A 373 A 428 A 483 B 538 D 593 A
44 D 99 B 154 A 209 D 264 A 319 A 374 A 429 D 484 C 539 D 594 A
45 A 100 B 155 D 210 D 265 C 320 B 375 C 430 C 485 A 540 D 595 D
46 A 101 D 156 C 211 D 266 A 321 C 376 C 431 C 486 C 541 B 596 A
47 B 102 D 157 C 212 A 267 B 322 B 377 A 432 C 487 A 542 A 597 A
48 B 103 D 158 D 213 A 268 C 323 A 378 D 433 C 488 C 543 C 598 C
49 C 104 A 159 A 214 B 269 C 324 A 379 A 434 B 489 B 544 B 599 A
50 C 105 B 160 D 215 C 270 D 325 A 380 C 435 B 490 A 545 A 600 B
51 A 106 A 161 C 216 D 271 B 326 A 381 D 436 A 491 A 546 C
52 D 107 B 162 C 217 D 272 A 327 A 382 A 437 B 492 C 547 B
53 C 108 D 163 B 218 B 273 B 328 A 383 C 438 B 493 C 548 D
54 A 109 C 164 C 219 D 274 A 329 C 384 A 439 B 494 C 549 A
55 A 110 A 165 B 220 D 275 D 330 D 385 B 440 C 495 A 550 B
600 Questions Pg 46